Identifying emotional factors for quantitative evaluation ...
Identifying factors that bridge the research into practice ...
Transcript of Identifying factors that bridge the research into practice ...
IDENTIFYING FACTORS THAT BRIDGE THE
RESEARCH INTO PRACTICE GAP IN INCLUSIVE
EDUCATION: AN ANALYSIS OF SIX CASE STUDIES
A thesis submitted in fulfilment of the requirements for the degree of Doctor of
Philosophy
at
Charles Sturt University
By
Christine Grima-Farrell
Diploma of Teaching, Bachelor of Education, Masters of Inclusive Education
Charles Sturt University
April, 2012
ii
Certificate of Authorship
I hereby declare that this submission is my own work and that, to the best of my
knowledge and belief, it contains no material previously published or written by
another person nor material which to a substantial extent has been accepted for the
award of any other degree or diploma at Charles Sturt University or any other
educational institution, except where due acknowledgment is made in the thesis.
Any contribution made to the research by colleagues with whom I have worked at
Charles Sturt University or elsewhere during my candidature is fully acknowledged.
I agree that this thesis be accessible for the purpose of study and research in
accordance with the normal conditions established by the Executive Director,
Library Services or nominee, for the care, loan and reproduction of theses.
Signature: Date:
iii
Acknowledgements
iv
Abstract
Advances in research on evidence-based practices for educating students with
disabilities have generated a strong knowledge base that can underpin efforts to
make classrooms more inclusive. Despite these advances, there remains a
significant gap between our accumulated knowledge about effective educational
practices and the extent to which they are utilized. This inability to bridge the
research to practice gap, has an adverse effect on the progress of inclusion in schools
and the ability of individual teachers to respond to the needs of all students. This
project built on prior knowledge and promoted a greater comprehension of the
factors that both enabled and interfered with the successful translation of research to
practice (RTP) in inclusive education, with a specific focus on the role of teacher
preparation.
The context for the study was a graduate (Masters level) teacher preparation course
in inclusive education designed specifically for a cohort of practicing graduate
teachers from a regional educational authority. The capstone experience for the
course was the design and implementation of an inclusive education intervention in
an applied setting. The year-long course project involved identifying and
implementing an approach to learning and /or teaching that had the potential to be
scaled up (i.e., used by other teachers and students) and sustained within the setting.
Six of the ten students in the cohort participated in the investigation that employed
an ex post facto case study approach to study their projects. Five case studies were
set in primary schools and one was set in a secondary school. The trajectory of each
case is described including projects that terminated after one year, those that were
sustained, those that scaled within a school and those that were scaled beyond a
single school setting.
v
The goals of this study were three fold. The first was to explore and then apply
the existing literature on RTP as a framework to investigate the six diverse RTP
cases conducted over a multi-year period (including some that are ongoing) in a
range of education settings. The second goal was to identify and explain factors that
contributed to the status of research based projects in practical application. This
included the explanation of factors that contributed to both the success and difficulty
in sustaining and scaling research-based innovation. The third goal of this research
was to expand upon RTP knowledge through validating and building upon these
assertions. As a result a specific focus on the role of graduate teacher preparation as
a vehicle for sustaining and scaling research based practice, was conducted to further
enhance the understanding of ways to create inclusive classrooms and schools.
vi
Table of Contents
Certificate of Authorship ............................................................................................... ii
Acknowledgements ........................................................................................................ iii
Abstract .............................................................................................................................. iv
List of Tables .................................................................................................................... xii
List of Figures ................................................................................................................. xiii
Purpose of this Study .................................................................................................... 14
Introduction ..................................................................................................................... 16
1.1. The Direction of this Investigation ....................................................................... 19 1.1.1. Exploration phase .................................................. Error! Bookmark not defined. 1.1.2. Explanation phase ................................................. Error! Bookmark not defined. 1.1.3. Expansion phase .................................................... Error! Bookmark not defined.
Chapter 2. .......................................................................................................................... 22
Review of the Literature .............................................................................................. 22
2.1. Inclusion ......................................................................................................................... 23 2.2. Research into Practice ............................................................................................... 28 2.3. The research to practice gap. .................................................................................. 29 2.4. Method employed to review the RTP literature .............................................. 30
2.4.1. Research into Practice ..................................................................................................... 41 1.1.1.1. 2.4.1.1 Research-to-Practice Commentary Claims and Assertions ....................... 42 1.1.1.2. 2.4.1.2. Related RTP intervention research ..................................................................... 45 1.1.1.3. 2.4.1.3. Professional Development and RTP .................................................................... 51 1.1.1.4. 2.4.1.4 Teacher Education and RTP .................................................................................... 60 1.1.1.5. 2.4.1.5 Comprehensive School Reform and research to practice .......................... 69
2.5. Concerns Based Adoption Model (CBAM) .......................................................... 81 2.6. Stages of Concern ........................................................................................................ 82 2.7. Levels of Use .................................................................................................................. 83 2.8. Innovation Components ........................................................................................... 85 2.9. Review of the literature ............................................................................................ 98 2.10. Literature review conclusion ................................................................................ 102
Chapter 3. Methods ................................................................................................. 106
3.1. Introduction ................................................................................................................ 106 3.2. Overview and Purpose of the Study .................................................................... 106
3.2.1. Exploration phase. ................................................. Error! Bookmark not defined. 3.2.2. Explanation phase. ................................................ Error! Bookmark not defined. 3.2.3. Expansion phase. ................................................... Error! Bookmark not defined.
3.3. Case Study Research Design .................................................................................. 110 3.4. Types of Case Studies ............................................................................................... 111
3.4.1. Causal comparative case study. ................................................................................. 115 3.4.2. Definition. ........................................................................................................................... 116
3.5. Five Components of Research Design (Yin, 1994) ......................................... 117
vii
3.5.1. A study’s question. .......................................................................................................... 117 3.5.2. A study’s propositions. .................................................................................................. 118 3.5.3. A study’s unit(s) of analysis. ....................................................................................... 118 3.5.4. A study’s linking data to propositions and criteria for interpreting findings.
118 3.6. Replication Within the Multiple Case Study Design ..................................... 122 3.7. Validity, Reliability and Trustworthiness in Case Study Research ......... 125
3.7.1. Reliability and validity. ................................................................................................. 125 3.7.2. Trustworthiness. .............................................................................................................. 126
3.8. Logical Positivism ..................................................................................................... 127 3.9. Triangulation ............................................................................................................. 133 3.10. Participant Researcher ........................................................................................... 134 3.11. Strengths and Limitations of a Causal-Comparative Case Study Design136
3.11.1. Strengths .......................................................................................................................... 137 3.11.2. Limitations ....................................................................................................................... 137
3.12. Data Collection Approaches .................................................................................. 139 3.13. Data Analysis .............................................................................................................. 143 3.14. Theoretical Propositions ....................................................................................... 143 3.15. Procedures .................................................................................................................. 145 3.16. Participants ................................................................................................................. 145 3.17. The Settings ................................................................................................................ 146 3.18. Phased Research Questions .................................................................................. 146 3.19. Data Collection Sequence ....................................................................................... 149 3.20. Literature Investigation - Factors Derived From Literature That
Contribute to the Status of Research Based Projects. .................................. 151 3.20.1. Interviews. ....................................................................................................................... 157 3.20.2. Survey. ............................................................................................................................... 157 3.20.3. Focus groups. .................................................................................................................. 158 3.20.4. Permanent product record. ...................................................................................... 159 3.20.5. Ethical and methodological implications. ........................................................... 160 3.20.6. Recording of results. .................................................................................................... 161
Chapter 4. ....................................................................................................................... 163
Results ............................................................................................................................. 163
4.1. Exploration Phase ..................................................................................................... 163 4.1.1. Exploration phase questions. ........................... Error! Bookmark not defined. 4.1.2. Explanation phase questions. ........................... Error! Bookmark not defined. 4.1.3. Expansion phase questions. .............................. Error! Bookmark not defined.
4.2. Introduction to the Background and Context of the Cases ........................ 166 4.2.1. Participants ........................................................................................................................ 168
4.3. Introduction to Individual Participant and Case Details ............................ 170 4.3.1. Case 1- Chris (Year 2- Curriculum-Based Measurement- DIBELS- Oral
Reading Fluency) ............................................................................................................................. 170 1.1.1.6. 4.4.1.1. My reported program implementation integrity ........................................ 173 1.1.1.7. 4.4.1.2. Results of the project ............................................................................................... 173 1.1.1.8. 4.4.1.3. Scaling up of the project ......................................................................................... 174
viii
4.3.2. Case 2- Mary (Kindergarten- Curriculum Based Measurement- DIBELS-
Initial Sound Fluency and Letter Naming Fluency) ........................................................... 174 1.1.1.9. 4.4.2.1. Mary’s reported project implementation integrity ................................... 177 1.1.1.10. 4.4.2.2. Results of the project ........................................................................................... 179 1.1.1.11. 4.4.2.3. Scaling up of the project ..................................................................................... 180
4.3.3. Case 3- Diane (Years 7 to 10- Curriculum- Based Measurement- Peer
Assisted Learning) ........................................................................................................................... 180 1.1.1.12. 4.4.3.1. Diane’s reported project implementation integrity ............................... 182 1.1.1.13. 4.4.3.2. Results of the project ........................................................................................... 183 1.1.1.14. 4.4.3.3. Scaling up of the project ..................................................................................... 184
4.3.4. Case 4- Wilma (Year 6- Curriculum-Based Measurement- DIBELS- Oral
Reading Fluency) ............................................................................................................................. 184 1.1.1.15. 4.4.4.1. Wilma’s program implementation integrity .............................................. 185 1.1.1.16. 4.4.4.2. Results of the project ........................................................................................... 186 1.1.1.17. 4.4.4.3. Scaling up of the project ..................................................................................... 186
4.3.5. Case 5- Sam (Year 1- Explicit Teaching as a practice for quality teaching)
187 1.1.1.18. 4.4.5.1. Sam’s reported program implementation integrity ............................... 189 1.1.1.19. 4.4.5.2. Results of the project ........................................................................................... 190 1.1.1.20. 4.4.5.3. Scaling of the project ............................................................................................ 192
4.3.6. Case 6- Meg (Year 3-Peer Assisted Learning- Spelling) ................................... 192 1.1.1.21. 4.4.6.1. Meg’s reported program implementation integrity ............................... 194 1.1.1.22. 4.4.6.2. Project results ......................................................................................................... 194 1.1.1.23. 4.4.6.3. Scaling of the project ............................................................................................ 195
4.4. Summary of the reported implementation integrity of the projects ...... 195 4.5. Summary of the status of the Projects ............................................................... 197
4.5.1. Definitions of Operational Categories: .................................................................... 197 4.5.2. Exploration Phase ............................................................................................................ 199 4.5.3. Exploration phase ............................................................................................................ 202
1.1.1.24. 4.6.3.1. What factors have been identified in literature that contributes to
sustaining RBP in inclusive educational settings? .......................................................................... 202 4.6. Factors identified by participants prior to the introduction of RTP
knowledge identified in the literature .............................................................. 209 What RTP factors were identified through initial teacher interviews? ..................... 209
4.7. Participant responses to the first round of interviews ............................... 210 4.7.1. Support ................................................................................................................................ 211
1.1.1.25. 4.8.1.1. Shared responsibility and accountability ................................................... 211 1.1.1.26. 4.8.1.2. Resources .................................................................................................................. 212 1.1.1.27. 4.8.1.3. Consistent and long term support.................................................................. 213 1.1.1.28. 4.8.1.4. Shared ownership and responsibility .......................................................... 214 1.1.1.29. 4.8.1.5. Shared goals ............................................................................................................. 215 1.1.1.30. 4.8.1.6. Technology ............................................................................................................... 216 1.1.1.31. 4.8.1.7. Leadership ................................................................................................................ 217
4.8. Teacher Education .................................................................................................... 219 4.8.1. Depth of knowledge ........................................................................................................ 220 4.8.2. Structure of the course .................................................................................................. 222 4.8.3. Collaboration and sufficient preparation .............................................................. 223
4.9. RTP factors not identified in the literature ..................................................... 225 4.9.1. Role of the student and the parents ......................................................................... 225
ix
4.10. RTP factor not identified by participants ........................................................ 226 4.11. Integrity of implementation ................................................................................. 227
4.11.1. Comparison of the RTP factors identified by individual participants and
the integrity of the implementation of their projects. ...................................................... 228 4.11.2. Summary of the Exploration Phase ....................................................................... 229
Chapter 5. Explanation Phase Results .............................................................. 231
5.1. Review of data collection tools ............................................................................ 232 5.2. Part 2 of the survey. ................................................................................................. 232 5.3. Semi structured interviews ................................................................................... 234 5.4. Explanation phase participant responses ....................................................... 235 5.5. Summary of the responses to Part 2 of the survey ....................................... 235 5.6. Support ......................................................................................................................... 239 5.7. Cross case comparison of support factors ....................................................... 241 5.8. Collaboration .............................................................................................................. 242 5.9. Cross case summary of collaboration factors ................................................. 244 5.10. Responsiveness of research .................................................................................. 245 5.11. Summary of cross case responsiveness of research factors ..................... 247 5.12. Participant responses to the written survey responses and the semi
structured interviews ............................................................................................. 248 5.13. Shared ownership and responsibility ............................................................... 248 5.14. Genuine questions and clear goals ..................................................................... 251 5.15. Scalability .................................................................................................................... 254 5.16. Substantive and ongoing communication ........................................................ 257 5.17. Consistent long-term support that considers the personal qualities of
stakeholders ............................................................................................................... 259 5.18. Resources and training ........................................................................................... 264 5.19. Reward and acknowledgement ........................................................................... 266 5.20. Technology .................................................................................................................. 266 5.21. Projects viewed as credible by stakeholders ................................................. 269 5.22. Limiting of competing demands .......................................................................... 270 5.23. Sufficient and ongoing instructional time, preparation and resources 275 5.24. Complete, practical and accessible ..................................................................... 277 5.25. Teacher education .................................................................................................... 278 5.26. Collaboration .............................................................................................................. 281 5.27. Responsive to change .............................................................................................. 284 5.28. The implementation and sustainment of research based projects is an
ongoing process ......................................................................................................... 286 5.29. Summary of the factors identified by participants during the explanation
phase ............................................................................................................................. 286 5.30. Comparison of the data collected through the explanation and
exploration phases ................................................................................................... 288 5.30.1. Chris ................................................................................................................................... 288 5.30.2. Mary ................................................................................................................................... 290 5.30.3. Diane .................................................................................................................................. 292 5.30.4. Wilma ................................................................................................................................. 294 5.30.5. Sam ..................................................................................................................................... 296
x
5.30.6. Meg ...................................................................................................................................... 298 5.31. Summary ...................................................................................................................... 301 5.32. Explanation phase results across the six cases .............................................. 303 5.33. Key RTP factors and their connections ............................................................. 303
5.33.1. Masters Course/Teacher Education...................................................................... 303 5.33.2. Collaboration .................................................................................................................. 304 5.33.3. Leadership ....................................................................................................................... 306 5.33.4. Time .................................................................................................................................... 307 5.33.5. Feedback ........................................................................................................................... 307 5.33.6. Project scalability with a complete approach ................................................... 308
Expansion Phase Results .......................................................................................... 309
6.1. Summary of the structure of the focus group ................................................. 310 6.2. Key RTP priorities identified through the connections of the RTP factors
.......................................................................................................................................... 311 6.3. Collaboration and feedback .................................................................................. 312
6.3.1. Focus group questions ................................................................................................... 312 6.3.2. Responses ........................................................................................................................... 312
6.4. Leadership ................................................................................................................... 320 6.4.1. Focus group questions ................................................................................................... 320 6.4.2. Responses ........................................................................................................................... 320
6.5. Project scalability with a complete approach and time .............................. 324 6.5.1. Focus group question ..................................................................................................... 324 6.5.2. Responses ........................................................................................................................... 324
6.6. Masters Course/Teacher Education ................................................................... 330 6.6.1. Focus group question ..................................................................................................... 330
6.7. Summary of the consistencies identified through the focus group......... 334 6.8. Inconsistencies identified by participants ....................................................... 336 6.9. Summary of the results collected during the expansion phase ................ 337 6.10. Overview of the results collected through the three phases of this study
.......................................................................................................................................... 338 6.11. Relationship of factors that contributed to the extinction of two
individual RTP cases ................................................................................................ 345 6.12. Connections between RTP factors that were consistently identified by
participants ................................................................................................................. 349 6.12.1. Ways that were consistently described to engage people and enable them
to work to their capacity to create effective inclusive environments ........................ 350 Ways to engaging schools and universities in effectively preparing teachers
.......................................................................................................................................... 354 Ways that effective projects and content can enable the engagement of
multiple interrelationships to be enacted in ways to meet the diverse
needs of multiple stakeholders ............................................................................ 356
Discussion and Conclusion ...................................................................................... 359
1.1. Overview of the three phases of this study ...................................................... 359 6.12.2. Exploration Phase ......................................................................................................... 361 6.12.3. Explanation phase ........................................................................................................ 365 6.12.4. Expansion phase ............................................................................................................ 372
xi
6.12.5. Summative overview of the data collected through the three phases of
this study ............................................................................................................................................. 379 1.2. Introduction of the RTP Model............................................................................. 382 RTP model .............................................................................................................................. 384
6.12.6. Description of the RTP model and the complex and cyclic interconnection
between the identified components ........................................................................................ 385 6.13. Examples of the application of the RTP Model ............................................... 387 6.14. Future utility of the RTP Model ........................................................................... 390
6.14.1. Summary .......................................................................................................................... 394 6.15. Limitations of the study and recommendations for future research ..... 396 6.16. Conclusion ................................................................................................................... 398
Chapter 7. References ............................................................................................ 403
xii
List of Tables
Table 3.1 The 3x2 table below displays Yin’s (1993, p.5) six different types of
case studies 114
Table Page
2.1 Effective Research Based Programs 14
2.2 Research to Practice Key Themes and Related Factors 54
2.3 Consistency and development of RTP literature based within
and across identified areas 58
3.1 Yin’s Six Different Types of Case Studies 67
3.2 Data Collection Tools, Advantages and Limitations 84
3.3 Participant Information and Case Study Number 88
3.4 Case Setting Details 88
3.5 Data Collection Sequence and details 92
xiii
List of Figures
Figure 2.1 Literature review road map Error! Bookmark not defined.
Figure Page
2.1 Literature Review road map 12
3.2 Operational Pathway 69
3.3 Overview Linking Yin’s (1994) Components of Research Design 71
3.4 Replication Logic 73
3.5 Case Study Validity Tactics 77
3.6 Convergence of Multiple Data Sources of Evidence 78
3.7 Multiple Causal-Comparative Case Study Design Research
and Question Overview 90
14
Purpose of this Study
The core motive which underpinned this study was the demand for educators to be
responsive to inclusion as a movement through the use of research based practice to
bridge the research to practice gap (Ashman & Elkins, 2011; DETYA, 2000;
Disability Standards, 2005; Foreman, 2005; Fullen et. al., 1998; Innes, 2007; Singal,
2008; Slee, 2005; Westling & Hobbs, 1998; Villa & Thousand, 2000).
This research responded to the call for more effective practice based knowledge on
the translation of research to practice by investigating projects that were the capstone
experience of a graduate level teacher education program. A number of factors have
been presented as contributors to the gap between research and practice. They
include research not being designed to make a practical difference (Billups, 1997;
Carnine, 1997; Foegan, Espin, Allinder, & Markell, 2001; Malouf & Schiller, 1995;
Sydoriak & Fields, 1997), and inadequate linkages between teacher preparation
programs and the workplace (Bain, 2004; Grima-Farrell, Bain & McDonoagh, 2011;
Goodlad, 1990; Morrissey, 1997).
This study determined whether a series of applied research based projects, required
as part of a graduate teacher preparation experience, were implemented, sustained or
scaled. In doing so it identified the factors that contributed to the status of the
projects over time. The study employed prior knowledge of factors that contributed
to the successful translation of research to practice and sought to identify new
sources of influence. In summary the purpose of the study was to develop a greater
understanding of ways in which education programs and educators could promote
and foster the use of valuable research to enhance inclusion. This knowledge should
15
assist teachers in successfully responding to diversity in classrooms, schools and
systems. This study presented the critical factors, asserted by researchers and
educators, that could be used in research to practice projects to enhance the sustained
use of effective research based applications. Knowledge of these factors could also
influence the way graduate teacher education programs are designed to bridge the
gap between research and practice.
16
Introduction
A well-documented global movement exists which urges educators to make schools,
and classrooms more responsive to the needs of all children (Ashman & Elkins,
2011; Darling-Hammond, 2011; Disability Standards, 2005; Foreman, 2005; Fullan
et.al, 1998; Hattie, 2011; Loreman, Deppeler & Harvey, 2011; Slee, 2005; Villa &
Thousand, 2000; Westling & Hobbs, 1998). Advances in research on evidence-
based practices for educating students with a diverse range of abilities has
contributed to a strong knowledge base that can be employed to underpin efforts to
make classrooms more inclusive (Cunningham & Cunningham, 1992; Cunningham
& Hall, 1994a, 1994b; Delquadri, Greenwood, Whorton, Carta, & Hall, 1986; Fuchs
& Fuchs, 1998; Gersten & Vaughn, 1997a, 1997b; Harry, Allen & McLauglin, 1995;
Klingner, Vaughn, & Schumm, 1998; Lloyd, Weintraub & Safer, 1997; Loreman,
Deppeler & Harvey, 2011; Mastropieri & Scruggs, 1998; Mathes & Fuchs, 1993;
Vaughn, 2000; Vaughn, Klingner & Hughes, 2000).
Best practice examples that promote inclusion, through making classrooms more
responsive to students’ needs, include cooperative learning, explicit teaching, peer
tutoring, direct instruction, Curriculum Based Assessment (CBA) and Curriculum
Based Measurement (CBM) (Deno, 2003; Golder, Norwich, & Bayliss, 2005; Good,
Kaminski, Simmons, Kame'enui, & Oregon School Study Council, 2001; Good,
Simmons, & Kame'enui, 2001; Griffin & Warden, 2006; Hattie, 2009; The ERIC
clearinghouse on disabilities and gifted education, 2003; Villa & Thousand, 1996c).
These approaches have been shown to improve the achievement of all students and
17
are essential for differentiating the content, process and product of classroom
instruction (Fraser et al, 1987; Hattie, 2003; Marzano, 1998; Tomlinson, 2004;).
This body of knowledge on inclusion has the capacity to make curriculum, materials,
school and classroom environments more responsive to students from different
backgrounds with different learning styles. This knowledge should significantly
reduce segregation based on performance levels or perceived abilities (Ashman &
Elkins, 2011; Cunningham & Cunningham, 1992; Cunningham & Hall, 1994a,
1994b; Delquadri, et al, 1986; Good, Kaminski, Simmons, Kame’enui, 2001; Good,
Simmons and Kame’enui, 2001; Klingner, Vaughn, & Schumm, 1998; Mathes &
Fuchs, 1993; Vaughn et al., 2000; Harry, Allen & McLauglin, 1995, Gersten, et al.,
1997; Lloyd et al., 1997; Loreman, Deppeler & Harvey, 2011; Fuchs & Fuchs, 1998;
Mastropiere & Scruggs, 1998; Vaughn, 2000). Despite these advances in research,
there remains a significant gap between our accumulated knowledge about effective
inclusive educational practices and the extent to which they are utilized (Foegan et
al., 2001; Forness et al., 1997; Grima-Farrell et. al., 2011; Vaughn et al., 2000;
Billups, 1997; Carnine, 1997). Klingner (2001) suggested that even when
instructional practices specifically designed for heterogeneous classrooms have been
implemented with positive outcomes, there is no guarantee that they will be
sustained and most frequently they are not.
This inability to ‘bridge the gap’ between research and practice is well documented
(Abbott, Walton, Tapia, & Greenwood, 1999; Carnine, 1997; Gersten, Vaughn,
Deshler, & Schiller, 1997; Grima-Farrell et. al., 2011; Kauffman, 1993; Korthagen,
2007; Malouf & Schiller, 1995; National Joint Committee on Learning Disabilities,
18
1999; Richardson, 1996; Stanovich & Stanovich, 1997). It has had an adverse effect
on the progress of inclusion in schools and the ability of individual teachers to
respond to the needs of all students. International efforts to improve the use of
research to address the diverse needs of classrooms and schools has generated
extensive literature on inclusion, best practice, professional development and school
reform (Bain, 2007b; Daniels & Vaughn, 1999; Darling-Hammond, 2011; Darling-
Hammond, Dozer, Johnston, & Rogers, 2006; Deno, 2003; Epstein, 1996; Francis,
2002; Golder, et al., 2005; Griffin & Warden, 2006; Gunstone & Northfield, 1993; J.
K. Klingner, S. Ahwee, P. Pilonieta, & R. Menendez, 2003; Schneider & McDonald,
2006; Shallcross, Loubser, Le Roux, O'Donoghue, & Lupele, 2006; Wanat, 1999).
This challenge of implementing, sustaining and scaling research efforts in
classrooms and schools remains largely unresolved for both educators and
researchers.
Much has been written about the challenge of narrowing the gap between ‘theory' or
research and practice as a major problem in education (Abbott, Walton, Tapia, &
Greenwood, 1999; Carnine, 1997; Gersten, Vaughn, Deshler, & Schiller, 1997;
Kauffman, 1993; Malouf & Schiller, 1995; Korthagen, 2007; Korthagen, 2010;
Richardson, 1996; Schultz, 2010; Stanovich & Stanovich, 1997). Few studies have
generated objective evidence about the specific factors that affect the implementation
and sustainability of these practices in classroom and school applications (Billups,
1997; Brouwer & Korthagen, 2005; Darling-Hammond & Baratz-Snowden, 2007;
Francis, 2002; D. Fuchs & L. S. Fuchs, 1998; Gersten, Chard, & Baker, 2000). The
19
predominance of literature in the area is based upon opinion and commentary
derived from the reflections and insights of researchers.
In order to build a more complete understanding of the factors that contribute to RTP
a need to investigate and develop the assertions made in commentary pieces through
applied intervention research was required. Areas posited in the RTP literature that
were attributed to impacting RTP efforts included; the integrity with which research
is implemented, the responsiveness of research to the needs of classrooms and
schools, the extent to which feedback is embedded and the completeness or
comprehensiveness of the design. These assertions required investigation through
empirical research for their validation as significant contributors to RTP efforts. A
deeper understanding of these factors could inform teacher preparation programs and
enhance the use of research-based practices to address the needs of all students.
1.1. The Direction of this Investigation
This investigation consisted of three phases; an exploration, explanation and
expansion phase. The initial exploration phase focused heavily on instantiating
factors identified in the existing literature as influences on direct six RTP cases. The
second phase was an explanation phase that built on the exploration phase to broaden
the comprehension of RTP efforts through directly examining the range of specific
RTP cases. The final, expansion phase, built on this accumulated RTP knowledge
and provided an opportunity for an open discussion which identified consistencies
and the recognition of additional factors that resulted from direct RTP experiences.
20
This approach explored, explained and expanded the understanding of the factors
that contributed to the status of research-based projects as a way of enhancing and
sustaining validated RTP efforts. The overarching research question was planned to
be answered through the research questions below which are presented in the
respective exploration, explanation and expansion phases. The data collected through
each of these phases was analyzed and used to inform the direction of the data
collection through the subsequent stages. Given this methodological approach, the
original research questions were modified and the additions to the original research
questions are represented by the italic text.
1.1.1. Overarching Research Question
What are the factors and relationships between them that contributed to the status of
research-based projects in inclusive education settings?
1.1.2. Exploration phase questions.
What factors that have been identified in previous literature contribute to sustaining
RBP in inclusive education settings? How have these factors been identified? To
what extent have these factors been validated through empirical research? What are
the existing key RTP gap contributors identified through initial teacher perception?
How do they compare to existing literature?
1.1.3. Explanation phase questions.
How do factors identified in the cases contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive
education settings? In what ways do those factors exert an influence?
21
Additional question established after the analysis of the data collection through the
exploration and explanation phases- How have the identified relationship between
factors exerted an influence on the practical application and sustainment of the
projects?
1.1.4. Expansion phase questions.
What factors, other than those identified in the exploration and expansion phases,
contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive education settings?
Additional question established after the analysis of the data collection through the
exploration and explanation phases- What were the differences and consistencies in
the relationships between the RTP factors that contributed to the status of the
projects that were identified by the research participants?
22
Chapter 2.
Review of the Literature
The discussion of research into practice is extensive, yet there are few empirical
studies specifically focused on the factors impacting upon the translation of research
to practice in inclusive education settings. This review integrates, in a narrative
approach, the larger commentary literature with a smaller number of related research
studies.
This literature review is presented in three sections. The first section defines and
describes the area of inclusion in order to situate the study and explain the content,
context and circumstances for the research to practice issues investigated. The
parameters of the review are set within this area of inclusion to include five main
bodies of literature that strive to link educational research and practice efforts. These
parameters were derived from key RTP factors that were consistently presented in
the literature.
The second section presents the consistencies in the five bodies of literature to
identify the RTP factors in existing literature that are reported to contribute to the
status of research based projects. This literature, while limited in terms of direct
RTP examples, explored the areas of Research to Practice (RTP), Professional
Development (PD), Teacher Education (TE), Comprehensive School Reform (CSR)
and Concerns Based Adoption Model (CBAM). The PD and TE searches focussed
specifically on the translation of research to practice. The CSR literature was
examined as it constituted a large-scale effort, with guidelines specifically requiring
23
the implementation of research based practices at scale. The CBAM was explored as
it represented a prolifically used longstanding model related to adopting change.
The purpose of including CSR and CBAM was to go further in identifying more
specific factors not generated by the RTP, PD and TE literature. Figure 2.1 presents
a visual representation of the path this literature review travelled within an inclusive
education framework as the investigation of one body of literature led to the next.
The third section of the review offers a summary within each area of the literature
and is followed by an overview that reconciles key themes and factors for
consideration when addressing RTP in inclusive education settings. It concludes with
two tables. Table 2.1 presents a summary of the literature included in this review.
Table 2.2 is a comprehensive table that presents the consistency and expansion of
RTP factors within identified themes, across the five bodies of literature.
Figure 2.1 Literature review road map
2.1. Inclusion
It is acknowledged that Inclusive Education has a range of interpretations both
nationally and internationally and debates concerning its definition and ownership
exist. For the purpose of this study notions of inclusive education are aligned with
those presented in the Salamanca Statement and Framework for Action (UNESCO,
1994). The Statement re-affirms every individual’s right to education. It also
supports the 1993 UN Standard Rules on the Equalisation of Opportunities, which
RTP PD TE CSR CBAM
24
states that the education of children with disabilities should be an integral part of
education systems.
Through this study inclusion is referred to as a commitment to educate students with
disabilities in high quality, age appropriate, general education classrooms in their
local communities (Allen & Cowdery, 2011; Ashman & Elkins, 2011; Duhany,
1999; O'Neil, 1994; Loreman, Deppeler & Harvey, 2011; Smith, Polway, Patton, &
Dowdy, 1998). Foreman (2005) states that inclusion is based on the philosophy that
schools should provide for the needs of all students in their communities regardless
of their abilities or disabilities. Inclusive schools welcome, celebrate and cater for
diversity ensuring that all students share the same rights and have the opportunity to
reach their full potential (Villa and Thousand, 2000, p.37). Over the two past
decades, efforts to make classrooms more responsive to the needs of diverse learners
have produced educational guidelines, policies and ethical standards that frame
efforts to create inclusive learning environments for all students (Allen & Cowdery,
2011; Duhaney, 1999; Gartner & Lipsky, 1987; Gottlieb, 1981; Loreman, Deppeler
& Harvey, 2011; McLaughlin & Warren, 1992). The aim of those efforts was
to provide the conditions whereby students experience a sense of belonging, mastery
and independence in inclusive classroom and school settings.
This aim is strengthened by a global movement focused on supporting students with
disabilities in mainstream settings. Innes (2007) highlighted the strong international
support for catering for the rights of people with disabilities, in stating that on the
30th March 2007, Australia and 80 other countries supported the Disability
Convention at the United Nations (UN) in New York. The Disability Convention
25
received the greatest number of signatures of any international convention on its first
day. With such a well-supported drive for the inclusion of all students, empowering
teachers who are at the forefront of making these inclusive visions a reality should be
a priority.
A strong body of research evidence on programs and interventions that cater for
student diversity and inclusive efforts exist. This includes research into Curriculum
Based Measurement (CBM) of reading which has developed at a rapid rate over the
past decade (Allinder & Beckbest, 1995; Capizzi & Fuchs, 2005; Deno, 2003; D.
Fuchs & L. S. Fuchs, 1998; Lembke & Espin, 2005; Madelaine & Wheldall, 2004;
Martens, et al., 2007; McGlinchey & Hixson, 2004; Stecker, Fuchs, & Fuchs, 2005).
Strong evidence of the technical characteristics, validity and positive effects of CBM
of reading has been produced. Validated effective math’s instructional techniques,
peer mediation, cognitive strategies, direct instruction and co-operative learning
strategies are also documented in a variety of applications (Allinder & Beckbest,
1995; Capizzi & Fuchs, 2005; Martens, et al., 2007) Faykus & McCurdy, 1998;
Fuchs et al, 1992; Jenkins and Jewell, 1993; Skin et al, 2000; Noble, 2010).
Despite the solid research base supporting the overwhelming benefits of CBM, direct
instruction, co-operative learning techniques, peer tutoring and other research based
intervention techniques, the implementation of these strategies has varied
considerably (Allinder & Swain, 1997; L. S. Fuchs & D. Fuchs, 1998; Miller,
George, & Fogt, 2005; Swain & Allinder, 1996) Noble, 2010). Many studies have
highlighted the advantages of these interventions (predominantly in American
schools), however there is a limited body of research available that provides
26
evidence that these validated interventions are extensively employed and sustained
by teachers in school settings (Eckert et al., 1995: Hasbrouk et al., 1999; Hattie,
2009).
While the policy frameworks exist to encourage the widespread implementation of
strategies including peer tutoring, co-operative learning, direct instruction and
curriculum based measurement; their articulation in practice has remained an
immense challenge (Crocket & Kauffman, 1998; Hattie, 2009; Lipsky & Gartner,
1998; Korthagen, 2007; Korthagen, 2010; Schultz, 2010; Shanker, 1995; Zigmond &
Baker, 1996). The translation of research into practice is a complex process
involving change at all levels of the school and system. Forlin (2007) states that for
inclusive education to become a reality, teachers need to be sufficiently trained and
willing to support this reform (Darling-Hammond, 2011; Forlin & Lian, 2008;
Wilczenski, 1992).
A range of teacher training sources exists for the purpose of sustaining and scaling
research into practice. Some of these training experiences include PD events led by
school systems or consultants as well as university pre service and graduate teacher
education programs. Teacher education has been presented throughout the literature
as a key source of educational change in a range of areas including RTP (Brouwer &
Korthagen, 2005; Darling-Hammond, 2006a; Gravani, 2008; Kochanek, 2005;
Simmons, et al., 2000). It is especially pertinent to this study as all participants
experienced the same Masters of inclusive education program and it represented an
avenue that collaboratively linked school and university RTP efforts (Capizzi &
Fuchs, 2005; Darling-Hammond & Baratz-Snowden, 2007; D. Fuchs & L. S. Fuchs,
27
1998; Golder, et al., 2005; Gravani, 2008; Korthagen, 2004; Winn & Zundans,
2004b). Knowledge of factors that promote the implementation and sustainment of
research based practices may promote the use of comprehensive and appropriate
education programs to assist children with and without disabilities through the
merger of resources, knowledge, and talents of general and special educators (Lipsky
& Gartner, 1998; Sailor, et al., 1993; Stainback & Stainback, 1991).
In brief for the purpose of this review inclusion is referred to as the commitment to
educate each child, to the maximum extent appropriate, in the school and classroom
he or she would otherwise attend (Sailor, 1991; Rogers, 1993). Inclusion is the right
of all individuals with disabilities to be included in naturally occurring settings and
activities with their siblings and neighbourhood peers (Allen & Johnson, 2012;
Ashman & Elkins, 2011; Erwin, 1993). This approach requires educators to respond
to the diversity of student needs in ways that are beneficial to students with and
without disabilities. Through raising awareness of the factors that have supported the
implementation and sustainment of research based strategies, educators and
researchers may gain a deeper understanding of ways to use research to cater for the
needs of an increasing range of diverse learners in mainstream settings (Korthagen,
2007; Sharma, et. al., 2006).
This approach to inclusive education represents a whole school concern that strives
to align special education with all other school-based resources, including general
education in a manner that most effectively and efficiently imparts quality education
to all students (Lipsky & Gartner, 1997). Lipsky & Gardner’s (1997)
conceptualization of inclusion is of importance to research to practice initiatives, as
28
they both require education systems to respond to the diversity of all learners. The
following section strives to identify those factors critical to the implementing and
sustaining research in schools and classrooms. The data collection tools were
developed from the RTP factors collected through this literature review in an attempt
to bind the content, context and circumstances that link research to practice efforts in
diverse classroom applications.
2.2. Research into Practice
This RTP section of the literature review identified the unique challenges associated
with linking educational theory to practice in an inclusive education frame.
Explanation of the terms theory and research are presented to promote consistency in
the interpretation of terms through this investigation. Specifically, this section
explored the long standing concern that evidence based research knowledge is not
being used to its full potential in practical applications. This section identified the
need to narrow the gap between research and practice; this is especially compelling
and problematic in the area of inclusion (Mitchell, 2008).
It is acknowledged that the term theory is over interpreted to mean both theory and
research in RTP literature. The expression theory represents a depth of thought,
concepts and ideas that provide an explanation of how and why a phenomenon
exists. Research refers to the use of facts and information collected from the
gathering of data that has contributed to increased knowledge (Bogdan & Biklen,
1982; Miles & Huberman, 1994). The oversimplification and synonymous use of
these terms may be problematic. The purpose of this study was not to debate the
terminology issue but to acknowledge the way in which they have been conflated in
29
discussions of RTP issues and to clarify that for the purpose of this study the term
research to practice was investigated.
2.3. The research to practice gap.
The inability of educators to "bridge the gap" between our accumulated knowledge
about effective inclusive educational practices and the extent to which they are
utilized is well documented (Abbott, Walton, Tapia, & Greenwood, 1999; Carnine,
1997; Gersten, Vaughn, Deshler, & Schiller, 1997; Kauffman, 1993; Korthagen,
2007; Korthagen, 2010; Malouf & Schiller, 1995; National Joint Committee on
Learning Disabilities, 1999; Richardson, 1996; Stanovich & Stanovich, 1997).
While empirical evidence that directly examines these assertions does not exist,
relevant research that contributes to RTP knowledge has been identified. This
research included the investigation of a spectrum of intervention research examples
and large-scale reform efforts whose criteria was driven by the implementation of
research-based practices.
An initial broad literature search using the descriptor research into practice located
1158 references. Of these results, references were made to a wide range of areas
including public health, medical, alcohol and drug related fields and education. The
introduction of the term education as a descriptor narrowed the search to 440
references, yet public welfare, social services and medical care continued to feature
strongly in this set. Knowledge of the causes, cures and general assertions pertaining
to the RTP gap was largely based on commentary or position pieces. Many of these
claims included researchers drawing upon the cumulative experience of others in the
field to offer suggestions as to why the gap exists and ways to address these concerns
30
(Carnine, 1997b; Foegen, Espin, Allinder, & Markell, 2001; Gersten, et al., 2007a;
Gunstone & Northfield, 1993). No empirical research examples that directly
examined research into practice factors and experiences, using a number of research-
based programs across a variety of settings were identified. Given the lack of this
type of direct empirical investigation of RTP, the related work that focuses on RTP
commentary, research based interventions; recent school reform efforts and the
Concerns Based Adoption Model were used to guide this research.
2.4. Method employed to review the RTP literature
Relevant studies from 1967 to the present were located through an EBSCOhost
(Education) database search. EBSCOhost was selected as it included the most
complete selection of references with the least number of repeated entries. Studies
were included in this review if they appeared in a published peer-reviewed journal
and identified specific RTP, professional development (PD), teacher education (TE),
Comprehensive School Reform (CSR) or Concerns Based Adoption Model (CBAM)
factors which could be beneficial in translating the work of researchers to address the
needs of students in school settings.
Descriptors were introduced in the following sequence: research into practice (1158
references), inclusive education (limited results), education (440 references),
research to practice and education (80 results). Of the 80 articles located using the
terms research to practice and education, 29 were selected for this review as they
specifically discussed the use of research-based programs in primary, secondary and
university settings.
31
A second search was conducted regarding PD, as RTP is a common focus of PD
efforts although it is not treated in depth in many discussions (Ax, Ponte, &
Brouwer, 2008; Klingner, Vaughn, Arguelles, Hughes, & Leftwich, 2004;
Ysseldyke, 1989). The identification of relevant literature commenced with an all-
field search using research to practice, education and professional development as
descriptors. Of the 296 citations, many made only brief mention of RTP issues and
included work in fields of nursing, engineering and mental health. An abstract search
using the same descriptors identified eight articles that specifically presented detailed
discussions of PD as a comprehensive or longitudinal approach to address the RTP
gap in education. Articles that made reference to PD in fields other than education
and did not refer to the RTP gap were not selected for this review.
A third search was conducted in the area of teacher education. TE represented an
avenue that links the efforts of researchers and educators who work in inclusive
education environments to enhance RTP endeavours (Darling-Hammond, 2011;
Everington & Hamill, 1996; Golder, Norwich, & Bayliss, 2005; Korthagen, 2007;
Villa & Thousand, 1996). Like PD, TE was expected to have a RTP agenda,
however, the TE literature indicated that while RTP remains a concern, it was often
discussed in depth (Carnine, 1997; Darling-Hammond, 2006a; D. Fuchs & L. Fuchs,
1998; Gravani, 2008). An all-field search using research into practice and teacher
education as descriptors located 440 references. A review of the abstracts identified
that many references made only limited mention of RTP issues. Subsequently, this
search was refined through an abstract search using the same descriptors and located
90 references. These articles were scrutinised and 12 were located based on the
32
criteria that they must have made reference to TE and identified RTP factors. Of
these 12 references a refined search was conducted and 4 offered a sound
representation of RTP implementation factors as a result of TE efforts.
The review was expanded to gain additional knowledge on other factors that had an
impact on the RTP phenomenon and could inform the way research is established in
practice. Comprehensive school reform (CSR) and Concerns-Based Adoption
Model (CBAM) represent such approaches. These initiatives have the capacity to
deepen our comprehension of change elements through direct research examples and
in turn raise an awareness of related RTP factors.
A fourth search was conducted in the area of Comprehensive School Reform (CSR)
literature as it represents a large-scale effort whose guidelines specifically require the
implementation of Research based practices at scale. An all-field search using
comprehensive school reform as a descriptor located 1168 references. A review of
the abstracts identified that many references made only limited mention of RTP
issues. Subsequently, this search was refined through an abstract search using CSR
and implementation as descriptors, which located 110 references. This search was
further refined when program implementation replaced implementation as an
abstract search descriptor as it aimed to identify the implementation concerns that
may constitute RTP issues or factors. Of the 12 references that were located as a
result of this refined search 8 offered a sound representation of RTP implementation
factors as a result of CSR efforts.
33
The fifth and final search was conducted in the area of Concerns Based Adoption
Model as it represents a prolific longstanding model related to adopting change.
Increased knowledge of concerns associated with change may raise awareness of
ways to promote future RTP efforts. An all field search conducted using Concerns-
Based Adoption Model as a descriptor located 187 references. A review of the
abstracts identified that many references made only limited mention of RTP issues.
Subsequently, this search was refined through an all field search using Concerns-
Based Adoption Model and Program implementation as descriptors and located 25
references. These articles were scrutinised based on the criteria that they must have
made reference to CBAM and identified RTP factors. Many of these references
presented descriptive aspects of CBAM. A final search using Concerns-Based
Adoption Model, research and practice as descriptors in an abstract search located 6
references. Of these references 5 references presented a sound representation of
RTP implementation factors as a result of CBAM efforts.
34
Table 2.1
Overview of literature included for review.
Study Category Participants Focus area Major conclusions/RTP
factor
Foegen, Espin, Allinder, &
Markell (2001)
RTP 45 Preservice teachers Preservice teachers beliefs
about CBM
Researchers disseminate
their findings effectively
and practitioners review
research
Foorman & Moats (2004) RTP 1400 (K–4) Students from 17
low performing schools in
Houston and Columbia
Early reading instruction and
RTP
Trustworthiness and speed
of TE and PD were
obstacles to RTP
D. Fuchs & L. Fuchs (1998) RTP 7 teachers from Nashville
schools
Maths Peer Assisted
Learning Strategies (PALS)
Partnership survival
requires continuous work
Fuchs & Fuchs (2001) RTP Researchers and educators
working with 25 students
Maths Peer Assisted
Learning Strategies (PALS)
Inadequate teacher demand
for research
Vaughn, Klingner, & Bryant
(2001)
RTP Summary of Collaborative
Strategic Reading (CSR)
studies
Describes four CSR
strategies and the role of
peer-mediated instruction.
Supportive partnerships
promote trust in research
DETYA (2000)
RTP Comprises the following 5
studies
Research and its Impact on
Australian Schools
RTP Postgraduate students,
practitioners, principals,
professional associations,
policymakers
Mapped Australian
educational research using
Australian Education Index
(AEI)
TE requires engagement of
researchers and educators
Backtracking Practices and
Policies to Research
RTP Researchers and educators Appraised the influence of
research on educators
Marketing research
knowledge
35
Teacher Knowledge in
Action
RTP Teachers Analysed teachers’
explanations of the decisions
they made during a videoed
lesson
Shift in what is valued in
university work
Education Research in
Australia
RTP Institute of Scientific
Information (ISI) database
Assesses the international
visibility of Australian
educational research
Good attitudes and exposure
to practical research
The Selby Smith report
(1999)
RTP Review of literature and
multiple data sources
Adds the policy formulation
perspective in relation to
vocational education and
training
Modest influence of research
on policymakers
Gersten, Morvant, &
Brengelman (1995)
PD 12 classroom teachers from a
large inner city elementary
school
Coaching in reading for
students with learning
disabilities
Collaborative processes and
decision-making are
essential
Little & Houston (2003) PD Conceptual PD framework
by Florida’s DET and the
University of Central Florida
4-step model promoting
scientifically based practices
Relevance to classrooms,
support, collaboration of
researchers and educators
Gravani (2008) PD 22 teachers and 12 tutors Case study of experiences of
a university led in-service
training course
Importance of joint
partnerships between
universities and schools
Vaughn, Hughes, Klingner,
& Schumm (1998)
PD 7 general education and 5
special education teachers
A PD reading program to
enhance the usability of
research
Collaboration and balance
between responsibilities
between researchers and
teachers.
Klingner, Vaughn, Hughes,
& Arguelles (1999)
PD Follow-up study involving 7
teachers
Examined teachers’
implementation,
modification and
Responding to classroom
contexts and organisational
demands
36
sustainment of reading
practices
Klingner, Ahwee, Pilonieta,
& Menendez (2003)
PD 29 teachers from 6
elementary schools
Investigated reading
practices amongst teachers
Challenges of scaling of
research-based practices
identified
Gunstone & Northfield
(1993)
PD 21 high school science
teachers from 4 schools
Examining the intertwining
between research and
practice
Ongoing PD and its need to
be viewed as credible
Sparks & Richardson (1997) PD Analysis of 11 national
reports and resolutions
Examines effective staff
development and student
learning
PD is complex and
dependent of clear plans and
common goals
Darling-Hammond (2000)
TE Surveys, case study and the
National Assessment of
Educational Progress
Examined data to determine
ways TE and other school
factors related to student
achievement
Increased teacher’s abilities
and interests in research
increases student
achievement
Miller, George, & Fogt
(2005)
TE Case study of Centennial
School
Rigorous onsite TE program
using a teaming approach
Well articulated rationale,
leadership, staff commitment
and resources
Winn & Zundans (2004) TE 40 preservice teachers and
20 primary students
Literacy development
program for children at risk
Collaboration between the
schools and universities
Golder, Norwich, & Bayliss
(2005)
TE 223 postgraduate students
and 296 tutors
An initiative to enhance
differentiating instruction
Web-based resources
supported teaching
partnerships
Hurley, Chamberlain,
Slavin, & Madden (2001)
CSR 11 schools from Texas Comparison of state reading
measures across grades 3-5
Consistent commitment from
all teachers and leadership
Madden et al., (1993); Ross CSR 6000 students in control Comparison of student Increased results in research-
37
et al., (1995); Ross et al.,
(1997)
group/ 6000 in Success For
All (SFA) group from
Baltimore, Philadelphia,
Memphis, Tucson, Ft.
Wayne (IN), and Modesto
(CA)
results from high-poverty
schools within eleven school
districts with and without
implementation of SFA
based reading program
Borman, Hewes, Overman,
and Brown’s (2002)
CSR Meta analysis of 232 studies Achievement effects of
"whole-school" or
"comprehensive" reforms
Ongoing staff PD
75% staff approval rate
Replicable student
assessments
Mac Iver, Kemper and
Stringfield (2003)
CSR Two cohorts of students (in
kinder or grade 2 during
1996-97)
4-year study examining the
implementation of the
Baltimore Curriculum
Project (BCP) in six
Baltimore City public
schools
Regularly identify student
progress
Continuous program
structure and logical
progression
Bain and Hess (2000) CSR Study occurred from 1993-
1997 with an RSM Interview
Form administered on three
occasions resulting in a total
of 141 responses
Longitudinal effect of a
comprehensive school
design and reform program
on faculty perceptions
Collaborative approach to
problem solving and
instructional decision
making
Bain (2007) CSR Brewster Academy, 350
grade 9-13 students
Longitudinal Self
Organizing School (SOS)
case study
Nine targets representing
critical areas of need and
potential goals of next
generation CSR design
Pratt, Hall, Hord & Thurder CBAM Staff at Jefferson County, Case study of the All stakeholders should have
38
(1982) Colorado, Beach County
Schools Florida and
Research and
Development Centre,
University of Texas
collaborative efforts of
multiple agenda and
agencies.
input into expectations and a
common understanding
about implementation
details. Advance plan of
overall program is critical
Rutherford (1982) CBAM Multiple case study of 5
principals from different
settings
Comparison of facilitator
role and concerns about the
change process
Top down approach may be
detrimental to the transition
of research to practice
Huberman and Miles (1987) CBAM 146 school districts with
case studies from 12 sites
Implementation framework
to identify phases of
innovation to analyse the
feelings and concerns of
teachers
To implement change
stakeholders must change
first. Their needs, feelings
and perceptions must be
addressed prior to addressing
program-orientated concerns
Davidson (2010) CBAM 8 junior high resource
special education teachers
Changing teachers concerns
toward inclusion using PD
Need for communities of
practice to work within
environments that promote
inclusion
Carnine (1997) RTP Collaboration Usability, trustworthiness,
accessibility of research
Seashore & Jones (2001) RTP Collaboration Shared responsibility
Hall (1982) RTP Collaboration Shared understanding and
responsibility
Sydoriak & Fields (1997) RTP Collaboration Feedback is essential
Kratochwill & Shernoff
(2003)
RTP Collaboration Shared contribution and
ownership
Toch (1982) RTP Collaboration Cooperation
Lloyd, Weintraub, & Safer RTP Research Practical and responsive to
39
(1997) student needs
Slavin (2004) RTP Research Evidence based
Guba (1967) RTP Research Educational change
Eash (1968) RTP Research Many concerns exist
Coleman (1979) RTP Research Field based training
Schneider & Mc Donald
(2006)
RTP/PD Resource support Long-term with adequate
materials
Ysseldyke (1989) RTP/PD Collaboration Joint partnerships between
researchers and practitioners
Billups (1997) PD Support Consistent
McLeskey & Billingsley
(2008)
PD Support Comprehensive and
sustained
Malouf & Schiller (1995) TE Collaboration Active stakeholder
involvement
Grimes & Tilly (1996) TE Collaboration Practitioner involvement
required in research
Goodlad (1993) TE Collaboration Mutually aligned norms,
expectations and roles
El-Dinary, Pressley, Coy-
Ogan, & Schuder (1994)
TE Support Support of personnel
qualities and attributes
Tyack & Cuban (1995) CSR Change Inadequate comprehension
of time, effort and resources.
Lack of PD and insight
Slavin (2004) CSR Implementation
considerations
Strong teacher “buy in” with
visions of goals
Rapid roll out of program
elements
40
Appelbaum & Schwartzbeck
(2002)
CSR Evidence of effectiveness
and degree of rigor.
Need for common measures
of achievement, definition of
"significant" student
progress and universal
standards for good
implementation.
Waldron & McLeskey
(2010)
CSR Inclusion and school reform Critical role of collaboration
and distributive leadership in
“reculturing” a school.
Multiple solutions to
complex problems
Hord, Rutherford, Huling-
Austin & Hall (1987)
CBAM Group seven stages of
CBAM into three main
stages
Concerns for self, impact
and task orientation
Horsley & Loucks-Horsley
(1998)
CBAM Clarifies CBAM framework Programs are examples of
the content of change.
Parallel between an
individuals natural and
developmental process
Rutherford (1986) CBAM Teachers' contributions to
school improvement
Teachers believe their future
in relation to the innovation
is determined by a superior
41
Each of the studies was read and categorised according to the project details,
participants and the RTP factor identified. Commentary claims identified through
this investigation are evident within the narrative and consistencies in RTP assertions
are presented in Table 1.In brief, the literature search identified 32 studies that
identified RTP factors. Of these studies 23 were conducted in the United States (US),
seven in Australia and one in both Greece and the United Kingdom. The Australian
DETYA (2000) research evaluation program accounted for five studies, which are
presented in Table 1. Half of the studies reviewed were undertaken in schools with
the results described and presented in five sections: (1) RTP factors and themes
identified through research-to-practice commentary claims and related research into
practice examples, (2) RTP factors and themes identified through the PD literature,
(3) RTP factors and themes identified through the TE literature, (4) RTP factors and
themes identified through the CSR literature and (5) RTP factors and themes
identified through the CBAM literature.
2.4.1. Research into Practice
Commentary claims or position papers featured predominantly in the RTP search. Of
the 29 RTP references, 19 represented commentary claims or position papers while
10 presented RTP intervention research. Claims about RTP were generally based on
indirect evidence. The primary focus of the intervention research was in the area of
reading. There were no empirical research examples with a longitudinal,
intervention-oriented focus on research to practice.
42
1.1.1.1. 2.4.1.1 Research-to-Practice Commentary Claims
and Assertions
Carnine (1997) claimed the ‘research-to-practice’ gap exists because research has not
been designed to make a practical difference. He identified three factors or
characteristics that influence RTP efforts. These were usability, accessibility and
trustworthiness of research. Usability was described as the practicality of use.
Accessibility referred to the extent to which programs were available to those who
want to use them. Trustworthiness reflected the confidence and belief practitioners
had in research findings. Carnine’s themes of usability and accessibility built on
early claims made by Guba (1967), Eash (1968) and Coleman (1979) who identified
concerns related to transferring research to practice. Concerns that influenced the
aforementioned factors included: inadequate links between universities and schools,
inadequate training, and lack of use by practitioners. Toch (1982) concluded that the
failure of researchers and educators to cooperate contributed to their lack of
communication, which impacted negatively on the research in schools. Carnine
(1997) later presented that cooperation and communication are essential to the
identified notion of trustworthiness.
Ways to enhance consistency and support for teachers in their efforts to
translate research to practice were identified by Gunstone and Northfield (1986).
Suggestions included ensuring the grounding of research questions in practice with a
focus on efficient and manageable interventions, collaborating with practitioners to
establish feasibility, broadening the context for successful research-based
demonstrations, and promoting school-based research (Carnine, 1997). These
solutions were supported by Lloyd et al. (1997) supported these solutions by
43
emphasising that research should be responsive to practicing professionals’ needs in
order to effectively address the diverse needs of their students.
In order to address the usability, accessibility and trustworthiness of research,
Billups et al. (1997) proposed that information regarding the research base should be
included in school programs. It was suggested that this information should include
who did the study, how it was conducted, in what setting, length of time, and
evidence of its track record. Carnine (1997), Billups et al. (1997) and Lloyd et al.
(1997) proposed that relevant information should be disseminated in a user-friendly
format so teachers can fully understand the implications and the extent of usefulness.
Further, Sydoriak and Fields (1997) advocated for joint involvement and ownership
between researchers and practitioners to increase the likelihood of research reaching
classrooms in ways that are more reflective of ‘real world’ conditions.
According to Ysseldyke (1989) researcher training needs to be improved for
the translation of RTP to occur. Gersten, Vaughn, Deshler, and Schiller (1997)
expanded on this suggestion by proposing that alternative researcher roles, including
collaborators, facilitators and coaches, may reduce the gap between special education
research and classroom practice, thus making classrooms more inclusive. Such an
approach to enhancing collaborative links between researchers and practitioners may
contribute to enhancing Carnine’s (1997) notion of usability, as research is promoted
as proactive rather than reactive (Ysseldyke, 1989).
Slavin (2004) proposed that educational reform needs a well-designed
comprehensive approach to school-wide practice that is based on the best research
available. As such, attending to details such as professional development, evaluation
and comprehensive design are important. The integration of instruction, assessment
44
and classroom management into a school-wide reform plan to meet the diverse needs
of students is needed to ensure accessibility.
Consistencies in suggestions on ways to make research useable, accessible
and trustworthy are highlighted in Table 1. Carnine (1997) and Sydoriak and Fields
(1997) summarised these factors in their six principles: (1) importance of
practicality, concreteness and specificity of research-based practices; (2) scope and
magnitude of intended change should not be too broad or too vague; (3) linking
research ideas to classroom situations with opportunities to experiment with
feedback; (4) collaboration and joint problem solving between researchers and
practitioners, ensuring links to real life situations; (5) frequent and substantive
interaction to give teachers the opportunity to discuss new practices; and (6) relating
research applications to improvements in learning for all students. Collectively, these
principles propose the promotion of sustained use of research, summarising concerns
presented over the last four decades. Further, Sydoriak and Fields (1997) advocated
for joint involvement and ownership between researchers and practitioners to
increase the likelihood of research reaching classrooms in ways that are more
reflective of ‘real world’ conditions.
In summary, the RTP commentary claims support the need for strong collaborative
links between educators and researchers. Through working together researchers and
practitioners may build joint interest and ownership of research-based practices.
Consistent professional development efforts have been cited as a way to support
teachers’ access to research based practices. Concerns about the trustworthiness and
45
usability of research have also been presented. The following section identifies
research on interventions that have yielded some RTP knowledge.
1.1.1.2. 2.4.1.2. Related RTP intervention research
This section builds on commentary claims and presents the small number of related
research examples that identify factors that are claimed to reduce the RTP gap by
striving to make research useable, accessible and trustworthy. The work by Fuchs
and Fuchs (1998, 2001), Vaughn, Klingner, & Bryant (2001), Foegen et al. (2001)
and Foorman and Moats (2004) expanded on the importance of the trustworthiness
of research by promoting supportive partnerships and environments.
Foorman and Moats (2004) presented a PD approach that emerged out of
their research in Houston and Washington, DC. This study was conducted in the
Houston and involved 1400 children from 17 high-poverty, low-performing schools
in Houston and Columbia. Conditions under which these children from Kinder to
Grade 4 learn to read were examined. The data collection procedures were the same
in both cities and involved frequent visits to the classrooms by observers,
professional development staff, assessment personal and project faculty. All teachers
used a comprehensive reading program with implementation supported by the
publisher’s consultants. By the end of the 4-year project, students in both cities were
solidly at national averages in their reading scores. Although the achievement results
were positive, contextual variables differed in locations. The extent of PD differed.
In Columbia PD was multidimensional, whilst due to limited funds Houston’s PD
consisted of 4 days across the school year. On analysis of this reading intervention
study Foorman and Moats (2004) concluded that an obstacle to moving sustainable
46
research practices to scale include the slowness of teacher education and PD efforts.
Positive factors include the sound research-based practices available and an
awareness of the need for increased knowledge of how to bring research to scale.
Other critical elements identified as contributors to sustaining and scaling research-
based practices through this investigation include mutual respect, pride in academic
achievement and collegiality in interactions.
Fuchs and Fuchs (2001) described how researchers and educators could work
together more productively to produce methods that schools can continue to employ
once the researchers work is complete. This follows Fuchs and Fuchs’s (1998)
description of efforts linking researchers and educators in Metro Nashville PHASES
Public Schools. The Nashville study sought to identify principles for sustaining
research-based practices through a school-wide study utilising Math Peer Assisted
Learning Strategies (PALS). This study involved seven teachers across different
schools. The authors claim that this model differs from traditional research due to the
level of teacher involvement.
The model relies on ongoing collaboration between university researchers
and school building level educators and has three phases. The first phase involves
implementing a pilot process where teachers reflect on their concerns and work with
researchers to implement an innovation. Formal testing of the innovation occurs
during the second phase, with schools, districts and state departments providing
support to scale up the innovation in the third and final phase. This research example
united educators and researchers as partners in planning, implementing, providing
feedback and problem solving. They found that these partnerships only survived
when both sides worked continuously to preserve them. It should be noted that
47
during this research many challenges arose, such as the state adopting high-stakes
achievement tests, which increased anxiety levels, making partnerships more
susceptible to mistrust.
Fuchs and Fuchs’ (2001) discussion made reference to this PALS
investigation and indicated that inadequate demand for validated practices
represented a major reason for their lack of use. The use of only one research-based
intervention may be viewed as a limitation, yet this investigation reinforced the
importance of shared responsibility. Foegan et al.’s (2001) study, which examined
preservice teacher beliefs on curriculum-based measurement utility and validity,
added to the shared responsibility factor. They presented the need for researchers to
better disseminate their research and for practitioners to more actively review the
research. Researchers alone are said to be incapable of bridging the research-to-
practice gap. In sum, these studies have indicated that commitment and collaboration
between researchers and educators at planning, implementation and sustainment
phases of research-based interventions is beneficial in promoting RTP efforts.
Collectively they have suggested that to increase the demand for research,
researchers must work with educators to produce innovations that are validated and
PD efforts need to ensure meaningful dissemination of research findings.
Collegiality, mutual respect, time, resources, comprehensiveness, emergent
feedback, implementation integrity, long-term support, pride in achievement,
communication, shared responsibility, and positive student and peer responses were
factors identified to enhance supportive environments to promote the usability,
accessibility and trustworthiness of research (Bain, 2007; Fuchs & Fuchs, 2001;
Klingner, Ahwee, Pilonieta, & Menendez, 2003; Schneider & McDonald, 2006;
48
Vaughn, Klingner, & Hughes, 2000). Further, Foegen et al.’s (2001) work with
preservice teachers advocated that better dissemination of research and practitioner
review was required. Fuchs and Fuchs (2001) similarly found that partnerships only
survived when both sides worked continuously to preserve them.
Examples of professional development (PD) built on themes of accessibility,
trustworthiness and usability (Foorman & Moats, 2004). Obstacles to moving
sustainable research practices to scale include the slowness of TE and PD efforts.
Other factors identified as contributors to sustaining and scaling research-based
practices included the availability of sound research-based practices, and an
awareness of the need for increased knowledge of how to bring research to scale
(usability). Mutual respect between professional development staff and teachers,
student and teacher pride in academic achievement, and collegiality in interactions
among stakeholders were identified as features that can enhance trustworthiness and
narrow the RTP gap through addressing diverse student needs.
In 1998 the Department of Education, Training and Youth Affairs (DETYA)
conducted a study with the Australian Research Council (ARC) that provided
additional support for the many factors identified through RTP commentary claims.
The study sought to explore the impact of Australian educational research, with
particular respect to schools. The Research Evaluation Programme, managed by the
DETYA, identified five studies that presented different perspectives on the impact of
educational research in Australia and offered a broad insight into the influence of
Australian educational research. The first study Mapping Educational Research and
its Impact on Australian Schools is a comprehensive charting of Australian
educational research and identifies the published Australian educational research
49
undertaken during 1992–1997. Backtracking Practices and Policies to Research
appraised the influence of research on educators and Teacher Knowledge in Action
analysed teachers’ explanations of their decisions during a videoed lesson. Both
groups mapped backwards from the practitioner through the network of influences to
identify the impact of research on practice. Education Research in Australia: A
Bibliometric Analysis assessed the international visibility of Australian educational
research through lists of citations and inclusions in journals found in the Institute of
Scientific Information (ISI) database. The Selby Smith report (1999), The
Relationships Between Research and Decision-Making in Education: An Empirical
Investigation, (as cited in DETYA, 2000) adds the policy formulation perspective in
relation to vocational education and training (VET). Collectively, this research
confirms that quality teacher education needs to develop good attitudes to research
along with exposing educators to research-based knowledge that will assist them in
catering for the needs of individual students. For research to be applied in an
education context, researchers have to market their knowledge so that it is accessible
and motivating. This requires a shift in what is valued in the work of universities
(DETYA, 2000).
Results of these studies supported the need for the engagement between
researcher and educator in the creation of ‘new knowledge’ and ‘new solutions’,
adding that this interactive process must be multilayered (Carnine, 1997; DETYA,
2000; Sydoriak & Fields, 1997). DETYA (2000) refers to the inadequacies of
conceived linear relationship between educational research and practice, and suggest
a multilayered process of engagement between researcher and educator that is
responsive and effective at all levels. Multi layering identified educators’ problems
50
need to be addressed in context, with the acknowledgment of individual attitudes,
beliefs and organisational structures that provide opportunities for feedback and
communication with realistic expectations. The studies also expanded upon the
understanding of the accessibility of research suggesting the need for clear,
unambiguous language that is meaningful to educators. The importance of teacher
education was emphasised, and the need for developing educators who value and use
research to support change (Ax et al., 2008; Gravani, 2008; McLeskey & Billingsley,
2008).
To summerise the RTP commentary claims and related RTP research identify four
common themes. The first theme calls for research to be responsive to the needs of
educators and their settings. This theme has been identified through sub themes
suggesting that research should be relevant, useable, trustworthy and accessible.
Research should be evidence based, practical and manageable to ensure its
transference to direct practical applications. The second theme identifies the need
for effective professional development to actively involve teachers in reviewing
research to gain a sound knowledge of research based practices. Suggestions that PD
needs to be consistent and address to practitioner needs is said to encourage
practitioners’ valuing of research findings.
The third theme entitled collaboration refers to the need for shared understanding,
ownership, responsibility, collegiality and mutual respect. Collaborative efforts
require effective cooperation and communication between all stakeholders. This
approach may encourage frequent and substantive interaction catering for increased
opportunities for feedback and discussion. The final theme pertains to resource
51
supports. This falls from claims identifying the need for consistency in support
(including time and resources) for all stakeholders. As RTP efforts are recognized as
a process not a product, long-term support for projects that elicit positive attitudes
from peers and students is required.
In conclusion, research that has attempted to identify the success or concerns of
educational interventions has provided examples of ways in which researchers and
practitioners can work toward making research usable, accessible and trustworthy.
Through analysing the intervention research it became apparent that while immediate
application appears to be a high priority for practitioners, shared theoretical
understandings are essential for educators and researchers to be able to work together
(DETYA, 2000).
The following section builds on this RTP knowledge and describes the role
of professional development as a factor that can assist educators in creating
successful educational experiences for all students (Billups et al., 1997; Foorman &
Moats, 2004; Gunstone & Northfield, 1986; Klingner et al., 2003; Little & Houston,
2003).
1.1.1.3. 2.4.1.3. Professional Development and RTP
The second round of review was conducted based upon the factors identified in the
RTP literature. This was done to go further in identifying RTP knowledge that may
be gained from related research. A brief description of PD is presented which is
followed by the introduction of the articles that met the RTP and PD selection
criteria for this review. Eight publications were identified that specifically presented
52
a detailed discussion of PD as a comprehensive or longitudinal approach to address
the RTP gap in education. An article on coaching located in the TE search is also
presented in this section as it pertained to a PD intervention. Articles that made
reference to PD in fields other than education and did not refer to the RTP gap were
not selected for this review.
Fullen (2000) described PD as a continuous process, supported through
mentoring, coaching, and feedback to address the perceived needs of the students
within individual classrooms and schools. It may be further defined as a complex and
comprehensive process of change dependent on clearly articulated plans to address
common goals (Fullan, 1993; Fullan & Hargreaves, 1992; Sparks & Richardson,
1997).
McLeskey and Billingsley (2008) described the importance of PD in relation to RTP
efforts and special education. Support for concerns of accessibility, usability,
trustworthiness of research and the possible reasons for and solutions to the RTP gap
in the area of PD were stated. They proposed the two most influential RTP gap
factors are teacher preparation and the nature of research conducted. McLeskey and
Billingsley (2008) concentrated predominantly on issues related to the shortage of
special education teachers, yet they promoted the need for comprehensive,
coordinated, and sustained efforts in the area of teacher education to reduce the RTP
gap.
A reconceptualised PD model involving a four-step process to promote quality and
the use of scientifically based instructional practices was described by Little and
Houston (2003). The occurrence of educational learning or change was identified as
53
occurring when critical factors, including relevance to classroom needs, dependence
on required support, collaboration of researchers and multiple educators within
schools that can provide expert content knowledge, are met. This work increased
awareness of factors that can reduce the RTP gap by promoting the quality of PD
efforts through the use of scientifically based instructional practices. The model
introduced required collaboration among professionals within the research
community, the state department of education, local staff developers, administrators,
and teachers. It was developed by Florida’s State Department of Education and the
University of Central Florida through the Effective Instructional Practices (EIP)
project in an attempt to bring research into practice. From the outset, the model was
based on principles of educational change and adult learning theories. It involved a
four-step process including the;
1. Identification of scientifically based instructional practices, in which specific
criteria were developed as a standard to determine the efficacy of each scientifically
based instructional practice in relation to access to the general education curriculum.
2. Selection of teams of teachers to attend awareness-level professional development,
in which set criteria had to be met before the nominated applicants were accepted for
attendance at the professional development institute. Teams generally consisted of a
content-area teacher and a special educator.
3. Classroom implementation of scientifically based instructional practice from
initial training to quality implementation for all students, in which mentors and
54
coaches modelled and guided the participants through learning the content and
discussing its application within their classrooms.
4. Data collection of the results of student learning through traditional and action
research methodologies.
Implications of this research-into-practice model of professional development
indicated that educational learning or change could occur when critical factors are
evident. These factors include the relevance of issues to the classroom needs and the
dependence on required support. A limitation of this study is that it did not test
whether the transfer of RTP actually occurred. Calls for scientifically based
instructional practices that are directly related to student needs were identified. The
collaboration of multiple educators within schools and agencies and researchers was
again viewed as a high priority.
Gersten, Morvant, and Brengelman (1995) conducted an intensive coaching
process to support general education teachers’ adoption of research-based practices
selected to improve reading performance of low-achieving students was studied. Key
issues included the anxieties inherent to, and the variations in concerns and priorities,
of general and special educators. As such, general and special educators’ varied
perceptions emerged as a key issue in ways to bring research-based teaching into
general education classrooms to cater for the needs of students with and without
disabilities. Collaboration, including the use of collaborative decision-making teams
across the school and the adoption of collaborative meeting process in all committees
and groups, may rectify this issue.
55
Joint partnerships with mutual boundaries between universities and schools are
deemed important (Gravani, 2008). Gravani (2008) reported that the cultural clash
between researchers and teachers could be addressed through mutually identifying
boundaries, structures and purpose. Gravani’s (2007) qualitative case study with
university teachers and secondary teachers’ in Greece, collected data on their
experiences and perceptions of a university led in-service training course. The
research explored aspects of the relationships between academics and practitioners in
the context of a professional development program. A total of 22 secondary teachers
and 12 tutors interviewed over a two-month period (May-June, 2001) reported on
theory and practice, knowledge held, used and valued and the extent to which these
features influenced their learning during the course of the program. Data collection
consisted of transcripts of audio-recorded semi structured interviews. Three major
themes emerged from the analysis of these results. These themes included theory
versus practice, in which academics suggested theory was the core of in service
training whilst practitioners acknowledge practice as being the centrepiece of in-
service training. The second theme identified propositional versus procedural
knowledge, where the complimentary nature of propositional and practical
knowledge is presented. Knowledge producers versus knowledge translators is the
final theme, it identified that traditional roles need to move into an increased
collaborative state so that the power and responsibility is shared.
Gravani’s (2007) claim that this research is “fundamentally optimistic in that it does
not indicate, however imperfectly, that rather than focussing on the gap, the
discussion should be about the space” (Gravani, 2007, p. 657) refers to importance
56
of joint partnerships between universities and schools. The academic–teacher
relationship continued to be one of the most important areas upon which future
professional learning should be based.
Gunstone and Northfield’s (1993) case study on a preservice program for high
school science teachers at Monash University was referred to as representing the
author’s translation of research to practice. The program identified student teaching
as the first phase of career-long professional development. The Monash Program
was comprised of two foundation subjects, Social Foundations of school (SFS) and
Teaching and learning (TAL). Two methods of teaching subjects were involved.
These included teaching practice with supervising teachers and a number of short
service courses including educational technology and first aid. The authors prepared
science teachers by integrating all components into a “single whole” focussing on the
development of the student teacher. A major element in this approach was the use of
constant seminar groups across all integrated subjects rather than lecture-based
teaching. The authors identified the context as tangled and details are limited, yet
they do promote the notion of the reflective practitioner and identify the benefits of
maximizing student teachers' contacts with school pupils and teachers. Although
this article does not describe the methodology in detail including the way data was
collected, the research to practice issues identified include the importance of ongoing
PD and the need for it to be seen as credible by teachers.
Seven general education teachers and five special education teachers (secondary
participants) undertook a yearlong intensive PD reading program (Vaughn, Hughes,
Klingner & Schumm, 1998). Teachers were taught four writing and reading practices
57
in separate nine-week blocks. The program was designed to capitalize on key
elements of effective PD through the involvement of teacher researchers. These
elements included involving teachers who were willing to learn only four successful
research based instructional practices, the provision of ongoing coaching and support
with bimonthly meetings to discuss concerns. Data was collected through teacher
interviews, implementation validity checklists, barriers and facilitator checklists,
focus group interviews, researcher logs and classroom observations. Results
indicated that sustained implementation was maintained by four of the seven general
education teachers for the year. Three of the seven continued to display high
implementation into the following year. The reading intervention promoted PD as a
way of enhancing accessibility and usability of research by engaging teachers in
pursuit of genuine questions. It identified that RTP efforts can be enhanced by
establishing a collaborative link between researchers and teachers to build
trustworthiness and balance their differing agendas, roles and responsibilities.
A follow-up investigation (Klingner, Vaughn, Hughes & Arguelles, 1999)
examined the extent to which seven of these teachers continued to use instructional
practices they had originally learned. Six of the seven had continued to use one or
more of the practices. A year later, Klingner et al. (2001) investigated the extent to
which these practices had spread amongst teachers who were not part of the original
PD. Findings indicated that for programs designed to meet the needs of a range of
students, teachers were more likely to maintain a practice if peers perceive the
practice is valuable, and a support network is in place that allows for discussion
around implementation issues.
58
Klingner et al. (2003) extended PD research efforts implementing four
reading research-based practices with 29 teachers from six elementary schools. The
most frequently cited barriers included a lack of sufficient instructional time, too
many competing demands on time, and a lack of materials. Off-task students,
interruptions, insufficient administrative support and classroom management
challenges also made scaling efforts difficult. Factors that assisted the
implementation-included students enjoying the strategies, students performing well
during implementation, administrative support, teachers feeling sufficiently
prepared, materials being provided and ongoing support from the research team.
A key factor derived from Klingner et al. (2003) is that for research-based
practices to be sustained and scaled in general education classrooms that include
children with special needs, there must be ‘buy in’ from stakeholders at multiple
levels and teachers must take ownership of the practices. The need for collaboration
between researchers and teachers continued to be emphasised with a greater
awareness of the considerable time required to balance the many roles and
responsibilities essential to achieving the delicate balance between practice and
research. This reading intervention research supports the claims that top down
support for a bottom up model is required in bringing research efforts to scale
(Darling- Hammond & McLaughlin, 1995).
On analysis of the PD literature related to RTP, 4 major themes were identified. The
first theme, collaboration once again promotes the importance of joint partnerships
and shared ownership between academics and practitioners. The PD literature builds
on the initial notion of collaboration by identifying the need for mutually identified
boundaries, structures and purposes (Foorman & Moats, 2004; Klingner, et al.,
59
2003). “Buy in” from all stakeholders is said to strengthen the collaboration of
multiple agendas within school and academic communities. Researchers propose
that the most promising forms of Professional Development engage teachers in the
pursuit of genuine questions, problems and solutions. This assertion leads into the
second theme, which once again suggests that research should be responsive.
Although much of the PD knowledge has been gained through reading interventions,
these references identify that the RTP gap may be reduced if research pursues
genuine teacher needs and concerns. Claims that research needs to be relevant to
classroom contexts so that programs directly relate to student needs are presented.
The third theme suggests the need for scientifically based instructional practices.
Calls for PD efforts to be based on instructional practices that have been proven to
be effective are evident. PD should be sustained, coordinated, comprehensive and
seen as credible by teachers so they feel sufficiently prepared. This calls for the use
of scientifically based instructional practices that respond to claims that teachers’
intellectual and leadership capacity need to be catered for as they are central to
students learning.
Support in a PD context suggests the need for a support network that allows for
discussion of new practices and their implementation between practitioners and
academics. The provision of adequate resources, sufficient instructional time and
ongoing support from all stakeholders is cited as critical to effective PD efforts.
These assertions echo those identified in the RTP literature. Limiting competing
demands extends the notion of support in a PD context. If PD is to be effective the
60
demands placed on teachers must be manageable and realistic. Support in creating a
manageable balance of multiple agendas is necessary.
These assertions echoed and expanded upon those identified in the RTP
literature and suggested a need to limit competing demands in PD planning. If PD is
to be effective, the demands placed on teachers must be manageable and realistic.
Support in creating this manageable balance of multiple agendas is necessary for
consistent PD efforts to address the needs of staff in their ability to cater for the
needs of students with a diverse range of abilities. These PD factors are consistent
with previous RTP assertions and build on the knowledge required by researchers
and practitioners on ways to reduce the RTP gap. Factors within the identified PD
themes are specifically identified in Table 2.3.
The following section expands upon those factors identified in the PD
literature and describes teacher education as a way to influence research-to-practice
efforts (Everington & Hamill, 1996; Golder, Norwich, & Bayliss, 2005; Villa &
Thousand, 1996). Research examples that confirm and expand upon RTP and PD
assertions are presented.
1.1.1.4. 2.4.1.4 Teacher Education and RTP
Teacher education (TE) in an inclusive education context is identified in both
research and position papers as a key strategy in bridging the RTP gap, furthering the
capacity to collaboratively link university and school efforts (Capizzi & Fuchs, 2005;
Darling-Hammond & Baratz-Snowden, 2007; D. Fuchs & L. Fuchs, 1998; Golder et
al., 2005; Gravani, 2008; Korthagen, 2004; Winn & Zundans, 2004). TE can assist in
reducing the RTP gap as it represents an avenue linking the efforts of researchers and
61
educators who work in inclusive environments to enhance RTP endeavours
(Everington & Hamill, 1996; Golder, Norwich, & Bayliss, 2005; Villa & Thousand,
1996). Concerns about the difficulty in maintaining a collaborative link between
university and school partnerships have been raised (Sirotnik as cited in Goodlad,
1993). These concerns are based on the differing norms, roles and expectations of
researchers and practitioners and are referred to as a ‘cultural clash’ between
universities and schools. Yet the potential responsiveness of university education
programs in ensuring the practical preparation of teachers continue to be presented as
a way to enhance united RTP efforts (Billups, 1997; Miretzky 2007; Carnine 1997;
Richardson, Anders, Tidwell, & Lloyd, 1991; Lipsky & Gartner, 1996; Miller,
George et al. 2005). Some researchers suggest that teacher education programs bear
a heightened responsibility in addressing the long standing concern that evidence-
based knowledge is not being used to its full potential in school settings (Devine &
King, 2006; Golder, et al., 2005; Schmidt, Rozendal, & Greenman, 2002; Volonino
& Zigmond, 2007).
According to Zundans (2007) teacher education programs have received
much international criticism (Bereiter, 2002; Cochran-Smith, 2001; Edwards et al.,
2002; Korthagen, 2001; Russell et al., 2001; Vavrus, 2001; What matters, 1996).
These issues relate to the lack of collaboration and relevance, course and content
cohesion and delivery and lack of transference of knowledge into practical settings.
They are common themes and concerns that are raised in RTP assertions and
research. They interfere with the capacity of teacher preparation programs to
address the theory into practice issues relating to the challenges associated with
inclusion (Bates, 2002; Gore et al., 2004; Cochran-Smith, 2001; Edwards et al.,
62
2002;Korthagen, 2001; Russell et al., 2001). Yet the need for university and school
educators to engage collaboratively was promoted as involving teachers in the
research process encouraged deeper comprehension and ownership of research
efforts (Darling-Hammond, 1994; Gravani, 2008; Winn and Zundans, 2004).
A third round of review that built on factors identified in PD research and identified
issues that link TE and RTP assertions was conducted. TE literature indicated that
while RTP remained a concern, it was not treated in depth in many discussions
(Carnine, 1997; Darling-Hammond, 2006; Darling-Hammond, 2011; D. Fuchs & L.
Fuchs, 1998; Gravani, 2008; Korthagen, 2007). Of the 12 TE research-based
references located only four offered a specific focus on TE as a way to address the
RTP gap.
Darling-Hammond (2000) used an extensive dataset to examine ways in
which teacher education and other school factors related to student achievement.
This dataset included a 50-state survey of policies, state case study analyses, the
1993-94 Schools and Staffing Surveys (SASS), and the National Assessment of
Educational Progress (NAEP). Quantitative analyses indicated that measures of
teacher preparation strongly correlate to student achievement in reading and
mathematics. Results suggested that policies adopted by states regarding teacher
education, licensing, hiring, and professional development may make a difference to
the capacities that teachers bring to their work. This work gives indirect support to
the importance of TE in addressing RTP as teacher preparation has been shown to
differentially affect teacher capacity and ultimately student achievement.
63
Miller, George, and Fogt (2005) raised awareness of the impact of modifications to a
school’s organisational structure using a teaming approach. This descriptive case
study was conducted at Centennial School of Lehigh University, an alternative day
school for students with emotional and behavioural disorders and a teacher training
facility. Centennial School comprises of 80-100 students and provides educational
services to children with a disability. Graduate students work full time as teachers at
the school and complete course work in the evenings. A rigorous onsite professional
development program supplements students’ coursework.
Miller, George, and Fogt (2005) identified elements including a well-
articulated rationale for change, the quality of leadership, commitment from staff,
sufficient resources and the responsiveness of organisational features that were
cultivated through the change process. These elements were promoted as critical to
enhancing the effectiveness of teacher training efforts. They were also identified in
the work of Fuchs and Fuchs (2001) as strong features in ways to support the use of
research in schools. Further, Miller et al. (2005) advocated attention be given to
other variables including collaborative teacher education to ensure the research
approach selected is a good contextual fit. Interventions should be unobtrusive,
making them more acceptable to both teachers and students, and be consistent with
their values and beliefs.
Winn & Zundans (2004) 2-year project involving two State Public Schools, in the
central west of New South Wales included 40 special education students who were
paired and worked with 20 students from local schools twice a week for 2 hours each
day. The project was designed to enhance literacy development of primary aged
64
children, who were considered to be at risk in regards to their literacy and literacy
development. It was also aimed at developing skills and competencies by the
university students majoring in special education with a specific focus on developing
their ability to plan and implement a research based literacy program. Limitations
included the level of communication time between university students and teachers
and linking activities that occurred at school and university.
The need for collaboration between the schools and the university to develop explicit
links between theory and practice was identified as a key feature of this study.
Results indicated that programs between the university and local schools were
enhanced when the university students perceived them as valuable. The considerable
time required implementing and monitoring collaborative research based
intervention efforts were identified as an obstacle in this preservice RTP reading
intervention.
The TE literature collectively supported the need for RTP factors including
the need for sufficient time and the role of support and feedback in the use of
research-based practices through efforts to strengthen teacher education programs
(Barnes, 1999; Fuchs & Fuchs, 2001; Gersten et al., 2007; Griffin & Warden, 2006;
Hipp, Huffman, Pankake, & Olivier, 2008; Korthagen, 2004; Shallcross, Loubser, Le
Roux, O’Donoghue, & Lupele, 2006; Titone, 2005; Volonino & Zigmond, 2007;
Winn & Zundans, 2004). Through this TE research the provision of peer and
administrative support with feedback on multiple levels was presented as
advantageous for educators to bridge the gap between research and practice
65
(Carnine, 1997; Gersten & Vaughn, 1997a, 1997b; Lloyd et al., 1997; Sydoriak &
Fields, 1997; Zahorik, 1984).
Teacher educators share a responsibility for providing educators with a lens
through which to view every learner as valued and essential. One way to value
learners is by employing the best-researched practices when working with them.
Similarly, encouraging TE programs to work collaboratively with educators to
address identified needs may promote new knowledge and enhance the success of
individual learners (Klingner, Vaughn, Arguelles, Hughes, & Leftwich, 2004;
Klingner et al., 1999; Vaughn et al., 1998). A joint approach is said to provide
coherent, collaborative, research-based and relevant opportunities for practitioners to
develop skills that are supportive and foster achievement for all learners (Casale-
Giannola, 2005; Darling-Hammond & Baratz-Snowden, 2007; Darling-Hammond &
Berry, 2006; Golder et al., 2005).
The difficulty in maintaining a collaborative link between university and
school partnerships was raised (Sirotnik as cited in Goodlad, 1993, p. 31). Concerns
include differing norms, roles and expectations of researchers and practitioners.
Sirotnik referred to this situation as a ‘cultural clash’ between universities and
schools. TE programs bear heightened responsibility in addressing the longstanding
concern that evidence-based knowledge is not being used to its full potential in
school settings (Devine & King, 2006; Golder et al., 2005; Schmidt, Rozendal, &
Greenman, 2002; Volonino & Zigmond, 2007).
Positive partnerships between schools and universities have been identified.
Winn and Zundans (2004) presented a project designed to enhance literacy
development of primary aged children considered to be at risk in regards to their
66
literacy and numeracy development. A key feature identified was the need for
collaboration between the schools and the university to develop explicit links
between the theory and practice so that educators comprehended the theoretical logic
behind practical decisions. However, the considerable time required to implement
and monitor collaborative research-based intervention efforts was identified as an
obstacle in this RTP reading intervention (Winn & Zundans, 2004).
An initiative designed to enhance the knowledge, skills and attitudes of
trainee teachers and to equip them in differentiating their teaching was reported
(Golder et al., 2005). Evaluation reports indicated individualised teaching
partnerships involving a systematic strategy supported by web-based resources were
promising. The need to continue to develop practical ways of enhancing initial
teacher education in relation to special educational needs and inclusion was
promoted.
The examination of the TE literature identified consistencies with the RTP
and PD literature. It built on the initial themes of accessibility, trustworthiness and
usability of research describing their importance from a teacher educator rather than
a practitioner perspective. Additional factors including teacher enthusiasm and
fatigue and the length of time teachers are involved in learning a new instructional
practice reflect the importance of a collaborative partnerships as well as individual
personal attributes and qualities (Barnes, 1999; Darling-Hammond, 2011; D. Fuchs
& L. S. Fuchs, 1998; Gersten, et al., 2007a; Griffin & Warden, 2006; Hipp,
Huffman, Pankake, & Olivier, 2008; Korthagen, 2004; Shallcross, et al., 2006;
Titone, 2005; Volonino & Zigmond, 2007; Winn & Zundans, 2004b).
67
Three of the four themes most commonly identified in the RTP and PD literature
were also evident in the TE literature. The three TE themes that raised an awareness
of possible RTP factors included the responsiveness of university education
programs in ensuring the practical preparation of teachers, collaboration and support.
Collaboration referred to involving practitioners in the research process within the
TE context. The need for feedback on multiple levels is echoed. In a TE context
collaboration was extended to include responsive and coherent course structures that
contributed to a unified approach. In this context collaboration was cited as critical
in developing explicit links between research and practice. This link should assist in
aligning differing norms, expectations and roles of researchers and practitioners.
It was suggested that universities have the capacity to create practical pathways
between research and practice. In order to achieve this demanding goal university
education programs must be responsive to the needs of teachers and students. In the
TE context programs should be a good contextual fit. They still need to be valued by
students, be research based and be effective in delivery. They should also provide
relevant opportunities and time for practitioners to develop skills that will be helpful
in the classroom. TE that caters for the needs of both teachers and their students
through addressing real life concerns are required. Support is the final theme that
echoes and expands upon the sub themes identified in previous literatures. In the TE
context notions of support addressed teacher enthusiasm and education efforts. If
teacher’s needs and efforts are not supported they frequently experience fatigue and
exhaustion (Gersten, et al., 2007a; Miller, et al., 2005). Acknowledgement of
68
personal qualities and attributes and strengthening them through supportive and
professional programs has been introduced in TE literature.
In summary, universities were presented as having the capacity to create
practical pathways between research and practice. In order to achieve this
demanding goal university education programs must be responsive to the needs of
teachers and students. In the TE context, programs should be a good contextual fit.
They need to be valued by students, be research based and be effective in delivery.
They must also provide relevant opportunities and time for practitioners to develop
skills that will be helpful in the classroom. TE that caters for the needs of both
teachers and their students through addressing real life concerns are required.
Given the limited literature that specifically identifies TE, PD or other factors that
impact the RTP phenomenon, the review was expanded to look at other efforts that
address the way research is established in practice. Comprehensive school based
reform (CSR) and Concerns-Based Adoption Model (CBAM) represent such
approaches. These initiatives have the capacity to deepen our comprehension of
change elements through direct research examples and in turn raise an awareness of
related RTP factors. The following section presents the Comprehensive School
Reform (CSR) and RTP literature as it represents a large-scale effort whose
guidelines specifically require the implementation of Research based practices at
scale.
69
1.1.1.5. 2.4.1.5 Comprehensive School Reform and
research to practice
The Comprehensive School Reform Program started in the US in 1998 to raise
student achievement with a specific focus on using research-based effective
practices. Efforts to encourage the use of scientifically proven methods and
strategies to enable all children, particularly low-achieving children, to meet
challenging academic standards may be viewed as a response to the RTP paradigm
crisis (Bain, 2007b; McLeskey & Waldron, 2006; Slavin & Madden, 2001). CSR
reform initiatives have yielded some project implementation theoretical and factor
knowledge given their essential criteria is focused on bringing research-based
practice to scale in public education. Of the 12 references that met the identified
criteria, 6 offered a sound representation of RTP implementation factors as a result
of CSR efforts. Knowledge gained through these references may guide efforts to
directly investigate the RTP gap from a practical perspective are presented in Table
2.3.
The CSR program was authorized as a full program in 2002 as part of the No
Child Left Behind Act (NCLB). Two major concepts including the mandating of
school reform and its comprehensive nature (strengthening all aspects of school
operations including curriculum, instruction, professional development, parental
involvement, and school organization) and the use of scientifically based research
models (models with evidence of effectiveness in multiple settings) were emphasised
(Orland, Connolly, Fong, Sosenko, Tushnet, Yin, Burt and Warner, 2008).
Essentially the CSR program provided funding for schools that address the following
70
criteria: (1) Proven methods and strategies which are based on scientifically based
research and effective practices and have been replicated in schools with diverse
features. (2) Professional development that constitutes high quality and continuous
PD and training for staff (3) Comprehensive design with the integration of
instruction, assessment, classroom management and PD for effective functioning and
aligning these functions into a school-wide reform plan. (4) Support from staff:
Including school faculty administrators and staff. (5) Coordination of resources,
including the identification of how federal, state, local or private resources can assist
schools to coordinate and sustain reform efforts. (6) Evaluation: Arrangement to
evaluate reform implementation and student results. (7) External assistance:
University or other high quality external assistance from a CSR entity. (8) Parent and
community involvement: In planning and implementing school enhancement
activities. (9) Measurable goals for student performance including benchmarks for
these goals. (10) Scientifically based research to improve the academic achievement
of students (added in 2001).
CSR represented America’s most ambitious school reform effort with over US$1.8
billion spread over 6,000 schools (U.S. Department of Education, 2004). Knowledge
of CSR implementation integrity and data allowed researchers to determine the
impact of research based programs over time and provided guidance for future
efforts. Comprehensiveness in this context referred to designs being practical by
being complete. CSR research suggested the need for the presence of feedback
systems, well aligned system and school policy goals, evaluation as an emergent
function of the implementation process rather than an add on and the provision of
adequate professional development and material support. The following research
71
identifies RTP knowledge was gained from the implementation of CSR models prior
to the program being discontinued by the Federal Government in 2007 (Borman,
2009).
Tyack & Cuban (1995) identified the tension that long existed between Americans'
intense faith in education and the slow pace of changes in educational practices.
Previous attempts to improve education have resulted in school reform efforts that
rarely match expectations. This is due to the difficulty in changing the daily
interactions of teachers and students (Tyack & Cuban, 1995). Symptoms of the
failure of previous reform efforts stemmed from the inability to intersect content and
process. These symptoms were not unlike claims made in the three previous searches
about the causes of the RTP gap and included an inadequate comprehension of the
time, effort and resources required, a lack of insight about the nature of classroom
setting and the provision of PD. Knowledge gained from this fourth round of review
did yield additional factors and increased depth of information that may have
contributed to these symptoms. Such knowledge included incomplete design, modest
achievement, difficulty in scaling within schools, limited feedback, over reliance on
school leadership, under use of technology, limited feedback and a lack of theory
(Bain, 2007). As a result RTP knowledge can be sought from the outcomes of CSR’s
goal of making many parts work together as a “self-reinforcing whole” (Bain, 2007,
p.21).
The challenging history of school reform and the inability to sustain RTP efforts
indicate that the balance of content and process has been difficult to achieve. To
accomplish this balance, the challenging intersection between content and process
72
must be firstly identified and then accommodated. Following are examples of CSR
efforts that build on knowledge gained from past attempts to achieve the optimal
balance between content and process. Through understanding the content and
process required in CSR efforts an effective intersection of key requirements may be
achieved and contribute to knowledge of ways to implement and sustain RTP
initiatives.
A large study was conducted by Hurley, Chamberlain, Slavin, & Madden (2001)
evaluated the achievement outcomes across schools that used Success for All from
1994–1998 by comparing data collected on the internet. Success for All is an
example of an extensively evaluated comprehensive school reform reading model
that was awarded the highest rating for research quality and outcomes by the
Comprehensive School Reform Quality Centre at the American Institutes for
Research (CSRQ, 2005).
Hurley et al.’s (2001) study investigated the gains made on the Texas Assessment of
Academic Skills (TAAS) reading measures for grades 3–5 across 111 schools in the
state of Texas. Gains were determined by comparing the percentage of students
within schools that passed the TAAS reading measures. The collection of data via
the Internet may be considered a limitation, however the analysis of the results
identified that gains from the students from the Success for All schools were
significantly better than those from the rest of the state. Borman (2009) and Waldron
& McLeskey (2010) later supported the authors’ claims that the success of such
programs is dependent on the consistent commitment of all teachers and leadership
personnel (Hurley et al., 2001).
73
Other studies compared Success for All schools results to matched control schools
results on individually administered standardized tests such as the Woodcock
Reading Mastery Test and the Durrell Analysis of Reading Difficulty. Madden et
al., (1993); Ross et al., (1995); Ross et al., (1997) provided examples of these studies
as they followed the progress of students in both Success for All and control schools
starting at kindergarten or first Grade. These studies were conducted in high-poverty
schools within eleven school districts. A total of 6000 students formed the control
group and 6000 formed the Success For All group. Results from individually
administered assessments revealed that reading grade equivalents for Success for All
first graders were nearly three months higher than the equivalent students from the
control group. By the end of fifth grade the difference increased to slightly more
than a full grade.
These findings were consistent with the results from a summary of research on the
SFA program conducted by the Success For All Foundation in 2006. Collectively
they identified positive outcomes in increasing student reading (Slavin et. al., 2006).
Given that educators are increasingly being asked to use research-based programs,
the lessons learnt from the practical implementation of SFA may yield knowledge of
factors that support the translation of other research based programs to practice.
Slavin’s (2004) paper titled Translating research into widespread practice: The case
of Success for All (SFA) summarized implementation considerations as a result of
collective SFA experiences in an attempt to guide the effective implementation of
other research based programs (RBP). Assertions that broad scale implementation of
RBP can occur if well developed student materials, teacher manuals, assessment,
74
training, follow up and implementation assessments were evident. Slavin (2004)
maintained that if teachers were taught the principles of good practice and asked to
apply them to their own materials and instruction, it would be difficult to maintain
consistent high quality implementations. Given that “CSR is only as effective as its
implementation” (Kurki, Boyle & Aladjem, 2006), strong teacher buy in is required
across schools in favour of the program adoption if it is to be implemented
successfully. Required resources including time and professional development and a
rapid roll out of the main program elements so that teachers can see improvements
will assist in maintaining the programs implementation (Slavin, 2004).
Borman, Hewes, Overman, and Brown’s (2002) independent Meta analysis of
"whole-school" or "comprehensive" reforms identified that the combined quantity,
quality, and statistical significance of evidence set them apart from the rest. Analysis
of data highlighted that schools implementing CSR models for five years or more
showed particularly strong effects. Indicating that a long-term commitment to
validated research is required to establish comprehensive school reform. The
components attributed to the reforms success included the need for ongoing staff
development and training to enhance comprehension of the program details and
implementation concerns; the need for clear evidence of school-based support with
the authors suggesting a 75% approval before the reform can be adopted; replicable
student performance assessment methods and benchmarks that the school can use to
track student progress.
Direct Instruction is another comprehensive school reform model, which consisted of
carefully scripted lessons, backed by texts and workbooks. In a fact sheet presented
75
by The Baltimore Curriculum Project, Direct Instruction was denoted as being a
remarkable success in assisting children with reading, writing and maths since 1996.
Claims that the Direct Instruction model offered a comprehensive approach to school
reform, which included professional development, measurable weekly goals, staff
support, and evaluation and coordination of resources emerged. Mac Iver, Kemper
and Stringfield (2003) identified these assertions in a 4-year study examining the
implementation of the Baltimore Curriculum Project (BCP) in six Baltimore City
public schools. BCP used a combination of direct instruction (DI) and core
knowledge as its reform curriculum. Each school was demographically matched
with a similar, within-district school. Two cohorts of students were followed
throughout the 4 years (students who were in either kindergarten or grade 2 during
1996-97). Interviews with principals and DI coordinators and focus groups with
teachers were conducted each year to gauge staff perceptions of the innovation. In
the first 3 years, classroom observations were made in BCP schools. Overall, DI
curriculum and instructional methods were implemented in BCP schools, though
implementation did not proceed at the desired rate in kindergarten until year 4.
Implementation of core knowledge was not envisioned to begin until year 3 and
preceded more slowly than DI implementation. A lack of access to data about other
interventions was presented as a limitation of the study and this could inform RTP
efforts as participants identified the desire to be well informed.
The experiences of this longitudinal research raised issues about the transfer of
research to practice as achievement tests data indicated mixed results for students,
depending on subject, grade level, and school. Results were most positive for
76
mathematics computation with students moving from the 16th percentile at the end
of grade 1 to the 46th percentile by the end of grade 3. This was compared to growth
from the control group moving from the 27th to the 36th percentile over the same
period. DI students made the most significant improvements in mathematics
computation and reading. The effectiveness of the continuous structure and logical
progression of the program with the need for ongoing PD to implement the program
with integrity were issues raised. The ability to regularly identify student progress
was identified as a strength, yet frustrations about the robotic nature of the program
and lack of flexibility were identified through focus groups. In brief staff preferences
and needs of the students within specific settings were identified as priorities in the
implementation of DI in the Baltimore Curriculum Project.
Appelbaum & Schwartzbeck (2002) questioned CSR programs' evidence of
effectiveness and the evaluations' degree of rigor in a report that presented the
outcomes of a meeting of CSR researchers on how CSR should be evaluated. The
discussion focussed on the goals of CSR and definitions of "success". Methods of
measuring success in a CSR context and the critical role of the district in the success
of reform were also presented. Recommendations included developing common
measures of achievement and implementation to ensure consistency and the need for
a mutually agreed upon definition of "significant" student progress. The importance
of developing universal standards for good implementation was prioritised. As CSR
is based on the implementation of research-based practices, these recommendations
may guide student achievement using research-based projects.
77
Bain and Hess’ (2000) study sought to establish whether changes in faculty
members' perceptions of their work environment compared with the implementation
of the School Design Model (SDM) program. Stakeholders’ perceptions of their
contribution to students, collegial support, and autonomy in a secondary school were
examined over four years from 1993-1997. The first administration occurred during
a pilot phase of the SDM when the school's traditional independent school program
and a pilot of the SDM program were both in operation. The second administration
occurred 2 years later during the full implementation of the program, and the third
during the continuation phase after an additional 2 years. Results indicated higher
overall scores for faculty perceptions of culture in the SDM program over teachers in
the traditional program. These improvements remained stable in both the
implementation and continuation phases of the program. Comparison with a
benchmark study of over 40 schools revealed that despite the comprehensive reform
of the work environment, faculty remained positive toward their contribution to
students and felt more reinforced by peers. Although this study only represented one
case it provides valuable knowledge about RTP considerations. The interpretation of
results noted the benefits of a collaborative approach in providing the faculty with
collaborative problem solving and instructional decision making skills. Educators
indicated that having a sense that their efforts are making a difference is essential
irrespective of the RTP program selected or their paradigm approach. This work
links CSR and RTP as a need for a complete framework for implementation
including methods, design, tools and strategies was presented as being beneficial to
both initiatives.
78
More recently comprehensive school reform design efforts have built on this
knowledge and identified potential targets that contribute to making research
responsive to the needs of staff and students. Bain’s (2007) longitudinal Self
Organizing School (SOS) case study took place at the Brewster Academy, a private
secondary setting catering for 350, grade 9-13 students and span across a decade.
The project employed the School Design Model (SDM) as a strategic methodology
to build a new program that responded to commonly identified issues that have
emerged from RTP literature. Limitations of this study include the inability to
assign children to conditions and the normal faculty turn over within an 8 year
period. The study employed a theory-based approach to the challenges of site-based
reform and identified a number of implementation and RTP factors relating to the
content and process of CSR. Knowledge of these factors were identified during the
change process and included nine targets which represent critical areas of need and
potential goals of next generation comprehensive school reform design (Bain, 2007).
The nine targets are presented individually as they reflect knowledge gained from
SFA, DI and other CSR efforts. They include educational power,
comprehensiveness, emergent feedback, systemic technology, professional lives,
school level design for school level influence, effective adoption, implementation
integrity and theory (Bain, 2007). These targets collectively summarize assertions
identified through research and commentary pieces as they present an approach that
deepens our comprehension of the challenges and future opportunities associated
with intersecting RTP content and process.
79
Educational Power is a target that assists in making the migration from research to
practice by suggesting that in the first instance an approach needs to have the
research based capacity to bridge the gap. It refers to the research effect size as
minimal when measured against effort, time and money expended and suggests that
research based practice must be leveraged in sustainable ways to magnify the desired
effects. In brief educators need to be sure that research has “power” before applying
it. The second related target theory pertains to the need for a complete framework.
The implications of the use of theory in the responsiveness of research category are
that this target could identify and address the issues that get in the way of RTP.
Theory and educational power represent targets that can be linked to give research
the framework and leverage to directly respond to the needs of individual settings.
Emergent feedback, effective adoption and school level design for school level
influence support and deepen administrative backing and supportive environment
factors knowledge. Emergent feedback has proven to be beneficial as a feature of
the program design as it allows the monitoring and management of implementation
through responsive, timely and relevant feedback. Through the use of school level
design, interventions that address school level factors can be scaled beyond single
classrooms. School leadership can be a key factor connecting content,
implementation of design with people, processes and systems. Professional lives
describe initial teacher enthusiasm and can be linked with TE efforts to raise
awareness of how this passion can readily turn to fatigue and disappointment.
Professional lives also refer to how teacher’s jobs are defined, recognized and
rewarded. The acknowledgment of these dimensions and concerns related to the
80
status and expectations of educators can assist in the planning and practical
application of research efforts.
Collectively these factors combine to create a strong case for their use in a RTP
investigation, which aims to validate elements that contribute to the well-
documented RTP gap. As a goal of comprehensive school reform is to make the
many parts work together, knowledge of these targets assist in raising an awareness
of elements that go beyond these usual RTP factors. In sum CSR efforts have
consolidated and expanded on previous literatures to identify themes that echo and
expand upon previous literatures.
These themes include scalability and educational power, comprehensiveness and
supportive environments and structures. Scalability and educational power identifies
the need for teacher training and use of scientific research. It suggests research is
validated and has scalability potential prior to application. Elements of Bain’s
(2007) school level design for school level influence target fall into this theme as
knowledge of the practical elements must be considered in order to scale projects.
The second theme is titled comprehensiveness. In order to make projects
comprehensive, previously identified collaboration themes are essential. The CSR
literature expands on this and identifies the need for a complete framework.
Knowledge of the intersection of content and process will assist in identifying factors
that assist schools in working together as a self reinforcing whole.
Comprehensiveness also refers to the project being comprehensive by design, by
being adequate and complete. The third theme, supportive environments and
structures expand upon previous notions of support. This is done through the
81
introduction of calls for the use of systemic technology and well-aligned system and
policy goals. This theme also incorporates parent and community involvement in
supporting school activities. The use of evaluation as an emergent function rather
than an add on may also support planning and implementation efforts.
The final section introduces the Concerns Based Adoption Model (CBAM) as it
represents a prolific longstanding model related to adopting change. This model is
presented as a final component of this literature review as changed approaches are
required from both researchers and educators as they strive to bridge the RTP gap.
Increased knowledge of stages of concerns associated with change may raise
awareness of both personal and environmental features and assist in preparing and
accommodating future RTP efforts.
2.5. Concerns Based Adoption Model (CBAM)
The Concerns-Based Adoption Model is a framework that was developed at the
University of Texas and has implications for practice as it raises an awareness of the
factors involved with a change process (Hall & Hord, 1987; Hord, Rutherford,
Huling-Austin, & Hall, 1987; Loucks-Horsley & Stiegelbauer, 1991). The basis of
this model can provide a diverse lens into a deeper awareness of ways RTP transition
can be enhanced through the raised knowledge of how to support change.
The CBAM model presented below identifies the primary concerns of individuals in
the process of change. They are beneficial as they suggest that anticipating people’s
concerns can enable innovators to focus on appropriate forms of support. This work
also reassures innovators that it is possible to anticipate much that will occur during
82
a change process. The primary concerns of individuals in the process of change are
identified in these seven stages.
2.6. Stages of Concern
Awareness. At this stage, individuals are not concerned about the innovation.
Information. Individuals would like to know more about the innovation before they
adopt the change and undertake new practices.
Personal. People at this stage are beginning to think about how the change will
affect them.
Management. Concerns about how to make the change work characterize this stage.
Consequence. Individuals are beginning to make the new practices their own and
now are concerned about how the change is affecting students.
Collaboration. People at this stage are trying to connect their work to what others
are doing.
Refocusing. Individuals now have integrated the practices into their professional
lives and are examining ways to improve these practices.
More than three decades ago Hord, Rutherford, Huling-Austin & Hall (1978)
grouped the seven stages into three main concerns. The first 2 stages can be seen as
concern for self: I am not concerned about the innovation; I would like to know more
about it; how will using it affect me? Stage 3 is a task orientated concern: I seem to
be spending all my time getting materials ready; keeping track of progress is
83
difficult; I am still not sure how to do this. Stages 4 to 6 are concern for impact: I
am looking at the effects of the innovation on my students; I am concerned about
relating what I am doing with what other instructors are doing; I have some ideas
about something that would work even better.
Horsley & Loucks-Horsley’s (1998) commentary piece added clarity to the CBAM
framework. They suggested that when most educators think of change they think of
a new program or practice. Horsley & Loucks-Horsley (1998) proposed that
programs do not represent change they are examples of the content of change.
CBAM identified the parallel between the natural and developmental process
individuals go through when they engage in something new or different.
CBAM examines this process in three distinct ways:
Stages of Concern (introduced above).
Levels of Use.
Innovation Components.
2.7. Levels of Use
Levels of use described the behavioural dimension of change. This referred to what
teachers do in the classroom when making the transition from teaching one way to
teaching differently. There are three Levels of Use that define nonusers of a
program these include:
Level 0, Non-use. Refers to no action being taken with regard to the program or
practice;
84
Level I, Orientation. Refers to a person seeking information about the program or
practice;
Level II, Preparation. Identifies that a decision has been made to adopt the new
practice, and the person is actively preparing to implement it.
CBAM also reveals five distinct Levels of Use among users:
Level III, Mechanical. Reflects early attempts to use new strategies, techniques and
materials.
Level IVa, Routine. The establishment of a satisfactory pattern of behaviours.
Level IVb, Refinement. Refers to where people feel comfortable and go beyond the
routine and assess the impact of their efforts and making changes to increase that
impact.
Level V, Integration. When people are actively coordinating with others to use the
innovation.
Level VI, Renewal. The final level where people seek more effective alternatives to
the established use of the innovation.
85
2.8. Innovation Components
Innovation Components or Configurations referred to the importance of recognizing
the specific parts of a change. They provided staff developers with tools called
Practice Profiles. Practice Profiles require an innovation to be formally defined. A
description of the resources and conditions necessary to implement them with critical
program components identified.
This description of the three aspects of CBAM above have been introduced due to
the knowledge it presented on the crucial phases of change. This information
yielded knowledge of factors that may contribute to the transition of RTP,
particularly in the early implementation phases.
In an early case study example conducted by Pratt, Hall, Hord & Thurder (1982) that
demonstrated the collaborative efforts of multiple agenda and agencies, a concise
overview of the basic assumptions, which outlined the improvement process of
CBAM, were presented. These CBAM assumptions have been considered in the
search of factors that contributed to the sustainment of research based applications as
they have successfully united efforts by teachers, curriculum developers, staff
developers, school administrators, principals, evaluators and researchers (Pratt,
1982). Participants included staff of three different agencies across America. These
agencies included the staff developers at Jefferson County, Colorado, staff
developers at Beach County Schools Florida and a team of researchers at the
Research and Development Centre at the University of Texas. Qualitative and
quantitative data was collected over 4 years and emphasis was placed on analysing
86
what occurs at individual teacher and classroom level when innovations are
introduced.
Claims that change is a process not an event were identified in this research (Hall,
1980; Horsley & Loucks-Horsley, 1998; Pratt, 1982). Results indicated that change
could not simply be viewed in terms of larger organisational factors. Change (or
RTP endeavours) must be viewed from the point of view of the many individuals
who participate in it. Teachers, administrators and others experienced efforts to
improve school projects individually as well as collectively. This implied that
individual members of a community must be considered when change is expected.
Through using the knowledge outlined in Pratt et.al.’s (1982) planning,
implementation, and evaluation of two CBAM case studies, a deeper comprehension
of factors that could expand upon RTP knowledge may be gained.
The use of CBAM to address teachers concerns was demonstrated through Jefferson
County (Colorado) Schools program to improve elementary science curriculum and
instruction and the Palm Beach (Florida) Schools development and implementation
of the Unified Curriculum program. This research emphasized the important role of
training and the importance collaborative efforts. The authors suggested that staff
and principals do not benefit from one or two-day workshop and those principals do
affect teacher’s implementation and use of new programs. A short list of key change
principles was presented at the conclusion of this research. The additional principles
that had relevance for future RTP efforts included the need to develop as much
clarity and consideration about the operational components of the innovation prior to
implementation. When all stakeholders have input into expectations and a common
87
understanding about the implementation less confusion results. Professional
development should occur over time and address participants concerns as “pre-use
launch” workshops are ineffective. Finally an advance plan of the overall design of
the intervention had been presented as critical. This principle allows for increased
continuity and support as provisions for staff meetings, newsletters and day-to-day
occurrences can be planned for and closely interrelated complementing each other.
Rutherford (1982) conducted a study that examined whether principals have similar
stages of concern about their change facilitator role, and, if they have concerns about
the shift as the change process unfolds. Five short case studies were presented to
illustrate how the Stages of Concern looked and shifted during the period of the
study. Interviews were conducted with 5 principals at different settings and case
study notes were collected. A limitation included that verification of tentative data
on the relationship between the principal’s experience and identified concerns. The
author noted that if this data had been verified it would have had important
implications for the staff development of change facilitators. Results indicated that
while change facilitators' concerns are different in content from those of teachers, the
overall concern dynamic seems to be the same. RTP implications that fall from this
research included that the teacher is a major contributor to facilitating change in
schools. This impacts on the role of the principal, as a top down approach may be
detrimental to the transition of research to practice. Another implication was that
effective PD or TE must consider the needs and concerns of individuals. These
concerns will change at different points in time and RTP efforts that are aware and
cater for these changes through training and resources may be more effective.
88
Rutherford (1986) presented a meeting paper reporting on teachers' contributions to
school improvement. Through reflecting on fifteen years of research his report
presented findings of research studies on how teachers responded to attempts to
implement educational innovations. Details on how this information was
accumulated and synthesized were not located however a summary presents insights
on how teachers’ beliefs could impact upon the transition of RTP. The author
claimed that in many cases, teachers believe their future in relation to the innovation
is determined not by them, but by some superior. Other teacher responses indicated
that change will soon fade away as other fads have. Some teachers may also give the
impression that they are using an innovation when, in fact, they are not. Researchers
have concluded that teachers are most often the recipients rather than the initiators of
any change affecting their classrooms and are therefore resistant to innovations. It is
pointed out that although it is essential that teachers be receptive to change, when
large numbers of participants are involved, developing universal teacher ownership
of the change is difficult. The Concerns-Based Adoption Model provided a systemic
plan for facilitating change that gives teachers priority consideration. This report
raised awareness of teacher perceptions and strengthens the importance of shared
ownership between researcher and educators when implementing research-based
practices.
Huberman and Miles (1987) conducted a CBAM validity study that combined
quantitative data from 146 school districts with case studies from 12 sites to examine
the process of innovation in schools. A spectrum of contexts ranging from maths,
counselling, reading to environmental and social sciences were investigated. Phases
89
of the implementation framework included ways to identify the adoption, early
implementation and later implementation phases of innovation were employed to
analyse the feelings and concerns of the teachers from 12 sites. Huberman and Miles
(1987) proposed that concerns appeared to be self-orientated during early
experiences with innovations. This implied that to implement change stakeholders
must change first. Concerns regarding efficient management, collaboration,
refocussing and student consequences or effects were said to occur during the later
stages of implementation. Huberman and Miles (1987) efforts supported the CBAM
shift in concerns from self to practice or task-orientated concerns. They also
proposed that programs need different types of nourishment to mature. They must
address the stakeholder’s needs, feelings and perceptions prior to addressing
program-orientated concerns. This implied that for research to be translated to
practice, factors that attend to the personal concerns must be addressed initially.
RTP initiatives may then move into more mature stages where they build on initial
experiences and task orientated concerns become a priority.
Horsley & Loucks-Horsley (1998) presented the phases described above and
introduced additional key themes embodied in the model. They identified their bias
early and stated they were involved in the development of CBAM. Their article
described ways CBAM can be used when developing and evaluating staff training
efforts. The first three stages of the CBAM model have implications for teacher
education in a RTP context. The first stage involved attending to where people are at
and addressing their concerns. Secondly, the allocation of realistic time frames with
responsive assistance was determined to be critical to the implementation of new
90
interventions. Finally, new innovations for teachers often grafted on top of regular
expectations, placing increased and unrealistic demands on teachers. The
identification of such elements through CBAM research raised awareness of possible
factors beneficial to the progression of reform efforts. This work expanded RTP
knowledge beyond the usual claims made through intervention research.
This tri phased CBAM system identified an awareness of participant needs initially,
prior to moving into a middle management driven stage focusing on task mastery.
The final stages of concern related to the impact of an activity and related results.
This knowledge broadened claims that research must respond to the needs of
individuals and drew attention to their specific needs for information, assistance and
support (Bybee, 2005). Through work on CBAM stages of concern educators and
researchers gained an increased awareness of a research based developmental
process, which may guide implementation and sustainment efforts (Sweeny, 2003).
Davidson’s (2010) action research using mixed methods employed CBAM’s stages
of concern continuum to determine if PD alters the concerns of junior high teachers
toward inclusion. Training occurred over four months and was focused on inclusion
and incorporated information on building communities, developing strategies for
collaboration, equity, accommodations to student learning and the change process.
Results identified that teachers were concerned about managing tasks whilst
overcoming barriers to inclusion and the impact that the use of inclusive practice has
on them and their students. This study provided recent insights on the factors to
consider when employing PD to establish inclusive communities of practice.
91
The CBAM literature expanded upon around three themes identified in review.
They are research based change process, support through change and collaboration.
The first theme identifies the work of Horsley and Loucks-Horsley (1998) and
recognised that change is a process, not an event. It implied that PD should occur
over time and be dynamic in addressing participants changing needs. Through
raising awareness of the change developmental process the recognition that changes
in support structures followed. The second theme Support through change identified
that comprehensive change goes far beyond the individual. As change is a highly
personal experience involving developmental growth in feelings as well as and skills
and knowledge, sustained assistance was required. This assistance will need to
change as required by the changing needs of the stakeholders. The final theme
collaboration once again echoes the previous sub themes. In the CBAM literature
the notion of collaboration was expanded to include shared ownership of the
elements involved in and resulting from change process. Collaborative efforts may
change to address the changing needs of stakeholders and their environments.
The practical knowledge gained from CBAM and CSR projects such as Slavin’s
Success for All and Bain’s Self Organizing School efforts provided an insight into
the challenges associated with merging content and process. They collectively
delved deeper than prior curriculum or intervention based initiatives to provide an
insight into the totality of the life of a school and the issues around RTP. The
knowledge of the RTP factors gained through intervention research were linked with
CBAM and CSR efforts to gain a more comprehensive perspective of ways to
enhance the use of research innovations. Table 2.3 presents that major themes
92
identified through RTP, PD, TE, CSR and CBAM literature. The major themes
identified in each of the literature summaries are collated through the outlined bodies
of literature and have been presented along with the authors who presented the
specific factors in Table 2.3.
93
Table 2.3
Consistency and development of RTP literature based within and across identified areas
Research to practice Professional development Teacher education CSR CBAM
Collaboration Collaboration Collaboration Collegiality Collaboration
Shared responsibility,
understanding,
contribution and
ownership (Gunstone &
Northfield, 1986; Hall,
1982; Kratochwill &
Shernoff, 1993; Seashore
& Jones, 2001).
Collegiality, mutual
respect and
Cooperation (Foegen et
al., 2001; Foorman &
Moats, 2004; Fuchs &
Fuchs, 1998, 2001; Toch,
1982; Vaughn et al.,
2001).
Substantive frequent
interaction and
communication (Carnine,
Joint partnerships
(Ysseldyke, 1989; Gersten
et al., 1997; Gravani,
2008).
Mutually identified
boundaries, structures and
purposes (Gravani, 2008).
“Buy in” from all
stakeholders (Klingner et
al., 2003).
Engagement in pursuit of
genuine questions,
problems and solutions
(Sydoriak & Fields, 1997;
Vaughn et al., 1998).
Joint partnerships/active
involvement (Klingner et
al., 2004; Malouf &
Schiller, 1995).
Teacher contribution and
involving practitioners in
the research process
(Billups et al., 1997;
Darling-Hammond, 1994;
Gravani, 2008; Grimes &
Tilly, 1996).
Multiple level feedback
(Grimes & Tilly, 1996).
Responsive, cohesive
course structures (Miller et
al., 2005).
Mutually aligned norms,
expectations and roles
Need for complete theory
framework (Bain, 2007)
Intersection of process and
content (Tyack & Cuban,
1995)
Adequate and complete
design (Bain, 2007; Bain
and Hess, 2000)
Self reinforcing (Bain,
2007)
Well aligned system and
policy goals (Bain, 2007)
Shared ownership of the
elements involved in and
resulting from the change
process (Horsley &
Loucks-Horsley, 1998;
Rutherford, 1982)
Shared acknowledgement
of changing needs of
stakeholders and
environments (Huberman
& Miles, 1987;
Rutherford, 1982)
Understood by all and
united (Pratt et al., 1982)
Awareness of shared
ownership and individual
strength (Rutherford,1982)
Communities of practice
94
1997; Sydoriak & Fields,
1997; Toch, 1982).
Feedback (Carnine, 1997;
Sydoriak & Fields, 1997).
(Goodlad, 1993).
Critical in developing
links between theory and
practice (Winn &
Zundans, 2004).
Consistent and coherent
(Grimes & Tilly, 1996).
Flexibility (Mac Iver,
Kemper & Stringfield,
2003).
(Davidson, 2010)
Resource Support and PD Support Support Supportive Environments
& Structures
Support through change
Long term with adequate
time and materials (Bain,
2007b; Fuchs & Fuchs,
2001; J. Klingner, S.
Ahwee, P. Pilonieta, & R.
Menendez, 2003;
Schneider & McDonald,
2006; Vaughn & Klingner,
2000).
Positive attitude from
students and peers and
pride in academic
Teachers need to feel
sufficiently prepared (2.7)
Networks (Klingner et al.,
1999).
Sufficient instructional
time (Klingner et al.,
2003)
Adequate resources
(Klingner et al., 2003).
Addresses teacher
enthusiasm and concerns
(Gersten, et al., 2007b;
Miller, et al., 2005).
Awareness of fatigue and
exhaustion (Gersten et al.,
2007; Miller et al., 2005).
Support personnel
qualities and attributes (El-
Dinary et al., 1994).
Emergent feedback (Bain,
2007)
Evaluation as an emergent
function rather than an add
on (Bain, 2007)
Use of systemic
technology (Bain, 2007)
Long term and consistent
(Hurley et al., 2001)
Sustained assistance
(Horsley & Loucks-
Horsley, 1998; Rutherford,
1982)
Support structures must
change as needs change
(Horsley & Loucks-
Horsley, 1998; Rutherford,
1982)
Beyond individuals
(Huberman & Miles,
95
achievement (Foorman &
Moats, 2004).
Well developed student
materials (Klingner et al.,
(2003).
Professional Development
Consistent (Billups et al.,
1997; Gunstone &
Northfield, 1986).
Address needs (Billups et
al., 1997; Carnine, 1997;
Seashore & Jones, 2001).
Active teacher
involvement (Sydoriak &
Fields, 1997).
Review research to
increase research
knowledge (Sydoriak &
Fields, 1997).
Ongoing stakeholder
support and assistance
(Klingner et al., 2003).
Limiting competing
demands to achieve a
balance of multiple
agendas (Vaughn et.al.,
1998).
Scientifically based
instructional practices
(Little & Houston, 2003).
Evidence based and
proven to be effective with
an integration of
instruction, assessment
and classroom
management components
(Slavin, 2004).
Central to students
learning and students
performing well (Klingner
et al., 2003).
Viewed as credible by
teachers (Klingner et al.,
Need for theory and well
designed programs to
make TE more coherent
(Grimes & Tilly, 1996).
Adequate depth and time
to research based practices
(Foorman & Moats, 2004).
Well developed student
materials, teacher
manuals, assessment and
training (Slavin, 2004)
Professional Lives
acknowledgement of the
need for recognition and
reward (Bain, 2007)
Instructional leader
support for the project
(Hurley et al., 2001)
Regular identification of
student progress (Mac
Iver, Kemper &
Stringfield, 2003)
1987)
From multiple agencies,
levels and agendas (Pratt
et al., 1982)
Within realistic time
frames (Horsley &
Loucks-Horsley, 1998)
96
1999).
Comprehensive
(McLeskey & Billingsley,
2008).
Responsiveness of
research
Responsiveness Responsiveness of
University education
programs
Scalability and
Educational Power
Research Based Change
Process
Useable (Billups et al.,
1997; Carnine, 1997;
Seashore & Jones, 2001).
Practical and responsive to
needs (Carnine, 1997;
Lloyd, Weintraub & Safer,
1997).
Accessible (Billups et al.,
1997; Carnine, 1997).
Trustworthy (Carnine,
1997).
Evidence based (Slavin,
2004).
Manageable and efficient
(Carnine, 1997; Gunstone
PD programs must
respond to genuine teacher
needs and concerns (Little
& Houston, 2003).
Reflective of student and
staff needs (Little &
Houston, 2003).
Responds to classroom
contexts and
organizational demands
(Klingner et al., 2003).
Consistency (Billups et al.,
1997; Gunstone &
Northfield, 1986).
Joint partnerships (Miller
et al., 2005).
Research based (Slavin,
2004)
Effective delivery (Foegen
et al., 2001).
Good contextual fit
(Miller et al., 2005).
Valued by students (Winn
& Zundans, 2004).
Address real life needs and
concerns (Little &
Houston, 2003; Klingner
et al., 2003).
Need for opportunities and
Use of scientific research
(Borman et. al., 2002)
Validated with scalability
potential (Bain, 2007;
Borman et. al., 2002)
Joint partnerships
(Borman et. al., 2002)
School level design for
school level influence
(Bain, 2007)
Effective adoption
(Appelbaum &
Schwartzbeck, 2002)
Self reinforcing (Bain,
2007)
Responds to personal
growth in knowledge and
skills (Horsley & Loucks-
Horsley, 1998; Rutherford,
1982)
Process not an event (Hall,
1980; Pratt et al., 1982;
Horsley & Loucks-
Horsley, 1998)
Change is a highly
personal experience
(Horsley & Loucks-
Horsley, 1998; Rutherford,
1982)
PD should occur over time
and be dynamic in
addressing varying
97
& Northfield, 1986).
Examined in rich contexts
and grounded in practice
with research details
provided (Billups et al.,
1997; Carnine, 1997;
Sydoriak & Fields, 1997).
Joint ownership (Sydoriak
& Fields, 1997).
time for practical
development of classroom
based skills and
knowledge (Winn &
Zundans, 2004).
Continuous program
structure and logical
progression (Mac Iver,
Kemper & Stringfield,
2003)
participant needs and
abilities (Rutherford,
1982)
98
2.9. Review of the literature
In summary the RTP literature indicates that for research to be responsive through an
intersection of process and content, the themes identified in table 2.3 needs to be addressed.
Consistency in these themes was evident although each theme was interpreted in different
ways in each of the domains (PD, TE, CSR and CBAM). Initial RTP comments by Carnine’s
(1997) and others included the importance of teacher contribution, trustworthiness, usability,
accessibility of educational research and the need for consistent research findings are
supported and expanded upon in later literature based searches (Billups, 1997; Breslin &
Buchanan, 2008; Capizzi & Fuchs, 2005; Carnine, 1997b; De Landsheere, Masoner,
Masoner, Dickson, & Kida, 1981; Foegen, et al., 2001; L. S. Fuchs & D. Fuchs, 1998; Hall,
1978; Hall & Pratt, 1984; Hord, 1981; Horsley & Loucks-Horsley, 1998; Kornblet, 1997;
Malone, 1984; Malouf & Schiller, 1995; Miller, et al., 2005; Miretzky, 2007; Pratt, 1982;
Rutherford, 1986; D. Sydoriak & M. Fields, 1997) .
Other intervention research raised an awareness of the need to be responsive to organizational
demands; the need to display tolerance for initial implementation difficulties and the
importance of recognizing accomplishments and encouraging feedback on multiple levels
(Grima-Farrell, Bain & McDonagh, 2011; (Hargreaves, 2007; Hasbrouck, Woldbeck, Ihnot,
& Parker, 1999; Miller, et al., 2005). In an effort to search beyond these commonly
identified RTP factors, a broader search was conducted that links accumulated RTP
knowledge to the totality of school based RTP efforts directly.
CSR provided a deeper insight and additional awareness of the RTP context, the elements
and factors required to implement and sustain reform efforts. This increased knowledge
about the practical capacity of such complex reform initiatives provided research based
99
information on ways reform efforts contribute to making research more responsive (Aladjem,
et al., 2006; Bain, 2007b; Bain & Hess, 2001; McLeskey & Waldron, 2006; Sherwood, 1999;
Slavin & Madden, 2001). CSR efforts specifically identified a diverse range of elements that
contributed either directly or indirectly to the factors that were suggested to influence RTP.
Hord, Rutherford, Huling-Austin, and Fall’s (1987) suggestion that "one of the most common
and serious mistakes made by …leaders of a change process is to presume that once an
innovation has been introduced and initial training has been completed the intended users
(teachers) will put the innovation into practice" (1987, p. v) was supported by Klingner et. al
(2003), who advocated that sustaining a project is a process, not an event. Researchers
sought to establish long-term collaborative partnerships with schools as a way to facilitate
change and enhance sustainability (Abbott et al., 1999; El-Dinary, Pressley, Coy-Ogan, &
Schuder, 1994; MacArthur, Schwartz, Graham, Molloy, & Harris, 1996; Schumm & Vaughn,
1995; Vaughn, Hughes, Schumm, & Klingner, 1998). These partnerships have promoted
deeper involvement from teachers and included some form of ongoing support from the
project implementation team after the initial instruction in research-based practices has taken
place.
Some teachers have effectively implemented and sustained research based instructional
practices over time whereas others have not implemented the practices at all (Englert &
Tarrant, 1995; Fuchs & Fuchs, 1998; Gersten et al., 1995; Gersten et al., 1997; Jenkins &
Leicester, 1992; Klingner, Vaughn, Hughes, & Arguelles, 1999; Scanlon, Deshler, &
Schumaker, 1996; Vaughn et al., 1998). Most studies that contributed to this knowledge are
of a brief duration. The NRP (2000) found few studies that went beyond a single year. This
was evident even when high levels of support were provided (El-Dinary et al., 1994). This
100
suggested that personal qualities and attributes of teachers might also need to be considered
in establishing effective graduate experiences. These variables may impact upon the
project’s success, as one’s ability to be innovative and differentially engage in a professional
capacity with research based projects over a length of time may be a factor worth
investigating further.
Nuthall (2004) proposed an explanatory theory that links research and teaching assertions.
He suggested the RTP gap may be bridged if research provides continuous, detailed data on
individual experiences, analyses changes, skills, beliefs and identifies and responds to real
time interactive relationships. This purported the need to investigate whether the factors and
features of a teacher education course are replicated in respective school based settings.
The consistencies in the teacher education research to practice literature indicated that
research alone could only provide a road map to practice. Suggestions that attention should
be given to organizational issues so that research based practices can be sustained over time
warrant additional investigation (Miller et. al., 2005). For the RTP gap to be reduced a need
exist to incorporate empirically derived educational practices into the instructional repertoire
of educators (Grima-Farrell, Bain & McDonaugh, 2011; Foegan et.al., 2001), as teacher
knowledge and context are important to conceptualizing the relationship between research
and practice (Malouf et.al., 1995).
Reducing the research to practice gap is said to be possible, when educators are informed and
actively involved in the process (Grimes and Tilly, 1996). Although significant challenges
do exist, the collection of research to practice literature highlights that well designed teacher
education programs, which are collaborative, coherent, responsive, provide support and
101
feedback on multiple levels can positively support research efforts in practical applications
(Darling-Hammond, 2006b; Francis, 2002; Gunstone & Northfield, 1993). These assertions
reflected a need for additional investigation through collaborative university and school
partnerships to reduce the research to practice gap (Russell et al., 2001; Bates, 2002; Sullivan,
2002; Korthagen, 2004). Darling-Hammond (2005) suggests that teacher effectiveness is
strongly linked to the preparation teachers receive. Therefore if schools and universities are
collaboratively involved in examining factors that contribute to the research to practice gap,
identified barriers may be overcome (Grimes & Tilly, 1996; Miller, et al., 2005). This work
coincides with an increasing recognition of the capacity of teacher education as a locus for
addressing the research to practice gap and calls for additional investigation utilizing specific
RTP practice cases which share a common inclusive teacher education experience (Blanton,
Griffin, Winn, & Pugach, 1997; Winn & Zundans, 2004; Gravani, 2007; Darling-Hammond,
2005).
Teacher education was a key factor in this research as each of the coordinators of the RTP
projects under investigation shared the same graduate preparation program. Given that
teacher education was a unifying factor across all six cases, it represented a key focus and
created a central avenue for the investigation. In essence, this literature review was a pivotal
part of the methodology as subsequent explanation and expansion components were
dependent on the underpinning exploration of those factors asserted in the RTP literature.
The review concluded with a synthesis within and across key RTP areas and a description of
the role of the literature as a methodological frame for the study.
102
2.10. Literature review conclusion
While the discussion of RTP was extensive, there were few empirical studies
specifically focused on the translation of RTP in inclusive education settings. This
review integrated, in a narrative approach, the larger commentary and opinion
literature with a small number of related research studies. It went further and
investigated PD, TE, CSR and CBAM literature that informed RTP efforts. Major
themes presented as ways to assist researchers and practitioners in reducing the RTP
gap are presented in Table 2.3. These include the responsiveness of research,
collaboration and support. This table presents the consistencies and expansion of
asserted RTP factors from five bodies of literature across these identified themes.
Overall, the research articles support the major themes identified in opinion papers
and reflective essays. The initial RTP comments by Carnine (1997) and others
including the importance of teacher contribution, trustworthiness, usability,
accessibility of educational research and the need for consistent research findings are
supported and expanded upon in later literature-based searches (Billups, 1997;
Breslin & Buchanan, 2008; Capizzi & Fuchs, 2005; Carnine, 1997; Davidson, 2010;
De Landsheere, Masoner, Masoner, Dickson, & Kida, 1981; Foegen et al., 2001; D.
Fuchs & L.S. Fuchs, 1998; Grima-Farrell, et. al ., 2011; Hall, 1978; Hall & Pratt,
1984; Hord, 1981; Horsley & Loucks-Horsley, 1998; Kornblet, 1997; Lloyd et al.,
1997; Malone, 1984; Malouf & Schiller, 1995; Miller et al., 2005; Miretzky, 2007;
Pratt, Thurber, Hall, & Hord, 1982; Rutherford, 1986; Sydoriak & Fields, 1997).
Other intervention research raised an awareness of the need to be responsive to
organisational demands, the need to display tolerance for initial implementation
difficulties and the importance of recognising accomplishments and encouraging
103
feedback on multiple levels (Hargreaves, 2007; Hasbrouck, Woldbeck, Ihnot, &
Parker, 1999; Miller et al., 2005).
Researchers have sought to establish long-term collaborative partnerships with
schools as a way to facilitate change and enhance sustainability (Abbott et al., 1999;
El-Dinary, Pressley, Coy-Ogan, & Schuder, 1994; Klingner et al., 1998; Schumm &
Vaughn, 1995). Such partnerships have promoted deeper involvement from teachers
and included some form of ongoing support from the project implementation team
after the initial instruction in research-based practices had taken place.
The TE literature indicates that additional attention should be paid to organisational
issues so that research-based practices can be sustained over time (Miller et al.,
2005).
The need to incorporate empirically derived educational practices into the
instructional repertoire of educators has also been presented as a way to reduce the
RTP gap (Foegen et al., 2001). As a result, teacher knowledge and context are
important to conceptualising the relationship between research and practice making
classrooms more responsive to all students (Malouf & Schiller, 1995).
Reducing the RTP gap is said to be possible when educators are informed and
actively involved in the process (Grimes & Tilly, 1996). Although significant
challenges do exist, the RTP literature highlights that well-designed teacher
education programs, which are collaborative, coherent, responsive to stakeholder
needs, and provide support and feedback can positively support research efforts in
practical applications (Darling- Hammond, 2006b; Francis, 2002; Gunstone &
Northfield, 1993). These assertions reflect a need for additional investigation through
collaborative university and school partnerships to reduce the research-to-practice
gap (Korthagen, 2004). Darling-Hammond (2005) suggested that teacher
104
effectiveness is strongly linked to the preparation teachers receive. Therefore, if
schools and universities are collaboratively involved in examining factors that
contribute to the research-to-practice gap, identified barriers may be overcome
(Grimes & Tilly, 1996; Miller et al., 2005). This work coincides with an increasing
recognition of the capacity of teacher education as a locus for addressing the
research-to-practice gap. It calls for additional investigation utilising specific RTP
cases that share a common teacher education experience and address the diversity of
student needs (Blanton, Griffin, Winn, & Pugach, 1997; Darling-Hammond, 2005;
Gravani, 2008; Winn & Zundans, 2004). Collectively, researchers have described
models used to involve practitioners in the development, implementation and
maintenance of empirically validated interventions (Abbott et al., 1999; El-Dinary,
Pressley, Coy-Ogan, & Schuder, 1994; Vaughn et al., 1998; Vaughn et al., 2000).
Others have compared variations in the intensity of professional development
programs and described models used to deliver research-based education to teachers
(Darling-Hammond, 2005; Schumm & Vaughn, 1995). Those researchers have
focused their efforts on working more collaboratively with practising teachers to
improve the trustworthiness, accessibility, usability, attractiveness and
responsiveness of research.
This review yielded a cross-section of relevant guiding information on ways to
bridge the RTP gap. These areas of review fell broadly from theory-to-practice
assertions that claim to impact upon the transition of research to practice. The initial
investigation included RTP literature, which then led to an examination of PD, TE,
CSR and CBAM literature. As a result, the RTP factors identified three key RTP
themes: responsiveness of research, collaboration and support. The review provided
an integrative account of those factors that can promote RTP efforts, which can assist
105
in making our classrooms more inclusive. These factors can be addressed more
deeply through the implementation of much needed intervention research focused on
translating research into practice in applied settings.
This exploration of literature formed the initial phases of the response to calls for
additional research into the RTP and linking school based and university based
efforts. The results of this literature search informed the method section of this
investigation. The literature predicated the research questions and consequently the
progression of the research and tool development. Significant areas of literature that
yielded relevant guiding information on ways to bridge the research to practice gap
were identified. These areas of review fell broadly from theory to practice assertions
that claimed to impact upon the transition of research to practice. As the initial
investigation included RTP literature, which led to PD, which led to TE, which led to
CSR that led to CBAM literature, this study incorporated knowledge from five
linked RTP areas. This provided a broader knowledge base that planned to assist in a
deeper comprehension of the factors that impacted upon the transition of research to
practice. In brief, this base of knowledge was used to frame the methodology
employed in the study.
106
Chapter 3. Methods
3.1. Introduction
This chapter restates the purpose of the study and outlines the methodological
approach selected to address the research questions. It begins by broadly defining
case study in order to locate the placement of this research within this specific
methodology. The types of case study and related approaches that were used to
guide the design decisions are also presented. A definition of comparative case
studies with related strengths and limitations precedes the brief introduction of Yin’s
(1994) and Fraenkel and Wallen’s (2006) features of comparative case study.
Elements of both approaches were used to define the operational pathway of this
case study design. A replication logic is introduced to ensure consistency in
implementation. This is followed by the data collection methods, analysis and
validity techniques employed to gain a deeper understanding of the factors that
contribute to narrowing the RTP gap. The chapter concludes with a procedures
section that provides specific participant details, participant researcher bias, site,
research design, data collection and analysis processes follow this case defining
preface.
3.2. Overview and Purpose of the Study
A multiple or collective case study approach was used to investigate the
implementation of inclusive education reforms in six Western Sydney school
settings. The intent of this research was to ascertain those factors that influenced the
translation of research into practice. This was done by examining six discrete efforts
to implement research-based inclusive educational practices across a range of school
settings. Program implementations ranged from Kindergarten to a high school
107
education experience. The subject of the individual cases included literacy, peer
tutoring, spelling and in school staff development. The six cases represented a 60%
sample of students who participated in an education system funded Masters graduate
teacher professional experience program to promote inclusive education in the
sector.
Part of the experience involved designing and implementing an applied inclusive
education intervention in their schools. The six students who completed the graduate
level subject were required to conduct an independent research project. The
research-based project was to specifically address the needs of their individual
settings. This task was the culmination of a two and a half year university based
Masters course that was collaboratively designed using elements from
comprehensive and self-organizing school reform efforts.
The final subject (ESS527) within this Masters course was the capstone in the
program. The subject required students to implement an applied program in their
schools using a research-based practice drawn from prior learning in the course. The
course and subjects were designed using a theoretical framework derived from
research on complex systems (Pascale et.al, 2000) and developed by Bain (2007).
Bain (2007) identified six principles of self-organization these include simple rules,
embedded design, similarity at scale, feedback, dispersed control, and schema
applied to course design. The theory represented a response to concerns described
in the teacher education literature and called for coherent theory driven teacher
preparation programs (Gore et al., 2004, Tomlinson, 2001; Morrison, 2002; Davis &
Sumara, 2006).
108
This project intended to study six cases to build on prior knowledge, instantiate the
existing literature and expand the comprehension of the factors that both enabled and
interfered with the successful translation of research into practice in inclusive
education. This included examining the extent to which the factors identified in the
existing research in the area exerted an influence in the cases; explained the
influence of those factors and then expanded on existing research by investigating
other possible sources of influence on the RTP dimensions of the cases.
A multiple case study methodology was used to investigate whether the innovations
were sustained over time and what factors contributed to their status. An ex post
facto causal-comparative research design was employed to study the cases. Each
educational site was the subject of an individual case and the use of the multiple case
study method, allowed for the in-depth investigation of multiple cases within a range
of applied educational setting. This multiple case study design catered for the
investigation of the RTP phenomenon through extensive description and content
analysis. The evidence from multiple cases is considered more solid and compelling
than the investigation of single case (Herriott & Firestone, 1983; Yin, 2003),
enhancing the articulation of why the experiences occurred as they did.
Semi-structured and open-ended one to one interviews, focus groups, a survey and
analysis of permanent product records are methods that were employed to undertake
an in depth study of each case. Collected results were analyzed and compared across
cases. The questions were divided into three phases that represented the phases of
the study. The first phase being the exploration phase, examined literature and initial
teacher perceptions for relevant RTP factors. The second explanatory phase used
these literature based assertions to develop survey and interview questions.
109
Participant perspectives were collected as a response to these questions to explain the
factors that were detrimental or beneficial in addressing the purpose of this complex
case in real life interventions. The final expansion phase identified other RTP
factors that emerged as a result of this investigation. The data collection methods
were used to answer the following overarching question by responding to
exploration, explanation and expansion research questions (see figure 3.2 for
additional sub questions):
3.2.1. Overarching Research Question
What are the factors and relationships between them that contributed to the status of
research-based projects in inclusive education settings?
3.2.2. Exploration phase questions.
What factors that have been identified in previous literature contribute to sustaining
RBP in inclusive education settings? How have these factors been identified? To
what extent have these factors been validated through empirical research? What are
the existing key RTP gap contributors identified through initial teacher perception?
How do they compare to existing literature?
3.2.3. Explanation phase questions.
How do factors identified in the cases contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive
education settings? In what ways do those factors exert an influence?
Additional question established after the analysis of the data collection through the
exploration and explanation phases- How have the identified relationship between
factors exerted an influence on the practical application and sustainment of the
projects?
110
3.2.4. Expansion phase questions.
What factors, other than those identified in the exploration and expansion phases,
contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive education settings?
Additional question established after the analysis of the data collection through the
exploration and explanation phases- What were the differences and consistencies in
the relationships between the RTP factors that contributed to the status of the
projects that were identified by the research participants?
3.3. Case Study Research Design
Case study design falls broadly within the theoretical underpinnings of qualitative
research and has been selected for this research study. According to Creswell (1998)
a case study is defined as an exploration of a “bounded system” or a case (or
multiple cases) over time through detailed, in-depth data collection involving
multiple sources of information rich in context. Some consider “the case” as an
object of study (Stake, 1995) while others considered it a methodology (Merriam,
1998). Creswell (1998) described the bounded system as being bounded by time and
place, and it is the case being studied – a program, an event, an activity, or
individuals. It allowed for an important example to be “… studied extensively and
varied data are collected and used to formulate interpretations applied to specific
cases (e.g., a particular school board) or to provide generalizations” (Fraenkel &
Wallen, 2006, p.13).
Mirriam’s (1998) notion of a bounded system refers to each of the six research
projects as individual systems. Bounded within each unit are the people, experiences
and all details relevant to that one project and unique setting. Huberman and Miles
111
(2002) suggested that this strategy focuses on the understanding of case dynamics.
“It is crucial to have understood the dynamics of each case ......without that
superficiality sets in” (Miles and Huberman, 1994, p. 207). Case dynamics referred
to specific details that pertained to each case and the interrelationships between
them. According to Mishler (1986) and Miles and Huberman (1994) an
understanding of the synthesis of these details and relationships in each case is
required prior to effective cross case analysis.
In brief, this study is an investigation of the dynamics within each case in order to
gain specific details prior to any cross case analysis. The survey, interviews and
permanent product records provided details that were case specific. Yin’s (1994)
causal link proposal was investigated in “real life interventions”, to explore, explain
and expand the knowledge of factors that contributed to the status of each of the six
research based projects over a three year period across multiple settings. Given the
need for an explanation of real life complex causal links and an understanding of
specific case dynamics within and across each bounded system, case study design
was selected as the methodology for this investigation.
3.4. Types of Case Studies
The following section provides a brief overview of the types of case study design
that influenced the present research design. The diversity of case studies within the
flexible parameters of qualitative research has been used to unpack the elements
within and across each case. The works of Yin (1994), Datta (1990) and Fraenkel &
Wallen (2006) have influenced this causal comparative design framework and
elements of this work are presented. This section begins with a brief account of the
112
general uses and types of case study, prior to introducing the research framework for
this investigation.
A case study approach has been used widely in medical, business and legal
investigations. “In general, case studies are a preferred strategy…. when the
investigator has little control over events, and when the focus is on a contemporary
phenomenon within some real life context” (Yin, 1994, p.1). Case study research
has been employed in the field of education to study students with special needs into
the mainstream, the use of various technologies in educational settings, evaluating
comprehensive reforms and assessing the impact of Legislation on education (Janney
& Snell 1997: Armstrong, Galloway, & Tomlinson 1993; Edelman & Cloninger,
1994; Gilbert, 1998; Heward & Lloyd-Smith, 1990; Houck & Rogers, 1994; Yin &
Davies, 2007).
Broadly speaking this qualitative study is influenced by elements of the types of case
studies described by Yin (1994), Datta (1990) and Fraenkel & Wallen (2006). Datta
(1990) categorizes case studies into six groups, which include illustrative case
studies, exploratory case studies, critical instance case studies, program
implementation case studies, program effect case studies and cumulative case
studies. Features of Datta’s (1990) program effects case study design provided a
lens to investigate the impact of programs and provide inference about reasons for
success or failure. Datta’s (1990) features that influenced this design included the
use of methods such as examining literature to identify specific findings or
assertions. Case study investigations are then used to maximize the usefulness of
this information.
113
Stake (cited in Fraenkel & Wallen, 2006) identified three types of case studies,
intrinsic, instrumental and multiple. In an intrinsic study the researcher is
specifically interested in understanding a situation or an individual. Through
detailed description, the researcher seeks to understand the case in all parts,
including its inner workings. Intrinsic case studies are often used in exploratory
research in which the aim is to understand more about some little known
phenomenon by studying it in depth. Instrumental case study is interested in more
than a particular case. The researcher investigates a particular case as a means to a
larger goal. They are interested in drawing conclusions that apply beyond a
particular case. Multiple case studies involve a number of cases being investigated
at the same time as part of one overall study to generate the detailed description
within and between cases. This research is an example of a multiple case study
design as the six cases were investigated concurrently as part of one RTP
investigation.
Yin (1994) provided a specific description of six types of case studies identified (see
table 3.1). He suggested that exploratory, descriptive and explanatory studies can
exist within single and multiple case study designs. One of the major variables
between these six different design types is the number of cases employed, and the
functions they serve. “Nevertheless, this does not imply that the boundaries between
the strategies - or the occasions when each is to be used - are always clear and sharp.
Even though each strategy has its distinctive characteristics, there are large areas of
overlap among them” (Yin, 1994, p.4). Yin (1994) described descriptive cases that
require a descriptive theory that must cover the depth and scope of the case under
study. Case studies have additionally been loosely defined in terms of the
114
disciplinary orientation or by function. Within the disciplinary orientation one might
find ethnographic, historical, psychological, or sociological case studies.
Table 3.1
Yin’s (1993, p.5) six different types of case studies
Single case
Exploratory study
Single case
Explanatory study
Single case
Descriptive study
Multiple case
Exploratory study
Multiple case
Explanatory study
Multiple case
Descriptive study
In the present study Datta’s (1990) investigation and verification elements of the
program effects case study design are linked with Yin (1994) and Fraenkel &
Wallen’s (2006) multiple case study design. These perspectives have been linked to
explore existing literature to identify RTP factors, their sources, potential strengths
and gaps. Yin’s (1994) exploratory phase of case study research was employed
through the examination of literature for relevant factors prior to the exact definition
of the research questions. Some may consider this type of investigation as a prelude
to larger social research. Features of Yin’s (1994) explanatory phase were used to
build on factors identified in the exploratory phase (review of the literature). During
the explanatory phase the in depth analysis elements of causal comparative studies
allowed the factors identified through the literature review to be investigated across
in multiple cases. These features were beneficial in addressing the purpose of this
complex case in real life interventions. A final expansion phase was incorporated to
identify any other RTP factors beyond those identified in the literature that emerged
as a result of the empirical investigation of the six cases.
115
The dominant thread that ran through this study was the need to address the lack of
research that provides understanding of what factors make research based projects
sustain and scale in practical applications. Fraenkel & Wallen’s (2006) and Yin’s
(1994) multiple case study designs provided organizational scaffolds that aligned
with the nature of this investigation. Yin’s (1994) design directly forged links
between the exploration and explanation phases of the research questions, to the
appropriate data collection and analysis required to answer them (see figure 3.2) This
was important in the present study which has descriptive, exploratory and
explanatory purposes.
3.4.1. Causal comparative case study.
The following section briefly defines causal comparative case study, outlines the
strengths and limitations of the approach and presents two causal comparative
perspectives. Fraenkel &Wallen’s (2006) key features of causal comparative
research represent a more quantitative approach, whilst Yin’s (1994) presents a
detailed qualitative perspective. Although this study is qualitative, knowledge and
use of complimentary features of both approaches provided a solid base to guide the
operational pathways of this research, through the descriptive, exploratory,
explanatory and expansion phases. This approach aimed to address the “separate
mindsets stem that from the classical view of research as being either rigorous or
relevant” to determine “what works in education, given that researchers tend to
emphasize basic research, rigor, internal validity, and evidence-based practices,
whereas practitioners tend to value applied research, relevance, external validity, and
practice-based evidence” (Smith, Schmidt, Edelen-Smith, & Cook, in press, p.1).
116
3.4.2. Definition.
Bogdan and Biklen (2007) described comparative studies as “two or more cases that
are done and then compared and contrasted” (Bogdan and Biklen, 2007, p.69).
Fraenkel and Wallen (2006) also noted that causal comparative research could also
be referred to as ex post facto research, as it provides a means to determine the cause
for, or consequence of, existing differences in groups of individuals.
Given the intent of this investigation in its three phases, features of Fraenkel and
Wallen’s (2006) quantitative and Yin’s (1994) qualitative approaches are combined
to provide an in depth understanding of the project status of each case in retrospect.
Elements of both approaches provide a diverse approach from different perspectives.
This was done through employing Yin’s (1994) five components of research design
with Fraenkel & Wallen’s (2006) key features of causal comparative designs. The
use of features of both approaches to explore, explain and expand upon RTP factors
provided an insight through differing lenses. Figure 3.2 below represents the
operational pathways derived from the merger of elements of both approaches. This
visual representation provided a scaffold for the purpose of this research design. It
supports Yin’s (2003) suggestions that case study research can be influenced by the
emulation of the scientific method. It is followed by a brief description of Yin’s
(1994) and Fraenkel & Wallen’s (2006) key features of causal comparative designs.
This outlines their original intentions which were utilized to provide a lens into the
approach, sequence, methods and logic underlying this merged research framework.
Figure 3.2 Operational pathway using elements of Yin’s (1994) key features of case
study design and Fraenkel and Wallen (2006)
117
This operational pathway displays Yin’s (1994) influential components in bold font
and Fraenkel and Wallen’s (2006) in italic font. The components are briefly outlined
below to add clarity to the flow in which they are linked to meet the intersecting
needs of this research.
3.5. Five Components of Research Design (Yin, 1994)
Yin’s (1994) components of research design include: a study’s questions, I’ts
propositions, its unit(s) of analysis, the logic linking the data to the propositions, and
the criteria for interpreting the findings. These components are described below.
3.5.1. A study’s question.
Study Questions in this research pertain to the factors that contributed to the status of
research based practices at the implementation and subsequent phases. The
Exploration Phase
Problem formation/exploring assertions through investigating
prior research and published commentory
pieces
Explanation Phase
Questions and proposals formulated to add depth to literature based assertions
Design and analysis
sample and units of analysis
described
Instrumentisation development to
Link data to propositions
Interpretation of findings
Explanation phase &
Expansion Phase
elements
118
overarching “what” question outlined at the start of the chapter is exploratory in the
initial program phase, then moved into an explanatory approach as the researcher
analysed the quantitative survey data. The following phase sought additional “how”
explanations through more qualitative methods, before any expansion on RTP
phenomenon proposals were investigated.
3.5.2. A study’s propositions.
Study Propositions presented in figure 3.3 directed attentions to factors that were
examined in the scope of this study. The specific propositions were selected in an
attempt to ensure this case study remained within feasible and manageable limits.
3.5.3. A study’s unit(s) of analysis.
Unit of Analysis relates to the fundamental problem of defining a case. Throughout
this research the unit of analysis was represented by the unique variables of each
case.
3.5.4. A study’s linking data to propositions and criteria for
interpreting findings.
Linking data to propositions, and criteria for interpreting findings represented a data
analysis step in case study research (see figure 3.3). Yin (1994) described
proposition formation as a tool or a way of keeping the investigations on track. He
advocated that a set of proposals (reflective of research questions) have the capacity
to directly link research questions to data collection and analysis. Figure 3.3
displayed the use of this tactic specifically for the purpose of this research as it
linked Yin’s (1994) propositions, unit(s) of analysis and logic, linking the data to the
propositions components as a tool to streamline the intersecting purpose of this
investigation.
119
120
Table 3.1
Overview linking Yin’s (1994) components of research design including
propositions, unit(s) of analysis and logic linking the data to the propositions
Propositions
Exploration: Key
components to reducing
the research to practice
gap have been identified
through the literature
commentary pieces and
intervention research.
Explanation: Lack of
empirical evidence exists
in the key RTP identifiers.
RTP knowledge gained
from PD, TE, CSR and
CBAM efforts identified
major themes. These
include support
collaboration, research
based, scalability and
responsiveness of
research. These assertions
need to be validated,
explained and expanded to
gain an in depth
understanding of these
factors in RTP. Empirical
evidence that examined
specific research to
practice cases was
employed to add rigor to
Data Collection using
Mixed Methods
An investigation of
literature was conducted
initially to identify
claimed key contributors.
Features of these claims
were examined and used
to develop specific
research questions and
data collection tools.
A two-phased survey was
used to investigate
specific details pertaining
to individuals, their
setting and statistical
program data. It was
used to describe the case,
primarily through the
examination of factors.
More qualitative
information regarding
process, events, structure
and outcomes were
sought through the use of
open-ended and semi
structured interviews,
permanent product
records and focus groups,
which were used to
Analysis
Linking questions, data,
propositions through
qualitative and
quantitative paradigms
as presented by Yin
(1994) and Fraenkel
and Wallen (2006)
Through directly
linking questions and
propositions derived
from literature, this
research analysis sought
to use collected data
through the
employment of mixed
methods from a
spectrum of research
based practical
applications to verify
identified claims.
121
these claims.
Expansion: Other factors
may contribute to the
status of research-based
projects in inclusive
settings.
explore factors more
deeply.
Fraenkel and Wallen’s (2006) more quantitative perspective of casual-comparative
research included problem formation, sample, instrumentation and design. Features
of this perspective were merged with Yin’s (2003) qualitative approach through case
study design (see Figure 3.1). The six case studies selected all experienced the same
graduate teacher training, however it was expected that projects would vary in their
sustainability status. This causal comparative approach investigated the causes of
the differences in project status that already existed. Through this design the
knowledge from each set of experiences formed a converging and complimentary
base, which was used to explain factors through the assertions gained from prior
RTP research.
Figure 3.1 provides a projection of the studies direction, using Yin’s (1994) 2x2
matrix of four major case study designs, his proposal of the five key components of
research design (Yin, 1994). This qualitative study that was predominantly
influenced by Yin’s (1994) work was strengthened by the use of features of Fraenkel
& Wallen’s (2006) perspective on causal comparative research. Given this case
study dealt with a logical problem not a logistical problem, the main purpose was to
ensure that the evidence collected addressed the initial research questions in an
empirically validated fashion.
122
In brief, this study merges Yin (1994) and Fraenkel &Wallen’s (2006) differing, yet
complimentary causal comparative approaches in the following way. RTP concerns
were identified (problem formation). Exploration and confirmation of these
assertions and possible solutions were then identified through published pieces.
Questions and proposals were formulated, with the data collection methods and
analysis decisions being directly linked to these questions and proposals. The
interpretation of findings explained and expanded upon this RTP phenomenon at the
centre of this inclusive education investigation.
The following section describes a replication design, within the broader case study
approach. It was employed as a means of maintaining consistency in and across the
investigation of each case. Using this repeated operational approach in the same
manner aimed to enhance the quality and rigor as guidelines were replicated to
ensure regularity. Given that this study employed causal comparative case study
designs to address the purpose of this research, the following replication details are
included to enhance uniformity in approach.
3.6. Replication Within the Multiple Case Study Design
The six case studies followed a “replication logic” derived from the work Yin,
Bateman and Moore (1983). The replication of data collection methods, sequence,
analysis and approach was consistent across all six cases. This consistency allowed
the use of multiple cases to be “considered more compelling, and more likely to lend
themselves to generalisations” (Fraenkle and Wallen, 2006, p.439). The cases
ranged from infants to secondary programs conducted in inclusive educational
settings. The subjects of implementations ranged from literacy programs to peer
123
tutoring initiatives. It was expected that this range of case would drive responses
from different perspectives, allowing the analysis of differences and commonalities.
The use of this replication logic approach guided the replication of data collections
tools and process with differences and convergences being identified on analysis and
being treated individually. All six cases were considered separate bounded units
with convergent evidence being sought for each RTP factor. A summary of each
case indicated how and why factors contributed to the individual project status at
annual points. Analysis and conclusion occurred within each case then across all the
six cases, as a high degree of certainty of the factors that contributed to the success,
sustainment or extinction of research based practices was sought.
124
Figure 3.3
Replication logic has been derived from the work Yin, Bateman and Moore (1983)
Cross Case
Analysis
Single Case Data Collection
and Analysis
Design Phase
Exploration,
Explanation,
Expansion
and
validation of
literature
based RTP
assertions
6 out of 10 of a
total graduate
teacher cohort
selected as
individual
cases
Data collection
tools included;
survey,
interviews,
focus groups
and permanent
product record
Conduct
case study
Number 1
Conduct
case study
Number 2
Conduct
case study
Number 3
Conduct
remaining
case studies
4-10
Analyse
individual case
data.
Draw cross
case
conclusions,
that identify,
address any
differences
related to the
content of the
cases.
Write cross
case report on
the factors that
contribute to
the status of
RBP in
practical
applications.
Investigation
themes
included;
Teacher
education
programs,
support,
responsiveness
of research
125
3.7. Validity, Reliability and Trustworthiness in Case Study Research
As this research cited approaches from differing research perspectives, terms from
both paradigms are briefly identified. Data collection methods are described and
broad overviews of terms from relevant perspectives are presented. Primarily case
study research falls within a qualitative paradigm, yet a broad understanding of
quantitative perspectives added a slightly more diverse perspective to purpose of this
case study. Campbell’s (1975) view on logical positivism is presented to frame this
selected qualitative paradigm which was informed by features of experimental
science for this exploratory, explanatory and expansion investigation. The selected
validity tactics will be outlined to present a rigorous case study design.
3.7.1. Reliability and validity.
Qualitative researchers view validity and reliability concepts very differently to
quantitative researchers (Golafshani, 2003). Reliability in terms of qualitative work
corresponds to the notion of dependability (Lincoln and Guba, 1985). Reliability
refers to a dependable way of information elicitation that would “generate
understanding” (Stenbacka, 2001, p.551). Joppe (2000, as cited in Golafshani, 2003)
described validity from a quantitative paradigm as a way of determining whether
research truly measures what was intended or how truthful the results are.
Enthusiastic discussion amongst some qualitative researchers exists about the
relevance of these terms in qualitative research. Greater consensus is present about
the need for a qualifying check being required to add quality to research efforts
(Freankel & Wallen, 2006; Golafshani, 2003). Some authors suggest that reliability,
validity, trustworthiness, quality and rigor are important to research in any paradigm
(Yin, 1994, Golafshani, 2003).
126
Yin (2003) states that in case study design “the goal of reliability is to minimise the
errors and biases in a study” (Yin, 2003, p.37). The use of a case study protocol,
case study database, the outlined replication approach and use of triangulation
require procedures to be clearly documented in detail. These tactics were employed
to address these reliability concerns. Through identifying biases and making steps as
operational and specific as possible, another researcher could repeat the procedure
and arrive at the same conclusions (Patton, 1990; Yin, 1994). This systematically
followed approach uses the carefully planned operational pathway which built on
literature assertions and contingencies to conduct a causal comparative investigation
of RTP factors.
3.7.2. Trustworthiness.
Trustworthiness, credibility, confirmability and dependability are the concepts
generally offered to represent a logical set of statements in case study design
(Lincoln & Guba, 2000; U.S. General Accounting Office, 1990; Yin, 1994).
Trustworthiness is a term that is used in qualitative research that encompasses both
reliability and validity, although they are treated individually in quantitative research
(Golafshani, 2003). Maxwell (2004) referred to credibility as the correctness of a
description, conclusion, explanation or interpretation. Confirmability refers to the
degree to which the results could be confirmed or corroborated by others. The
traditional quantitative view of reliability is based on the assumption of repeatability.
Lincoln and Guba (2000) introduced dependability as a parallel to reliability in
qualitative research. They suggested that a notion of dependability focused on the
researcher’s responsibility for ensuring the research process was logical, traceable
and documented.
127
Examination of trustworthiness is critical to ensuring reliability in qualitative
research (Seale, 1999), and reliability can be viewed as a consequence of validity
(Patton, 2001). Some qualitative researchers have developed their own concepts of
validity and use what they consider more appropriate terms, being trustworthiness,
quality and rigor (Lincoln & Guba, 1985; Mishler, 2000; Seale, 1999; Stenbacka,
2001). In qualitative research the use of these concepts are essential to the study
being viewed as trustworthy and beneficial.
3.8. Logical Positivism
Validity and reliability are briefly compared and contrasted from quantitative and
qualitative perspectives in the work above. From a positivist perspective valid
knowledge is testable and based on empirical observation of reality. Wainer and
Braun (1998) described reliability in terms of whether results are replicable and
validity in terms of whether the means of measurement are accurate and whether
they are actually measure what were intended.
Yin (2003) introduced logical positivistic views as a way of validating inferences
from events outside the laboratory while at the same time retaining the goals of
knowledge shared with laboratory science. Elements of this strategy were referred to
through this case study (Lincoln & Guba, 2000; Yin, 2003). Yin (2003) suggested
that logical positivism is a way in which case study research can be influenced by the
emulation of the scientific method. Evidence is presented through the practical
requirements of the operational pathway that used the following validity checks to
contribute to scientific evaluation.
Yin (1994) presented four validity/reliability tests used to establish the quality of
empirical social research. These four validity tests presented in figure 3.5 were used
128
at the design and subsequent phases of this research. They included construct
validity, internal validity, external validity and reliability and have been adapted to
enhance the quality, truthfulness and rigor of this design.
Analysis of existing literature was used as a frame for the collection of empirical
data. Analysis and conclusions were based on the data collected from this
framework. Building and confirming social field RTP knowledge in this way aimed
to contribute to an understanding, based on a variety of theoretical, intellectual and
social explorations and explanations (Denzin & Lincoln, 2008). The credibility of
this work is dependent on the credibility of the high quality of analysis and data
collection through rigorous methods (Golafshani, 2003; Patton, 2003). Reliability,
validity, rigor and triangulation from a qualitative perspective through the use both
qualitative and quantitative methods to establishing truth and empirically validate
assertions are proposed. Yin’s (1994) work was used to frame this analysis due to its
completeness and ability to pay attention to validity and reliability from both diverse
perspectives.
The purpose of this research is embedded within a qualitative case study design.
Multiple ways of determining truth from are proposed to assist in illuminating and
validating RTP factors. Table 3.2 outlines and defines the tactics applied with a
cross reference to the test criteria and phase of implementation.
129
Table 3.2
Case Study Validity Tactics (Adapted from Cosmos corporation, cited in Yin, 1994)
Test Tactic Implementation
Phase
Construct validity
Trustworthiness
The establishment of
correct operational
measures for the concept
being studied/ determines
which data is to be
gathered and how it is to
be gathered
The development of an
operational pathway which
merges the work elements of
causal comparative research
from both qualitative and
quantitative perspectives.
Investigation of literature to
develop an operational set of
measures that encourage
objective judgements in data
collection.
Using multiple sources of
evidence including permanent
product records, interviews,
focus groups and surveys.
Establishing a chain of evidence
(Yin, 1994), whereby an external
observer-the reader of the case
study can follow the derivation
of evidence from the research
questions to the study
conclusions in either a forward
and reverse direction. Yin
(1994) describes this principle to
be based on a notion that is
similar to criminal
investigations. Both tactics will
Literature review
Data collection
phase
130
be used to establishing correct
operational measures for the
RTP factors being investigated.
Internal validity
Trustworthiness
Establishing a causal
relationship whereby
certain conditions are
shown to lead to other
conditions.
Through pattern matching we
aim to establish a causal
relationship.
Researcher bias
acknowledgement
Design phase
Data analysis
phase
Used in
explanatory rather
than exploratory
phase
External validity
Trustworthiness
Establishing where
findings can be
generalized beyond the
immediate case
Replication logic will be utilized
to establish consistency in
approach both within and across
each bounded system. It will
also provide a domain to which
the study’s findings can be
generalized.
Use of six cases to generalize
findings to theoretical assertions,
to explore, explain and expand
RTP knowledge. Ultimately
providing a vehicle for
examining other cases and
providing a significant
contribution bridging the well
documented research to practice
gap.
Research Design
phase
131
Reliability/Dependability
Demonstrating that the
operations of a study can
be repeated with the
same results/ minimize
errors and biases.
Method and data triangulation
Through the use of the case
study protocol and the
development of a case study data
base, data collection operations
can be demonstrated and
repeated to achieve the same
results (Yin, 1994).
Clarify researcher bias.
Design Phase
Data collection
phase
This table identifies the construct, internal and external validity and reliability as
four validity tactics that were used in this study. These validity tactics commenced
at the design phase and continued to be conducted throughout the study. The
outlined construct validity tactics are identified in the operational pathway merging
both qualitative and quantitative perspectives to add depth to the intersecting purpose
of this case study investigation. This operational direction allowed for the
development of a literature based set of measures, from previous research and
commentary pieces to create objective tools and judgements in data collection. In
order for construct validity to occur, the specific RTP gap contributing factors
selected must have reflected the specific RTP gap factor information required. The
use of multiple sources of evidence was used to encourage convergent lines of
inquiry. See figure 3.6 which indicates the convergence of sources of evidence to
substantiate RTP facts. This approach was applied to each of the six case study
exemplars.
132
Figure 3.6 Convergence of multiple data sources of evidence
Throughout this research data was collected in the exploration phase through the
investigation of literature. This was then used in the explanation and expansion
phases to provide an investigative framework for multiple data sources and analysis
including the survey, interviews, permanent product records and focus groups.
These multiple data collection methods assisted in controlling bias (Golafashani,
2003) and were used in a mix of triangulation techniques to establish rigor.
Davidson & McAllister’s (2002) use of thick description provided detailed extracts
to ensure authenticity was utilized to substantiate my understanding of data with
participants.
Internal validity tactics were to be employed in the explanatory phase to investigate
causal relationships. By establishing how factors contributed to project status, an
explanation of why various factors contributed to the success or failure of research-
based projects in practical applications were identified. As this case study is an ex
post facto design, concerns over internal validity, could have been extended to the
Survey One to one interviews
Permanent product record Focus groups
RTP Factors
search for commonalities or differences
133
broader problem of making inferences, as an event could not be directly observed.
The analytic pattern matching tactic described by Yin (1994), use of existing
evidence of program implementation, integrity, findings and status were ways of
addressing whether these inferences were correct. Given this design had anticipated
these concerns, it had begun to deal with the inference generation problem and
therefore the problem of internal validity.
3.9. Triangulation
External validity deals with identifying whether the study’s findings are
generalizable beyond this study. This has been a concern in conducting case studies,
as critics state that studying a single case offers a poor basis for generalisation. The
use of data and method triangulation has been selected to address these concerns.
The use of triangulation was selected as a source of external validity as it presented a
way of crosschecking information and conclusions through the use of multiple
procedures of sources. When the different procedures or sources are in agreement
you have corroboration (Johnson, 1997). It is equally important in triangulation to
use the same procedures to detect discontinuity. The use of triangulation
“strengthens a study by combining methods” (Patton, 2001, p. 247). Triangulation
was conducted through the use of the case study protocol, tightly geared to test RTP
assertions. The range of data collection methods sought converging lines of inquiry
to triangulate evidence to ensure a rigorous, trustworthy, reliable and valid
investigation was conducted. The triangulation of methods enabled causal
comparative analysis to check the explanation of findings generated by the various
data collection methods described. Both divergent and consistent findings provided
134
an increased understanding of the complex nature of this phenomenon (Patton, 2002,
p.559).
The triangulation of data sources was also be employed as this approach enabled
consistency of information collected at different times and with different participants
to be checked. Data from individual interviews was triangulated with focus group
and survey data. If this triangulation did result in consistency or commonalities,
explanations for differences lead to further understanding of the phenomenon, giving
increased credibility to results (Patton, 2002). The use of methods and data
triangulation strived to reduce bias and enhance reliability.
3.10. Participant Researcher
This section presents a definition of a participant researcher and identifies the
strength and limitations of my participant researcher position as a participant within
this study. Insider / outsider perspectives in relation to researchers as research
participants are also be presented.
Through my role as Master’s cohort member and the desire to be included as part of
the cohort in this study, I completed all data collection tools other than focus group
participation. Through my cohort membership I am in a unique position of being
able to view methods and data from both the researcher and participant perspectives.
I have shared similar experiences with other participants and developed professional
relationships with them. Bogdan and Biklen (2007) presented a participant/observer
continuum. Given my role as the sole researcher and a participant I am defined as a
participant researcher. With this position come practical considerations, such as
researcher bias. Researcher bias is acknowledged and addressed through the use of
135
multiple sources of data collection, internal validity tactics such as the chain of
evidence approach outlined in figure 3.5.
Glesne and Peshkin (1992) also referred to the role of “participant” as having the
potential to become a trusted person with documentation and information access
being more readily available. Dwyer and Buckle (2009) added to this perspective by
introducing researchers as insiders and/or outsiders. The authors suggested that as
an “insider” researchers could situate themselves within the research enhancing
depth and breadth of understanding. Dwyer and Buckle (2009) proposed that an
insider role status frequently allows researchers more rapid and complete acceptance
by their participants. This added to openness and trust, which may have increased
the quality of data gathered. Although efforts were required to eliminate researcher
bias, advantages of this position included understanding firsthand how specific
actions corresponded to words and outcomes, allowing me to understand responses
more readily. Patterns of behaviour and actions became more readily evident as a
relationship of trust may have motivated others to share details, which they
otherwise may not.
As participant researcher I acknowledged that I commenced the study with
preconceived ideas on RTP issues. Miles and Huberman (1994) acknowledged this
concept by stating as researchers “we do have background knowledge” (p.17). It
was through this related knowledge that we comprehend situations, issues, details
about the complex phenomenon under investigation.
Given my awareness of the advantages and challenges of my participant researcher
position, I addressed these challenges by completing the data collection tools prior to
administering them to others. I had an independent person ask me the interview
136
questions. These were conducted prior to the other participant interviews to prevent
my case results being influenced by others. I did not participate in the focus group
activity in a participant’s capacity as other group members may have consciously or
subconsciously expected me to lead the session. Focus group participants may have
been less willing to offer suggestions or be altered by my responses or input. The
increased Masters cohort sample for all other data collection methods had the
capacity to build on prior knowledge in order to extrapolate and validate RTP
themes. In brief an opportunity for participants to participate in a focus group
without my participant input may have consolidated or expanded upon RTP themes,
assertions and factors more effectively.
In summary the participant researcher position is identified and four tests presented
above have been selected to enhance this research design quality. Through the use
of diverse evidence sources, this research explored, explained, validated and
expanded RTP assertions with a rich and extensive data collection and analysis effort
using six case study exemplars. This logical positivist (Yin, 1994) approach
provided a clear operational direction for the constructs of validity and reliability.
This was outlined by researchers such as Fraenkel and Wallen (2006) and Wainer
and Braun (1998) to complement concepts of trustworthiness, quality and rigor
(Lincoln & Guba, 1985; Mishler, 2000; Seale, 1999; Stenbacka, 2001), through the
utilization of Yin’s (1994) case study validity tactics.
3.11. Strengths and Limitations of a Causal-Comparative Case Study Design
Following is a description of the strengths and limitations pertaining to this research
design.
137
3.11.1. Strengths
The exploration of existing literature guided the specific operational pathway
through causal comparative design to address this studies purpose. This process has
identified concerns and presented ways to address them. As such the present design
utilized features of diverse approaches, within the flexibility of case study design to
strengthen its approach as a result of previous experiences. Replication logic
allowed for each case to follow the same operational pathways, using the data
collection and analysis techniques. This encouraged consistency in approach across
a spectrum of case perspectives, in search of differences or commonalities that
resulted from examining RTP factors in practice.
The examination of multiple cases allowed more accurate conclusions about
interorganisational factors, as contemporary events were measured when relevant
behaviours could not be manipulated. There is a precedent as a number of multiple
case study examples exist that provide an illustrative example of this approach (Yin
and Moore, 1988; (Corcoran, Walker, & Wals, 2004; Roland, Daniel, Arnim,
Alexander, & Michael, 2006; Stecker & Skinner, 2006).
Through employing a causal comparative case study approach researchers are able to
deal with a full spectrum of evidence. This was considered advantageous for the
purpose of this investigation, as it gave capacity for an in depth understanding of the
factors that had contributed to the status of RBP’s over a three year period both
within and across cases.
3.11.2. Limitations
Case studies are a relatively recent development in comparison to more experimental
approaches. As a result claims that less guidance has led to some case study
138
investigations having insufficient precision and rigor (Creswell, 2003; Yin, 1994).
Descriptions such as “weak sibling among social science methods” (Yin, 1994,
p.xiii) have criticized their applications. The use of increasing theoretical framework
knowledge and the introduction of the various types of case studies has guided this
design (Davey, 1991). Using existing literature to provide a scaffold can create
increased focus to add essential rigor to the design (Guba, 1985; Yin, 2003).
Concerns regarding the lack of rigor exist in the use of single cases to make
concluding generalizations (Creswell, 2003; Yin, 2003). Hamel et al (1993) and Yin
(1994) have responded to these sufficient case number concerns by suggesting that
relative sample size does not transform a multiple case into a macroscopic study, and
that even a single case could be considered acceptable, provided it met the
established objective. Procedures that positively contribute to these concerns now
exist to assist case study researchers satisfy the three tenets of the qualitative method
being describing, understanding, and explaining (Yin, 1989).
Increased time and resources in collecting and analysing multiple sources of data is
required to gain a depth of understanding across multiple settings. These limitations
have been considered; yet causal comparative case study remains suitable for this
design as it allowed for factors to be retrospectively traced over time. The
articulation and verification of why RTP factors occurred as they did, was sought
through this comprehensive research strategy as it allowed for the in depth analysis
required (Stoecker, 1991, as cited in Yin, 1994).
Freankel and Wallen (2006) highlighted two major concerns from a more
quantitative perspective, being the lack of randomization and lack of control over
threats to internal validity, as no manipulation of the independent variable was
139
possible. Fitzpatrick, Sanders & Worthen (2004) suggested that judgment or
purposive sampling is successfully used in case studies where small groups are
drawn to identify and explore particular issues. For the purpose of this research, six
of the ten of the Masters cohort who graduated from the same course in 2008 have
been selected as the sample to explore this RTP phenomenon. All six participants
who shared the same graduate teacher experience were expected to devise a research
based program specific to the needs of their setting.
Location threat as defined by Freankel and Wallen (2006) in experimental studies,
referred to the concerns of data collection location and details differing in each case.
These concerns were reduced as the same data collector collected data under the
same conditions. Standardizing procedures to establish rigor minimized data
collector bias.
3.12. Data Collection Approaches
This section outlines the use of mixed data collection approaches in the light of the
exploration, explanation and expansion purpose of this investigation. Methods of
data collection employed throughout this research are briefly introduced. A visual
representation of each tool is presented with their respective strengths and limitations
to highlight their position in the proposed operational pathway. A detailed
description of each tool is following in the procedures section.
Five forms of data collection were employed throughout this research. These
included; reviewing of literature, a two-part survey, two interviews, focus groups and
permanent product records (participants written Masters thesis’). Descriptions of
each method will follow later in the chapter. The use of this mixed methods
approach is especially applicable to the phenomenon under investigation, as it
140
allowed flexibility in data collection methods and interpretation of both data and real
life situations (Stake, 1995). These dimensions of mixed methods of data collection
lend themselves to the desired depth of data required to address the purpose of this
research.
The overarching research question for this study was answered through a series of
sub questions that initially fell from the literature into the outlined exploration,
explanation and expansion phases. The exploration phase was divided into two parts
and investigated the factors that had been identified in previous literature that
contributed to sustaining RBP and whether these factors have been validated through
empirical research. The review of the literature initially identified key RTP areas,
claims and validation techniques, prior to a deeper analysis of each of the
acknowledged areas. The results of this two-part literature exploration strategy are
presented in the literature review in chapter two.
The second part of the exploration phase investigated responses to semi-structured
interviews and Part one of the survey. This required participants to outline their
original (non influenced by literature) understandings of the factors that contributed
to the status of the projects in their setting. Part two of the survey was also
distributed and then collected one week later. Part two of the survey used RTP
factors identified through literature to elicit project details and status responses.
The explanation phase utilized Permanent Product records, semi-structured
interviews and focus groups to establish a deeper understanding of how these
identified factors contributed to project status in practical applications. During the
expansion phase analyses of responses collected from part one of the survey,
141
Permanent Product records, semi-structured interviews and focus group to establish
whether any other factors contributed to project status.
Although these data collection methods were planned, it is worth noting that Ezzy
(2002) suggested the flexibility in design allows for the modification of these tools if
required. This process built on the strengths of qualitative methods as it allowed
such decisions to be made in a more fundamental way than if analysis was left until
after all data collection was completed. Descriptions of each of the planned data
collection methods with associated strengths and limitations are identified in table
3.4.
Table 3.4
Data collection tools, advantages and limitations (adapted from the work of
Creswell, 2003)
Data
Collection
Tool
Implementation
Phase
Advantages Limitations
Literature
review
Exploration /
Confirmation
*Beneficial in recording
relevant information at
convenient times.
*Useful in exploring
information previously
discussed.
* Builds on prior work
in the research to
practice gap.
* Encourages direction
and relevance.
*Requires the
research to search
out and filter
through relevant
literature.
*Time
consuming.
Two Phased
Survey
Exploration /
Explanation
*Provides measureable
data to set questions.
*Allows for direct
comparison of cross
case written analysis.
* Second part can be
completed at leisure
within personally
selected comfortable
* Dependent on
subject’s written
response ability.
* Responses may
be limited and
time consuming.
* Body language
and human
subtleties can not
142
locations.
* Allows for a second
phase of interview to
build on initial written
responses.
be detected.
* Responses are
limited to the
questions.
Permanent
Product
Records
Exploration/Expla
nation/Expansion
*Enables the researcher
to gain information that
the case coordinator has
given attention to,
closer to the time of the
program
implementation.
* Can be accessed at a
convenient time.
* Saves time and
transcribing expenses.
*Address some ex post
facto concerns, as
records were kept as
events unfolded.
*Information may
not exercise
confidentiality.
* Materials may
be incomplete and
vary in detail and
accuracy levels.
*Requires
approval from
case coordinators.
Interviews
(Open-ended
interview will
occur initially
with the data
gathered
being used to
inform the
following
semi
structured
interview)
Explanation/Expa
nsion
*Beneficial when direct
observation is not
possible, suited to ex
post facto.
*Can build on
previously collected
details.
*Allows for questioning
to be directed to gain
deeper understanding.
*Body language and
gestures can be
observed.
*May be
considered
indirect
information,
filtered through
views of
interviewees.
* Researchers
presence may bias
responses.
* People are not
equally articulate
and perceptive.
Focus
Groups
Explanation/Expa
nsion
*Beneficial when direct
observation is not
possible, suited to ex
post facto.
*Provides a forum for
open in depth shared
discussion.
*Body language and
gestures can be
observed.
*Can be
dominated by one
voice and
reluctance to
speak in an open
forum.
*May be
considered
indirect
information,
filtered through
views of
143
interviewees.
*Researchers
presence may bias
responses.
3.13. Data Analysis
This section briefly defines data analysis then refers to the modes of analysis,
including theoretical propositions that are specifically relevant to this multiple case
study design.
Data analysis is defined as a “matter of giving meaning to first impressions as well
as final compilations” (Stake, 1995, p. 71). Stake (1995) explained data analysis
from a qualitative frame as a way of synthesizing the direct interpretation of a case.
Miles and Huberman (1994) presented challenges that face qualitative researchers in
their analysis of data, due to the “multiplicity of data sources and forms” (p. 55).
To address the challenges of acquiring multiple sources of data from six individual
cases, the review of literature was used to guide focus for overcoming this issue.
Through reflecting on key RTP findings from relevant literature, the parameters by
which data was to be interpreted were defined. Such an approach to data analysis is
referred to by Yin (1994) as a dominant mode of analytical analysis titled theoretical
propositions.
3.14. Theoretical Propositions
The theoretical assertions identified in relevant RTP literature, provided a framework
to guide this case study. Lincoln and Guba (1985) suggested that the benefit from a
systematic review of literature, can include having a frame to check the soundness of
interpretations and having a solid base to create an emergent map of what it all
means. Through identifying theoretical assertions, theoretical propositions have
been formed (identified in figure 3.3) and were used to analyse data within
144
individual cases and across them. This form of analysing case studies is an effective
way “of laying the groundwork for high quality case studies” (Yin, 1994, p. 125). It
was through the identified theoretical propositions that the need to conduct the case
study was recognized. Research questions and the design of this exploration,
explanation and expansion research were all directed by these RTP theoretical
propositions.
The predominant analysis step in this case study research was using propositions.
The use of propositions was used as a beacon to direct data collection and as criteria
for interpreting findings (see figure 3.3). As previously identified, Yin (1994)
described proposition formation as a tool or a way of keeping the investigations on
track. As this set of proposals was based on theoretical underpinnings, they had the
capacity to directly link research questions to data collection and analysis,
streamlining empirical investigations.
Other processes of analysis involved employing methods of interpretive narrative
accounts. Interpreting analysis accounts referred to examining the parts of a work to
discover deeper meanings. Categorizing the data to extrapolate themes and provide
possible explanations are other analysis processes that were employed (Glesne &
Peshkin, 1992; Miles & Huberman, 1994; Stake, 1995; Yin, 1994). These processes
were applied to permanent product records, interview transcripts and focus group
responses.
Yin’s (1994) pattern matching logic was merged with components of Donald
Campbell’s (1975) pattern matching techniques. This was done through comparing
theoretical assertions with the real life RTP experiences and knowledge of each case.
Several pieces of information (survey, interviews, focus groups and permanent
145
product records) from the same case were related to the theoretical propositions. “If
the patterns coincide, the results can help a case study strengthen its internal
validity” (Yin, 1994, p.106). The convergence of these results employed a
triangulation approach to further substantiate these results in relation to the
propositions (see figure 3.6). The replication approach outlined in Figure 3.4 was
derived from the work Yin, Bateman and Moore (1983) and assisted in maintaining
consistency in application and analysis.
3.15. Procedures
This section builds on the framework, decisions and definitions identified through
this chapter. It provides the specific details pertaining to participants, settings, data
collection tools, procedures and analysis.
3.16. Participants
Six teachers from a special education division of a Western Sydney based non-
government school system represented the total population of this study. These
teachers were also students enrolled in the pilot version of the Masters of education
(inclusive education) at Charles Sturt University. The participants in this Master’s
cohort graduated in 2008 and ranged from kindergarten teachers to a high school
special education teacher. All participants shared the same graduate teacher
experience and were expected to devise a research based program specific to the
needs of their setting. All graduates were asked to participate in this study. Five
cases were joined by my case, with the difference of my role as the participant
researcher being noted. Data collection commenced one year after graduating from
the distance inclusive education Masters program. See Table 4.1 in the results
section for participant details.
146
3.17. The Settings
The projects were set in school-based sites across Western Sydney. Sites included
primary schools and a single sex high school. All projects were implemented in
2006, with data collected on project status at three annual intervals from 2006-2008.
The schools span across a 70-kilometre radius, and included a diverse socio-
economic population, family and teaching structures. Implementation sites
comprised of students from both single parent and dual parent families with a wide
range of incomes and living conditions. An overview of details that are specific to
each case setting are presented in the results section as this data was collected
through the exploration phase.
3.18. Phased Research Questions
A visual presentation of the overarching and sub questions is presented in figure 3.2.
This was intended to highlight the exploration, explanation and expansion nature of
this investigation. The overarching question is presented at the top of figure,
followed by sub questions with selected data collection methods displayed. The
questions identified in the table were further developed as a result of the survey and
interview responses which elicited participants perspectives of literature based
factors contributing to the status of projects.
147
Figure 3.7
Multiple Causal Comparative Case Study Design Research Questions and Overview
What are the factors and relationships between them that contributed to the status
of research-based projects in inclusive education settings?
Exploration Phase
Designed to gain an
account of RTP beliefs
prior to introducing
themes identified through
the literature
Sub Questions required to address overarching
question
1a. What factors have been identified in RTP, PD,
TE, CSR and CBAM literatures that contributes to
sustaining RBP in inclusive educational settings?
b. To what extent are these factors been validated
through empirical research?
c. What are the major RTP themes that have been
identified through these literatures?
( Literature review)
2. What RTP factors were initially identified by case
coordinators prior to literature based themes being
revealed?
(Open-ended interview)
2. Which of the factors described in the extant
literature contributed to the status of the projects
in the case settings?
(Survey phase 1)
Confirmation 3. Which factors identified in previous RTP, PD,
TE, CSR and CBAM literature have contributed
to the status of your project?
(Survey phase 2)
4. To what extent have these factors contributed to
the status of your project?
(Survey phase 2)
Explanation Phase 7. How do aspects of collaboration (emergent
feedback, joint ownership and responsibility,
collegiality, increased communication, positive
peer and student responses) contribute to the
status of RBP in inclusive education settings?
8. How does the responsiveness of research
(research relevance, usability and trustworthiness,
responsiveness to organisational demands,
practical difference, increased teacher
contribution, systemic technology,
comprehensiveness, school level design)
148
contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive
education settings?
9. What support features (time, resources,
consistency, networks, emergent feedback, well
developed materials) contributed to the status of
RBP in inclusive education settings? How?
10. What features of a TE program contribute to
RTP (framed conceptually, theoretical basis,
replication of form, subject structure) in inclusive
education settings?
11. Did you experience these?
(Permanent Product records, semi structured
interviews, focus group)
Expansion Phase 12. What factors other than collaboration,
responsiveness of research, PD, TE, resource,
environmental and change process support,
scientifically based practices, scalability and
educational power contribute to the status of RBP
in inclusive education settings?
13. How have these additional factors been
identified?
(Survey-phase 1, Permanent Product records, semi
structured interviews, focus group)
The three distinct exploratory, explanatory and expanding purposes of this research
were presented as a systematic overview representing the nature and sequence of the
investigation and data collection methods that directly responded to each research
question. This display visually presented the features of the design that aligned
closest to Yin’s (1994) multiple explanatory case study design. The investigation of
six individual bounded cases provided the opportunity to examine trends and
strengthen explanations of how and why factors exerted influence. Given the limited
empirical evidence currently available on RTP factors, the exploration of assertions
and related research based applications, was required prior to the explanation and
expansion phase. The multiple methods of data collection provided a diverse and
solid depth of understanding of RTP factors and contributed to the prevention of
149
errors or distortions in analysis and conclusion. The use of mixed data collection
methods contributed to more reliable conclusions, adding to the robustness of theory
(Yin, 1994). The section that follows describes the data collection tools through
their features that directly respond to these identified research questions in table 3.7.
3.19. Data Collection Sequence
Table 3.5 below provides an overview of the data collection sequence and related
details. Open-ended interviews were initially conducted to gain each participant’s
thoughts prior to any literature-based questions being presented. The two-part
survey was then distributed and collected the following week. Semi structured
interviews followed the collection of part two of the survey. This allowed semi
structured interview questions to be derived from the survey and initial interview
data. Analysis of permanent product records occurred throughout this data collection
phase. Focus group sessions were the final data collection event and all participants
met in the same location for all interviews and the focus group session.
Table 3.5
Data collection sequence and details
Sequenced Data
collection
methods
Expected time
required
Recording
technique
Details
1.Open ended
interviews
60 minutes Digital voice
recorder
One to one
interview
2. Two part
survey
65 minutes Written responses Each participant
completes both
parts
3. Semi
structured
60 minutes Digital voice One to one
150
interviews recorder interview
4. Focus
Group
60 minutes Video and
digitally voice
recorded
9 participants and
a facilitator
5. Permanent
product record
On going Collection of
previous written
responses
One per
participant
Three of the five data collection tools were derived from literature based RTP
assertions and used participant responses to develop questions. Table 2.3 outlines
the development of these literature based assertions. It also provided parameters for
the confirmation and explanation of data collected through part 2 of the survey, the
semi structure interviews and focus groups. Each phase of this data collection was
used to inform the next. The first part of the survey and the open-ended interviews
sought participant’s original responses, prior to the introduction of any literature
based categories.
The adaptability of case study design allowed the use of mixed data collection
methods. The two-part survey, although limited in number, provided some statistical
information whilst the employment of focus groups and interviews enabled the
researcher to get closer to the focus of the study. The combination of these
approaches through the flexible case study design developed an “in depth subjective
understandings of people, situations and key episodes” (Hitchcock & Hughes, 1995,
p.318). The data collection methods outlined below was drawn predominantly from
a qualitative paradigm. Features of survey reflected elements of the more
151
numerically driven quantitative paradigms to intensify the depth and comparability
to research question responses.
3.20. Literature Investigation - Factors Derived From Literature That
Contribute to the Status of Research Based Projects.
An investigation of related literature was the initial strategy utilized to inaugurate
this research. It also provided a framework for all subsequent decisions and analysis.
According to O’Leary (1996) such an approach identifies tangible issues in relation
to theory. It informs readers of developments in the field, generates ideas for
measuring assertions and provides a method to critically evaluate methods that may
identify shortcomings prevalent in literature. The investigation of literature
identified an urgent need to link research based knowledge and practical application.
Commentary pieces and assertions based on intervention work were used to frame
and provide scope for the study to confirm and build on the well-documented RTP
concerns. The review of the literature in chapter two commenced with RTP
literature. This was predominantly based on commentary claims. As a result PD,
TE, CSR and CBAM literature was investigated to gain a deeper understanding of
RTP factors. Consistent themes and key factors that were supported and further
developed across five bodies of literature were used to develop relevant research
questions (see literature review chapter 2). Data collection methods including a
detailed survey were developed to test these factors in practical applications.
Table 3.6 identifies the commonalities within and across RTP, PD, TE, CSR and
CBAM literature. It confirms consistency across the areas of literature and links key
literature based assertions from each of these areas to the corresponding survey
questions (see appendix 1). The recognition of factors and development of these
152
themes across the bodies of literature reviewed was crucial to the purpose of this
study and as a result they were used as a theoretical framework for the collection of
data for subsequent phase.
153
Table 3.6
Consistency and development of RTP literature based themes and related factors
RTP PD TE CSR CBAM
Collaboration Collaboration Collaboration Collegiality Collaboration
Shared responsibility,
understanding and
ownership (1.2)
Collegiality (1.11)
Mutual respect (1.3)
Cooperation (1.6)
Communication (1.1)
Substantive frequent
Joint partnerships (1.11)
Mutually identified
boundaries, structures and
purposes (1.4)
“Buy in” from all
stakeholders (1.16)
Engagement in pursuit of
genuine questions, problems
and solutions (1.5)
Joint partnerships (1.11)
Involving practitioners in the
research process (1.13)
Multiple level feedback
(1.12)
Responsive, cohesive course
structures (4.6)
Mutually aligned norms,
expectations and roles
Need for complete theory
framework (4.1)
Intersection of process and
content (4.4)
Adequate and complete
design (4.3)
Self reinforcing (3.2)
Well aligned system and
policy goals (1.7)
Shared ownership of the
elements involved in and
resulting from the change
process (1.6)
Shared acknowledgement of
changing needs of
stakeholders and
environments (1.10)
Understood by all
154
interaction (1.1)
Feedback (1.12)
(1.8/4.5)
Critical in developing links
between theory and practice
(1.14)
Consistency (4.2/4.7a)
Flexibility (4.8)
United (1.15)
Awareness of shared
ownership and individual
strength (1.9)
Resource Support and PD Support Support Supportive Environments &
Structures
Support through change
Adequate materials (2.1)
Adequate time (2.2)
Long term (2.3)
Positive attitude from
students and peers
(2.14/2.15)
Teachers need to feel
sufficiently prepared (2.7)
Networks (2.12)
Sufficient instructional time
(2.22)
Adequate resources (2.22)
Addresses teacher
enthusiasm and concerns
(2.13)
Awareness of fatigue and
exhaustion (2.11)
Support personnel qualities
and attributes (2.25)
Emergent feedback (2.10)
Evaluation as an emergent
function rather than an add
on (2.21)
Use of systemic technology
(2.26)
Long term and consistent
Sustained assistance (2.9)
Support structures must
change as needs change
(2.5)
Beyond individuals (2.16)
From multiple agencies,
155
Well developed student
materials (2.4)
Professional Development
(2.7)
Consistent (2.9)
Address needs (2.8)
Active teacher involvement
(2.23)
Review research to increase
research knowledge (2.24)
Ongoing stakeholder support
and assistance (2.8)
Limiting competing
demands to achieve a
balance of multiple agendas
(2.11)
Scientifically based
instructional practices
Evidence based and proven
to be effective (2.24)
Central to students learning
(2.20)
Viewed as credible by
teachers (2.18)
Comprehensive (3.19)
Need for theory to make TE
more coherent (4.1)
Adequate depth and time to
research based practices
(2.19)
(2.3/2.9)
Well developed student
materials, teacher manuals,
assessment and training
(2.1/2.4)
Professional Lives
acknowledgement of the
need for recognition and
reward (2.17)
Instructional leader support
for the project (2.26)
levels and agendas (2.16)
Within realistic time frames
(2.2)
156
Responsiveness of research Responsiveness Responsiveness of
University education
programs
Scalability and Educational
Power
Research Based Change
Process
Useable (3.1)
Practical (3.7/3.22)
Accessible (3.7)
Trustworthy (3.3)
Evidence based (3.3)
Manageable and efficient
(3.2)
Examined in rich contexts
(3.4)
PD programs must respond
to genuine teacher needs and
concerns (3.11)
Reflective of student and
staff needs (3.6)
Responds to classroom
contexts and organizational
demands (3.12)
Consistency (4.11)
Joint partnerships (1.11)
Research based (3.3)
Effective delivery (4.7b)
Good contextual fit (3.14)
Valued by students (3.15)
Address real life needs and
concerns (3.8)
Need for opportunities and
time for practical
development of classroom
based skills and knowledge
(3.9)
Use of scientific research
(3.3)
Validated with scalability
potential (3.13)
Joint partnerships (1.11)
School level design for
school level influence (3.19)
Effective adoption (3.16)
Self reinforcing (3.20)
Responds to personal growth
in knowledge and skills
(3.17)
Process not an event (3.18)
Change is a highly personal
experience (3.17)
PD should occur over time
and be dynamic in
addressing varying
participant needs and
abilities (3.10)
157
3.20.1. Interviews.
Open-ended and semi-structured interviews were conducted on a one-to-one basis in
a conversational style. Semi-structured interviews were designed to elicit
spontaneous, relaxed responses to a number of open-ended items pertaining
specifically to their experience and project details. All participants were asked the
same set of questions beginning with easy to answer questions to build participant’s
confidence in the research process. These semi-structured and efficient forms of the
qualitative interviewing techniques are beneficial when comparing the responses of
different respondents. The interviews were conducted in the same living room to
ensure a relaxed, comfortable and quiet setting and took between 60-75 minutes to
complete. As previously mentioned the semi-structured interview questions were
informed by survey and initial open-ended interview responses.
All interviews were audio taped due to its ease and cost effectiveness. A small audio
recorder is less obtrusive than a video recorder in a one to one interview situation
and adds the nuances of a person’s voice to the printed words. The use of an audio
tape allowed for analysis through repeated studying as well as checking against notes
and transcripts.
3.20.2. Survey.
A two-part survey had been purposefully designed for this research. Part one of the
survey consists of three components pertaining to personal, setting and program
details. Along with statistically driven items relating to the identified themes and
open-ended questions were included in part one of the survey to elicit responses not
influenced by literature from each participant.
158
The second part of the survey was divided into an implementation integrity section
and a research driven investigation section. The implementation integrity section
sought to determine if the selected program was implemented according to specified
guidelines. The research driven section used literature-based themes to investigate
specific program details and decisions. The literature review in chapter two
identified the development and consistency of RTP factor assertions within and
across five bodies of literature. Table 2.3 displays the numerical link to specific
questions in the survey that address these literature based assertions. The
investigation categories sought statistical data at the annual points from 2006-2008.
This was followed by open-ended questions, which directly compared the unique
case study exemplars details to the RTP factors identified through literature on an
individual basis prior to making cross case comparisons. This was collected a week
after distribution and a stamped self-addressed envelope was provided for its return
(see appendix one for survey).
3.20.3. Focus groups.
The structure of the focus group and questions was dependent upon the responses
gained from the survey and semi structured interview. They provided an opportunity
for in depth discussion around relevant themes including supportive environments,
responsiveness of research and collaboration. They were not limited to these criteria
as additional RTP factor responses were encouraged through the expansion phase of
this research.
Focus groups were conducted after the collection the survey and the completion of
both interviews. They provided an open forum for discussion for 5 out of the 6
participants and took approximately 70 minutes to complete. The focus group was
159
time efficient, as information was gathered collectively. A facilitator was used to
guide and maintain the flow of the session and was on hand to address group
dynamic problems if they had occurred. The focus group was video taped to display
the context, verbal interaction of many and non-verbal elements such as gestures,
facial expressions, activities and pauses. With the increased number of participants
it was hoped that after a short while they would relax and become unaware of the
video recorder. This process once again allowed for repeated studying of the session
and cross checking against notes and transcripts.
3.20.4. Permanent product record.
Permanent product records were used to provide an additional source of information
on project planning, implementation and outcome-related details. These details
included the needs of the setting, target subjects, aims of the project, implementation
integrity, modifications and success rates. The permanent product records are the
completed assignment documents that were presented for marking at the culmination
of the Master of Education degree. They were not produced for the purpose of later
research, yet they can add specific and comprehensive context details. These
documents were written shortly after the projects implementation and provide time
specific details.
The decision to use permanent product records was made after the consideration of
the “cost/benefits ratio” (Cohen, Manion and Morrison, 2000, p.50). This feature
referred to the fact that the records currently exist and no additional demands need to
be placed on researchers as professionals in the pursuit of the truth. Participants all
agreed to release their project documents, so these documents were consulted at
regular intervals, at convenient times and contributed to the convergence of
160
evidence. Given that this investigation is an ex-post facto design, the use of
permanent product records addressed the time delay threat as it presents data that
was gathered at a particular point in time.
3.20.5. Ethical and methodological implications.
Time concerns in completing the survey and participating in semi structured and
open-ended interviews and focus groups was considered a burden to participants.
Allowing ample time to complete tasks and building a schedule that was sensitive to
the commitments of the participants responded to this risk. Approximately one hour
was required from each participant to complete the survey, with an additional hour
for the focus group session, open-ended and semi-structured interviews.
Confidentiality and privacy was exercised through the use of pseudonyms. All
documents and recordings are securely stored in a locked cabinet and will be
destroyed after five years.
Concerns related to my role as a participant researcher have been previously
outlined. The initial completion of tools assisted in addressing these concerns.
Asselin’s (2003) insider-outsider researcher work adds to participant researcher risk
awareness. Suggestions that role confusion can occur if the researcher is familiar
with the participants through a role other than that of a researcher are valid. Clear
participant and researcher roles and the use of an interviewer to conduct my
interviews assisted in catering for these concerns. Breen (2007) suggested that
ethical issues that arise from insider research often lack guidelines and need to be
dealt with on an individual basis. Ethical principles of privacy, confidentiality,
signed consent and non-maleficence guided additional ethical considerations.
161
3.20.6. Recording of results.
Interviews were audio taped and focus groups were videotaped. All recordings were
transcribed. Participants were asked to validate the accuracy of their transcript and
clarify unclear responses.
Due to my position as a member of the graduate teacher cohort I took on the role of a
participant in this study. Given that I am also the sole researcher an independent
external observer was asked to read the case study to reduce possible bias that could
have been created due to my participant researcher status. By following the
derivation of evidence from the research questions to the study conclusions in either
a forward and reverse direction, bias elements were reduced (Yin, 1994). This
process allowed me to participate in discussions that responded to the research
questions, so that results from a 60% sample of Masters graduates were obtained.
Both the interviews and focus group approach provided an opportunity for
participants to add further clarification and understanding to the overarching research
question and sub questions in person. Analysis of this data was compared to
participants survey responses in order to determine if any correlation of factors that
influenced the practical application, sustainment or extinction of the project existed.
In brief, three data collection gathering occasions occurred after the initial
investigation of literature. The first event comprised of an open-ended interview and
the two-part survey. This was representative of the exploration phase and elicited
responses prior to RTP literature based themes were introduced. Once findings from
this exploration phase were analysed and a second gathering (semi structured
interviews) followed. This semi structured interview utilized questions based upon
the initial interview and survey findings. This represented the explanation phase and
162
sought to determine which literature based RTP factors contributed to the status of
research based projects. This second occasion also contributed to the expansion
phase as opportunities for the identification of additional RTP factors existed. The
focus group was informed by all previous data collection opportunities and
represents the final data-gathering occasion. Collectively these data gathering
opportunities combined to gain details pertaining to the exploration, explanation and
expansion of RTP factors across diverse implementation settings.
163
Chapter 4. Results
4.1. Exploration Phase
The results chapter is organized into three sections. The first section is an
introduction to the background and context of each case. This includes a description
of the cases and identifies the status of cases from 2006-2009. The chapter also
presents the techniques described by the research participants to ensure the integrity
of the implementation of each case. This information was collected to establish the
veracity with which the projects were implemented, in order to determine the quality
of the research to practice efforts from which data was derived and conclusions
drawn. The second section presents an overview of the RTP factors asserted in
existing literature that were used as a reference point for the description of data
generated by the cases. The final section compares the cases to respond to the
research questions within the three phases of this study; the exploration, the
explanation and the expansion phases.
The exploration phase sets a baseline for the study by investigating what the
literature stated about RTP and what the participants found through their unique
experiences and compared them. The first part of the exploration phase investigated
five bodies of literature to identify existing factors that influenced the research to
practice gap. Each participant was also asked to identify the factors that contributed
to the status of their projects prior to the RTP literature being shared with them. A
comparison between the findings derived from the RTP literature and the perceptions
of the participants about the factors that had an impact on the implementation of their
projects was conducted.
The second explanation phase generated a deeper interrogation of the factors that
contributed to the status of research-based projects in the six different classroom
164
applications. The findings of the literature review and participant experiences were
used to guide the development of interview and survey questions employed in the
explanation phase. The information participants shared about why and how
individual projects were implemented was compared to the factors identified through
the literature to create questions that would encourage additional detailed RTP
responses.
The third, expansion phase presented the connections identified by participants
between the first two phases. Throughout a focus group participants explored the
priorities and interactions among the factors presented. They discussed, elaborated
upon and confirmed the RTP factors they identified through their direct experiences.
They expanded on their description of the relationship between the factors and
presented factors that were not identified in the first two phases of the study. This
final section of the results chapter used the accumulated knowledge gained through
the exploration, explanation and expansion phases to respond to the overarching
research question: What are the factors that influence the translation of research to
practice in inclusive education settings?
The results section is organized to accomplish the following:
1. To introduce and describe each of the cases, including researcher background,
setting, their research foci, quality of implementation, and status of the projects at the
end of each academic year over the study.
2. To present a summary of the literature review conducted as part of the exploration
phase of the study. The literature identified through this RTP search was used to
inform interview questions to identify those factors that contributed to the status of
research based projects in classroom applications. The same methods were used to
165
collect data across all cases. This assisted in identifying the similarities and
differences across cases.
3. To present the findings derived from the investigation of the six cases through the
three phases of the study: Exploration, Explanation and Expansion.
Each of these phases had its own sub-questions, which assisted in the acquisition of
knowledge to answer the overarching question of this investigation. Sub-questions
for each phase are as follows:
What are the factors and relationships between them that contributed to the status of
research-based projects in inclusive education settings?
4.1.1. Exploration phase questions.
What factors that have been identified in previous literature contribute to sustaining
RBP in inclusive education settings? How have these factors been identified? To
what extent have these factors been validated through empirical research? What are
the existing key RTP gap contributors identified through initial teacher perception?
How do they compare to existing literature?
4.1.2. Explanation phase questions.
How do factors identified in the cases contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive
education settings? In what ways do those factors exert an influence?
Additional question established after the analysis of the data collection through the
exploration and explanation phases- How have the identified relationship between
factors exerted an influence on the practical application and sustainment of the
projects?
166
4.1.3. Expansion phase questions.
What factors, other than those identified in the exploration and expansion phases,
contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive education settings?
Additional question established after the analysis of the data collection through the
exploration and explanation phases- What were the differences and consistencies in
the relationships between the RTP factors that contributed to the status of the
projects that were identified by the research participants?
In summary, this study identified and validated the specific factors that contributed
to the status of six individual research to practice projects. Through the examination
of the six different cases, the RTP knowledge identified in the literature search could
be directly examined.
4.2. Introduction to the Background and Context of the Cases
This study took place in a non-public educational system in Western Sydney. Six
participants were involved and pseudonyms have been used and locations removed
to maintain anonymity in all cases other than my own. An overview of case and
participant details is presented in Table 4.1 followed by a description of each case.
Each participant completed the same Masters of Education (Inclusive Education)
course at a regional university via distance education with a 2 day residential school
each semester. Coursework commenced in 2006 and was completed in 2007.
Participation in the course was voluntary and was partially sponsored by the
participant’s employer both financially (75% of the course costs) and through the
allocation of two study days per semester. Participants completed a written
application for entry into the Masters program and their employer used this
167
application as the basis of selection. The participants who were selected for
admission indicated that they completed the Masters course to increase their depth of
knowledge in inclusive education. They stated that they wanted to become better
equipped to assist their students and colleagues and be able to share their knowledge
of research based practices and inclusive education with other members of the
educational community. The course culminated in the development and
implementation of an applied research based project to address the needs of the
students at their setting.
The implementation of the research-based project was required as a capstone
experience for the completion of the Master of Education degree. The project
required the design and implementation of an empirically validated (proven to be
effective as a result of sound rigorous investigations) research to practice
intervention. The course was framed around an evaluation methodology that required
participants to employ a known evaluation model in the design and implementation
of their project (Bain, McDonagh & Lancaster, 2005). Evaluation is described as
“the identification, clarification, and application of defensible criteria to determine
an evaluation object’s value, it’s merit or worth, in regard to those criteria”
(Fitzpatrick, Sanders & Worthen, 2004, p.27). The evaluation approach provided an
expedient yet empirically robust and informative way to determine the process and
outcomes of the projects developed by the participants. The approach also provided
practical opportunities for feedback that were used in school settings to further
develop the projects.
Participants were required to develop their research-based projects based upon
interventions in inclusive education that had a record of prior successful use in
168
applied settings. The existing record of applied empirical research on the topic
determined this. Participants presented a final report describing their projects and the
details of its implementation as their Masters’ thesis. These projects were used as a
permanent product record that provided an account of the individual projects written
by each participant. These permanent product records are referred to as projects
through this research.
Six out of ten research participants who completed this requirement of the Masters of
Education course were participants in this study. The implementation of the projects
in the respective school settings provided the context for this study.
The following section individually introduces the research participants and the
details that are specific to their settings and cases.
4.2.1. Participants
All participants were female and their ages ranged from 40-54 at the commencement
of the project. All were experienced teachers and had taught at an average of 4
schools. They all held the role of Special Education Teacher at the setting where
their project was implemented. All six had completed two university degrees prior to
participating in this project. Five of the six projects were conducted in primary
schools with student enrolments ranging from 350 to 600. One project took place in
a high school where approximately 1200 female students were enrolled. At the time
of completion of the data collection in 2009, three of the six participants were still
working at the school where their project was implemented. The other three had
moved to other school settings.
169
Table 4.1 provides a visual overview of participants, their project and setting details.
Additional details that are relevant to individual cases are provided in a narrative
form following the table.
Table 4.1
Research participant details
Participants Years of
teaching
experience
Project Setting Students
involved at
implementation
/students at
school
Staff involved
at
implementation
/
staff at school
Chris
19 Oral Reading
Fluency
Elementary
school
(K-6)
90 in year
2/580
4/42
Mary
31 Curriculum
Bases
Measurement
–literacy
Elementary
school
(K-6)
45 in K/353 4/32
Diane
25 Reading tutor
program
Secondary
school
(7-12)
50 in years 7
to10/1200
2/150
Wilma
27 Oral Reading
Fluency:
CBM
Elementary
school
(K-6)
42 in Year
6/350
6/32
Sam
21 Explicit
teaching:
reading skills
Elementary
school
(K-6)
66 in Year
1/600
5/40
Meg
27 Peer assisted
learning in
spelling
Elementary
school
(K-6)
50 in Year
3/600
2/40
The following section introduces the cases individually. Unique factors about
research participants that are not identified in Table 4.1 are presented. Project setting
details and features of each project are described. The approaches taken to maintain
the integrity of implementation of the projects are also described for each case.
170
4.3. Introduction to Individual Participant and Case Details
4.3.1. Case 1- Chris (Year 2- Curriculum-Based Measurement-
DIBELS- Oral Reading Fluency)
As a participant researcher I completed each phase of the data collection first so that
I was not influenced by the responses of other participants. I have pre-existing views
and opinions that are unique to my experience and relate to the focus of this study. I
acknowledge that I have brought personal and professional insights as a student,
researcher and educator through my teacher and researcher experience to this study.
These experiences have, and continue to present both positive influences and
challenges in this research. As a teacher, I have both an interest in, and commitment
to inclusive education. The insights gained from being a researcher and as a primary
school teacher may also be seen to add strength to this investigation. However, it is
also acknowledged that my personal experience may create biases in the
interpretation and presentation of findings within this thesis. The ways in which
these possible biases have been reduced were explained in the Methods chapter
(Chapter 3).
At the time of the project implementation I described the school in the following
way:
My school is new, only ten years old, and staff remain stable with minimal
changes prior to 2007. I have enjoyed watching the school grow and change
over the past decade. Staff members are supportive of each other and school
initiatives. We enjoy social gatherings on a regular basis and work very hard
to provide a range of opportunities for the students. The staff, students and
parents work together to give the students the opportunity to participate in
171
events such as Wakakiri (a creative arts initiative where students perform for
large audiences in a well publicized evening event at a reputable Sydney
venue), a school production of Robin Hood and multiple sporting days
(Chris, 2009, p.1).
In order to cater for the needs of my students and meet the requirements of the
Masters degree I implemented a project titled: A program for tracking reading
fluency for year two students. It started as a pilot program to address the lack of
growth in the reading development between students in year 3 and year 5. The
project was designed to track individual student’s reading abilities of 94, Year 2
students.
The Dynamic Indicators of Basic Early Literacy Skills (DIBELS) was employed in
the project. DIBELS was developed at the University of Oregon and is described as a
prevention-orientated, Curriculum Based Measure (CBM) utilized to identify readers
at risk of not achieving adequate outcomes (Good & Kaminski, 2002). DIBELS is
comprised of the following measures which are implemented individually: ISF
(Initial Sounds Fluency – preschool to mid Kindergarten); LNF (Letter Naming
Fluency- beginning Kindergarten to beginning 1st grade); PSF (Phoneme
Segmentation Fluency- mid Kindergarten to end 1st grade); NWF (Nonsense Word
Fluency – mid Kindergarten to end 1st grade); ORF (DIBELS Oral Reading
Fluency- mid 1st grade through 6th grade); RTF (Retell Fluency- mid 1st grade
through 6th grade).
DIBELS Oral Reading Fluency (DORF) measures were selected for my project to
address the identified reading needs of students. DORF measures have been used
widely in schools to respond to Great Britain’s National Literacy Strategy
172
(Department for Education and Employment, 1998) and America’s No Child Left
Behind Act (2001). DORF is a standardised individually administered test of
accuracy and fluency with connected text.
A number of studies investigating the efficacy of the DORF approach have shown
that improved fluency can lead to comprehension gains, and improved reading
growth (Kuhn & Stahl, 2003; Shinn & Good, 1992). The success with a wide variety
of implementation settings, support the use of DORF measures as being beneficial in
single class implementation as well as promoting its ability to be scaled up to whole
school implementation (Berniger, Abbott, Vermeulen & Fulton’s, 2006; Shinn,
Knutson, Good, Tilly and Collins, 1992).
Student performance is measured by having students read a passage aloud for one
minute. Reading passages with clear instructions are provided. They are calibrated
for the goal level of reading for each grade. My pilot project represented the first of a
three-staged planned program that was specifically designed to address the lack of
student growth in reading ability using DORF. The second phase aimed at
implementing DORF measures in year one and the third phase was to expand the use
of these measures from years three to six. The need to address the lack of growth in
student’s reading abilities was identified by the school staff and through an external
school review. The increasing transparency of students’ academic results due to
state-wide testing also identified the lack of reading growth in many students’ results
from the year three to year five NSW Basic Skills Tests (BST).
173
1.1.1.6. 4.4.1.1. My reported program implementation
integrity
The DIBELS program included a number of protocols and procedures for monitoring
the integrity of implementation of the measures (See Table 4.2). Other ways the
program was monitored included observations, pre and post interviews, student and
teacher questionnaires and surveys. The Masters project was consulted to provide the
following implementation details;
The instructions provided in the DIBELS teacher manuals were used. DORF
data was collected from ninety four, year two students over a six week
period. Three DORF passages were presented to each child in week four and
week nine of term four, 2006. An average of the raw scores from the three
passages was calculated. Student performance was measured by having
students read each passage aloud for one minute. Words omitted, substituted
or hesitations of more than three seconds are scored as errors. Words self-
corrected within the three seconds are scored as accurate. The number of
correct words read in one minute from each of the three calibrated passages,
were averaged to calculate individual student’s oral reading fluency rate. The
same process was repeated in week nine. This second opportunity to collect
students ORF results made it possible to compare tracked reading fluency
results on two separate occasions (Grima-Farrell, 2007, p.46).
1.1.1.7. 4.4.1.2. Results of the project
The DORF results collected at the start of the project indicated that student scores
ranged from 13 to 191. Of the 94 students assessed in 2006, only 55% were reading
beyond the age appropriate rate of 90 words per minute. The mean DORF rate
174
increased from 87.47 words per minute at the start of term four, 2006 to 95.9 by the
end of 2006. These DORF results along with 97% of teachers’ who indicated that
they believed DORF measures to be accurate in determining ORF, combined to
highlight the benefits in implementing DORF measures at my setting (Grima-Farrell,
2007).
1.1.1.8. 4.4.1.3. Scaling up of the project
Scaling up of the project occurred at a faster rate than expected. The project started
with three year 2 classes in 2006 and by the end of 2007, DIBELS measures were
used from K-6. Student reading fluency growth rates continued to increase across the
school until December, 2007. By 2008 the DORF measures were no longer
administered during the recommended time frames and the project was only partially
sustained. By 2009 the DORF measures were no longer administered and the project
became extinct.
4.3.2. Case 2- Mary (Kindergarten- Curriculum Based Measurement-
DIBELS- Initial Sound Fluency and Letter Naming Fluency)
Mary was the only participant with international teaching experience. She
had taught for 13 years in schools in Ireland, Kenya and Spain (K-6) prior to her 16
years of teaching in Australian schools as a K-6 and Special Education Teacher.
Mary described her school in the following way:
My school is a rural K-6 two stream school situated in south western Sydney.
Many of the students in our school are from families where one or both
parents are from a European background, where English is spoken as a
second language. Some parents work on the land, while others would be
considered blue-collar workers (Mary, 2009, p.1).
175
Mary’s project initially targeted Kindergarten students and aimed to identify those in
need of extension or additional supports in the area of literacy as early as possible.
Information gained from the project was used to inform intense explicit teaching for
those students and make their school experiences effective from the start. The
project was titled: Curriculum Based Measurement – A method of identifying
students who are ‘at risk’ with literacy at the beginning of Kindergarten. Mary stated
that:
This project was selected to establish the value of immediately identifying
children ‘at risk’ of reaching kindergarten benchmarks with literacy, and that
with additional explicit instruction in phonemic awareness, the needs of these
children could be addressed (Mary, 2009, p.1).
Mary reported that her project presented the value of using a curriculum based
measurement from the beginning of Kindergarten to identify students at risk of
failing to read. It also included four weeks of explicit instruction for the students
identified as being ‘at risk’. The curriculum based measurements used were DIBELS
Initial sound fluency (ISF) and Letter Naming Fluency (LNF) probes.
These measures were also created at the University of Oregon and developed by Dr.
Roland Good III and Dr. Ruth Kaminski but they have a different application to the
DORF measures used in my case. The ISF task requires students to identify the word
that begins with a target sound from an array of four pictures. There are a total of 12
items on each probe. Every fourth item requires that the child produce the onset
sound for a target word (Good, Kaminski, Simmons, & Kame’enui, 2001). The LNF
tasks requires the student to name as many letters as they can in one minute from a
printed page containing rows of randomly ordered upper and lower case letters. They
176
were specifically designed to assess the Big Ideas of early literacy and the critical
areas of literacy indicated by the National Reading Panel (2000) and the National
Research Council (1998). These critical areas of literacy include; phonemic
awareness, phonics, fluency, vocabulary and comprehension.
A number of studies investigating the efficacy of CBM approaches have shown that
it
has been recognised internationally as a tool that is reliable and inexpensive
to administer (Allinder, Fuchs & Fuchs, 2004; Shinn, 2002). CBM measures
have been applied to screening, placement in curriculum levels and progress
monitoring although the best feature of CBM is its usefulness in helping
classroom teachers to determine the effectiveness of their teaching in a
variety of applications (Fuchs, 1993; Fuchs, Fuchs & Hamlet, 1989; Witt,
Elliot, Daly, Gresham & Kramer, 1998 as cited in Mary, 2007, p.18).
Mary’s project used the Initial sound fluency (ISF) and Letter Naming Fluency
(LNF) aspect of DIBELS whilst my case utilised the DORF components. Mary
reported that she implemented the ISF and LNF measures at the start and the end of
every four-week cycle within her project to determine if any changes in student
achievement were evident. Her project was consulted for additional information. In
the project Mary stated that the measures were specifically designed to focus on
phonemic awareness and provide teachers with knowledge to assist with explicit
instruction in this area. She identified that explicit instruction can be referred to as
the systematic instructional approach that consists of both design and delivery
components (Mary, 2007).
177
Mary did not provide literature support for explicit teaching although it has a solid
foundation (Cohen, & Spenciner, 2005; Hall, 2009). An additional search identified
that teaching using explicit instruction is most beneficial for low-performing
students and students in special education. However, the results from extensive
research repeatedly indicate that all students benefit from well-designed and
explicitly taught skills (Hall, 2009). Explicit teaching draws on both the behavioural
and cognitive theories of learning. Cognitive theory is concerned with “how students
think, process information and remember” (Cohen, & Spenciner, 2005, p.192).
Behavioural theorists are concerned with observable behaviours and the arrangement
of stimulus conditions as well as reward (Cohen, & Spenciner, 2005). The key
features of explicit instruction are structured tasks that are developed after a highly
sophisticated analysis of curriculum. Teacher demonstration, guided practice based
on the principles of mastery learning, academic focus, student engagement, teacher
feedback, scaffolding and reinforcement of tasks, verbal and cognitive clarity and
independent practice are important elements of explicit teaching (Arthur-Kelly as
cited in Foreman, 2005; Killen, 2003). A number of studies examining the efficacy
of explicit instruction have shown it as an effective strategy for teaching
phonological awareness (Al Otaiba et al., 2005; Carnine et al., 1990; Ellis, 2005;
National Inquiry Into the Teaching of literacy, 2005).
1.1.1.9. 4.4.2.1. Mary’s reported project
implementation integrity
Mary’s completion of the implementation integrity checklist identified that DIBELS
Initial Sound Fluency and DIBELS Letter Naming Fluency progress monitoring
probes were implemented according to guidelines specified in the program (See
Table 4.2). She also used teacher observations and teacher and student feedback to
178
assist her in determining the effectiveness of her project. Mary reported that results
were calculated and the project was evaluated in accordance with these guidelines.
Mary used DIBELS Kindergarten Benchmark assessments to collect data on the
phonemic knowledge of 45 children beginning school in 2007. Mary’s project
confirmed that the DIBELS tools used in the intervention were Initial Sound Fluency
and Letter Naming Fluency (Mary, 2007). This written resource added that all 45
students across 2 classes in Kindergarten were assessed in weeks one and two. The
probes took a minute each to administer. ISF required students to look at a series of
pictures in groups of four and to point to the picture beginning with a particular
sound. Students needed to score eight to be in the low risk category, four in the some
risk category and less than four to be in the at risk category. The initial assessment
found 27 students to be at risk with 16 in the some risk category and two in the low
risk category. Eight children out of the 27 in the ‘at risk’ group had a score of zero.
Twenty students were found to be at risk of not knowing letter names (Mary, 2007).
Mary reported that in the following weeks the students were taught four sounds
explicitly for ten minutes in each class. Students were given the opportunity to
develop independent practice by playing games like ‘ I Spy’ and composing silly
sentences orally using vocabulary built from the initial sounds taught. Rhyming
skills were developed by creating word families. During the second interview Mary
stated that by the end of one week of explicit instruction the 27 children in the ‘at
risk’ category were assessed using ISF progress monitoring probes and only 13
students were found to be at risk. Direct instruction lessons continued in the
following week but the ‘at risk’ group received five extra minutes instruction to help
practice and consolidate the sounds learnt. The thirteen ‘at risk’ students were
assessed again and six students were still found to be at risk but nobody scored less
179
than two. Explicit instruction lessons continued over a four week period and at the
end of the intervention six students were recorded in the ‘at risk’ category, 16 in the
some risk category and 23 in the low risk category (Mary, 2007).
Mary reported that she modelled explicit instruction in the first week of the project.
The classroom teachers then taught it in subsequent weeks. Through teacher
observations Mary found that the instruction given was direct and explicit. Feedback
was given to teachers on their use of guided and independent practice during the
lessons. Teachers completed a survey on their experience teaching phonemic
awareness explicitly as well as the training provided in the administration of the
DIBELS probes. Mary’s responses to the survey and her interview responses
identified that teacher feedback supported the value of using a CBM to identify
children at risk with literacy from the beginning of Kindergarten. She reported that
teachers valued the support this data could give when planning instruction.
1.1.1.10. 4.4.2.2. Results of the project
Mary’s analysis of the data identified 27 children to be ‘at risk’. Following the first
four-week period of explicit instruction in phonemic awareness, ‘at risk’ students
were assessed using DIBELS Progress Monitoring probes in Initial Sound Fluency.
Mary reported that the number of ‘at risk’ students reduced by 46.7% from 27 to 6.
Classroom observations indicated that teachers were graphing data and modifying
their instruction to support those children at risk. Mary reported that the teacher
feedback she collected on the administration of the DIBELS probes indicated that the
probes were easy to administer and were an invaluable way of collecting data in a
busy classroom.
180
1.1.1.11. 4.4.2.3. Scaling up of the project
Mary reported that her project grew rapidly due to its success. The project was
scaled in 2008 with DIBELS measures being administered in all classes from Kinder
to Year 6. Through the first interview Mary stated that the project was scaled and
used in schools beyond the implementation setting in 2009.
4.3.3. Case 3- Diane (Years 7 to 10- Curriculum- Based Measurement-
Peer Assisted Learning)
Diane described her project implementation setting as having a“low socio-economic
status, with many nationalities but the majority of students are from Philippine
backgrounds.” Diane’s project title was: “A Reading Tutor Program.” It was
designed to prevent students from leaving school prior to completing Year 10
because their reading ability did not allow them to fully participate in learning
experiences whilst at school. The project aimed at boosting the reading levels of
fifty students. It was initiated to improve reading accuracy, fluency and
comprehension.
During the interview Diane reported that the project consisted of students using Peer
Assisted Learning Strategies to improve student reading ability. Her project provided
additional details about peer-assisted learning (Diane, 2007).
Topping and Ehly (1998) defined peer-assisted learning as the acquisition of
knowledge and skill through active helping and supporting among status
equals or matched companions. Peer tutoring is a specific form of peer-
assisted learning; it is a collaborative approach in which students (in pairs)
interact to assist each other’s academic achievement, with one pupil adopting
the role of tutor and the other the role of the tutee. Students read aloud to a
181
tutor who encouraged, corrected (accuracy) and checked for comprehension.
The program was modified for the high school setting and was based on Peer
Assisted Learning Strategy research.
A number of studies identified the efficacy of Peer-Assisted Learning
Strategies (PALS) through providing evidence of its effectiveness (Topping
& Ehly, 1998; Fuchs, Fuchs, Thompson & Svenson, 2001). PALS strategies
were used extensively in the US and were found to have potentially positive
effects on reading achievement for English language learners (What Works
Clearinghouse, 2010). Rohrbeck, Ginsburg-Block, Fantuzzo & Miller’s
(2003) study added that all teachers should receive training on the
implementation of effective PAL strategies (Diane, 2007, p.17).
Diane described that she used CBM DIBELS Oral Reading Fluency probes to
determine if a student qualified for placement on the program. Non-standardized
measures for repeated reading were taken to assess student improvements whilst on
the program. The structure of the program included repeated reading, partner
reading, paragraph shrinking and prediction relay. Partner reading used a technique
called pause, prompt and praise.
Diane reported that the school executive and the teaching staff supported the
program. The implementation setting was a Year 7 to 10 secondary school campus
and students from each year group were represented. Participants included students
who had been identified as ‘at-risk’ and Year 10 volunteer tutors. The students had
been identified from school-based Screening Tests on enrolment, ELLA and reading
assessments. Additional investigation identified that ELLA is the English Language
and Literacy Assessment (ELLA) administered to all Year 7 students in government
182
schools and interested non-government schools in NSW. ELLA is a curriculum-
based assessment, testing students' knowledge and skills in particular aspects of
literacy.
Diane reported that the tutors worked one on one with a particular student all year.
The teachers supervising and managing the program were from the Learning Support
Team. The stakeholders were the school executive, classroom teachers and parents
of the student ‘at-risk’. Diane’s project was consulted to add clarification to the
implementation details that Diane had provided during the interview. It identified
that the project ran for two days a week (Tuesday and Wednesday) for 30 minutes
per day, all year. Diane explained that the timing encompassed 10 minutes before
school, 10 minutes of Homeroom time and 10 minutes of Period 1(Diane, 2007).
1.1.1.12. 4.4.3.1. Diane’s reported project
implementation integrity
Diane stated that she used observations, checklists, student surveys, teacher
interviews and questionnaires to determine the effectiveness of her Reading Tutor
Program. She also employed DORF probes, described in my project to determine
changes in student oral reading fluency rates. Diane’s completion of the
implementation integrity checklist and interview responses indicated (See Table 4.2)
that although the DIBELS ORF measures and guidelines were used, they were not
calibrated for high school students. Diane stated that some modifications to fluency
rate expectations were evident as her students were in high school.
Diane reported that:
the majority of teachers (80%) thought that the reading ability of the students
had improved and this enabled them to access more of the curriculum. They
183
also thought the students participated more in classroom activities. The tutor
survey results identified that all of the tutors thought the program helped the
students read better. There was concern from some of the tutors that they
needed more training in the specific techniques of the activities” (Diane,
2007).
Diane reported that the tutors thought the graphing of results from the Repeated
Reading exercise onto a chart inspired the students to do better.
Diane selected the DIBELS primary school measures for her high school setting
because “some students were considered to be ‘at-risk’ because their literacy levels
were significantly lower than their peers, so they were disengaging with their
learning” (Diane, 2007, p.30). Diane explained that the Reading Tutor Program used
the standardized Neale Analysis of Reading Ability Test to determine improvement
in reading accuracy and comprehension after the initial ten-week period. She stated
that the results of the Neale and DORF measures indicated an improvement in
reading rate, comprehension or accuracy.
1.1.1.13. 4.4.3.2. Results of the project
Diane’ reported an average of a six month improvement in reading accuracy, a four
month improvement in reading comprehension and an average improvement of 52
words read per minute per student over the first term of the project’s implementation.
Both Diane’s interviews responses and project presented that the implementation of
the program was affected by student absenteeism, lateness to school. Diane
identified that the strongest response from students was from the Repeated Reading
activity. She stated that students were inspired to improve their scores as the visual
impact of their graphs had a great effect.
184
1.1.1.14. 4.4.3.3. Scaling up of the project
Diane stated that her project continued to be sustained at her implementation setting
in 2009. The project grew to incorporate year 9 students as tutors as well as the year
10 students. Diane reported that due to the limited space in the library the project
couldn’t be scaled. During 2007 Diane moved to another secondary setting where
she implemented the same project. Diane reported that the projects were still being
sustained at both high school settings in 2010.
4.3.4. Case 4- Wilma (Year 6- Curriculum-Based Measurement-
DIBELS- Oral Reading Fluency)
Both Wilma and Mary implemented their individual projects at the same setting.
Wilma’s description of the setting provided additional details:
The program was conducted at a mainstream primary school of 356 children.
The setting was rural with children living on farms or in small residential
areas. There was a wide cultural diversity within the school and large
numbers of students had Lebanese, Italian, Maltese or Croatian background.
The majority of students were born in Australia. The Year Six cohort was
comprised of 42 boys and girls. Classes were of mixed ability, although
seven students formed a small group who received extra support in reading
from the Special Education Teacher (Wilma, 2009, p.1).
Wilma’s project was aimed at the Year 6 level whilst Mary’s was aimed at the kinder
students. Wilma’s project title was Oral Reading Fluency: Using Curriculum Based
Measurement for Assessment and Instruction (See Chris’ case for description of
DORF). She stated the reason for selecting this project for her setting was because;
185
The Program was designed to address the problem of limited assessment of
Year Six students in Reading. The students completed the TORCH
Comprehension Test at the beginning and end of the school year and this was
been documented in the School Assessment Plan. This data was used to plan
graded reading groups and as evidence in the E-A Reporting Scale. Students
experiencing difficulty were tested regularly using the PM Benchmark Kit
that ceased when they attained Level 30 (Reading Age 12 years). The PM
Benchmark kit is used to assess students reading abilities using unseen and
age relevant texts (Randell, Giles, Nelley & Smith, 2002). The Year Six
students Basic Skills Test data was also used to inform planning and
instruction. The DIBELS Oral Reading Fluency was introduced to assess the
students’ skill of reading connected text in grade level material (Good, Gruba
& Kaminski, 2002). The Program served the need for regular student
assessment using a reliable, valid and research-based tool and the planning of
explicit instruction that would improve oral reading skills based on this data
(Wilma, 2009, p.8).
Wilma outlined how the data gathered was used to plan appropriate instruction using
the re-reading strategy. The students completed activities daily and graphed their
results as a self-monitoring approach. Corrective feedback was given during the
project and instructional adjustments were made when needed.
1.1.1.15. 4.4.4.1. Wilma’s program implementation
integrity
Wilma used student and teacher surveys, observations and the Dynamic Indicators of
Early Literacy Skills Oral Reading Fluency (DORF) measures to determine the
186
effectiveness of her project. During the interviews Wilma reported that all students
were assessed using the DORF measures at the beginning, middle and end of the
year and additional data was collected throughout the year according to the
guidelines. Wilma’s implementation integrity checklist (See Table 4.2) indicated that
DORF structures and materials were implemented using DIBELS instructions and
guidelines as outlined in my case. Wilma stated that results were calculated and the
project was evaluated in accordance with the guidelines.
1.1.1.16. 4.4.4.2. Results of the project
Wilma stated that all students in Year Six were assessed using the DIBELS ORF at
the commencement of the project in 2007. She identified that on the completion of
this initial assessment, seven students were in the ‘at risk’ band with scores ranging
from 44 – 70 words per minute. Wilma explained that the reading of 83 words per
minute was required to move up to the “some risk” band. Wilma went on to report
that after a period of four weeks only 3 students remained in the at risk group with
scores ranging from 48 – 70 wpm. Additional details on the results of the project
were located in Wilma’s project;
In general there was an upward shift of students throughout the 3 bands. All
students completed reading fluency activities during the project and graphed
their results daily. A small group of students also completed oral reading
activities as part of their homework and parents provided feedback regarding
their child’s progress (Wilma, 2006, p.60).
1.1.1.17. 4.4.4.3. Scaling up of the project
Wilma stated that by 2008 her project was scaled and DIBELS measures were being
implemented in all classes from Kinder to Year 6. During the first interview, Wilma
187
reported that the project was scaled beyond her setting and was implemented at
another school in 2009.
4.3.5. Case 5- Sam (Year 1- Explicit Teaching as a practice for quality
teaching)
Sam worked at two primary settings during her project implementation year. Sam
implemented her project in the larger primary school that she taught at and described
the setting in the following way:
The program is set in a non public school in NSW. The school of 600
students was built twenty years ago to service newly developed housing
estates in an Outer Western Sydney area that is predominantly working and
middle class. Although not regarded as a school with a high migrant
population significant numbers of the children are second and third
generation Australian from Maltese backgrounds. In the past three years a
number of refugees from the Sudan have been enrolled in the school. A
significant number of children enter Kindergarten each year having had
limited experiences with literacy and books (Sam, 2009, p.37).
Sam suggested that a significant number of children had limited literacy experience
as they began Kindergarten. As a result Sam stated that a need existed to understand
and explore explicit teaching of phonological awareness with her group of students.
Her project was titled: Explicit Teaching: Improving Foundational Reading Skills in
Year One (See Mary’s and Chris’ cases for a description of other DIBELS probes). It
explored the relationship between explicit teaching and the reading development of
66, Year One students. Sam provided the following project description:
188
This program seeks to build capacity amongst Year One teachers to
implement explicit instruction in reading particularly in the area of
phonological awareness. The program exists to support the work of the
school leadership team who promote the use of explicit teaching as a practice
for quality teaching. It has been initiated because ongoing professional
development of teachers is needed to successfully implement this pedagogy.
Improving student outcomes in the area of English was a recommendation of
the school review conducted in 2005.
Teachers and parents are concerned when children do not meet the expected
outcomes for reading. Children are keen to succeed in reading, and are
frustrated when they cannot read at the level of their peers. This has
consequences for learning and behaviour as well as social and emotional
development.
The Learning Support Team have noted that children who are referred
because of reading difficulties consistently score below the benchmark in the
area of phonological awareness as measured by The Sutherland Phonological
Awareness Test SPAT-R (Neilson, 2003).
The goal of this program is to provide a model of explicit teaching that could
be scaled up in the school. It is hoped its use will be sustained over time to
become an embedded teaching practice that promotes inclusion. A secondary
goal is to improve student outcomes in reading in Year 1 through the explicit
teaching of phonological awareness (Sam, 2007, p.36).
Sam indicated that her project addressed the complex skills of blending and
segmenting, after the review of sound and word discrimination, syllables, rhyme
189
identification and production. As a result of the implementation of this research-
based project, Sam believed that teachers have the capacity to implement reforms
that can positively impact student outcomes.
1.1.1.18. 4.4.5.1. Sam’s reported program
implementation integrity
Sam described her project and its implementation with great clarity. She explained
that she employed an implementation integrity checklist and interviews to confirm
whether teachers incorporated the key features of explicit instruction in the
phonological awareness lessons (See Table 4.2). The existing record relating to the
efficacy of explicit instruction is described in the account of Mary’s project and will
not be reiterated here. Sam reported that the SPAT-R (Nielson, 2003) and DIBELS
Phonemic Segmentation Fluency (PSF) probes were administered pre and post
instruction to determine changes in student phonemic segmentation fluency scores.
Sam’s project identified that SPAT-R provides a diagnostic overview of skills
involved in early literacy development and PSF measure assesses a student’s ability
to segment three- and four-phoneme words into their individual phonemes fluently.
The PSF measures are different to the DIBELS measures implemented in the other
cases. Sam’s project identified that she selected this measure as evidence based
research shows that phonological awareness is a foundational reading skill that is
best taught explicitly (Carnine, Silbert , & Kameenui, 1990; Ellis, 2005; Stanovich,
1986 as cited in Sam, 2007, p.51).
The implementation integrity checklist completed by Sam in her survey identified
that she used DIBELS materials and guidelines with consistency. She reported that
she used a number of tools to calculate results or evaluate the explicit teaching
190
program. These tools included the use of Sutherland Phonological Awareness Test or
SPAT-R (Nielson, 2003) and DIBELS PSF measures. The SPAT-R was used to
measure the improvement in the children’s phonological awareness. This test
allowed not only general performance to be evaluated but also included individual
test items for syllable counting, rhyming, blending, segmenting and manipulation.
“This test is easily administered and effectively identifies deficiencies in a
comprehensive range of phonological skills” (Robinson, in Foreman, 2005 as cited
in Sam, 2007, p.34). Sam reported that this information can be validated by the use
of a curriculum based measure or CBM. The DIBELS Phoneme Segmentation
Fluency will be to monitor the mastery of at risk students. The implementation
integrity of explicit teaching will be measured by an observation checklist completed
by the literacy support teacher when mentoring the teachers (Sam, 2007). Sam’s
project also identified that an evaluation questionnaire was completed by the
teachers.
1.1.1.19. 4.4.5.2. Results of the project
Sam reported that her project commenced in 2007 with initial SPAT-R (Neilson,
2003) scores collected on three classes of Year 1 students. In Class A the range of
scores on the initial SPAT-R was from the 2nd to the 95th percentile. The median
score was in the 49th percentile. A total of 21% of children in Class A fell below the
benchmark of the 25th percentile; 13 % were in the critically low range which is
below the 10th percentile. In Class B the range on the SPAT-R was from the 2nd to
the 89th percentile. The median score was in the 36th percentile. 19% of children fell
below the benchmark; 13% were in the critically low range. In Class C the range on
the SPAT-R was from the 2nd to the 95th percentile. The median score was in the 30th
percentile. 32 % of children fell below the benchmark; 18% were in the critically
191
low range. In each class only one child had a reading age of less than six years as
measured by the Waddington Reading Test.
Sam continued to explain that student’s instructional reading levels as measured by
running records from the PM Benchmark (2000) ranged from 0 to 24. By the end of
Kindergarten, 52% of students did not meet the school benchmark of level five. Sam
identified that all the children who had critically low scores on the SPAT-R failed to
meet the reading benchmark of level five. She added that DIBELS PSF measures
were also used during the project to monitor student progress. Sam stated that by the
conclusion of the project, PSF and an analysis of the pre and post test SPAT-R
results showed improvements across all students
The children at high risk and some risk were monitored weekly during the
project using the progress monitoring forms of the DIBELS PSF. The post-
test results show that the children at high risk or some risk of not achieving
the benchmark score of 35 correct segments per minute fell in all three
classes. In Classes A & B 26 % of the class moved out of risk compared to
9% in Class C. At the conclusion of the project 83% of class A were at low
risk, 86% of class B were at low risk and 45% of Class C were at low risk.
Four percent of Class A remained at high risk, 0% of Class B remained at
high risk and 15% of Class C remained at high risk (Sam, 2007, p.63).
Sam suggested that teacher attitudes on rating scales were positive towards
phonological awareness and explicit teaching. She calculated that one hundred
percent of teachers reported using explicit teaching strategies after the project’s
conclusion.
192
The implementation integrity checklist and weekly interviews were used to
confirm whether teachers incorporated the key features of explicit instruction
in the phonological awareness lessons. All teachers were observed using the
scripted program and they reported finding it helpful. On one occasion when
the teacher anticipated her absence the next day the program was left for a
casual teacher to use. Implementation integrity was strongest for Teacher B
who followed the lesson plan verbatim. Monitoring, feedback and verbal
clarity were particular strengths for teachers A1 and A2. On occasions both
teachers A1 and A2 reverted to questioning the students rather than
modelling and leading (Sam, 2007, p.62)
1.1.1.20. 4.4.5.3. Scaling of the project
During the first interview Sam reported that her project continued to be sustained at
her implementation setting in 2009. She also stated that she has also implemented a
similar project at another primary school setting. No additional details were
identified through the exploration phase.
4.3.6. Case 6- Meg (Year 3-Peer Assisted Learning- Spelling)
Meg and Sam implemented their individual projects at the same setting. Meg added
that the setting is in a “lower socio economic working class area outer western
suburb of Sydney”. Meg’s program targeted spelling skills and addressed a need
identified through Basic Skills Testing. The project title is: Peer Assisted Learning
and its use as an Intervention Strategy in the Improvement of Spelling skills. Meg
stated that:
The project was originally designed to address the problem of poor spelling
skills in Year Three in classroom writing tasks. Previous results from the
193
Basic Skills Tests (2005-2006) in both Literacy and Numeracy assessments
revealed that on an overall basis, the students did not perform well in the
spelling skills area (Meg, 2009, p.1).
During the interviews Meg’s reported that Peer-Assisted Learning Strategies (PALS)
Reading and PALS Math were developed to help teachers accommodate diverse
learners and to promote their academic success. Meg’s project identified that PALS
is listed among best evidence-supported math programs on the John Hopkins
University website. The What Works Clearinghouse found that Peer-Assisted
Learning Strategies instructional program to have potentially positive effects on
reading achievement for elementary-age children. PALS was designed to be used
with all students in kindergarten through 5th grade (Meg, 2007). Meg did not provide
evidence on PALS yet it has been successfully implemented in Iowa, Minnesota,
Oregon, Tennessee, Texas, and other states. The findings of Fuchs, Fuchs,
Thompson & Svenson (2001) and Rohrbeck, Ginsburg-Block, Fantuzzo & Miller
(2003) presented evidence for the effectiveness of PALS. The work of Calhoon
(2005), Marchand-Martella, Martella, Bettis & Blakely (2004), Allor, Fuchs &
Mathes (2001), and Fuchs, Fuchs & Kazdan (1999) all used variations of PALS to
determine its effectiveness.
Meg indicated that she identified poor spelling skills when she read student’s work.
She added that she decided to implement her project with Year 3 because she was
confident that two of the Year 3 teachers would be willing to help the following year.
Meg explained that the initial phase of the project was implemented over a four-
week period. Fifty students participated in a 20 minute structured paired spelling
session using the seven-step SPELLER structure (Keller, 2002). SPELLER uses
194
visual imagery, systematic testing, and auditory reinforcement on a daily basis
through the use of peer assisted learning strategies. It is a Class Wide Peer Tutoring
strategy (CWPT) that has proven to be effective for increasing students’ mastery of
spelling (Keller, 2002). Working for twenty-minutes a day, all students take turns
playing the role of tutor and tutee, and they use the SPELLER strategy in order to
learn their weekly spelling words. The Waddington Diagnostic Spelling Test was
administered as a pre and post test to determine changes in students spelling ability.
Meg stated that the Waddington Test was easy to use and was a useful tool for
diagnosing literacy difficulties. Meg provided less information than other
participants through the interviews, surveys and her permanent product record.
1.1.1.21. 4.4.6.1. Meg’s reported program
implementation integrity
Meg determined the effectiveness of her Peer Assisted Learning project through
teacher and student surveys and the weekly monitoring of spelling scores. Meg
stated that she completed checklists on both students and teachers to monitor the
implementation of correct Peer Assisted Learning Procedures. She administered a
pre and post Waddington Diagnostic Spelling Test to determine any change in
individual student’s spelling skills. Meg’s responses to the implementation integrity
checklist stated that some pre existing project material and guidelines were used
without consistency (See Table 4.2). No additional information on the integrity of
the implementation of Meg’s project was located.
1.1.1.22. 4.4.6.2. Project results
During the interview Meg reported that 98% of students experienced improvements
in their spelling scores when using peer assisted learning strategies within the first
195
four weeks of the project. Meg’s explained that through observation and the use of
checklist data she was able to determine that all teachers involved in the project
adhered to the peer assisted learning procedures and consistency was maintained.
Her permanent product record was consulted to gather additional information on the
spelling scores but this data was not available. Meg’s project did confirm that
spelling scores had improved in 98% of students, yet no additional data was located.
It also stated that not all teachers implemented the project with integrity in 2008 as
they did not maintain consistency in their use of the instructions that Meg had
provided. Her interview responses did report that the school executive did decide to
scale the project in 2008 without consulting the staff.
1.1.1.23. 4.4.6.3. Scaling of the project
During the first interview Meg reported that her project was sustained in 2007. She
stated that it became partially sustained in 2008 and was extinct by 2009.
4.4. Summary of the reported implementation integrity of the projects
This section presents a table that summarises the responses to the implementation
integrity checklist that participants individually completed in the surveys. It is
followed by a summary of the status (level at which the project is implemented or
sustained in the school setting) of the projects at annual intervals.
All participants individually completed an implementation integrity checklist which
was included in Part 1 of the Survey. Table 4.2 provides summary of these
responses. A description of how the implementation integrity of each project was
maintained was identified within the previous descriptions of the cases. Each
research participant through the use of the methods they selected determined the
effectiveness of individual projects.
196
Table 4.2
Summary of the reported implementation integrity checklist provided by research
participants
Response
Checklist questions Yes No N/A
Did your project use a pre existing program with
guidelines or instructions (for example, CBM, CBA,
DIBELS)?
Chris
Mary
Wilma
Sam
Meg
Diane
If so were they utilized? Chris
Mary
Wilma
Sam
Diane
Meg
Was there consistency in the implementation of program
features?
Chris
Mary
Wilma
Sam
Meg
Diane
Were suggested project materials, such as workbooks or
manuals used throughout your project?
Chris
Wilma
Sam
Meg
Mary
Diane
Were results collected and calculated in accordance with
guidelines or instructions provided?
Chris
Mary
Wilma
Meg
Diane
Sam
Was the project evaluated using the guidelines or
instructions provided?
Chris
Mary
Wilma
Meg
Diane
Sam
In summary a review of the implementation integrity information provided by each
research participant identified that four of the six participants implemented programs
that were resourced with scripted instructions. Meg and Diane implemented
programs that were not resourced with scripted instructions. Diane implemented her
project in accordance with implementation guidelines however the project was not
calibrated for secondary school students. Meg reported that she adhered to the peer
assisted learning procedures and that consistency in implementation was maintained,
however additional information gathered from her Master’s project identified
inconsistencies in the way teachers implemented the spelling lessons and gave the
spelling tests in 2008 (Meg, 2006).
197
4.5. Summary of the status of the Projects
This section presents a summary of the standing of the projects within their setting at
the end of each academic year of the study. The data in Table 4.3 was collected
through the Master’s projects, interviews and surveys (described in the methods
chapter) and presents an overview of each projects status from 2006 to 2009.
Definitions of each category being; extinct; partially sustained; sustained; scaled
within settings; and scaled beyond settings, provide guidelines to maintain clarity
and consistency across all responses.
4.5.1. Definitions of Operational Categories:
1. Project extinct refers to projects that are terminated at the conclusion of the
academic year.
2. Partially sustained refers to projects that are operational beyond year of
implementation (course requirement) however the project form was not fully
consistent with program guidelines.
3. Sustained refers to projects that continue to be utilized in the same capacity
as it was in the implementation year.
4. Scaled within setting refers to programs that have been utilized with staff/
students beyond those that were planned at the initial implementation year
and within the same setting.
5. Scaled beyond setting refers to programs that have been utilized in settings
beyond the original implementation setting.
Note implementation year refers to year the project was undertaken as a part of the
CSU course requirement.
Table 4.3
198
Project Status
Project 2006 2007 2008 2009
C1 Chris/Primary Pilot
Program for tracking
reading fluency of year 2
students
Established
and sustained
Scaled within
setting
Partially
sustained
Extinct
C2 Mary/Primary CBM
Identifying students who
are “at risk” with literacy
at the beginning of
Kindergarten.
Not yet started Established
and sustained
Scaled within
setting
Scaled beyond
setting
C3 Diane/Secondary
Reading tutor program
years7-10
Established
and sustained
Established
and sustained
Scaled within
setting
Scaled beyond
setting
C4Wilma/Primary
Oral reading fluency:
Using CBM for
assessment and
Instruction for year 6
Not yet started Established
and sustained
Scaled within
setting
Scaled beyond
setting
C5 Sam/Primary
Explicit teaching:
Improving foundational
reading skills in year 1
Not yet started Established
and sustained
Scaled within
setting
Scaled beyond
setting
C6 Meg/Primary Peer
assisted learning and its
use as an Intervention
strategy in the
improvement of spelling
skills for year 3
Established
and sustained
Sustained Partially
sustained
Extinct
Chris, Mary and Meg commenced their projects in 2006, while Diane, Wilma and
Sam commenced in their projects in 2007. By the end of 2009, two primary school
based projects became extinct and four projects (three primary and one secondary)
had been scaled beyond the implementation setting. Of the four projects that were
scaled beyond their implementation setting in 2009, two participants remained at the
setting in 2009 and two did not. Of the two extinct projects, one participant remained
at the setting in 2009 whilst the other did not.
199
The following section presents the data gathered through the three phases of this
study; the exploration, explanation and the expansion phases. Collectively this data
presented the RTP factors that had an impact on the status of the direct
implementation of research projects in unique classroom and school settings.
4.5.2. Exploration Phase
The first phase of this study, the exploration phase, presents the theoretical assertions
identified in relevant RTP literature (see literature review). This knowledge was then
used as a framework to guide the study. The review of literature was set within the
parameters of inclusion and investigated five main bodies of literature that worked to
link educational research and practice efforts. As investigations that directly
examined the implementation of validated research projects into schools were
limited, the literature search continued to investigate the areas of Professional
Development (PD) and Teacher Education (TE) that were specific to the translation
of research to practice. The Comprehensive School Reform (CSR) literature was
examined as it constituted a large-scale effort, with guidelines specifically requiring
the implementation of research based practices at scale. The Concerns Based
Adoption Model (CBAM) was also examined as it represented a longstanding
model, related to adopting change. The purpose of including CSR and CBAM was to
further identify more specific factors not generated by the RTP, PD and TE
literature. Table 4.4 presents the factors that were identified through the investigation
of the five bodies of education literature that are said to influence research to practice
(RTP) and make educational settings more responsive to the needs of all students.
These areas were treated extensively in the literature review and are summarised as a
source of data here.
200
Table 4.4 provides an overview of the total number of references located within each
of the five areas investigated. It presents a breakdown of the number of references
identified within each of those literature areas. Not all references were related to
education as some presented medical and other perspectives. Details of the literature
search refinement process are identified in the literature review. In brief, studies
were only included in the reviewed literature if they appeared in a published peer
reviewed journal and identified specific RTP factors that assisting in translating the
work of researchers to address the needs of students in school settings. Descriptors
introduced to refine the EbscoHost search included: research into practice,
professional development, teacher education, comprehensive school reform,
concerns based adoption model, inclusive education and education. Articles were
only selected for this review if they specifically discussed the use of research-based
programs in primary, secondary and university settings.
Each of the studies was read and categorized according to the project and participant
details and the RTP factor identified. The consistencies in RTP assertions across
both intervention research and commentary claims are presented in Table 2.2
(Chapter 2 the literature review). Commentary based claims were greater in number
than claims that emerged from an empirical study of research to practice. Articles
that made reference to PD in fields other than education and did not refer to the RTP
gap were not selected for this review. TE represented an avenue which links the
efforts of researchers and educators who work in inclusive education environments
to enhance RTP endeavors (Everington & Hamill, 1996; Golder, et al., 2005; Villa &
Thousand, 1996c). Like PD, TE was expected to have a RTP agenda however the TE
literature indicated that while RTP remains a concern, it was often only discussed in
depth (Carnine, 1997a; Darling-Hammond, 2006a; D. Fuchs & L. Fuchs, 1998;
201
Gravani, 2008). The Comprehensive School Reform initiatives yielded information
about the way reform projects were implemented through its focus on bringing
research based practice to scale in public education. The Concerns Based Adoption
Model and related research focused on deepening RTP knowledge through
increasing an awareness of change related elements. CSR and CBAM searches
presented the strongest representation of research-based knowledge when compared
to commentary claims, than the RTP, PD and TE searches.
Table 4.4 Number of located and used references within each literature search area
Key literature search area Number of references
located
Number of
Commentary
References found
Number of
research examples
found
Research to practice 1158 19 10
Professional development and
research to practice
296 4 8
Teacher education and research to
practice
440 4 4
Comprehensive school reform 1168 4 6
Concerns based adoption model 187 3 4
Total references located 3249
34 32
The following section presents a summary of the major themes and factors that were
derived from the review of RTP and the related literature.
202
4.5.3. Exploration phase
1.1.1.24. 4.6.3.1. What factors have been identified in
literature that contributes to sustaining RBP in
inclusive educational settings?
The factors that were consistently identified through the RTP literature as being
contributors to the status of research-based projects are presented in Table 4.4.
Increasing detail and less commentary-based assertions were evident as the literature
search moved from the initial RTP search through to the investigation of the CBAM
literature. The factors presented in the RTP column predominantly represented the
assertions gained through commentary claims. PD with a RTP agenda went further
in identifying ways RTP knowledge could be shared with educators. PD assertions
supported the concerns identified about the possible reasons for and solutions to the
RTP gap. They promoted the need for comprehensive, coordinated, and sustained
efforts in the area of teacher education to reduce the RTP gap.
The investigation of the TE literature built on factors identified in PD research. The
main need identified in the teacher education literature was the need to
collaboratively link university and school efforts (Capizzi & Fuchs, 2005; Darling-
Hammond & Baratz-Snowden, 2007; D. Fuchs & L. S. Fuchs, 1998; Golder, et al.,
2005; Gravani, 2008; Korthagen, 2004; Winn & Zundans, 2004b). Collaboration,
defined in the teacher education context, referred to researchers working with
practitioners to address their questions and needs. The exploration of the TE
literature built on prior RTP knowledge to present TE as an avenue for researchers
and educators who work in inclusive education environments to enhance RTP
endeavors, through involving practitioners in the research process. This was said to
203
encourage a deeper comprehension and ownership of research efforts (Everington &
Hamill, 1996; Golder, et al., 2005; Villa & Thousand, 1996b).
Through the Comprehensive School Reform initiative, previously identified
collaboration factors were further described through the identification of the need for
a complete theory and framework. A need for well-aligned system and policy goals
with feedback and evaluation features built into projects rather than added on at the
end was identified (Bain, 2007a; McLeskey & Waldron, 2006; Slavin, Madden, &
Educational Resources Information Center (U.S.), 2001).
The Concerns Based Adoption Model work provided information on the changing
needs of stakeholders and environments and provided an insight into the variables
that required attention for the successful transition of research to practice (Hall &
Hord, 1987; Hord, Rutherford, Huling-Austin, & Hall, 1987; Loucks-Horsley &
Stiegelbauer, 1991).
Collectively the information collected from the RTP literature provided an
accumulation of knowledge about which factors are said to contribute to the research
to practice gap. They presented the value in establishing links between researchers,
teachers and schools and this became more specific as they moved through the stages
of the review of the literature. Table 4.4 presents a summary of the RTP factors
categorized within themes. See Table 2.1 and table 2.2 in the review of the literature
for additional details re studies, factors and authors.
204
Table 4.4
Research to Practice key themes and related factors
RTP PD TE CSR CBAM
Responsiveness of
research
Useable
Practical Accessible
Trustworthy
Evidence based Manageable
Collaboration
Shared
responsibility,
understanding and ownership
Collegiality
Mutual respect
Cooperation
Communication
Substantive frequent interaction
Feedback
Professional
Development
Consistent
Address needs
Active teacher involvement
Review research to
increase research knowledge
Resource Support
Adequate time and
materials
Long term
Positive attitude
from students and
peers
Responsiveness
PD programs must
respond to genuine
teacher needs and concerns
Reflective of student
needs Responds to
classroom contexts
Collaboration
Joint partnerships
Mutually identified boundaries, structures
and purposes
“Buy in” from all
stakeholders
Engagement in
pursuit of genuine questions, problems
and solutions
Scientifically based
instructional
practices
Evidence based and
proven to be effective Central to students
learning
Viewed as credible by teachers
Comprehensive
Support
Teachers need to feel
sufficiently prepared
Networks
Sufficient
instructional time Adequate resources
Ongoing stakeholder
support Limiting competing
demands to achieve a
balance of multiple agendas
Responsiveness of
university education
programs
Joint partnerships Research based
Effective delivery
Good contextual fit Valued by students
Address real life
concerns Need for opportunities
and time for practical
development of classroom based skills
and knowledge
Collaboration Joint partnerships
Involving practitioners in the research process
Multiple level
feedback Responsive, cohesive
course structures Mutually aligned
norms, expectations
and roles Critical in developing
links between theory
and practice
Support
Addresses teacher enthusiasm
Awareness of fatigue
and exhaustion
Support personnel
qualities and attributes
Need for theory to make TE more
coherent
Adequate depth and time to research based
practices
Scalability and
Educational Power
Use of scientific
research Validated with
scalability potential
Joint partnerships School level design
for school level
influence Effective adoption
Comprehensiveness
Need for complete
theory framework
Intersection of
process and content
Adequate and
complete design Self reinforcing
Well aligned system
and policy goals
Supportive
environments and
structures
Emergent feedback Evaluation as an
emergent function
rather than an add on Use of systemic
technology
Long term and consistent
Well developed
student materials,
teacher manuals,
assessment and
training. Professional Lives
acknowledgement of
the need for recognition and
reward
Research based
change process
Responds to personal
growth in knowledge and skills
Process not an event
Change is a highly personal experience
PD should occur over
time and be dynamic in addressing
participant needs
Collaboration
Shared ownership of
the elements involved
in and resulting from
the change process
Shared acknowledgement of
changing needs of
stakeholders and environments
Understood by all United
Awareness of shared
ownership and individual strength
Support through
change
Sustained assistance
Support structures must change as needs
change
Beyond individuals
From multiple
agencies and agendas
Within realistic time frames
The way in which the factors from the five key literature areas added depth to the
research to practice knowledge was specifically presented in the literature review
(Chapter two). In brief, researchers have described ways to involve practitioners in
the development, implementation, and maintenance of empirically validated
interventions. Others have compared variations in the intensity of professional
development programs and described models used to deliver research- based
205
education to teachers. CSR efforts have provided an insight into factors that have
resulted from large scale RTP efforts and CBAM introduces elements associated
with change. Researchers focused their efforts on working more collaboratively with
practicing teachers to improve the trustworthiness, accessibility, usability,
attractiveness and responsiveness of research.
The knowledge and assertions associated with each area was identified through their
interrelationship and links to research based knowledge relevant to our classrooms,
schools and systems. These key RTP themes derived from factors identified through
the culmination of the literature search predicated the research questions and
consequently the progression of the research and tool development. Significant areas
of literature that yielded relevant guiding information on ways to bridge the research
to practice gap were identified. These areas of review fell broadly from theory to
practice assertions that claim to impact upon the transition of research to practice.
As a result of this search that incorporated knowledge from five linked areas, a
broader knowledge base that may assist in a deeper comprehension of the factors that
impact the transition of RTP has been produced.
The collation of these factors presented in Table 4.4 generally fell across three
themes; collaboration, responsiveness of research and support (see literature review
for distillation of themes). They were used as guiding and non- exclusive themes to
examine factors that have impacted upon the practical transition of RTP within and
across the six specific cases. Although the RTP literature was predominantly based
on commentary claims, the investigation of the other bodies of literature has been
used to create the list of succinct and detailed RTP factors. This list represents the
factors that have been asserted repeatedly through the RTP literature. It distills the
206
RTP factors and presents a more detailed account of what is described in the
literature review. The validity of these claims is examined through six RTP cases. A
list of 16 succinct and detailed RTP factors follows:
1. Research to practice is influenced by the extent to which educators can be
involved with research projects. Such involvement can result in partnerships
that share responsibility and ownership and build a sense of credibility
among stakeholders in the results of research and the research process (Fuchs
& Fuchs, 2001; L. Fuchs & D. Fuchs, 1998; J. Klingner, et al., 2003; J. K.
Klingner, et al., 2003; Klingner, Vaughn, Hughes, & Arguelles, 1999;
Vaughn, 2001; Vaughn & Klingner, 2000).
2. Research into practice works most effectively in systems and schools that
have clear goals promoting the use of research. When these goals are shared
and research projects respond to genuine questions, problems and solutions
the RTP gap can be reduced (Fullan, 1993, 1999; Fullan & Hargreaves, 1992;
Sparks & Richardson, 1997).
3. Research projects that have shown or considered ways to address scalability
have a greater likelihood of bridging the research to practice gap and exerting
whole school influence or effect (Bain, 2007b; Bain & Hess, 2001; Slavin &
Madden, 2001).Hurley, Chamberlain, Slavin, & Madden (2001) add to
endnote
4. Research projects are enhanced when communication and feedback from
many stakeholders (from all levels) is ongoing and substantive (emergent
function) (Ahwee et al. 2003; Bain, 2007; Foegan et al., 2001; Foorman &
Moats, 2004; Fuchs & Fuchs, 1998, 2001; Vaughn et al., 2001).
5. For research based projects to be successful, they need consistent, long term
support that addresses teacher enthusiasm, personal qualities, fatigue and
changing needs is required (Bybee, 2005) add to endnote (Hall & Hord,
1987; Hord, Rutherford, Huling-Austin, & Hall, 1987; Loucks-Horsley &
207
Stiegelbauer, 1991).
6. Well-developed student materials, teacher manuals and training within
realistic time frames promote the effective adoption of research-based
projects (Billups, 1997; Carnine, 1997; Gersten et al., 1997; Lloyd,
Weintraub, & Safer, 1997; Sydoriak& Fields, 1997; Zahorik, 1984).
7. Acknowledgement, recognition and reward for the use of research based
practices will enhance their use (Bain, 2007b).
8. Technology has many functions that can help make RTP more efficient.
When it is accessible and used by stakeholders it can enhance the
implementation, sustainment and expansion of research based projects (Bain,
2007b).
9. The use of validated research based projects is enhanced if their outcomes are
viewed as credible by stakeholders, elicit positive student attitude and
address genuine teacher and student concerns and needs (Borman, Hewes,
Overman, & Brown, 2002; Foorman & Moats, 2004; Slavin, 2004).
10. Limiting the competing demands placed on practitioners is required if
research based practices are to be implemented and sustained (Gersten, et al.,
2007b; Miller, et al., 2005).
11. Sufficient and ongoing instructional time, preparation and resourcing are
contributors to the effective use and promotion of Research based practices
(Ax, Ponte, & Brouwer, 2008; Everington & Hamill, 1996; Foorman &
Moats, 2004; Golder, et al., 2005; Gravani, 2008; Villa & Thousand, 1996c).
12. Research based projects that have a complete implementation strategy
through being comprehensive, accessible and practical will be more
successful. When these features are woven into the projects design the
engagement of all parts of the project can have a reinforcing effect that can
further enhance its success (Darling-Hammond, 2006b; DETYA, 2000;
Francis, 2002; Gunstone & Northfield, 1993; D Sydoriak & M Fields, 1997).
13. Teacher education has the capacity to promote the use of research based
practices when subjects or courses in a preparation program are intentionally
208
linked, reinforcing key ideas and enabling students to build both a big and
small picture understanding such practices. When such courses directly
respond to teacher needs through a clear and consistent approach the bridge
between research and practice can be further reduced efforts (Capizzi &
Fuchs, 2005; Darling-Hammond & Baratz-Snowden, 2007; D. Fuchs & L. S.
Fuchs, 1998; Golder, et al., 2005; Gravani, 2008; Korthagen, 2004; Winn &
Zundans, 2004a).
14. Research based projects can be enhanced when teachers and researchers work
together to develop links between theory (researchers perspective) and
practice (classroom teachers perspective). This can contribute to teachers
feeling sufficiently prepared which creates an avenue for research based
practices to be effectively used in classroom (Everington & Hamill, 1996;
Foorman & Moats, 2004; Golder, et al., 2005; J. K. Klingner, et al., 2003;
Villa & Thousand, 1996a).
15. An awareness of changing stakeholder and setting circumstances is required
to ensure research-based practices are be responsive to individual and setting
needs (Hall & Hord, 1987; Hord, Rutherford, Huling-Austin, & Hall, 1987;
Loucks-Horsley & Stiegelbauer, 1991).
16. An understanding by all stakeholders that the implementation and
sustainment of research based practices is an ongoing process not an event
enhances their continued use (Abbott et al., 1999; El-Dinary, Pressley, Coy-
Ogan, & Schuder, 1994; Horsley Loucks-Horsley, 1998; MacArthur,
Schwartz, Graham, Molloy, & Harris, 1996; Schumm & Vaughn, 1995;
Vaughn, Hughes, Schumm, & Klingner, 1998).
This list reflects well-documented commentary claims and insights from related
large and small research based projects. The following section identifies the
alignment between the perceptions of the research participants and these literature-
based assertions. The first interviews provided an opportunity for open ended
discussion and were all conducted over afternoon tea, in the same location and used
the same questions. The guiding questions were framed to give participants an
209
opportunity to introduce their project and present the factors and events that they felt
contributed to the status of their projects. A description of all the data collection
tools was provided in the Methods chapter.
4.6. Factors identified by participants prior to the introduction of RTP
knowledge identified in the literature
This second part of the exploration phase presented the factors that contributed to the
direct implementation and status of the individual projects from the participant’s
perspective and prior to sharing RTP knowledge identified in the literature with
them. These responses were collected to ensure that participants were not influenced
by the literature when they were describing their individual RTP experiences. The
responses also created a baseline to establish the perceptions and priorities
unencumbered by any expectancy that may be created by the prior knowledge of the
literature. These responses that were not influenced by the literature were then
compared to the RTP factors identified through the literature. The explanation phase
used the literature to build on the responses collected through this exploration phase.
This was done through the practical examples that provided additional details of how
the factors unfold in classroom settings. During the exploration phase the participant
data was collected through one to one interviews (see Appendix 4.1 for a list of
interview questions) to respond to the second research question:
What RTP factors were identified through initial teacher interviews?
Responses were collected individually and compared across case studies. The
practical examples given through the six cases provided details of the factors that
enabled or inhibited the implementation and sustainment of the research-based
projects in each school setting.
210
Responses from individual participants were collected through the first round of
interviews. These responses were compared to the list of 16 succinct RTP factor
statements which summarised the literature based assertions and knowledge.
Although participants were not influenced by the introduction of literature during the
first round of interviews, most of the asserted RTP factors were identified by
participants prior to any RTP literature being introduced.
The following section identifies the similarities and difference in participant
responses across the six cases. The responses articulated by participants identified
two major themes; support and teacher education (described in the literature review).
Closer investigation of these responses identified connections with 15 out of the 16
succinct research to practice statements that were identified as a result of the review
of the literature (see summary of the literature review). Participant responses are
presented using the two broad themes of support and teacher education as articulated
by participants. The responses are further categorized using the 16 RTP factor
statements as a frame of reference, within these two themes. Responses are presented
under the RTP statements in the order in which they were prioritized by participants.
The RTP factor not identified by participants during this exploration phase is also
presented. This section concludes with a comparison of the number of factors
identified by participants and the integrity with which the project was implemented.
4.7. Participant responses to the first round of interviews
Practical examples that support the impact of RTP factors can be linked to more than
one RTP statement, however the examples are presented with the RTP statement
they best align with.
211
4.7.1. Support
Support factors were presented first as they were identified as the major contributor
to the successful implementation and status of projects by all participants prior to the
introduction of the literature. Support factors were identified through 12 of the 16
RTP factor statements that were derived from the literature. This section presents
specific RTP statements, followed by practical examples of elements of these
statements described by participants during the initial data collection phase (the
exploration phase).
1.1.1.25. 4.7.1.1. Shared responsibility and
accountability
Sufficient and ongoing instructional time, preparation and resourcing are
contributors to the effective use and promotion of Research based practices (Ax, et
al., 2008; Everington & Hamill, 1996; Foorman & Moats, 2004; Golder, et al., 2005;
Gravani, 2008; Villa & Thousand, 1996c)
Research to practice is influenced by the extent to which educators can be involved
with research projects. Such involvement can result in partnerships that share
responsibility and ownership and build a sense of credibility among stakeholders in
the results of research and the research process (RTP factor statement 1)
All participants described elements of RTP factors statements 1 and 11. The need for
sufficient and ongoing time to prepare, instruct and make resources required to
implement and sustain projects was consistent across all cases. Partnerships that
share responsibility and ownership of project commitments with the support of
colleagues and school leaders were also prioritised by all participants.
212
They (staff, students and school leaders) were very keen. Staff support was
good as was ownership, they were very keen and they all wanted to get on
board and have a go (Wilma, 2009, p.2).
They all endorsed it (Diane, 2009, p.4).
You need to have ownership; people really have to own it. Resourcing was
really important and the staff need to feel supported so they knew they did
not have to do it all on their own (Chris, 2009, p.4).
Peer support and being part of a team had a significant impact (Sam, 2009,
p.3).
1.1.1.26. 4.7.1.2. Resources
Well developed student materials, teacher manuals and training within realistic time
frames promote the effective adoption of research based projects (RTP factor
statement 6)
All participants reported that adequate staffing and materials reduced the demands
on individual stakeholders and assisted in uniting school based staff in supporting
the projects and each other. This was identified as being essential to the
implementation and sustainment of all individual projects. The following quotes
provide practical examples of how a united approach can assist the sustainment of
projects;
We made sure that the booklets were all prepared for everyone when they
were needed. There was goodwill towards it, everyone just helped when it
was needed and got on with it (Mary, 2009, p.5).
213
People were united in owning the decision to implement DIBELS, as this was
a way of addressing the schools needs and it served our purpose! We were
able to see the gains that the students were making and that the teachers had
something tangible to go back to that was consistent and standardised was
great (Chris, 2009, p.1).
1.1.1.27. 4.7.1.3. Consistent and long term support
For research based projects to be successful, they need consistent, long term support
that addresses teacher enthusiasm, personal qualities, fatigue and changing needs is
required (RTP statement 5)
Limiting the competing demands placed on practitioners is required if research based
practices are to be implemented and sustained (RTP statement 10)
An understanding by all stakeholders that the implementation and sustainment of
research based practices is an ongoing process not an event enhances their continued
use (RTP statement 16)
All participants presented a need for consistency in enthusiasm, preparation time,
and student and teacher resources (RTP factor statement 5). It was also identified
that long-term support is required for programs to be sustained and scaled within
schools (RTP factor 16). The projects that were scaled and those that were extinct
presented different examples of the inclusion and withdrawal of these supports
through their direct RTP experience. Examples of support ranged from the need for
adequate staffing to self determination and web support. The following examples
present a range of support factors identified by participants:
214
It was the time, it was difficult to work with time constraints. I don’t know
how I would the time for the project if I had been full time then. I was
working three days a week, so I was going in on my two days off to make up
for things for the kids, laminating etc. (Meg, 2009, p.4).
Support had to be consistent; it couldn’t stop after the project was up and
running otherwise it would be bound to fail. You still needed time to ensure
you could answer questions and coordinate materials etc. (Sam, 2009, p.3).
You know there is a fabulous web site that goes with it (DIBELS) so if
people are interested they can go and do their own investigation (Mary, 2009,
p.3).
1.1.1.28. 4.7.1.4. Shared ownership and responsibility
Research projects are enhanced when communication and feedback from many
stakeholders (from all levels) is ongoing and substantive (emergent function) (RTP
statement 4)
Research projects that have shown or considered ways to address scalability have a
greater likelihood of bridging the research to practice gap and exerting whole school
influence or effect (RTP statement 3)
All participants identified the need for shared accountability and a positive attitude
from stakeholders if projects are to be sustained in classroom applications. Three
participants highlighted that shared ownership and responsibility can be enhanced if
research based projects falling within the schools focus:
215
By having the whole school focused on reading and literacy last year
certainly helped the project. Everyone had to know about it and be able to
talk about it and act on it (Mary, 2009, p.5).
Once it became part of the whole school assessment plan it sought of meant
everybody had to take ownership and it was mandatory, they didn’t have a
choice (Wilma, 2009, p.4).
....suggested that this needs to become part of school policy. When it did
become part of the school policy it was a given, a non negotiable, everyone
owned it, it was part of the long term school plan (Sue, 2009, p.4).
1.1.1.29. 4.7.1.5. Shared goals
Research into practice works most effectively in systems and schools that have clear
goals promoting the use of research. When these goals are shared and research
projects respond to genuine questions, problems and solutions the RTP gap can be
reduced (RTP statement 2)
All participants presented that support was most effective when all stakeholders
shared the goals of the project. This united approach identified in Mary, Wilma and
Sue’s quotes about the projects becoming part of the school policy, presented the
impact of staff members being required to implement and sustain the projects. Mary
identified that when staff were part of the decision to make the project part of the
school policy stakeholders shared the goals and they were more supportive of the
common goals. Meg presented another perspective of the importance of support and
shared ownership, through an account of what happened when it did not exist:
216
I did a staff development day and part of that day was me presenting the Peer
Assisted Learning which is what I had done for teachers the previous year, I
could tell straight away that some said “I don’t want to do this. This is not
really going to work!” I knew that some of the teachers will want to do it and
some of them won’t want to. Also I did no t have the time to go into the
classroom and check how it is being done, I went in and demonstrated as
much as I could with the time limit I had. It was so hard working with them
and you could tell they were not going to do it (Meg, 2009, p.3).
1.1.1.30. 4.7.1.6. Technology
Technology has many functions that can help make RTP more efficient. When it is
accessible and used by stakeholders it can enhance the implementation, sustainment
and expansion of research based projects (RTP statement 8).
Mary supported the need for projects to become a whole school focus and she added
that her project itself was a support when it became part of the whole school plan as
it was user friendly and directly addressed the needs of her students. Mary was the
only participant who presented the advantages of stakeholders being able to access
website support to enhance the use of projects, during the exploration phase.
I think it was user friendly, it was simple there was no real long process that
you had to go through to up skill staff to use it, they could always refer back
to the web. Another thing is that we, as a whole staff decided that our focus
for the year was going to be reading and literacy.....I really can say
comfortably now that in our school there wouldn’t be a child that slipped
under the radar and that has not been picked up, even a kid in the “some risk”
category (Mary, 2009, p.6).
217
1.1.1.31. 4.7.1.7. Leadership
An awareness of changing stakeholder and setting circumstances is required to
ensure research based practices are be responsive to individual and setting needs
(RTP factor statement 15)
The use of validated research based projects is enhanced if their outcomes are
viewed as credible by stakeholders, elicit positive student attitude and address
genuine teacher and student concerns and needs (RTP factor statement 9)
All six participants affirmed the significance that the principal and leadership team
had on the implementation and sustainment of research based projects in schools.
Four of the six participants commented on the impact of a change in leadership
whilst their projects were being implemented. In three of these four cases the new
leaders supported the projects and they continued to be sustained. Mary, Meg and
Diane shared examples of the positive impact of support from the school leaders.
Mary’s experience highlighted the importance of consistency in the support from the
leadership, even when there is a change of personnel. Diane provided an example of
the benefits of the support principal and executive as she struggled with the lack of
instructional reading materials for secondary students:
It is the same personnel that were there as well, that does help, even though we had a
change of principal, but the new principal is supportive and is keen. So from that
point of view it can work! I think having the new principal on board could have
been different if he had said no, I don’t agree with that, it might just be all over. It
might just depend a lot on leadership support. You know, I think that might be
probably one of the main factors as to why it is still there (Mary, 2009, p.6).
218
They (principal and executive) all endorsed it. I think the research helped make a
bigger improvement; it increased the level of improvement. Now I have got to say
there wasn’t a hell of a lot of research on it. It was very difficult to find anything in a
secondary setting on the reading program and so what there was, I took what they
said and used those strategies and my principal and staff supported it (Diane, 2009,
p.4).
Meg’s case identified that even when stakeholders have concerns about asking the
principal for support, if they are approachable and share the project goals they can
have a positive impact and promote the use of the project:
“In his favour, the Principal was on board right from the word go. I was a bit
nervous about asking but he was brilliant. Another Principal may not have
been so happy” (Meg, 2009, p.4).
Wilma provided another example of the impact of a supportive and enthusiastic
principal. She also commented on the variance in support levels of individual
teachers. Wilma shared her experience of the strength of the support of the
leadership over staff support by stating that once the project became part of the
whole school assessment plan it became a permanent, non negotiable feature of the
school:
Because the Principal was so supportive he was very keen for it to become a
part of our whole school assessment plan. Once it was adopted that meant
we assessed the kids at the beginning, the middle and at the end of the year.
Once it became part of the whole school assessment plan it sort of meant
everybody had to take ownership and it was mandatory, they didn’t have a
choice (Wilma, 2009, p.3).
219
The support of the school leaders was a factor that was described as being critical to
the implementation and sustainment of research-based projects across all cases. The
above examples identified how the support of the leadership team positively
contributed to the implementation and sustainment of projects. The following
example described how a change in leadership and their lack of support negatively
contributed to the status of my research based project. The following account
confirmed the importance of the support of the leadership team through the negative
impact of the withdrawal of support by the new principal and deputy. This example
describes the result of the lack of ownership and commitment by leaders can have on
a project. This lack of support from school leaders ultimately led to the projects
extinction:
We had new staff come on board and we happened to lose a principal and a
deputy at the same time. I don’t think the ownership was there or the
commitment was there. They were not there through the school review when
the needs were identified. I think they had a different agenda and I think this
particular project did not fall into their agenda. I think that was probably one
of the strongest factors towards the projects extinction (Chris, 2009, p.4).
4.8. Teacher Education
All six participants suggested that teacher education efforts should directly respond
to teacher need through an approach that is clear and consistent. All participants
shared thoughts on the usefulness of the Master’s Course and its contribution to the
sustainment of all projects. Participants described the usefulness of the course in a
number of ways. Comments about the depth of understanding of what constitutes
research based projects were shared. All participants suggested that the consistency
220
in the structure and design of the course had assisted in their ability to comprehend
new knowledge and to be able to share this knowledge with their staff. Participants
reported that presentations to school staff were modelled on the information gained
and the structure demonstrated through the course. The resonating consistent notion
shared by participants was that the course was effective as the aims of the university
were the same as the school aims, so what was learnt through the course could be
shared with staff.
Teacher education factors were identified through 3 of the 16 RTP factor statements
that were derived from the literature. This section presents specific RTP statements
with examples of ways they were described by participants during the initial data
collection phase (the exploration phase). The following section present direct
examples of the way participants articulated the impact of the Master’s course on
their individual cases.
4.8.1. Depth of knowledge
Teacher education has the capacity to promote the use of research based practices
when subjects or courses in a preparation program are intentionally linked,
reinforcing key ideas and enabling students to build both a big and small picture
understanding such practices. When such courses directly respond to teacher needs
through a clear and consistent approach the bridge between research and practice can
be further reduced efforts (RTP factor statement 13)
Meg stated that the Masters course provided a depth of knowledge gained which she
tried to share at her implementation setting:
We really had to go into depth with it. I had to know Peer Assisted Learning
inside out. I knew where it worked, how many studies had been done, why it
221
worked, so I had all that research to back up what I was saying to teachers. I
presented all that to them, I suppose because I had done it in depth, nothing
was on the surface it was so thorough.
I know I was trying to give them (staff members) the knowledge that I had
gained from my course. For example that when I did my power point
presentation, we had done a power point presentation in a previous
assignment on Collaboration so I presented my Peer Assisted Learning power
point, it was like I was doing an assignment in an assignment I tried to be as
thorough as I could, so all the previous work that I learned I tried to put it
into the project (Meg, 2009, p.2).
Mary described how the Masters course had a strong impact on her research based
project. She identified that topics, such as assessment were covered in depth and how
she was able to share research knowledge gained from the course with her staff:
Well, as a result of the Master’s course I came up with this project. It was a
result of doing an assessment evaluation unit that really brought it together
for me. Because I never heard of the DIBELS actually she (lecturer) really,
really made us think about what assessment was. Why are we assessing?
Was it assessment just for the sake of assessment? Or are you teaching
towards the test or was it an assessment to guide your teaching?
The value of that questioning was important, so I think that is why I chose to
work with the younger kids in infants as well as I felt they needed help and I
could reach them and identify a larger number using this. It was intensive,
but you did not have to sit down for an hour per kid to do the assessment and
stuff like that. Who has the time to do that?
222
We were presented with a lot of the research across different subjects. That
was brought back to my staff when we were doing this project and devising
it. You know, learning about collaboration, working as a team, what was
going to be good for the whole school and a lot of the stuff I had learned
through my university course, I was able to use when we were devising that
program and implementing it in the school (Mary, 2009, p.3).
4.8.2. Structure of the course
Research based projects that have a complete implementation strategy through being
comprehensive, accessible and practical will be more successful. When these
features are woven into the projects design the engagement of all parts of the project
can have a reinforcing effect that can further enhance its success (RTP factor
statement 12)
Sam also commented on the structure of the course and described how the Masters
course assisted her in being able to cater for the needs of the staff and students at her
implementation setting:
I really think that the way our course was structured was to build up our
capacity. I guess I modelled my instruction on the way the course was
structured so we had done all those things on collaboration, in-service stuff,
we had to do the power points and the pre and post tests. I guess I tried to
model what I did on what we had done on the course as the aim was the
same. Anything that we had done in that course was building towards the
project. Anything that we had to do, that was important, we had to try and
put that in (Sam, 2009, p.2).
223
My comments about the Masters course also identified that it had a strong impact on
the implementation of my research-based project. Consistency, collaboration and
feedback that were positive features of the course were transferred to my
implementation setting:
I think the consistency in the Masters course across all subjects, was
replicated in our setting because everybody knew what they were going to
expect. I think the collaborative approach through the Uni masters project,
the feedback; the consistency was replicated in my setting (Chris, 2009, p.3).
The consistency in comments on the Master’s course confirmed the positive impact
it had on the implementation and sustainment of individual projects. Sam
summarized the strong impact of the Masters course well as she compared course
and school aims. Sam stated “like the course, the school must support teachers by
addressing their needs and capacity. The course aims are the same as our school
aims” (Sam, 2009, p.4).
4.8.3. Collaboration and sufficient preparation
Research based projects can be enhanced when teachers and researchers work
together to develop links between theory (researchers perspective) and practice
(classroom teachers perspective). This can contribute to teachers feeling sufficiently
prepared which creates an avenue for research based practices to be effectively used
in classroom (RTP factor statement 14).
Diane introduced the sense of inclusion as the major take away from the Masters
course. She referred to her interpretation of course components that were
meaningful. Diane commented on the adaptation of features of the course to suit the
needs of her secondary setting. She also referred to her moving from one secondary
224
setting to another and identified the positive impact collaboration had on the status of
her project:
The whole sense of inclusion was the driving force of the whole masters. I
was trying to get these kids included in every aspect of their education. The
other thing that specifically clicked with me was the little bit about DIBELS
and the reading, while I didn’t take that on as strictly as it was, because it was
really for infants and primary. I took parts of that and put it into a secondary
setting, that whole aspect about reading fluency. It was the CBM that drove it
and every time a student didn’t improve we intervened more. There was also
that book, I can’t think of the name of it, the book it’s in my study
(Interviewer intervenes and states Self Organising Schools after a long
pause). Yep that’s right! There were things in there that I reflected on
especially because I was going between the two schools, trying to make my
thing happen elsewhere. In my job in the secondary setting, it is all about
collaboration, if I didn’t collaborate with everyone it still wouldn’t be
running as it is now in my new school (Diane, 2009, p.2).
Wilma’s expanded on these school and course links when she described how her
staff had identified the strong research knowledge base she had acquired through the
course. She also made reference to the parent support raised as a result of having
their children involved in the research based project and how the experience
contributed to promoting the link between home and school:
I think one fact of it (the course) was that I had a pretty strong knowledge
base in the topic I was doing because I had done a lot of the background work
in the course and people recognised that. It wasn’t just that I was trying to
225
introduce this tool that I thought was really good. They understood that it
was research based, I had studied it, I had implemented it and it was a
positive move. I think that was the most important thing. I also think that for
parents it (the research based project) was particularly positive. I got letters
back from parents saying what a great thing it was and that they were very
proud for their children to be part of a research project and they actually
asked for ways that they could work on their children’s reading fluency at
home, so that was a way for us bridging the school from home gap (Wilma,
2009, p.3).
4.9. RTP factors not identified in the literature
4.9.1. Role of the student and the parents
Wilma described the enthusiasm of the children and the parents at her setting. She
described ways they interacted and engaged with the project and identified a
competitive element which encouraged some students. This factor was not identified
in the RTP Literature:
The kids were really tapped into it. I mean the ones on the project. We did
self assessment with them so they were graphing their own results everyday
taking it home at the end of the week. That was great they loved that
competitive edge to it, they could see in black and white if they were
improving or not.
Parents were able to see those results too because all the teachers were
showing the DIBELS booklets at parent teacher interviews. They had the
school reports and the booklets and quite a few parents said “that is really
great!” Now I can now see what you are looking for and how I need to
226
improve. They could see if they were making a lot of errors or if they were
decoding very well but were just really slow they just needed practice.
The parents were comfortable with it. If they had a child in Year 2 and
another in Year 6 it was all the same format. It is easy for a non educational
person to very quickly understand what the point of it is. It is not like another
test, like trying to explain a NEALE or something like that, it takes a lot more
input but the DIBELS you can explain very quickly.... this is what we do, this
is the information we gain from it and this is what we need to improve if the
score isn’t what we would like (Wilma, 2009, p.4).
Another factor that was not introduced through other cases was will power and
determination. Diane was the only participant who attributed the success of her
project implementation to her determination. Diane stated that because she was
doing the course and doing the professional readings, she was the driver of the
project. She indicated that she influenced her peers and she owned the project:
I was adamant I was going to succeed. I think I drove it! I also think that I
had the principal and the school executive behind me. I was my own driver. I
took other teachers with me. I kept on about it and the teachers are still doing
it (Diane, 2009, p.2).
4.10. RTP factor not identified by participants
Acknowledgement, recognition and reward for the use of research based practices
will enhance their use (RTP factor statement 7)
227
The only RTP factor statement that was not raised by any participant during the
exploration phase of this study was that acknowledgement; recognition and reward
for the use of research-based practices would enhance their use.
4.11. Integrity of implementation
Sam provided a unique perspective on the importance of integrity of the
implementation of her project during this exploration phase. She stated that as she
knew and had built a rapport with her cohort, she believed that the project
implementation was easier. She linked the importance of collaboration, flexibility, a
research base, implementation integrity, principal and leadership support within her
project (15 of the 16 RTP factor statements). Sam identified that the contributors to
her projects success also included the status allocated to projects and implementation
of projects as part of the school policy:
I think collaboration the fact that is was collaborative and I also think that is
was research driven, the whole review really helped refrain what I wanted to
do, I think that made a difference to. Another thing to is, that when I did it,
the uni teachers really insured that we did implement with integrity. You had
to monitor that implementation integrity, you couldn’t just start the course
and waffle back at the end and make sure. It was that the whole way through
you had to be monitoring how it was going, if it was a bit obscured you had
to fix it up. That was not only with implementation with the teachers but
monitoring it with the children because it was explicit teaching there was that
whole notion of testing, if this child has not quite got there you retest then
you reteach. You also needed flexibility in approach... in your monitoring
and you had to be flexible in your design. The other thing really is support
228
from your principal and the Exec that really makes a big difference, just in
terms of time and resources and giving it status. That is where it surprised me
that it did continue. I really did not expect it would be so ongoing. I think
that is because the co-ordinator at that stage was also the coordinator of
learning support she saw what happened and she took it back to the Exec and
stated that this needs to become part of school policy (Sam, 2009, p.2).
4.11.1. Comparison of the RTP factors identified by individual
participants and the integrity of the implementation of their
projects.
Sam and Wilma’s responses to the data collection tools during the exploration phase
of this study identified 15 out of the 16 RTP factor statements. When compared to
the depth of information they presented on the integrity of implementation, there was
a correlation between the strength of their implementation and the number of factors
identified. Mary and I identified 13 out of the 16 RTP factor statements. We also
both used project guidelines consistently and monitored the teacher’s use of those
guidelines. Diane identified eight and Meg identified 6 out of the 16 RTP factor
statements. Diane modified her project implementation to cater for the needs of a
secondary setting and Meg reported that some teachers were not interested in
implementing the project according to the set guidelines provided. Those participants
that reported the strongest integrity of implementation details within their cases are
the same participants that identified the greater number of RTP statements prior to
the literature based knowledge being introduced to them.
229
4.11.2. Summary of the Exploration Phase
All participants articulated the need for various forms of support and the positive
impact of the Masters Course. Additional investigation identified that participants
presented elements from 15 out of the 16 succinct RTP statements asserted through
commentary pieces and related intervention research. These RTP factors were
identified by participants through the direct implementation of their projects prior to
these literature based factors being introduced to them. The need for teachers to be
able to use projects to address the needs of their students was also identified as a
high priority across all cases. Wilma and Sam both stated that their projects became
part of their whole school policy. This resulted in an increase in status being given to
their project which contributed to them becoming an integral part of the school life.
Mary was the only participant who mentioned accessible technology through her
comments about web support during this initial exploration stage. Wilma expanded
on the RTP literature and identified the positive impact gained through the parental
support experienced at her setting. Diane also expanded on the literature through her
reference to self determination. Sam raised the importance of implementing research
projects with integrity. Wilma identified how research based projects can support
home and school links and Meg raised her concerns regarding the strong impact of
competing demands. I presented the importance of the support of leadership as I
attributed the lack of leadership support to the extinction of my project. Meg
suggested time constraints and competing demands were the factors which led to the
extinction of her project.
Other RTP factors raised by participants that elaborated on literature based assertions
were identified through this exploration phase. These factors included the benefits of
230
parental support in promoting the use of research-based practices and the advantages
of projects becoming school policy. All participants expanded on the literature
through identifying the benefits of replicating the consistency in knowledge and
structures learnt through the postgraduate course, with staff at their setting. Reward,
acknowledgment and recognition for the implementation of research-based projects
was the only RTP factor that was not identified through the exploration phase. In
brief, Sam and Wilma’s responses to the first round of interviews identified 15 out of
the 16 RTP factor statements, Chris and Mary identified 13, Diane identified eight
and Meg identified six RTP factors.
The following explanation phase goes further in identifying the specific details of
how those RTP factors contributed to the implementation and status of the projects.
231
Chapter 5. Explanation Phase Results
EXPLANATION PHASE RESULTS
The explanation phase is the second of three phases of this study. It presents a deeper
comprehension of those RTP factors identified by research participants that
influenced the implementation and subsequent status of their research projects. The
explanation phase builds on the previous phase by extending the depth of the study
to identify how RTP factors exerted an influence in each of the cases.
The explanation phase is informed by individual participant responses to Part 2 of
the survey and semi structured interviews (see Methods Chapter for detailed
descriptions of these tools). The master’s projects, which are accounts of projects
written by individual participants, were also consulted as a data source through this
phase. The comparison of the data collected through these three methods (responses
to the survey items, the written projects and responses to interview questions)
provides a detailed insight to how RTP factors impacted the projects and their status
over the three-year period (2006-2009). These responses are then compared to the
RTP factors identified in the literature. Collectively this information explains how
the RTP factors identified by individual participants had an impact on the status of
the six research to practice cases.
The explanation phase is divided into three sections. The first section presents a brief
review of the data collection tools used during this phase. The second section
presents a summary of the participant responses to the data collection tools, through
the use of the 16 RTP statements as a framework. The third section compares the
responses of participants between the exploration and explanation phases of the
232
study and additional RTP factors that were not identified through the literature are
also presented.
In brief, participant responses were collected individually and then compared and
contrasted across cases to respond to the following research questions:
How do identified RTP factors influence and contribute to the status of research-
based projects in inclusive education settings? In what ways do those factors exert an
influence?
5.1. Review of data collection tools
The survey and interview questions employed in this explanation section were
derived from the RTP factors identified through the investigation of the literature
(see literature review for RTP factors). As described in the methods chapter,
participant responses collected through the previous exploration phase were used to
inform the construction of the data collection methods used during this explanation
phase. Questions were designed to encourage participants to provide a
comprehensive and relevant explanation of how and why specific RTP factors
contributed to the status of their project.
The use of the same questions and data collection tools and techniques made cross-
case comparison possible. The purpose of employing this technique was to increase
consistency and produce more specific response to build a deeper understanding of
the impact of specific RTP factors.
5.2. Part 2 of the survey.
Part 1 of the survey identified details of individual participants and their setting (see
Exploration phase). Part 2 of the survey comprised 75 items across three categories:
233
collaboration, support and, responsiveness of research. These areas represented the
key themes asserted in the RTP literature as being significant to research to practice
efforts. Participants were asked to rate whether each of the 75 factors were: blank
[B], never [N], rarely [R], sometimes [S], mostly [M], or always [A] present during
the implementation and sustainment of their projects in 2006, 2007 and 2008.
Collaboration factors represented 23 items and included factors such as mutual
respect and shared ownership among stakeholders, and ongoing and substantive
communication and feedback.
Support factors were represented by 27 of the items and included examples
pertaining to the impact of clear school goals that promote the use of research.
Support items also sought to determine if research based projects responded to
genuine questions, problems and solutions. Questions pertaining to the use of student
materials, teacher manuals and training were included to gain details on what is
required for the effective adoption of research based projects in school settings.
Items linked to teacher preparation sought to establish if the participant teacher
education experience had an impact on the use and scalability of research based
projects. Teacher education items also sought to identify if the intentional linking of
subjects in the preparation program reinforced key ideas through a clear and
consistent approach.
The comprehensiveness, accessibility and practicality of research were grouped in a
section titled the responsiveness of research. This responsiveness of research section
of the survey consisted of 25 items. Data generated from these items sought to
establish those factors that enhanced the usability, flexibility and accessibility of
projects. The projects potential to be scaled and whether it could address the needs of
234
the whole school are examples of items within the responsiveness of research
section.
Participant responses to the survey items were collected in 2009 and were based
upon their retrospective perceptions of experiences from 2006 to 2008 inclusive (See
appendix for complete list of factors and individual participant responses).
Responses were collected at annual intervals over the three years (2006, 2007 and
2008) to identify the consistencies or changes in specific RTP factors. Table 4.?
presented the RTP factors that corresponded to the questions in Part 2 of the survey
and an overview of participants responses to the survey are following and are
presented in Table 5.1.
5.3. Semi structured interviews
Semi structured interview questions were informed by the data collected in the
exploration phase. Participant responses to the survey items and the initial open-
ended interviews were compared and analysed. These responses were then compared
with the RTP literature. This information was used to determine the content of the
semi-structured interview questions with the purpose of making them responsive and
relevant. Examples of semi-structured interview questions included: How did
features/elements of the university course have an impact on your knowledge and
skill level in promoting the use of research-based projects? Can you describe the
leadership style of your principal? A full list of interview questions is located in
Appendix 5.
The data collection methods including the survey and interviews were planned, yet it
was intended that flexibility in the design of interview questions be maintained
(Ezzy, 2002). This staged process developing the questions aimed to generate
235
detailed responses as one data source was used to inform the next, in an attempt to
make questions more specific and responsive. This developmental process intended
that decisions regarding interview questions be made in a more fundamental way
than if analysis was left until after all data collection was completed (Ezzy, 2002).
This approach to designing the interview questions intended to elicit meaningful
explanations on how and why specific RTP details were significant to the projects of
individual participants. Participant responses to the RTP details were collated and
compared to the 16 RTP literature factor statements to identify the similarities and
differences in literature assertions and RTP factors identified through the
implementation of research based projects.
5.4. Explanation phase participant responses
This section presents participant responses and is divided into three parts. The first
part presents a tabulated summary of individual participant responses to Part 2 of the
survey. The second part presents a narrative explanation of those RTP factors
identified by participants that were collected through both the survey and semi-
structured interviews. This section concludes with the presentation of additional RTP
factors not identified in the previous phase.
5.5. Summary of the responses to Part 2 of the survey
Table 5.1 presents a summary of participant responses to Part 2 of the survey. These
questions in the survey were derived from factors that were extrapolated from the
RTP literature (See literature review). The factors are presented within three themes
(collaboration, support, responsiveness of research). This section of the survey
introduced the RTP factors to participants. Participants rated each RTP factor at
annual intervals, in retrospect for three years (2006-2009). This collection of data
236
presents differences and consistencies in participant ratings for the three key themes
over the duration of the project.
237
Table 5.1
Responses to RTP themes 2006-2009
Frequency of Response
2006 2007 2008
B N R S M A B N R S M A B N R S M A
Chris Collaboration 0 0 0 0 12 11 3 0 0 0 11 9 3 1 5 11 3 0
Support 0 0 0 0 5 22 0 0 0 0 7 20 0 5 4 15 2 1
Responsiveness 0 0 0 0 1 24 0 0 0 0 1 24 0 1 5 14 1 4
Mary Collaboration 23 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 10 7 5 1 0 1 1 14 6
Support 27 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 0 3 8 14 0 1 0 3 7 16
Responsiveness 25 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 9 16 0 0 0 1 8 16
Diane Collaboration 0 0 0 3 11 9 0 0 0 3 11 9 0 0 0 3 11 9
Support 0 0 5 2 11 9 0 0 3 2 13 9 0 0 3 2 13 9
Responsiveness 0 0 0 1 13 11 0 0 0 1 13 11 0 0 0 0 14 11
Wilma Collaboration 0 0 0 0 8 15 1 0 0 0 7 15 1 0 0 0 9 13
238
Support 0 0 0 1 6 20 0 0 0 1 6 20 0 0 0 2 12 13
Responsiveness 0 0 0 0 4 21 0 0 0 0 6 19 0 0 0 0 11 14
Sam Collaboration 1 0 2 4 8 8 0 0 0 0 8 15 3 0 1 7 7 5
Support 22 0 2 1 0 2 0 0 1 3 2 21 1 0 0 6 4 16
Responsiveness 23 0 0 0 0 2 0 0 0 0 9 16 0 0 0 2 7 16
Meg Collaboration 2 0 0 0 0 21 2 0 0 0 0 21 2 0 3 13 4 1
Support 0 2 0 0 0 25 0 1 0 0 0 26 0 6 2 9 0 10
Responsiveness 0 0 0 0 0 25 0 0 0 0 0 25 0 19 0 5 1 0
B=No response, N=Never, R=Rarely, S=Sometimes, M=Mostly, A=Always
239
Mary and Wilma were at the same setting and both commenced their projects at the
start of 2007. Although Wilma did not implement her project during 2006, she
responded to the survey items for 2006 as her project was developed during that
year. The following section will present an overview of the rankings of factors
identified by participants within the three identified themes.
5.6. Support
My rankings of all support factors were very strong during the first two years of the
project. These ranks reduced significantly in 2008 as the project moved from full to
partial implementation. My responses to the five items that changed most
significantly across the duration of the project were those that related to leadership,
time and continuity of support. These items fell from always in 2006 to never in
2008.
Mary’s rankings of all support factors were consistent and slightly increased as the
project was sustained and scaled within her school. She allocated her highest
rankings to items indicating that her project had adequate materials and ongoing peer
and leadership support. Mary strongly identified the need for adequate time to be
allocated to stakeholders for project instruction, implementation, maintenance and
feedback. The only item that significantly increased in rank from never in 2007 to
always in 2008 pertained to the level of communication from staff. This was
consistent with the increase in status of her project.
Diane’s rankings of all support factors remained consistent from 2006-2008. She
allocated her lowest rankings to the area of support in survey. Diane responded with
rarely to three support items in 2007 and 2008. These items included; the
stakeholders’ active involvement in the program, the awareness of the project leaders
240
on the demands of the project on stakeholders and the level of instructional support
available. Diane strongly agreed with items that presented the need for ongoing
leadership and technology support. Diane also promoted the need for regular
meetings and feedback opportunities to be woven into the design of the project.
Diane’s support for the factors did not alter as her project was sustained and scaled
within and beyond her setting.
Wilma’s ranking of support factors was strongest during the implementation and
sustainment of her project. During 2008 as the project scaled up within her setting,
Wilma reduced her ranking of always on seven items to mostly. Her reduction in the
ranking of support items related to instructional time and understanding provided by
leaders, the need for evaluation as an emergent function and evidence of school
based support for the project. Wilma strongly supported the need for stakeholders to
experience the benefits of the project and that the positive responses displayed from
project stakeholders can contribute to their sustained use. The need for well-
developed resources and student materials with opportunities for communication and
feedback continued to be strongly supported from 2006 to 2008 inclusive as her
project was scaled.
Sam’s rankings of support factors reduced slightly as her project was scaled. Sam
allocated consistently high rankings to items indicating a need for ongoing
leadership support and communication opportunities. She also presented the need for
well-developed student materials and positive peer responses. As the project scaled
in 2008, Sam reduced her ranking on items related to the need for feedback being
woven into the design of the project rather than being added on at the end (emergent
feedback). Sam assigned her lowest rank of rarely to the item that sought to establish
241
whether regular meetings were held for stakeholders to share their experiences. Sam
increased her ranking on this item to sometimes during 2008 as her project was
scaled within and beyond her setting. When asked to expand upon these results, Sam
stated that initially she worked with a small group of people and was allocated
additional time to work on the project. She further explained that as the project
success grew in terms of student gains and stakeholder commitment, an increase in
the number of meetings was required.
Meg ranked 25 out of 27 support items with always (highest rank) and she ranked
the two remaining items with never (lowest rank) during the implementation and
sustainment years (2006-2007). The two items that were allocated the rank of never
included the use of technology as a support and the identification of emergent
feedback. During 2007, Meg increased the rank of never to always on the emergent
feedback item. The higher ranks presented by Meg during 2006 and 2007 reduced
significantly by 2008 as her project became partially sustained. Meg demonstrated
consistently high rankings on items indicating a need for ongoing leadership support,
teacher preparation and communication from staff on multiple levels. Meg increased
her lowest rank of never to the item that sought to establish if technology was used
as a support to always in the projects final year (2008), prior to its extinction.
5.7. Cross case comparison of support factors
Meg and I allocated the highest rankings of the support factors of the six participants
in 2006 and 2007. Our rankings significantly reduced to become the lowest scores
allocated to the support factors for 2008, prior to our projects becoming extinct by
2009. Mary and Diane’s ranking of support factors remained consistent as their
projects continued to be scaled within and beyond their setting. Wilma and Sam’s
242
ranking of the support factors were strong as their projects were implemented and
scaled within their setting. These rankings reduced slightly as Wilma and Sam’s
projects were scaled beyond their setting.
5.8. Collaboration
My rankings of all collaboration factors were consistent over the first two years of
the project. The factors I ranked as a priority in the collaboration section of the
survey included the need for united efforts that are understood by all and the
importance of developing links between theory and practice. The importance of
aligning the understanding of course structures, goals and expectation between
university staff and students (being the research participants) was also introduced as
a key factor during this phase (referred to as mutual alignment). There was a
reduction in my rankings of collaboration factors as the project moved from full to
partial implementation. My response to the item that asked whether stakeholders
were united reduced from always in 2006-2007, to never in 2008 as the project
became extinct.
Mary’s rankings of collaboration factors increased on most items in 2007-2008. Her
only significant reduction in rating was for the item asking if there was an awareness
of changing stakeholder needs. Mary’s ranking of all other collaboration factors
remained consistent or increased as the project moved through the implementation,
sustained to scaled within and beyond her school setting.
Diane’s rankings of the collaboration factors did not change over from 2006-2008.
She prioritized the need for united efforts and consistent feedback and the
importance of aligning the same understanding of course structures, goals and
expectation between university staff and students (being the research participants).
243
Diane’s rankings of collaboration factor remained consistent as the project moved
from the implementation to scale within and beyond setting stages.
Wilma’s ranking of collaboration factors remained consistent other than a slight
reduction in two factors from 2006-2008. These factors pertained whether
stakeholders had joint ownership of the project and whether the project created links
between theory and practice. Her rank reduced from always in 2006, to mostly in
2008 as the project became scaled within and beyond her setting. Wilma also
identified the importance of aligning the same understanding of course structures,
goals and expectation between university staff and students. United efforts that are
understood by all was also introduced as a key factor as Wilma’s project was scaled.
Sam ranked the collaboration items for 2006, in Part 2 of the survey although her
project did not commence until the following year. Her rankings for 2007 increased
and reduced for 2008. Factors that were prioritized included the need for strong and
united partnerships amongst stakeholders from various levels of responsibility. Sam
also supported the need for opportunities for feedback for stakeholders across these
levels of responsibility. The importance of aligning the same understanding of course
structures, goals and expectation between university staff and students received
Sam’s highest rating during the project planning, implementation and sustainment
stages. Sam did not respond to the mutual alignment factor for 2008 after rating it
with always for the 2006-2007 implementation and sustainment phases. Sam’s
support for the item identifying the need for individual stakeholder strength to
enhance the project, reduced from always in 2007 to sometimes in 2008 as her
project was scaled within and beyond her setting.
244
Meg’s ranking of collaboration factors remained constant in 2006-2007 and reduced
significantly in 2008. The factors Meg ranked as a priority included the need for
well-aligned project and school goals and the awareness of changing stakeholder
needs. Meg did not respond to two collaboration items in Part 2 of the survey. These
items included the need for shared ownership and the importance of aligning the
same understanding of course structures and roles between university academic staff
and students. Meg accounted for this by stating that she prepared the resources for
the project individually. Meg’s strong support for items identifying the need for a
unified stakeholder approach and opportunities for teachers to contribute to the
project reduced to a rank of rarely in 2008. The only item that Meg ranked
consistently with always (from 2006-2008) was the alignment of the school and
project goal item. Meg’s rankings indicted that although her project had the support
of the principal and executive, it did not have the support of all stakeholders. Meg
significantly reduced her rankings of collaboration items during 2008 as her project
became partially sustained, prior to becoming extinct in 2009.
5.9. Cross case summary of collaboration factors
Wilma and Sam’s ranking of collaboration factors represented the strongest rankings
of the six participants during their project implementation year. Sam significantly
reduced her ranking of the collaboration factors as her project was scaled within and
beyond her setting in 2008. Like Marys, Wilma’s ranking of the collaboration factors
remained constant as their projects were scaled. Meg’s strong support for the
collaboration factors remained constant in 2006-2007 as her project were
implemented and sustained. Her rankings reduced significantly as her project
became partially sustained in 2008 prior to its extinction the following year. My
ranking of collaboration factors fell as the status of the project reduced. The lowest
245
score allocated to any theme over the data collection period was allocated to the area
of collaboration in 2008 as my project became partially sustained.
5.10. Responsiveness of research
My rankings on factors that identified the responsiveness of research remained
consistent for 2006-2007. Priority was given to the usability, trustworthiness and
accessibility of research-based projects. During 2008 my rankings fell most
significantly in factors pertaining to the fit of the project to my setting and whether it
had flexibility in relation to changing setting needs. These factors were linked to the
change of leadership in my setting and the ranks reduced in 2008 as the status of my
project reduced prior to it becoming extinct.
Mary’s responses to those items pertaining to whether the project was responsive to
research were ranked highly during 2007 and 2008 with the exception of the item
about the use of the project data in addressing the settings needs. Priority was given
to items pertaining to accessibility, feasibility and practicality of the project. Mary’s
ranking remained consistent as her project became scaled within and beyond her
setting.
Diane’s rankings once again remained consistent from 2006-2008. She ranked most
items with mostly or always, except for the rank of sometimes allocated to the item
about the project catering for a variance in staff abilities in 2006-2007. As the project
scaled beyond her setting in 2008, Diane’s changed her response to this item from
sometimes to mostly. Other rankings remained consistent as her project continued to
be scaled.
Wilma’s strongest rankings for the responsiveness of research factors were allocated
in 2006 and reduced in 2007 and 2008. The items that were allocated a reduction in
246
rank pertained to accessibility, feasibility and consistency of the project and the
ability to respond to the personal skill growth of individual stakeholders. The
number of “always” rankings allocated by Wilma fell as her project was scaled
within her setting.
Sam allocated a rank to only two items during 2006 as this represented the planning
phase of the project. She allocated strong ranks to other factors in this category in
2007 and a slight reduction in rank was evident in 2008. These items ranked by Sam
in her planning stage (2006) identified that her project was always responsive to the
needs of classroom contexts and always responded to genuine teacher concerns. Sam
reduced these ranks of always to mostly during the project implementation year
(2007). Sam allocated her lowest rank of sometimes to two items during 2008 as her
project was scaled within and beyond her school setting. These factors related to the
personal growth in the skills of stakeholders and the effective adoption of project
features.
Meg’s allocated the highest rank of always to all the responsiveness of research
items for 2006-2007. She significantly reduced these high rankings as the project
became partially sustained in 2008. The only item that maintained the rank of mostly
in 2008 was the item seeking to determine if the project features were adopted
effectively. Meg’s ranked five items with sometimes as the project became partially
sustained. These items related to personal and varying growth in the skills of
stakeholders, the responsiveness of the project to classroom contexts and the project
being valued by students. Meg’s responses to the factors in this category represented
her greatest reduction in rankings as her project moved from sustainment to
extinction in 2008.
247
5.11. Summary of cross case responsiveness of research factors
The rankings allocated to the responsiveness of research factors remained the most
consistent in five of the six projects. Little change was evident in the four projects
that were scaled and Meg’s project that became extinct. My rankings remained
consistent as the status of my project strengthened and reduced significantly as my
project became partially sustained and extinct.
Summary of rankings of participants to part 2 of the survey
Overall Table 5.1 identified that the projects reporting the highest rankings in their
implementation year and the greatest reduction in these rankings from 2006-2008
were the cases that became extinct (Meg and Chris). The key differences between the
rankings allocated by the participants included a gradual change in support for the
identified factors being evident in the four cases that were scaled within and beyond
their school settings. The extinct cases displayed a significant reduction in the
ranking of factors as the status of their projects within their settings reduced. The
exception to this was Meg’s ranking for the responsiveness of research factors,
which only reduced slightly as the status of her project fell from sustained to partial
sustainment.
The responsiveness of research category was allocated the greatest number of
“always” ratings in all of the 4 out of 6 cases that completed the survey for 2006. Of
the remaining two cases that implemented their projects in 2007, Mary also allocated
her highest ranking of “always” to the greatest number responsiveness of research
factors, whilst Sam was the only participant who allocated her strongest number of
‘always’ rankings to the support category. These high ratings were maintained in all
projects as they were scaled within their school setting the following year. The
248
ratings that most significantly reduced during 2008 were Meg’s and mine as the
status of our projects became partially sustained, prior to becoming extinct in 2009.
The most consist responses were evident in Diane’s ratings over the three years.
Diane’s highest rankings occurred in 2007-2008 as her project was sustained and
scaled within the implementation setting. The only change in Diane’s rankings over
this period was a slight increase on the item describing the way the project catered
for a variance in staff abilities.
5.12. Participant responses to the written survey responses and the semi
structured interviews
This section was informed by the written responses that participants provided to the
short answer questions in the survey. These written responses were consulted to
finalise the semi-structured interview questions. As a result the verbal responses to
the semi-structured interviews clarified and added detail to the written survey
responses. The responses to the semi-structured interviews were transcribed and
cited throughout this phase. Masters projects were consulted to verify or add to the
information collected. These results were analysed and are presented using the 16
RTP statements as a framework.
5.13. Shared ownership and responsibility
The majority of participants reported that research to practice is influenced by the
extent to which school based staff can be involved with research projects. Of the six
participants, five made reference to how such involvement can result in partnerships
that share responsibility and ownership and build a sense of credibility among
stakeholders. Diane was the only participant that did not make reference to this
factor in her interview or written survey responses. Meg reported the benefits of
249
shared accountability experienced with the staff members that were involved
willingly. She also described a lack of support for accountability of the integrity of
the project by the primary teachers as it became scaled. My survey responses and
interview comments presented both the benefits of shared ownership when it existed
in my setting along with the negative impact of its withdrawal.
Each of the five participants expanded on their brief survey responses through the
interview. During the interviews participants reported on different aspects of ways in
which the joint involvement of stakeholders at their setting contributed to the status
of their research projects. Sue described that when she went on leave the staff at her
setting continued to implement the next stage of the project without her, which
highlighted the positive impact that a shared initiative can have on the trajectory of
projects.
I took and week or two’s leave and when I came back they had already
implemented it. At first I thought Oh, O.K. but then I thought well they have
taken ownership..... Shared ownership they became effective drivers all by
themselves (Sue, 2009b, p.3).
Sue also commented on the importance of ensuring information on the project is
clearly understood by staff members to make certain they are comprehending the
aims and details of the projects. Sue added that the staff at her setting took more
ownership of the project “as it went along” (Sue, 2009, p.3). Mary reported a similar
experience about ownership building as the project unfolded. She added that this
resulted due to her staff feeling comfortable with what was familiar to them.
When I started I certainly modelled in both Kindergarten classes. I began to
withdraw and then the teachers took up more ownership but not initially.
250
Everybody knows where they are going with it. There is comfort and
familiarity (Mary, 2009b, p.2).
Wilma reported that all the staff members who were involved in her project kept a
professional journal. She identified that the collection of resources by all
stakeholders encouraged shared ownership of the project:
They kept a professional journal along the way we met every week they
would tell me things that were going well and things that weren’t. Through
the collection of newspapers for reading passages, this brought us
together.....the resource collection was a really good thing for ownership and
collaboration [sic]. This gave us some type of ownership as we came up with
the resources together (Wilma, 2009b, p.3).
Meg did not exclusively comment on shared responsibility and ownership. She
linked the use of graphs to shared ownership in her response. Meg reported that her
use of graphs had encouraged shared ownership within the staff at her setting as they
could see that gains students had made were strong. Meg explained that the staff
were motivated to remain involved in the project given the gains presented. She
stated that as the graphs identified the growth in student abilities, they “didn’t go
back to their old ways, as they saw the value in it” (Meg, 2009b, p.2).
Meg’s written survey comments gave a description of the events that occurred when
staff members other than those who nominated to be in the project were instructed to
participate.
Lack of support occurred when the project was up scaled to the primary
classes. Some teachers were not willing to implement the strategy in the way
251
it was designed. There was a sense that they were implementing it because
they were asked to by the principal. An opportunity was given to all teachers
to observe the strategy by one of the original implementing teachers. Few
teachers took advantage of this demonstration (Meg, 2009c, p.8).
I presented the positive impact of a staff that voluntarily united to identify the
specific needs of students and collectively worked toward addressing these
needs. I expanded on my survey responses and reported on the importance of
equal parity and how it encouraged group interdependence and respect for
each other during the interview. I also described the events that resulted in a
reduction of shared ownership following a change in leadership:
When people were not involved in decisions that affected them and were told
that they must do something different that was on top of their current loads,
that was a real negative. It contributed to the demise of the project and even
staff morale (Chris, 2009b, p.2).
5.14. Genuine questions and clear goals
During their semi-structured interviews all participants, other than Diane, expanded
on survey responses and reported that projects are more likely to be sustained in their
schools when they respond to genuine questions, problems and concerns. During the
interviews Mary and Sam added that a shared language, which was comprehended
by all stakeholders, was essential to creating effective communication. The
identification of clear goals that addressed the identified needs of staff and students
and was supported by stakeholders was also reported to be a beneficial to
implementing and sustaining school-based projects.
252
Open dialogue allowed the freedom to bring in something that was very new.
It was seen that we were looking at the research. Helping teachers by sharing
some of the current research, we certainly did that in our staff meetings. This
encouraged enthusiasm; it (use of research based programs to address reading
concerns) became a big focus in our school as it was what our kids and
teachers needed (Mary, 2009b, p.3).
Sam reinforced the need for common goals and regular communication from
multiple stakeholders. Like Mary, Sam reported that a collaborative environment
requires a common language that is understood by all stakeholders. Sam went further
and stated that as a result of her RTP experience she discovered that collaborative
environments might not always be harmonious. She suggested that respectful
disagreeing might be required to establish clear goals and push boundaries.
To me a collaborative culture is where you’ve got people who are building a
community of practice. You need a shared language, you need to be working
together towards the same goal and I guess if it is a community of practice I
guess it doesn’t necessarily have to be smooth running. I am someone who
does not like to ruffle people’s feathers; I like things to be all harmonious.
You realise that to make things happen and to bring about change you
sometimes need to push the boundaries. You can’t do it without that shared
language. That is what I was trying to do in the school. I was building that
shared language with explicit teaching and also understanding what
phonological awareness was. It was different to phonics and people needed to
have a deep understanding of it (Sam, 2009b, p.3).
253
Wendy reported that all stakeholders were part of the team that were united by the
common goal of implementing a research-based project in her school setting. She
believed this evolved as a result of effective communication and that her being in the
classroom made her more accessible to other staff members.
Being part of a team and setting realistic goals just evolved, so I think that it
was because open communication was part of the project. Being in the
classroom made me more accessible; this helped (Wendy, 2009b, p.2).
During the interview Meg reported that identifying the outcomes of the project in
terms of student goals proved effective at her school.
As far as the project goes there was parity between the teachers, and myself
we had a common goal and we could all see the value in it in terms of
children’s outcomes (Meg, 2009b, p.3).
When asked about her reduced survey ratings allocated to items about stakeholder
unity in Part 1 of the survey, Meg described the result of the school executive’s
decision to scale the project and its goals without involving other stakeholders in the
making of this decision. Meg explained that the decision to expand the project, due
to its success, was made at an executive meeting and there was no consultation with
other staff members. Meg explained that she became aware of the subtle negative
responses of a small number of staff members as they were being told they were
going to implement the project.
Meg explained that as time went on the original staff members remained committed
to the project and continued to implement it with success. She described that the
unity of staff members and communication opportunities did not continue to develop
254
with the expansion of the project. Meg went further and stated that although the
school and project goals were aligned, the lack of support and ownership contributed
to the projects extinction.
As a result of my project implementation, I reported in the survey that when the
goals of the project were establish jointly by the staff to address identified student
needs, respect and equal parity amongst stakeholders was encouraged. This
explanation was extended through the interview as I described both the positive and
negative results that can occur when systems, schools and staff work together toward
the shared goal of promoting the use of research to address the needs of the setting.
As more people came on board and worked toward the project goals its
momentum increased. I think as people saw it working they wanted to be part
of it. People knew what was involved and that it was manageable so I guess
the collaborative culture of respect for the programs goals and each other’s
efforts just grew. Unfortunately, this collaborative culture just came to a
sudden stop when we lost the three top leadership people at our school. We
lost our principal, deputy and REC at once. The system put in a principal and
deputy from the same school. They had no commitment to the project or its
goals, yet said we could still run it but all resources, time and supports were
withdrawn. So really the project had no real hope and became extinct (Chris,
2009b, p.3).
5.15. Scalability
All participants made reference to the way in which projects were scaled in both the
surveys and interviews. The status or standing of the project within the original
school was reported to have a strong impact on its ability to be scaled. During the
255
interviews all participants reported that research projects with participants who
considered ways to address the scaling of their projects had a greater likelihood of
being sustained and exerting whole school influence. Diane commented on the
practical implications required in the scaling of her project to facilitate its
sustainment in the high school setting.
The AP would deal with all the practical issues. We needed him to work
around the calendar, excursions, incursions and exam timetable. Because of
the demands of a high school, if the program wasn’t a priority it would get
lost. This contributed to it being of high status, you knew you had succeeded
when something was excursion and incursion free. This means if it was a
priority, it was put into the school calendar and all excursions and incursions
had to be worked around it. When things get to that stage they have a very
high status and are embedded into the culture of the school (Diane, 2009b,
p.4).
Mary’s survey responses reported that reading was a priority of the school and was
valued by her staff. During the interview she stated that as her project used
standardised measures and addressed this priority, it was given increased status and
this contributed to its scalability. Wilma identified the value in using hard data to
present student improvement. I also made reference to the projects potential for
scalability in terms of rigor, benefit to the students and ease of implementation.
The staff valued it because it is standardised and it gives you great data. We
were all part of the planning. As the school’s main focus was on reading this
certainly gave it a lot of status and standing. In terms of the schools priorities
256
it (the project) was high, it is written into our school assessment plan, it was
valuable it helped, it was not a new fad (Mary, 2009b, p.3).
It was recognised as something of value and that’s also why I believe it was
adopted. It proved itself, it evolved and results identified the high level of
improvement in students. You can’t back away from that, that is hard data
(Wilma, 2009b, p.2).
The intensity and rigor was different, it was clearly beneficial and easy to
implement. This helped it to be incorporated into the life of the school. It was
owned by many and that was because it was of the benefits to the kids. It was
even useful at parent teacher interviews. It also gave the parents faith in us
and our teaching. This gave it scalability potential (Chris, 2009b, p.4).
Both Sam and Meg identified factors that were not mentioned by other participants
in terms of the projects scalability potential. During the interview Meg did not
respond exclusively to the scalability question. She made reference to the principal
in her comments on the scaling of her project and did not separate the factors.
The principal was very allowing and it was given status because it was taken
up and scaled. Yes it was up-scaled because it was encouraged by the
principal (Meg, 2009a, p.3).
Sam reported on the intensity of the focus of the schools priority during the
interview. Her response captured the sentiment of all six cases when she suggested
that if projects displayed successful outcomes they gained traction. Sam extended
this response further and stated that the project is strengthened if it becomes part of
the schools policy.
257
Intensity of the focus on the project is a key to giving the project status. It is
the intensity of key priorities, if it falls into a key priority, which seems to get
more traction. It was the end of that year where the executive said this is
going to part of our school policy. It became a greater priority as the success
was evident (Sam, 2009b, p.3).
5.16. Substantive and ongoing communication
In the surveys and interviews all six participants reported that their research project
was enhanced when communication and feedback from many stakeholders, from all
levels, was ongoing and substantive. All participants reported that feedback and
communication that occurred throughout each stage of the project was more
effective than if it had been given at the end of each stage. Many comments made
reference to the need for ongoing communication between stakeholders and how
communication emerged as the projects unfolded. The following reports are
representative of the reports made during the interviews of the ways in which
communication occurred in the school settings. Mary and Sam described the
meetings at their settings and Sam presented the importance of stakeholders having a
common understanding of the language used. Diane reported on her use of
technology to constantly communicate with her high school students and Wilma
reported that a reduction of structured opportunities for communication was required
as the project unfolded due to the increase in informal feedback and conversations.
We would email to communicate with each other all the time and the kids
used it to work and gain results (Diane, 2009b, p.2).
Communication was open, all ideas were welcomed and everybody had an
opportunity to discuss things. People were pretty contactable and
258
comfortable. Meetings were held looking at resources, research information
and general practical details. So there were opportunities for regular analysis
and constant feedback and we could all grow from that (Mary, 2009b, p.4).
Sam’s written survey responses were not isolated to individual themes or areas. She
linked responses to the area of communication to other multiple factors. Sam stated
that communication enhanced teacher enthusiasm through “collaboration, positive
student outcomes, shared pattern language and building a community of practice”
(Sam, 2009c, p.8). During her semi-structured interview Sam provided additional
information describing how this communication occurred.
The start of the project involved face to face meetings with the teachers.
There were weekly meetings. I tried to keep them as informal because I
didn’t want to put any pressure on people. Each week I got them to fill in an
interview sheet to assess any problems they may be having or what I can do
to support them. You couldn’t do it without that shared language. That is
what I was trying to do in the school was build that shared language with
explicit teaching. Some meetings were informal at the start but when we got
down to the professional development it became more formal and power
point presentations were used. In small groups there was a lot of interaction
and discussion. We talked about what the teachers already knew and what
their interest in the project was. There was respectful disagreeing, constant
feedback all the time and constant modelling (Sam, 2009b, p.3).
Wilma’s survey responses continued to identify and expand upon the importance of
communication with parents and support staff. During the semi-structured interviews
Wilma reported that the need for larger structured meetings reduced.
259
As the project went on there was a lot more talking between teachers, so
there was less need for big meetings. The fact that people wanted to use it
showed that the project was working and when the principal wanted it as part
of the entire school assessment plan, no one ever said ‘no, we don’t want it’.
So everyone was happy to take it on. So it was a combination of the timing
and that it fitted the need for a more structured assessment plan perfectly. It
catered for the need that was there. No structured feedback was needed as
realistically if people didn’t want to use it, they wouldn’t have asked us about
it (Wilma, 2009b, p.4).
The participants whose projects became extinct offered the least number of
responses in relation to this communication factor. Both Meg and I allocated strong
rankings and reported on the need for ongoing and substantive communication, yet
the other four participants offered more detailed and frequent responses to this
factor. Meg was the only participant who reported that through the project her school
was being refurbished with open learning spaces and this changed the dynamic of the
teaching teams when she responded to a communication question.
5.17. Consistent long-term support that considers the personal qualities of
stakeholders
All participants reported various examples of support that enhanced the
implementation and sustainment of their research-based projects across a range of
school settings in both the surveys and interviews. Descriptions of the positive effect
of the long-term support derived from being part of a cohort to the impact of using
graphs to identify student gains were offered during the interviews. Three
260
participants also identified the difficulty in disseminating passion and how
enthusiasm within a staff can spread with an increase in the depth of knowledge.
The following reports expanded on the survey comments to present the impact of the
support generated from different stakeholders. Diane reported on practical elements
such as the need for space to run her project.
Well we had the principal support but we needed the support of the librarian
as well. We needed a big space as 50 people were involved. It meant we had
to close the library, there was a little negativity, but it was OK as everyone
was involved, it actually took on a life of its own. Everyone was on board so
I think that whole community ownership was the strongest support (Diane,
2009b, p.4).
During the interviews Diane, Sam, Wilma and I commented on the strong impact of
various stakeholders including the librarian, coordinators, colleagues and other staff
members in the sustainment of our projects.
Being part of a cohort is really good. I was lucky because two of us were
implementing it at the school. That made a big difference you weren’t on
your own (Sue, 2009, p. 4).
The other person who was mostly involved was the Stage one coordinator.
She was a driver who took it on and helped to sustain and scale it because she
could see that it was effective. As the year went on the Assistant Principal
also became very supportive as she had a strong focus on early intervention.
Those two people carried more than the Principal. They both had a strong
261
background in literacy and early intervention. It became a greater priority as
the success was evident (Sue, 2009, p. 4).
During the interviews Wilma and I reported on the impact on the support generated
by personal qualities, such as teacher enthusiasm and the way in which this
enthusiasm was shared. Comments in response to the support category were
extended to link depth of knowledge and staff enthusiasm to this factor.
Staff enthusiasm just grew quickly as this project was something that really
addressed a need that was reoccurring. The depth of knowledge on the
project was another essential it would not have working without a deep
understanding of how and why it was conducted the way it was. This also
fostered enthusiasm, which drove it. The results themselves provided hard
and fast feedback. People were engaging in professional dialogue constantly.
The team would also attend staff meetings and provide feedback on various
features on a regular basis, this ongoing interaction encouraged people to
want to be on board and we could modify features of the program as we
needed to (Chris, 2009b. p.2).
Often people are passionate about something, they drive it but it is hard to
disseminate that passion to the whole school unless it is valuable, but then
you remove that person and the whole thing goes to nothing, it just
disappears. I think people were just ready for a change, it came in at the right
time and people could see that it was valuable and that it was actually helping
them. Because teachers are such busy people, things can’t take more time.
With the DIBELS, they could see it was a quick assessment tool that showed
them growth and they were able to act on the data that they got. Teachers also
262
didn’t have to take any money out of their class budget. They are tiny things
but sometimes it is only little things like that that can pull things apart
(Wilma, 2009b, p.4).
I think the biggest support for me was the battery of knowledge I had behind
me. You can’t teach people unless you have the research and theory behind
you. When you do go to implement it and you have the knowledge you can
feel comfortable because I thought I knew what I was talking about at that
time. That was the biggest thing for me (Wilma, 2009b, p.6).
All participants indicated that the projects themselves and their features became a
support in school settings. Mary’s response during the interview reflected the
sentiment of four participants as she reported that the quick administration of her
measures was a strength of the project. Meg’s comments supported Mary’s use of
graphs to display student results. Wilma’s report was reflective of the occurrences at
five settings once the positive results became evident.
Teachers became familiar with the materials and how quick they were to
administer, 3 to 4 minutes per child compared to all the measures they were
using in the past that might have taken up to 20 Minutes. They could assess
and reassess again so you see growth as the measures were so user friendly. I
had very good teachers who were very open to it. That really supported me. I
had a depth of knowledge and I could organise and co-ordinate others and
that was a support really to others as well (Mary, 2009b, p. 3).
People could see that it was working, it spread through like word of mouth
then all of a sudden everyone wanted to use it, which wasn’t necessarily what
we intended to happen – we originally wanted to gradually increase use as
263
positive results were seen. Once the ball started rolling you just couldn’t stop
it, so we just had to do the best we could. In retrospect that was a negative,
because it went so fast, but then we turned it into a positive (Wilma, 2009b,
p.5).
Basically by putting all the data on a spread sheet and highlighting. It was
very visual people could see it is working they could see the growth within a
couple weeks. I gave this feedback to the parents as well. If we are increasing
the parent knowledge that almost increases the schools accountability. These
parents were very supportive of the project (Mary, 2009b, p. 3).
Meg went further to provide a practical example describing how she was able to
disseminate her passion for the project through the use of graphs. She also
commented on the support gained from the parents of children involved in her
project, which she originally identified in her response to the survey.
I had great depth of knowledge and passion and commitment. This was not
easy to transfer to others but I graphed it all so that the teachers could see the
results every week. This helped as buy in and enthusiasm increased because
of the knowledge of its success. Parental support was also great as they could
see the kid’s success (Meg, 2009b, p.4).
Mary and Diane were the only participants who proposed ways the education system
could support the implementation of projects in schools. Comments were also made
on ways the knowledge gained from the implementation of research based projects
could be shared with others to promote a prevention rather than cure approach to
learning.
264
Mine was literacy based. I am sure other peoples project especially the high
school people, that were on behaviour and stuff like that; it would be so
useful for us to hear. I mean at one stage when Lyn was there, it was
mentioned that we might do some talks and presentations but then everything
changed in the office, so new personnel had other agendas (Mary, 2009b, p.
3).
Systems could provide funding to schools to access experts to come to the
schools to give professional development to the whole staff (Diane, 2009,
p.3).
I never was asked when it was finished for any feedback on my project or
any information at all. In actual fact as time has gone on I feel that they
would not value my project at all. We have to get the projects out there as
prevention is better than a cure (Mary, 2009, p.4).
5.18. Resources and training
All participants reported on the importance of training and resources to the success
of their projects in both the surveys and interviews. A range of perspectives on the
implementation of training and resources were reported. Sam was the only
participant that promoted the need to identify the readiness levels of stakeholders
during this phase. Meg’s survey response represented the sentiment of three
participants when she linked training to the benefits of standardised information.
The key to successfully training our staff was finding where they were at and
moving forward from there (Sam, 2009b, p.3).
265
Training was easy as we used the standardised information to empower
instruction (Meg, 2009a, p.3).
Mary commented on the preparation of resources and the benefits in providing
simple and easy to use resources during the interview. She also reported on how
visual resources were created to assist in ongoing training and development.
I initially prepared all of resources in my own time as I really did not want to
say to the teachers you have to get the resources ready. My aim was to make
the project work, I believed in it strongly and I really wanted to transfer it to
other people. The materials were all user friendly and you have all the
instructions in front of you in bold. Then by putting all the data on a spread
sheet and highlighting it, it became very visual people could see it is working
they could see the growth within a couple weeks. So the training was
ongoing and we developed along with the program (Mary, 2009b, p.4).
During the interview I expanded on my survey responses to present an account of the
benefits in using technology when training staff in research based projects. I was the
only participant to report on what occurred when required well developed resources
were removed.
The whole online information and data entry/access system was great. You
would do training at school and then teachers would go over things online in
their own time. It was relevant and they could easily get standardised results
to empower your teaching. This feature really helped the training of our staff
and the project gained traction over time. We were at the stage when teaching
was becoming more informed with the use of results when the program came
to a sudden halt. The new principal and deputy had no commitment to the
266
project, they didn’t want to know about it and said we could still run it but all
resources, time and supports were withdrawn. Without the required time and
commitment the project began to lose the gains that were made (Chris, 2009,
p.4).
5.19. Reward and acknowledgement
Although the importance of recognition and reward for the implementation and
sustainment of research-based projects was identified in the RTP literature (see
literature review), no participant commented on the strengths of this factor during the
explanation or exploration phase. Meg was the only participant who mentioned a
lack of financial reward for the time required for the implementation and sustainment
of her research-based project. No other participant reported on the need for
recognition and reward for the implementation and sustainment of research-based
projects in their responses to this or any other RTP factor.
I was working part time, I was meant to go in 3 times a week but I was going in four
times a week during the project. There wasn’t any support financially, but I suppose
I didn’t have to go in the whole day sometimes I could leave around lunchtime. But I
was going in the extra day to prepare because you had a lot of resources to organize
(Meg, 2009b, p.3).
5.20. Technology
All participants acknowledged that technology has many functions that can help
make RTP more efficient. Only two participants out of six reported that they used
technology effectively. Diane reported on how technology was used in her secondary
school setting as an effective source of motivation and communication and I reported
on its advantages when communicating and online data entry.
267
I bought a comprehension program, so the kids would read the book and then
they would go on the computer to answer the questions. So the kids saw their
results instantly and I would keep a record. It was also used to gain
information from teachers, like a kid couldn’t come to reading today, so
would email to communicate with each other all the time and the kids used it
to work and gain results. It was good to communicate. I also have a data-base
that the teachers can access, it has the kids results, pre and post tests are there
to see improvement. It also allows the teacher to see if a child has been tested
(Diane, 2009b, p.4).
The benefits in using technology to simplify data entry and communicating
with parents were expressed. Yet concerns relating to the reliability of
school-based technology were also reported. The whole online data
entry/access system was great. You could easily get standardised results to
empower your teaching. It was used to enter data, collect knowledge but it
could have been utilized more effectively, I’m sure. The thing with
technology at school level, is that sometimes it lets you down. So you don’t
want to be totally dependent on it. It could be used formally in feedback from
parents, students and peers quite easily, but you would need time to do this or
it may not happen (Chris, 2009b, p.5).
Mary’s written survey responses reported that the materials required for her project
were easy to download. Yet during the interviews Mary and three others, Wilma,
Sam and Meg, identified the benefits of technology yet they reported that they had
not used technology to its full potential. During the interviews they presented the
268
ways they could have used technology more effectively to enhance the ease of
implementation of our projects and to provide avenues for feedback.
All the DIBELS results are on our M drive and accessible to everybody.
Technology could have even been used even more with all the resources and
all the materials available online (Mary, 2009b, p.4).
The only way I used technology was to print out the surveys and my power
point. I could have used it more to communicate with staff and have
resources available for them (Meg, 2009b, p.2).
I could have put surveys on line, used it to monitor the kids and that would
have made it easier to store the data. The actual teaching would have been
easier if I had it all on line. It would have been there for whoever needed it. It
would have been better for the sustainment and scaling really cause it would
have all been there. Technology could have helped the system become more
self-reinforcing. It would help people in the future (Sam, 2009b, p.4).
It wasn’t a big aspect of it I must admit, the only thing really where
technology was involved was to keep all the data in one place, we used it to
track the kids. If we were doing it now I would probably link it in with the
schools wiki and I could definitely use that easily. Kids could have put their
feedback on that instead of giving hard copies to me, even surveys could be
there also, of their reflections. They could even put that on the blog (Wilma,
2009b, p.6).
Five of these participant responses collected through the interviews identified that
when technology is accessible and reliable it can be used by stakeholders to enhance
269
the implementation, sustainment and expansion of research based projects in school-
based settings. The benefits in the use of technology were identified through cases
that continued to become scaled and extinct.
5.21. Projects viewed as credible by stakeholders
All six participants reported that the use of validated research based projects is
enhanced when stakeholders viewed their outcomes as credible in their ability to
address genuine needs. During the interview Mary and Sam’s responses reflected the
views of the other participants. Mary reported the benefits of projects having a clear
direction and Sam commented on increased participation as project credibility
through student success became evident.
We have had so many projects come and go over the years. This was
different; they could see exactly where it was heading and that opened up
expectations straight away. You could see growth and that made a big
difference (Mary, 2009b, p.3).
Teachers became more involved as it went on as they could see it become
more and more successful (Sam, 2009b, p.2).
Wilma’s response during the interview reinforced and expanded upon these
responses. She stated that when projects were identified as valuable by eliciting
positive student and teacher responses, they were more readily used and supported.
It was recognised as something of value by students and teachers and that’s
why I believe it was adopted. It proved itself, it evolved and results were seen
due to the high level of improvement because of the high level of consistent
instruction (Wilma, 2009, p.3).
270
5.22. Limiting of competing demands
There were no direct responses made by participants that exclusively reported on the
limiting of competing demands. All participants linked the strong impact of a
school’s leadership team to the ways in which they prioritised the projects within
their schools. They reported that when the school leaders positioned the project in
the school timetable or gave the project status this contributed to a reduction in the
competing demands placed on practitioners, as the projects were being implemented
and sustained. Three participants also made comments on the importance of sharing
the ownership of the projects when expressing their thoughts about the need to limit
competing demands if projects are to be sustained in school applications.
During the interview Diane went further and stated that she required the support of
two principals who had different leadership styles. She reported that she had the time
to implement her project and she wasn’t overloaded as her project was viewed as a
priority. Diane indicated that this contributed to the scaling of her project within her
setting.
I had to get the support from 2 principals as we had 2 sites. One was the 7-10
principal and the other was the college one (Year 11 and 12). The college one
was into data and the other was a people person and very laid back. The data
driven principal was a forward thinker and planner. The other one was very
relaxed and would communicate well with the parents so between the two of
them I guess we had a balance. It was great as they gave me the capacity and
time to do what I needed to do and I wasn’t overloaded with additional tasks
as this was a priority in their eyes (Diane, 2009b, p.5).
271
During the survey Mary provided an account of a unique experience that was not
shared by other participants. She reported that her first principal implemented the
project in the new setting when she had moved on and her second principal delivered
the project if she became overloaded. Mary suggested that this contributed to her
project being scaled within and beyond her setting. Meg reported that her principal
gave the project status and was realistic in his expectations from his staff and this
reduced stress levels generated from competing demands. Meg’s principal and
executive team decided to increase the project’s status within the school prior to it
becoming extinct that same year.
Executive support was very good, my AP was very interested in this area, she
has since moved on as Principal in the Wollongong diocese she has
introduced it down there. Our new principal was very open to it. He was
supportive and even administered it to our Kinder himself. He knew what
was involved and was fair so we could go to him for help if it (the load)
became too much (Mary, 2009b, p.5).
The principal gave it status because he knew it was going to help the
children. That principal was flexible and supportive. He was a people person
not a taskmaster. The teacher’s moral was always high the students would
then benefit from that. He was realistic in what he expected from us when we
implemented the project (Meg, 2009b, p.5).
Sam’s comment on her principal giving her project status and reducing the
expectations on individual stakeholders and thus limiting the demands placed on
them was reflective of the sentiment shared by three other participants. During the
interview Sam went further to state he acknowledged the time and effort required
272
when implementing the project and as a result there was a culture of appreciation
amongst the staff. Sam’s survey and interview comments combined to identify the
support of her leadership team in contributing to the increased status and scaling of
her project.
Our principal was someone who was happy to disperse control. He had a lot
of trust in people I felt he had trust in me. If you went to him with an idea he
would let you run with it he would not had to micro manage it. He gave it
status in the school and was very supportive. He did acknowledge what we
were doing was significant and so everyone appreciated the time and effort
that was involved (Sam, 2009b, p.6).
Wilma’s interview comments were less specific but captured the opinion of all six
participants. She reported that her flexible principal allowed staff to take time to
assist others when required and this reduced the pressures of competing demands
when implementing her research-based project at school.
We had a good solid leadership team. Our Principal was very resourceful. I
think he was a really dynamic and flexible. He was open to new ideas and
listened to your opinions on the project. He wasn’t entrenched in any fixed
style. He was never dogmatic, so that took a lot of the pressure off I think.
The fact that people wanted to use it showed that the project was working and
when the principal wanted it as part of the entire school assessment plan, no
one ever said ‘no, we don’t want it’. So everyone was happy to take it on. So
it was a combination of the timing and that it fitted the need for a more
structured assessment plan perfectly. It catered for the need that was there
273
and we were given the flexibility and time to help others when they needed it
(Wilma, 2009b. p.5).
These reports identified by five of the six participants describe the way in which the
support of the school leaders contributed to increased the projects status within their
schools. Of these five cases, four became scaled within and beyond their school
settings and one (Meg’s) became extinct.
During the survey and interview I reported on the positive impact the support of the
first two school leaders had on the sustainment and scaling of my project. I then
provided a contrasting report not experienced by other participants about the
negative impact a third principal had as he added additional expectations to staff
requirements. The third principal reduced the support and time allocated to
implementing the project and introduced additional expectations. Although the third
principal worked with the same stakeholders, within the same setting as the previous
principals, the additional demands and reduced support introduced by the third
principal contributed to the projects extinction.
As more people came on board and the momentum increased. People were
literally asking if they could do it after they understood the details as it could
lighten their loads and benefit them and their students. The project became a
priority as it addressed our needs so were given time and resources to scale it
up. It scaled very quickly, much faster than planned. We had three changes in
principal. The founding principal was brilliant and firmly believed in
distributive leadership. He strongly supported the project as it would make
the staff lives easier and it would really help the students. We then had a new
principal and she was also great, even though she was finding her feet she
274
was driven by the needs of the students and continued to keep the project as a
school priority. Then we got another new principal, who had a very directive
style. He was very driven by things looking good and his drivers were so
different. We even showed him the standardized data that display real
growth, but he and the new deputy were not interested, they had their own
agenda. So really the project had no real hope. Quite bizarre really. The same
setting, same project, same kids etc. Consistency in all details, yet new
principal 3rd time round, can destroy 3 years work with a very short time.
They didn’t say you can’t do it. It was there is no time to do that any longer
and here are additional things that need to be done which obviously directly
contributed to the demise in a smart and directive way (Chris, 2009b, p.7).
This semi-structured interview response added clarity to the written survey response
which reported “the support for the project increased as the demand for the project
increased. In the final year of the project with the change of leadership, support was
withdrawn from all areas, which increased the demands placed on all of us. Shared
ownership reduced as competing demands and directions changed the project status.
A collaborative sense within the school was replaced by a directive, authoritarian
leadership approach” (Chris, 2009c, p.9). This report identified a sequential
relationship between factors, as I was not able to isolate them to directly respond
exclusively to the factor identified in the interview or written survey questions.
Wilma’s short survey response statement summarised the sentiment of five of the six
participants about the way in which concerns about competing demands could be
successfully addressed in school settings. Meg was the only participant who did not
express this consideration.
275
Because it was part of the school day it wasn’t seen as an additional demand on the
teachers (Wilma, 2009a, p.5).
All participants were unable to isolate comments about competing demands from
comments about the principals and school leaders. Participants constantly referred to
the school leaders as having the ability to influence the status or priority of the
projects within the school settings.
5.22.1. Sufficient and ongoing instructional time, preparation and
resources
Sufficient time to prepare resources was reported to be essential to the
implementation and sustainment of all projects in both the surveys and interviews.
Working the projects into existing school timetables was also reported to have a
positive impact on the promotion of research-based practices in schools by five of
the six participants during the semi-structured interviews. The following examples
present the cross section of ways in which individual participants addressed practical
issues. Of these five accounts, four became scaled and Meg’s account, which stated
she worked the project into the timetable of her colleagues, was the only one of the
five to become extinct. A single account of the difficulty in maintaining projects
once supports were withdrawn was also presented. This project went on to become
extinct once the support including time and resources were withdrawn.
The AP would do all the practical issues. We needed him to work around the
calendar, excursions, incursions, exam timetables. If the program wasn’t a
priority it would get lost (Diane, 2009b, p.3).
The loads were shared. The Special needs team did all the data entry and
copying. It was appreciated so it was worth it. Time was allocated and it
276
became part of the literacy expectation, so it worked in very easily (Chris,
2009b, p.2).
Schools are so busy especially in the beginning of the year. I implemented
the actual teaching part of it during the literacy blocks so it was worked into
the timetable from the onset (Mary, 2009b, p.3)
In the implementation phase the time that I had to spend that was a real
bonus. Nobody minded that I took time from my normal teaching load to
focus on the project (Sam, 2009b, p.4).
We couldn’t run it when all resources, time and supports were withdrawn
(Chris, 2009a, p.4).
I worked in with their timetable (Meg, 2009b, p.3).
This interview comment by Meg followed her survey response which reported that
she was a part time employee and would come in on her days off to prepare
resources and the time required to implement the project and prepare these resources
was important to its success.
Wendy reported the sentiment of one other participant when she stated that as the
project continued, informal staff conversations proved to be beneficial to staff
members. Time for ongoing formal and informal contributed to the sustainment of
projects.
As the project went on there was a lot more talking between teachers and
they would help each other as it was needed (Wendy, 2009b, p.3).
277
5.23. Complete, practical and accessible
Participants reported that research based projects that have a complete
implementation strategy through being comprehensive, comprehendible, accessible
and practical will be more successful. All participants linked this to the teacher
education course as it modelled how the aforementioned features were woven into
the design of the course and impacted the way participants took up the task of
developing their projects. Participants reported that they modelled their project
designs on their course experiences to engage all of the parts of the project, as this
would have a reinforcing effect, which could further enhance its success.
Wendy and Sam reported on the need for the whole package when implementing
research-based projects in schools as singular, separated components are not enough.
Diane reported that the course, like our projects had a life of their own. All
participants referred back to the course experience when they reported on the way to
make their school-based projects practical and complete. Not one participant isolated
these factors in their interview responses.
At school in practice, they want the whole package they don’t just expect one
thing. They didn’t only need the content, they needed to know why and we
could answer it because of the course structure and depth of the course. We
had the graphic organisers that helped the more visual learners like myself go
step by step through the task and get to the endpoint. The step-by-step
structure of the course was huge, it was a main feature and so effective so I
then used a similar complete approach to implement my project at school
(Wendy, 2009b, p.4).
278
I think they embedded things right from the start. It was heavy going and we
were coming from so many different worlds. We lived and breathed the
course it had a life of its own. It was the readings, the research, the
collaboration and then we would put it into practice at school. It was putting
the research into the practice without us even knowing or realizing it (Diane,
2009b, p.4).
It was the way it was scaffolded, the spiralling effect. I did a previous course
in action research and I found this quite difficult, as there was no structure on
how to do it. I found this a completely different experience and I followed
the same process when I implemented my project. It was the whole package
(Sam, 2009b, p.4).
5.24. Teacher education
Many comments in the previous section reported on the capacity of teacher
education to prepare participants to be better able to implement and sustain research-
based projects within school settings. During the interviews all participants expanded
on these statements and their survey responses to report on how the teacher
education experience contributed to their ability to promote selected projects within
their settings. There was a consensus in reports that when subjects were intentionally
linked, they could reinforce key ideas that enabled students to build a depth of
understanding. All six participants also suggested that when courses directly
responded to teacher needs through a clear and consistent approach the projects had
a greater likelihood of success.
Meg, Mary and I reported on the totality of the teacher education experience. These
three quotes were representative of all participant reports that indicated that the TE
279
course provided a context for involvement and the acquisition of deep knowledge
and experience. A description of the successful completion of the course was
described as being predictive of the successful implementation of research-based
projects within schools.
I think all the assignments that we did, were exactly the way we needed to
follow through with the project. We had to do the theory side and the
practical side of it, there was always three components to every assignment
so you knew you were going to have the differentiation component. You
had to go into it so deeply to understand it. You had to know the theory, so I
think that is what helped you in the project. Because you knew why you were
doing everything. You need the total package. The depth of knowledge really
came out in our projects (Meg, 2009b, p.4).
You actually lived and breathed what you were doing and were drilled about
the whys and where for of what you were doing. It was not enough to know
specific features, it was all encompassing, and you had to know everything. If
we didn’t succeed in the training camp, it was like we would never succeed
in practice. It wasn’t for the faint hearted (Chris, 2009b, p.6).
I think the biggest support for me was the battery of knowledge behind me.
You can’t teach people unless you have the research and theory behind you.
When you do go to implement it and you have the knowledge you can feel
comfortable because I thought I knew what I was talking about at that time.
That was the biggest thing for me. That level of knowledge was huge to
implement the project. If we didn’t do assessment, collaboration etc. we
280
would never have everything come together at the school level or even class
level (Mary, 2009b, p.5).
During the interview Diane, Sam and Wendy went further and made comments
about how the knowledge and experiences continued through their personal journey
at school. Sam outlined the benefits in being part of a cohort and Wendy described
the importance of personal traits such as resilience.
We did the same thing, we followed the program, we relived the course in
our setting. We did what we did in the course at school (Diane, 2009b, p.4).
It was such a sudden impact. I would take the teachers at school along with
me, not physically but along the learning journey (Diane, 2009b, p.5).
We were taught a holistic structure to support staff. You already had the
skills, you may not have realised it at the time. Being part of a cohort was
really good. I really think that course built capacity. It gave you the skills to
engage with the people and to build their capacity and you did it without even
realizing that you were doing it. Looking back, without even realizing it, you
learnt how to build capacity, you learnt how to collaborate without even
realizing it. We set about getting our masters then, then we got all those meta
skills without even realizing it. If we hadn’t done all that collaborative stuff,
we wouldn’t even have learnt how to deal with all that stuff (Sam, 2009b,
p.5).
The depth of knowledge definitely played a key part in completing the
project, Resilience as well. By the end of it, the project highlighted our
profile in the school. They began to recognise that she knows a lot in this area
281
need to be able to adapt also if need be and be very resourceful. It did raise
our profile, which was good because we knew what we were talking about
(Wendy, 2009b, p.6).
Sam was the only participant who reported concerns regarding the sequencing of the
delivery of information during the teacher education course. She then offered ways
in which the TE experience could have been more beneficial.
That was a flaw in the design of the project probably. We were doing that
thing about the self-organising school at the same time, but really we should
have done it before that. If you completed that unit first, rather than doing it
all at the same time it wouldn’t have been so overwhelming. So if I started
another project now I would take that knowledge into account (Sam, 2009,
p.5).
5.25. Collaboration
The previous participant reports on the teacher education experience demonstrated
how TE can contribute to teachers feeling sufficiently prepared. In their responses to
collaboration questions participants again referred to their teacher education
experience. They described how research based projects can be enhanced when
teachers and researchers work together to develop links between theory (researchers
perspective) and practice (classroom teachers perspective).
You are tapping into personnel experience between people who have the link
between research knowledge and classroom based instruction. It was so valid
we just need to get it out there (Mary, 2009b, p.5).
282
During the interviews Diane reported on how she gained respect from her staff from
the knowledge she had accumulated from working with researchers. Mary, Sam and
I reported on the ways in which we engaged with people from our school setting
along our research journey.
I came with facts and figures, hard evidence and because I had done all the
reading I had all the knowledge. It sounded like I knew what I was doing, so
that helped with the collaboration and respect from others (Diane, 2009b,
p.5).
We were engaged in the course and the research from the start, so we could
then engage people as required. We needed to make sure they were familiar
with all of it, what the expectation were, they needed to be confident at
administering the probes (Mary, 2009b, p.5).
The way the tasks were broken down in the assignments. Do this little bit
then the next, the rest was practical. There was constant feedback and
collaboration all the time and constant modelling. This was what we needed
for it to play out in our real jobs (Sue, 2009b, p.5).
We had SDD days, sessions, readings, consistency and feedback
opportunities to make the project manageable, easy, productive and
meaningful. We stretched them out of the comfort zone and engaged them in
new learning just like the course did for us (Chris, 2009b, p.5).
Sam’s report represented the sentiment of all participants as she provided a summary
of the completeness of the teacher education experience and its effectiveness in
providing participants with the structure and depth of knowledge to effectively
283
collaborate and communicate key learning with school-based staff. All participants
were united in reporting that their teacher education opportunity strengthened their
knowledge on collaboration and the effective implementation and sustainment of
their selected research-based projects in their schools. Not one participant reported
on collaboration exclusively in their survey or interview responses. Meg went on to
suggest that collaboration could have further been enhanced through the sharing of
the wealth of knowledge gained with those other than school-based staff.
By replicating what we had done in the course was the biggest feature. The
course was modelled so well. The whole course was collaborative and was
embodied into a theoretical framework. The other really big thing in that
course was the whole professional language around inclusion. It is not
superficial it was that go deeper [sic], it was actually going deeper and it is
the total comprehension, the language, the living of the course (Sam, 2009b,
p.6).
It would have been good to gain the knowledge on what everybody else had
done in their projects (Meg, 2009b, p.4).
Meg was also the only participant to describe that the reduction in the collaborative
culture at her school was due to her it being restructured to cater for open
classrooms. She also stated that this collaborative culture was reduced when her
principal instructed that the primary teachers to implement her project. I reported
that collaboration within my setting reduced with the lack of support and
introduction of competing demands from my new leadership team. Of the six cases
that identified the strengths of collaboration on the status of the projects, Meg’s and
my case were the only two that became extinct. Our reports also offered accounts of
284
a reduction in collaboration as the projects moved from sustainment to partial
sustainment prior to becoming extinct in 2009.
Diane presented a unique perspective from her experience that was not reported by
other participants. She commented on the need for collaboration between staff
members to ensure that students are not teased for their participation in projects.
We had kids coming back to class a little late, so they were being bullied
because they had been to the “Sped” class, so we had to collaboratively
address that. But that was a real concern that collaboration addressed. It had
to be dealt with by a group of people. The collaboration wasn’t negative but
we had to use it to address it (Diane, 2009b, p.4).
5.26. Responsive to change
Wendy’s report was representative of the sentiment of all of the six participants in
that they suggested that flexibility assisted in the success of the projects. All
participants indicated that flexibility allowed for changes to be made to address the
changing needs of stakeholders and school setting. During the interview Wilma
attributed some of the ability of the stakeholders working with the program to be
responsive to change as required to the principal at her school.
I think it certainly was successful because we could change things if we
needed to. We weren’t ‘locked in’, so it gave us traction. He (the principal)
let it flow to cater for the needs of the setting (Wilma, 2009b. p.5).
Sam reported that it was essential to be aware of the readiness level of stakeholders.
She then began to comment on other factors in her account of the responsiveness of
research. Sam identified the importance of having a complete program and giving
285
staff time to become familiar with it. Meg, who supported the need to be responsive
to changing setting and stakeholder needs in her survey and initial interview
comments, later reported that she showed the staff what they were going to do and
they didn’t question anything.
I gave them readings, it was the PD, you know you find the level the people
are at, you have to find their level so it is meaningful. They were happy to do
it, cause they had the whole program, they didn’t have to do anything. They
had time to just get used to it because they had it, they had time to get
comfortable with it (Sam, 2009b, p.6).
Meg also described that she did not expect her staff members to prepare the research-
based project. The difference between Meg and Sam’s report was that Sam
commented on the time the staff had to become familiar with the project. Meg
described that she was predominantly the person who shared the knowledge of the
project and staff followed her lead.
It was mainly me, I did give them the PowerPoint based on what I had done
with the lecturers on the course beforehand to show them that this is what
they were going to do. They didn’t really question anything, but I suppose
that’s because they hadn’t done it before. They had knowledge of it. It was as
far as me telling them as much as I could during the power point, but because
they hadn’t experienced it before they had to go on what I was telling them
(Meg, 2009b, p.4).
I reported that when direct instruction was given without the opportunity for
collaborative decision-making and shared ownership, change became difficult. The
same staff had experienced a new principal with the second leader and had
286
responded well to this change. Yet I reported that the third principal was more
authoritarian in his approach and the response to change was not as positive. Both
cases that reported a negative response to change gradually became extinct.
5.27. The implementation and sustainment of research based projects is an
ongoing process
Participants identified that the implementation and sustainment of research-based
projects is an ongoing process not a singular event. Reports made by participants in
the previous 15 categories presented have identified that single factors cannot exist
in isolation if projects are to be sustained in school applications. Diane, Mary and
Sam reports during their interviews represent the sentiment of all participants when
they identify that projects that assist many people in a school community have an
increased capacity to continue to be sustained if they continue to prove to be
beneficial.
I guess this one gets the results as it helps the whole school it is not KLA
specific (Diane, 2009b, p.5).
It is purposeful and non judgmental and benefits us all (Mary, 2009b, p.5).
The fact that it was working made people want to pick it up and run with it. It
just keeps building (Sam, 2009b, p.6).
5.28. Summary of the factors identified by participants during the
explanation phase
All of the factors included in the survey, which were identified in the RTP literature
were reported as having a positive impact on the implementation and sustainment of
research projects, other the need for acknowledgement and reward. Meg was the
287
only participant who continued to mentioned reward when she stated that she did not
receive any financial gains for coming into school to prepare resources on her day
off.
Diane presented unique observations from her high school experiences. She reported
on the need for projects to be given status so that they are included on school
timetables due to the increased number of stakeholders involved in secondary
settings. She also expressed that a collaborative approach to bullying is essential for
students not to be targeted when participating in projects.
Reports about the need for personal traits such as passion, endurance and
determination were presented by five of the six participants. These factors went
beyond the need for enthusiasm of stakeholders as identified in the RTP literature.
Comments about the positive impact of visual organizers such as graphs and the
strengths experienced through the support of parents were also presented in the
interview responses of three of the six participants.
Sam was the only participant who expressed the importance of identifying the
readiness of staff to implement the projects at her school. She reported that the key
was moving staff forward from there. Yet all participants commented on the teacher
education experience and their growth during and after that experience. All
participants presented the strengths of the step-by-step structure of the course as a
key beneficial feature during both the surveys and the interviews. The structure of
the course was reported as having a positive impact on building our capacity.
In five of the six cases, participants linked the new knowledge gained through their
participation in the TE course to their increased status and the increased confidence
in their depth of knowledge and ability by staff members or parents. The importance
288
of the depth of knowledge could not be separated from teacher education experience
and comments on competing demands were not independent from reports on
leadership by any of the six participants.
5.29. Comparison of the data collected through the explanation and
exploration phases
The responses collected through this second phase (explanation) of data collection
built on the data collected through the first phase (exploration). This second phase
went further to explain how factors introduced by participants during the first phase
of this research impacted upon the implementation, sustainment, scaling or
extinction of six research-based projects in school settings.
During the surveys and first round of interviews conducted in the exploration phase,
all participants gave priority to broad statements of accessibility, feasibility and
practicality of projects in addressing genuine needs of the students within their
schools. Broad reports about the intensity and depth of the teacher education
experience and the strong impact of leadership support on the sustainment of projects
were also presented. The following descriptions provide an overview of the accounts
of the factors that contributed to the sustainability of the projects of individual
participants. These reports provided increased understanding through the stronger
description and clarification of the RTP experienced by participants as they moved
through the first two phases of this research.
5.29.1. Chris
During the exploration phase I gave priority to the importance of time, staff support
and material/resource supports when implementing and sustaining research based
projects. The need for these supports was echoed during this explanation phase. My
289
account of staff support was expanded to describe the positive impact of staff
enthusiasm for the project when the project was perceived as being beneficial to
students. During the second interview priority was given to the extent to which the
project was scalable, flexible and responsive to the changing needs of the setting.
The responses were consistent with those provided to earlier questions on usability,
trustworthiness and accessibility.
Through the semi-structured interviews I built on my survey and initial interview
responses by linking collaboration items to teacher education. I reported that teacher
education has the capacity to promote the use of research-based practices through
raising awareness of the skills required within these factors. I explained that
knowledge gained through comprehensive teacher education efforts can be shared
with school based staff to further promote the use of research based practices and
link theory and practice efforts.
During the explanation phase my responses were extended to propose that the
consistency across subjects in the Masters course was beneficial in promoting the
transfer of knowledge to other staff members. The demanding but equally beneficial
nature of the course was attributed to our increased depth of knowledge that was
shared with school-based staff through readings and professional development
sessions.
Through the exploration phase I reported on the importance of leadership support to
the status of my project. The responses to the survey were consistent with comments
made during open-ended and semi structured interviews about the impact of strong
leadership support for the project and the consequences of the withdrawal of this
support. The leadership factors, which I proposed to be important to the
290
implementation and sustainment of my DIBELS project, became more evident as
they were withdrawn. The strong status of my project began to reduce with the new
leadership in 2008 prior to becoming extinct in 2009. The changes in the leadership
style were also consistent with my reduction in support for key factors across all
identified themes.
5.29.2. Mary
Mary gave priority to the importance of time for her staff to implement and maintain
a research-based project during the exploration phase. This need was echoed during
the explanation phase as Mary’s report was expanded to describe how her project
was worked into the school timetable. She stated that her project became part of the
whole school literacy block and as a result became part of the scheduled daily
routines at her school.
During the first interview Mary reported that she initially prepared resources herself.
This was clarified in the second interview when Mary stated that and as the project
became a school focus, other staff members were allocated time to assist in the
preparation. Mary stated that the shared preparation reduced the demands on her
time. She suggested that these factors also positively impacted the project’s
scalability. As the project grew and became a whole school focus, Mary stated that
its status within the school increased. This increased status assisted in promoting and
prioritising the project over other competing demands. Mary explained that the
increased status of the project ensured the allocation of sufficient instructional and
resource time within her setting.
The need for evaluation and feedback to be ongoing throughout the projects rather
than being added at the end (emergent), were not identified during the exploration
291
phase, yet were rated as a high priority in Part 2 of the survey. During the
explanation phase Mary explained that this type of emergent feedback needed to be
woven into the project as it provided guidance to stakeholders on what to do next.
Mary also emphasised the need for sufficient instructional time to ensure
stakeholders were familiar with and could access project details. During the
explanation phase Mary reported that for evaluation to be effective it should be
ongoing, timely and responsive to actions rather than being added to the end of
phases.
Mary’s low survey ratings for positive peer responses were not consistent with other
high ratings. Mary clarified this difference during the second interview as she
identified the difficulties she experienced when moving away from the previous
approach the school used to teach phonics to Kindergarten. Mary reported that the
new approach to teaching phonics represented a significant change. She explained
that this change in approach did cause some concern for stakeholders but it did not
prevent her project from being implemented, sustained and scaled as all other
support factors were evident.
During the semi-structured interview Mary went further and explained how these
factors contributed to the increased status of the project, as it became part of the
school policy. Mary described how the accessibility of the project and the use of
technology enhanced her project’s scalability. She stated that the project was easy to
implement and provided teachers with data they could easily download and use to
plan instruction. Mary reported that this feature of her project assisted in making it
responsive to students changing needs.
292
The most resonant priority identified by Mary was the importance of research-based
projects being comprehensive, accessible and practical. During the explanation phase
Mary suggested these features were essential for projects to address genuine
questions, problems and solutions. This was consistent with original comments
linking accessibility of projects to the schools focus. These features were expanded
to suggest that projects also require the potential to be scaled and the effective
adoption of key features to be effective in meeting the needs of the setting. She also
described the significance of the lived experience of the Masters course to her project
status. Like me, Mary reported that the Masters course contributed to promoting the
depth of knowledge and skills required to transfer and implement key features that
promote the sustainment and scaling of research based projects.
5.29.3. Diane
During the exploration phase Diane’s responses indicated the importance of
consistent leadership and peer support, and adequate instruction and time. The need
for these supports was echoed during the explanation phase. Notions of adequate
instruction were expanded to suggest that experts should come to schools to deliver
relevant professional development opportunities to the whole staff. Diane went
further and suggested that experts should work with the school to develop whole
school policies based on validated research.
During the exploration phase Diane described her personal determination as a
driving support for the project. She also noted the importance of whole school
ownership and support when implementing and sustaining research-based projects.
Support factors that were not identified in the exploration phase, yet were rated as a
high priority in Part 2 of the survey included the need for projects to be central to
293
student learning along with the need for communication and feedback from multiple
stakeholders to be woven into project design.
The most important priority identified in the area of support during this explanation
phase was whole school ownership for the project. The responses to the survey were
consistent with comments made during both interviews about the need for a
determined approach by the project leader. Diane indicated that when personal
determination is merged with whole school ownership and support, research based
projects can take on a life of their own. Diane explained that a project takes on a life
of its own by becoming part of the day-to-day occurrences of the school.
During the survey and interview in the exploration phase Diane gave priority to the
importance of cooperation, frequent communication and engagement in genuine
questions, problems and solutions. During the semi-structured interview Diane
expanded on these factors to describe how collaborative efforts were necessary to
address the challenging situation that emerged when students were teased for
participating in the program. She attributed the knowledge required to implement
and sustain her project to her teacher education experience. Diane suggested that PD
meetings and staff development days were structured around the skills and
knowledge she had gained through the consistent approach of the Masters’ course.
As with Mary’s and my case Diane proposed that strong teacher education
experiences have the capacity to promote the use of research based practices through
raising awareness of the skills and factors required to link theory to practice.
The most resonant priority identified by Diane was the importance of the project’s
potential to scale and ensuring that project has the features required for
sustainability. This was consistent with Diane’s original notions of usability,
294
trustworthiness and accessibility. Diane expanded upon her original statements and
suggested that when projects have the potential to be scaled, they can address the
needs of the whole school. Diane explained that her experiences served to
demonstrate that when projects are accessible and useful, they can become a priority
and part of the life of the school. Diane suggested that through exerting a whole
school influence, her project became effective in meeting the needs of the setting by
addressing the identified gap.
Diane reported that the depth of knowledge and ability to share it with other staff
members contributed to the successful scaling of her project within her school in
2008 and beyond her setting in 2009. The importance of these factors on the
implementation, sustainment and scaling of Diane’s projects became evident as the
status of her project increased. This increased status within the school became
apparent as the project was identified as a priority by the staff and included on the
school annual calendar.
5.29.4. Wilma
During the exploration phase Wilma reported on the importance of adequate time,
leadership support and material/resources in implementing and sustaining research-
based projects. Notions of support were expanded to include the positive impact of
parental support on the sustainment of the project during the explanation phase.
During the exploration phase Wilma described the importance of principal support
and the need for strong and accessible research knowledge in implementing and
sustaining her project. During the explanation phase Wilma went further to describe
her principal’s modification to her timetable to give her extra time to share her
295
knowledge and train others. Wilma added that her project became more prominent in
the life of the school as the knowledge and skills of other staff members grew.
Support factors that were not identified in the exploration phase, yet were rated as a
high priority in Part 2 of the survey included the need to enhance feedback,
evaluation and communication by weaving it into the project design. The need for
support to be responsiveness to changing needs of the setting was also presented as a
priority through the explanation phase. The most important priority expressed by
Wilma during this explanation phase was her depth of knowledge. Wilma reported
that she gained the depth of knowledge required to implement and sustain her project
and increase its status through the teacher education course. The responses to the
survey were consistent with comments made during open-ended and semi-structured
interviews about the impact of solid research based knowledge.
During the exploration phase Wilma gave priority to the usability and accessibility of
research-based projects. More specifically, this factor was predominately viewed in
terms of the project being simple and easy to administer and monitor. During the
explanation phase Wilma went further and presented accessibility in terms of the
project becoming part of the school’s day-to-day occurrences. She reflected on how
the project was valuable and based on standardised and accessible data to identify
student improvement.
During this explanation phase Wilma also made reference to her passion and its
impact on a project’s intensity and scalability potential. Wilma described her project
as having the potential to be scaled and its ease of implementation. Unlike the other
participants Wilma went further to suggest that it is hard to disseminate a person’s
passion for a project unless it is considered to be valuable. She made reference to the
296
status of her project and stated that she believed it scaled quickly as her passion was
disseminated across the whole school and it was perceived as being purposeful by
both staff and students.
At the conclusion of the second interview Wilma reported that as a result of her
practical experience she had learnt that the “tiny things” collectively contributed to
the status of her project. Wilma stated that many factors combine to create a united
effort that is understood and shared by all stakeholders and that this merger was
essential to her project being scaled within her setting in 2008 and beyond in 2009.
5.29.5. Sam
During the exploration phase Sam’s reported on the importance of using projects that
directly support teachers by addressing their needs. Sam also prioritised building
rapport and capacity through sufficient preparation during the exploration phase. The
need for these supports was echoed during the explanation phase. The notion of
building capacity was expanded to describe the need for a common and
comprehensive understanding of educational terms. Sam explained that at her setting
the term explicit teaching was used to describe school practices. Sam explained that
completing the Master’s course had given her an accurate understanding of what
explicit teaching was. She went further to suggest that prior to the course she and her
fellow staff members had not really comprehended the key components required to
make explicit teaching effective.
During this explanation phase Sam expressed that being part of a cohort was another
effective way of supporting the needs of teachers. She described that she had
completed the same Master’s Course with another staff member at her school. Sam
297
went further to state that having two people who shared the same teacher education
experience at the same setting was advantageous.
During the exploration phase Sam described that building rapport made the
implementation of her research based project easier. Sam expanded on the ways to
develop rapport during the explanation phase. Sam reported that she gained
increased knowledge through staff questionnaires of their aspirations, intentions and
prior knowledge. Sam stated that this approach was effective in building rapport and
the success of the project as it raised awareness of where individual staff members
were. Sam added that she believed that this knowledge was required prior to the
project effectively moving forward.
Support factors that were not identified in the exploration phase and rated as a high
priority in Part 2 of the survey included the need for opportunities for feedback from
multiple stakeholders to be woven into project design. The most important priority
identified in the area of support during this explanation phase was the need for a
scaffolded course in building teacher capacity. Sam explained that teacher education
experiences that are clear in their sequence and expectations can effectively build
research based knowledge and skills within teachers.
During the exploration phase Sam gave priority to the importance of collaboration,
cooperation and feedback. Sam’s initial responses were extended during the
explanation phase to suggest that groups that are collaborative may not always be
harmonious, yet shared language and understanding is essential. Through the semi-
structured interviews Sam went further to link her knowledge of collaboration
factors to the course framework implemented in her teacher education experience.
During the explanation phase, Sam gave priority to the need for teacher training
298
courses that are practical. Sam explained that this can be achieved by having
essential knowledge embodied into the theoretical structure of courses. Sam further
explained that when teacher education courses are complete, comprehensive and
practical with key features woven into their framework, they are better able to
reinforce essential learning.
During the exploration phase Sam, like Wilma indicated that the scalability
component of her project allowed it to be implemented as school policy. This was
extended during the explanation phase to outline that stakeholders require both the
theoretical knowledge and skills prior to effective scalability of research-based
programs in practical applications. Sam described that engagement of both
theoretical and practical knowledge and skills are essential to the implementation of
research-based programs. Sam reported that by weaving these elements together, a
reinforcing effect can occur which enhances a project’s potential to be scaled in
practical applications.
The responsiveness of research factors that were not identified in the exploration
phase, yet were rated as a high priority in Part 2 of the survey included the need for
projects to be self-reinforcing and to be able to respond to the personal growth of
stakeholders. During the expansion phase Sam stated that she built rapport and
capacity by breaking key components into manageable steps. She also identified the
importance of a shared language on the implementation and sustainment of her
project in 2007 and it’s scaling within her setting in 2008 and beyond in 2009.
5.29.6. Meg
During the exploration phase Meg’s responses indicated the importance of adequate
materials, leadership and collegial support and preparation time. Like all the other
299
participants, Meg echoed the need for these supports during this explanation phase.
Meg expanded on these support items as she described them in relation to the status
of her project. Meg was the only participant that stated that the additional non-paid
work time she allocated to the project during the implementation stage contributed to
its success. She added that she did not have the additional time required to maintain
and support the project as it was expanded. Meg described the differences in the
level of collegial support she experienced throughout the project. She explained that
the level of collegial support did not expand as the project was expanded. She went
further to suggest that when RTP factors, such as time and support from colleagues
are not extended with the growth of projects, the project will move closer to
extinction.
During the exploration phase Meg shared the sentiment of all other participants as
she described the intensity and depth of knowledge she gained through the Masters
course. Through the explanation stage Meg went further to explain the benefit of the
Gannt chart to her project planning. She suggested that the course had given her
usable and practical knowledge that was critical for theory to become practice.
Factors within the support theme that were not identified in the exploration phase
and were rated highly in Part 2 of the survey included the need for opportunities for
feedback to be woven into project design. Like Sam, Meg explained that this type of
emergent feedback also created an opportunity to address stakeholder needs as they
were identified.
During the second round of interviews Meg suggested that for projects to be scaled
successful, sufficient preparation time with support from old and new colleagues is
required. Meg reported that the level of effort and time required to address these
300
factors should have changed with the projects status. Meg stated that as not all
stakeholders were committed to scaling the project, there was not the required
support from colleagues, time or positive team dynamics essential to sustaining the
project as it grew. Meg stated that these elements gradually contributed to her project
not scaling well and becoming extinct over time.
During the exploration phase Meg gave priority to the importance of the project
being research driven, manageable and reflective of the needs of students and staff.
This was expanded during the explanation phase when Meg explained that the
structure and content of the assignments she completed as a part of her Masters
course assisted in ensuring her project was research driven and manageable. She
suggested that the course readings and assignments assisted in empowering her with
the practical and theoretical knowledge required to implement her project at her
school.
Factors that were not identified in the exploration phase and were rated as a high
priority in Part 2 of the survey for 2006-2007, included the need for projects to have
validated scalability potential, be self reinforcing and to be a good contextual fit.
Meg reported that projects would become extinct if the merger of both practical and
theoretical elements does not exist. During the second interview Meg described the
decision to scale the project was made at an executive level without consulting other
staff members. The negative impact of the rapid scaling of the project without
consultation with the stakeholders and the heavy load experienced by the project
coordinator became more apparent as the project began to deteriorate in 2008 and
became extinct in 2009.
301
5.30. Summary
The reports collected through the explanation phase describe how the factors
introduced in the exploration phase and other factors asserted in the RTP literature
impacted upon the implementation, sustainment or extinction of individual RTP
project. Through all six cases the responses made during the semi-structured
interviews were consistent with and expanded on the written survey responses and
comments made during open-ended interviews.
Through the explanation phase the importance of the relationship among RTP factors
became apparent. The positive relationship between factors became evident as each
project was successfully implemented. This positive interconnection between factors
increased with the scaling of four projects over the course of this study. The negative
impact of the reduction or removal of key RTP factors was evident in the events
leading to the extinction of both Meg’s and my project.
The relationship between collaboration taught in the TE program and the need for a
complete framework that weaves practical experiences into a theoretical framework
were important factors, which linked to the benefits of emergent feedback. All
participants suggested that feedback was most effective when it was woven into the
project. This use of feedback was modelled in the Masters course and replicated
during the implementation stages of all six projects. It continued through all phases
of the four scaled projects. Collaboration was promoted through the use of a
common language that was understood by all. This increased comprehension of key
project features, enhancing accessibility, trustworthiness and in turn the usability of
projects. The use of clear communication, feedback and shared goals was also shown
to promote trustworthiness between the academics and practitioners and the projects.
302
Through working together to develop a shared understanding and links between
theory (academic perspective) and practice (classroom teacher perspective), all
participants felt prepared to effectively use the framework modelled in their TE
experience to share skills and knowledge essential to the implementation and sustain
their project with school based stakeholders.
The acknowledgement, recognition and reward of stakeholder efforts and for
identified student gains were shown to enhance the use of the project. Leadership
support also promoted the interconnection of required project enhancing factors.
This was evident through the successful implementation of all projects. The support
of the leadership team contributed to the allocation of the required time, resources
and increased project status within schools. The removal of the leadership supports
in my project highlighted how this directly contributed to the breakdown in the
interconnection of required factors such as time, shared responsibility and
communication opportunities. This lack of support directly contributed to a reduction
in project status by increasing demands placed on staff members.
These results indicate that implementing a research-based project is a process and
not a single event as successful implementation is dependent on the interconnection
of a combination of RTP factors. This interaction of factors is critical to enhancing
the sustainment of research-based projects in practical applications and without this
interconnection the success of research based project sustainment will be
compromised.
The following section describes the expansion phase, the third and final phase of this
research. The expansion phase concludes the data collection process with a focus
group session.
303
5.31. Explanation phase results across the six cases
Key RTP factors have been identified and explained through the practical
experiences of six specific RTP cases that were investigated using the replication
logic identified in the Methods chapter. The interaction of those factors has been
identified through the comparison of sustained, scaled and extinct RTP cases. A
summary of the key factors and their connections that have exerted an influence on
the status of each case are presented in this cross case analysis. They are informed by
data collected within each of the sub themes; support, collaboration and
responsiveness of research.
5.32. Key RTP factors and their connections
The following section presents an overview of the factors and their connections that
were presented as important to the implementation, sustainment and scalability of
RBP by the research participants.
5.32.1. Masters Course/Teacher Education
The depth of knowledge gained through the Masters course was identified as a
support by each research participant and was referred to in the data collected across
each of the sub themes. This teacher education experience was prioritised as a key
RTP factor as it was identified as being critical to the understanding of skills,
knowledge and attitudes essential to collaboration and to ensuring research could
respond to the needs of individual settings. There was also consistency across all
research participants in their responses about the effectiveness of the course structure
as it presented essential theoretical knowledge through consistent practical
components. These practical components included advanced organisers which
presented expectations graphically at the start of every unit and the consistency in
304
delivery and structure across subjects. The assessment tasks were effective in
building the Masters students’ capacity, as they were relevant to school settings. All
participants stated that the course was demanding and equally beneficial in
increasing the depth of research based knowledge and the ability to be instrumental
in implementing it. The merging of theoretical and practical components was
described as being highly effective in delivering new knowledge and preparing
students in their ability to transfer the newly gained skills and knowledge with other
school based educators.
All participants were part of the same Master’s course and presented differences in
comments about the type of support they gained from their teacher education
experience. These various types of support provided by the teacher education
experience ranged from Meg’s responses that highlighted the benefits of practical
tools such as the Gannt chart to Sam’s explanation of the advantages in ensuring
consistency in comprehension of a common educational language and the way that
language was used to communicate knowledge across all stakeholders. Sam also
identified the benefits of having a colleague whom she completed the course with at
her setting.
5.32.2. Collaboration
Collaboration was presented as being essential to the implementation, sustainment
and scaling of Wilma’s, Sam’s, Mary’s and Diane’s projects. The reduction in
collaboration levels contributed to the extinction of Meg’s and my projects through
the reduction in opportunities for communication, shared responsibility and
ownership. All participants linked their depth of knowledge of the elements required
to promote collaboration within their schools to their Masters course experience.
305
Mary described that the course structure encouraged a “lived experience” in that
there was an expectation that an action that incorporated a demonstration of new
knowledge would follow. Diane stated that through modelling the course structure
she was able to share knowledge about collaboration in a similar way with school
staff members through staff meetings, professional readings and staff development
days. Sam and Wilma stated that through their project scaling experiences they
learned that when courses are complete and comprehensive with practical
experiences woven into their framework, they have the capacity to reinforce essential
learning. They explained that through collaborative efforts teachers can be prepared
to implement projects as a whole rather than in parts.
Both Meg and I also attributed our depth of collaboration knowledge to our TE
experience. Through our project implementation experience we recognised the need
for united efforts that were understood and shared by all. Meg identified that the
decision to rapidly scale her project was not made collaboratively. She also
expressed that the project workload was not shared and that no additional time was
allocated to enhance communication opportunities as the project was scaled. Meg
indicated that these factors contributed to the extinction of her project. My project
was scaled successfully with strong support from all stakeholders until the new
principal and deputy arrived. They were not committed to the project and this
reduced the schools united effort and support for the project, which ultimately
contributed to the extinction of the project.
The need for united efforts that were based on cooperation, respect and engagement
in pursuit of genuine questions, problems and solutions were identified by all
participants. Mary and Diane identified that shared responsibility; ownership and
306
enthusiasm grew as the project addressed genuine concerns across her school. Sam
explained that collaborative cultures may not always be harmonious but a shared
language and common goals are essential. Mary explained that with opportunities to
promote substantive and frequent interactions her project was able to address a
genuine need and it became part of the school policy. This shared responsibility and
ownership led to the increased status of the project, which led to increased stability
and comfort. Both Meg and I identified the need for alignment of the project and
school’s goals with shared ownership and unity. It became clear that the status of our
projects significantly reduced as the unity in support and allocation of time for our
projects reduced.
5.32.3. Leadership
All participants identified leadership as a key support and all experienced a change
in leadership personnel. Five out of six participants described that the new principals
supported their project. Wilma described the increased traction gained when her
personal determination was combined with the support of her principal, whilst I
described the impact of the removal of leadership support on the trajectory of my
project. Differences in leadership style had a positive and negative impact at
individual settings. At five out of six settings the new principals sought to gain a
deeper understanding of the project. They supported the projects once they identified
the gains resulting from their implementation. At my setting the new leadership
regime did not have an interest in learning about the project. They did not share the
same common understandings of educational terms as existing staff members. They
also introduced additional responsibilities without the allocation of additional time
and support. These factors had a negative impact on the status of my project, whilst
the change in leadership did not have an adverse impact at the other settings.
307
5.32.4. Time
All participants suggested that time is a critical factor required to support the
practical application and sustainment of research based projects in school settings.
Time was linked to the scalability of projects in different ways. These examples
ranged from Wilma’s description of the modification of her timetable to allow her
time to work with others, while Meg described that she did not have the time
required to make resources or provide instruction as her project was expanded. Mary
described how that status of her project increased to a whole school priority and this
brought an increase in time allocated to her project. As a result it was prioritized
above other competing demands. Diane, Meg and Mary commented on the
importance of timely evaluation and feedback.
5.32.5. Feedback
All six participants commented on the value of feedback being woven into the design
of the project. Effective feedback was identified as being specific, relevant, timely
and beneficial in guiding future directions or activities. Sam clearly described that
when feedback is detailed, relevant and timely it can guide knowledge of ways to
enhance the next phase of the project and cater for stakeholder needs as they occur.
Sam also described how she gained knowledge of the readiness levels, intentions and
aspirations of staff members through surveys. She stated that this knowledge is
critical to directly supporting and addressing stakeholder needs. I described the
positive impact of staff enthusiasm for the project, whilst Diane presented her
personal determination for the project to succeed as a driving force. Wilma
commented on the need for resilience and commitment to the success of her project
and Meg described the negative impact of the lack of collegial support as her project
was expanded.
308
The need for consistency in feedback and opportunities for feedback from multiple
perspectives was presented by all participants as a way of ensuring that projects
remain responsive to student needs. Feedback that is woven into the project design
and is emergent (Berends et al., 2001) rather than being given at the conclusion of
the project was said to be more effective and enhance flexibility so that the projects
can continue to address the changing needs of staff and students.
5.32.6. Project scalability with a complete approach
All participants shared the view that the research project needed to have the potential
to be scaled so that it can have a whole school influence. Mary and I explained that
the scalability of a project can be enhanced through the use and accessibility of
technology. Mary identified the importance of scaling projects within time frames
that are effective and responsive to the needs of the stakeholders.
Wilma indicated that through a complete approach and engagement of strong project
features, the likelihood of scalability and project success are enhanced. Sam
supported this and added that through the weaving of accessibility, feasibility and the
practicality of her project a reinforcing effect occurred which enhanced the
scalability of her project as practical and theoretical components were merged.
In summary the 6 identified RTP areas and the connections described within and
across them were used to inform the construction of the guiding focus group
questions. The focus group represented the final phase of the data collection for this
study and it sought to gain a complete and comprehensive account across the total
participant cohort of how research-based projects were and could be successfully
implemented and sustained across diverse practical applications.
309
5.33. Expansion Phase Results
The expansion phase is the third and final stage of data collection. It went beyond
previous phases to present a deeper understanding of those RTP factors and the
connections among them that influenced the implementation and subsequent status
of six RTP cases. The expansion phase built on the previous exploration and
explanation phases by extending the scope of the study to provide the first focus
group session. The focus group presented an opportunity for an in-depth collective
discussion by participants of how and why RTP factors exerted an influence on the
trajectories of the cases. This phase also sought to identify any additional RTP
factors reported by participants that were not sourced through the literature or
participant responses during previous phases. These results are used to respond to the
following research question:
What factors, other than those identified in the exploration and expansion phases,
contribute to the status of RBP in inclusive education settings?
Additional question established after the analysis of the data collection through the
exploration and explanation phases- What were the differences and consistencies in
the relationships between the RTP factors that contributed to the status of the
projects that were identified by the research participants?
The focus group questions created to respond to this research question were derived
from the previous data collected from surveys, Master’s projects, and interviews
conducted through the exploration and explanation phases (see Methods chapter).
The key priorities extrapolated from these responses were used to develop the focus
group questions. These questions reflected the key priorities identified during
310
previous phases. The questions then proceeded to seek a deeper understanding of
how the RTP factors and their relationships contributed to the status of the cases.
The chapter is presented in three sections. The first section presents a summary of
the organizational details of the focus group. This is followed by the consistencies in
the RTP factors and their connections that were described and prioritized by the
research participants. The second section presents the inconsistencies identified in
the discussion when compared with the results of other phases. The status of the
individual cases will be presented with participant responses throughout this
expansion phase. The third section provides an overview of the data collected
through the exploration, explanation and expansion phase of this study. It concludes
with the presentation of figures that identify the significant relationships that
contributed to the scalability or extinction of the individual cases.
5.34. Summary of the structure of the focus group
All members of the group were known to each other and arrived on time. They
gathered for afternoon tea and were briefed on the procedure of the session. They
were comfortable with one another and appeared eager to share accounts of their
experiences. The structure of the focus group provided an open forum for discussion
for the participants and continued for 75 minutes. I facilitated the session to maintain
its flow and was available to address any group dynamic issues as they arose. Given
my role of participant researcher, I chose to maintain the role of facilitator so as not
to influence participants with my responses (see Methods chapter). The focus group
was videotaped to display verbal and non-verbal elements such as gestures, facial
expressions, articulated exchanges and pauses. Initially participants were a little
anxious about the video recorder. After 5 minutes they did relax and seemed
311
unaware of the video recording that was taking place. This process allowed for
repeated studying of the session and cross checking of discussions and body
language.
5.35. Key RTP priorities identified through the connections of the RTP
factors
The following section presents an overview of the consistency in factors identified,
and the connections among them in the areas of implementation, sustainment,
scalability or extinction of individual research to practice cases. This section is
organized around the group responses to the focus group questions. It is structured
according to the four key areas that represented the priorities extrapolated from the
group discussion. These areas include: collaboration and feedback, scalability and
time, leadership and teacher education.
The focus group questions that related to each of these areas are presented within
them. These questions follow a statement which links the question to the data
collected through the previous phases. The focus group question sought additional
clarity and details on the area introduced. The questions were followed by a
description of the discussion that unfolded within and across the unique school
settings. The discussion was not limited to the guiding questions. They were created
to encourage an in-depth discussion to enhance the comprehension of the RTP
factors and their interrelationships that consistently emerged within and across
specific RTP cases. The questions are grouped together and are presented at the start
of each of the areas. The group discussion is presented within the areas rather than as
a response to individual questions to avoid repetition and to identify the
312
interrelationships prioritised by participants prior to subsequent questions within the
same area being asked.
5.36. Collaboration and feedback
5.36.1. Focus group questions
All 6 case studies within this project identified the importance of shared
responsibility and ownership in implementing and sustaining Research Based
Projects (RBP) in schools. How can shared responsibility and ownership be achieved
and scaled up?
Collaboration has also been cited as a critical factor in implementing and sustaining
RBP in schools. A comment was made about collaboration not always being
harmonious and there is sometimes a need to push boundaries in some communities
of practice to get things done. What can be done in schools to foster respectful
disagreement without animosity?
Voluntary teacher or stakeholder participation in the project and student gain has
been suggested as key RTP components through literature based assertions as well as
data collected from this research. How do you ensure maximum student opportunity
if teacher participation is voluntary and not all teachers want to participate? (For
example a student would likely benefit from the RBP but the class teacher doesn’t
want to participate).
5.36.2. Responses
The focus group began with a discussion on collaboration. Collaboration was
described to be a situation where stakeholders all worked together to meet a common
goal. There was a subject in the course about collaboration with a compulsory
313
assessment which involved developing a PD module on collaboration for use in
schools. This assessment and unit was described as highly beneficial and practical. It
was presented as being critical to implementing and sustaining research based
projects in schools through all three phases of this study. During this phase
participants provided additional details that described and linked the many factors
that were reported to enhance collaboration within and across their schools. There
was a consensus that the knowledge and skills gained from the Masters Course
experience greatly assisted with the implementation and sustainment of the projects.
Participants agreed with Mary’s description that the course structure encouraged a
“lived experience.” Meg added that throughout the course there was an expectation
that an action, which incorporated a demonstration of new knowledge, would be
followed by the expectation that we would demonstrate how we would share this
new knowledge with our school-based colleagues. Diane interjected that through
modelling the course structure in her school she was able to share knowledge about
collaboration in a similar way with staff members. She elaborated by describing that
this was done through staff meetings, professional readings and staff development
days. Sam and Wilma reported that as their project became scaled, they realised that
when courses are complete and comprehensive with practical experiences woven
into their framework, they have the capacity to reinforce essential learning. Sam and
Wilma linked their experiences of the scalability of their projects to collaboration
when they explained that collaborative efforts are essential for teachers to be able to
implement projects as a whole rather than in parts.
During the discussion participants continued to link multiple factors identified
through previous phases when recounting the importance of collaboration on the
status of their projects. A strong consensus that well designed teacher education
314
opportunities can contribute to teachers feeling sufficiently prepared and that this
creates an avenue for research based practices to be effectively used in classrooms
was expressed. The discussion moved to reinforcing the importance of linking
factors so that other stakeholders are encouraged to be involved in the projects.
Mary, whose project was scaled within and beyond her setting, provided a summary
of the relationship between key elements identified by participants as critical if
projects are to survive in school-based applications:
To get people involved, they needed to be taught the processes (the
procedures, expectations and responsibilities required to implement and
sustain the projects), they needed to get up to speed with it. Up skilling and
empowering the whole staff so the whole school was aware of the project and
its details. It needs to be appealing in that it needs to be easy, doable quick to
administer and realistic in time expectations. The website was also useful.
(Mary as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.5).
Both Meg and I attributed our depth of collaboration knowledge to our TE
experience even though our projects became extinct. We described that as the
strength and status of our projects began to reduce, the importance of previously
identified collaborative cultures became increasingly evident. Through our project
implementation experience we recognised and reported a need for united efforts that
were understood and shared by all. Meg explained that the decision to rapidly scale
her project was not made collaboratively. She also expressed that the project
workload was not shared and that no additional time was allocated to enhance
communication opportunities as the project was scaled. Meg stated that the
collection of these factors contributed to the extinction of her project. I reported that
315
project was scaled successfully with strong support from all stakeholders until the
second new principal and deputy arrived. I explained how the new leaders were not
committed to the project and this reduced the schools united effort and support for
the project. I suggested that it was the breakdown in the strong relationship between
these factors that ultimately contributed to the extinction of the project.
Collaboration was again linked to the Masters course as participants expressed that
the course increased their depth of knowledge of the complexities required to
enhance collaborative cultures. The importance of collaboration was again echoed by
all through the discussion. There was an agreement that collaboration did not always
have to be harmonious. Participants suggested and there is sometimes a need to push
boundaries in some communities of practice to get things done. They recommended
ways that school staff could foster respectful disagreeing without animosity:
The improving of student outcomes needs to remain a central common goal.
Taking the personal nature out of it, taking the focus away from the teacher
or teaching and having it on improving student outcomes is the key (Sue as
cited in Focus group, 2009, p.5).
Yet you need to be aware that there will always be some people who may not
be happy due to other underlying issues or other variables but the common
goal without the personal agenda is how you can get passed that (Diane as
cited in Focus group, 2009, p.5).
The collaboration, feeling part of it is also important but keeping the children
as the essential focus. So adjustments may need to be made with the students
as the pivotal point (Mary as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.5).
316
General consensus from the four participants whose projects were successfully
scaled was that collaboration was critical to enhancing the strength of their
individual projects. Meg and I described how the reduction in collaboration at our
individual settings contributed to the extinction of our projects. We reported that the
reduction in collaboration within our settings led to the extinction of our projects due
to the decreased opportunities for communication, shared responsibility and
ownership.
Reports made through the focus group went beyond data collected through the
previous phases to link comments about collaboration to the need for ongoing
feedback. All participants supported those perspectives presented in the previous
phases that the value of feedback was increased when it was flexible and woven into
the design of the project. The discussion continued with a collection of suggestions
that combined to describe effective feedback as being specific, relevant, timely and
beneficial in guiding future directions or activities. Sam added to the discussion by
clearly describing that when feedback is detailed, relevant and timely it could guide
knowledge of ways to enhance the next phase of the project and cater for stakeholder
needs. Additional links with other factors were identified as Sam explained how she
gained knowledge of the readiness levels, intentions and aspirations of staff members
through surveys. She stated that this knowledge was critical to enhancing
collaborative cultures as it gave stakeholders the knowledge and capacity to directly
support and address the needs of others. Sam suggested that this interrelationship of
RTP factors assisted in the sustainment and scaling of her project. As the discussion
continued I described the benefits of the positive impact of staff enthusiasm for my
project, whilst Diane presented her personal determination for the project to succeed
as a driving force. Wilma commented on the need for resilience and commitment to
317
the success of her project and Meg described the negative impact of the lack of
collegial support, as her project was due to be expanded.
Mary and Wilma offered strategies to encourage less enthusiastic staff members to
become involved. These included collaborative weekly meetings to offer feedback
and discuss pros and cons that they had experienced during the project
implementation and sustainment phases of the projects. They suggested writing these
concerns and strengths in a journal and knowing that they had to share these entries
at weekly meetings was said to encourage staff to keep records. Mary and Wilma
added that this expected participation in weekly meetings encouraged ownership as
if they didn’t share or participate it would be evident to all at the meetings.
All participants supported Wilma’s claims “that once student gains were evident,
interest and growth in project ownership was a natural progression” (Wilma as cited
in Focus group, 2009, p.5). As the discussion continued, participants collectively
suggested ways to enhance interest in the project if student growth was not evident
early in the project implementation. All participants established that the project must
fit within the whole school plan and PD agenda and that all staff members need to
understand how it fits with opportunities for feedback and collaboration throughout.
It was suggested that this would allow staff members to be aware of when student
gains are expected. Teacher education and professional development were linked to
the increasing of knowledge and understanding required to comprehend key
components of the project. Feedback and collaboration within teacher education
courses was cited as being essential to support students and assist participants in
catering for the needs of stakeholders within their school settings. Meg and my
projects were the only projects that became extinct yet we both agreed and supported
318
these claims. I did add to the discussion by describing the contrasting impact of my
research-based project being part of the whole school plan and then being removed
from the whole school plan. All participants reinforced the importance of the
interrelationship between feedback, collaboration and whole school support as they
expressed that they comprehended the results of their withdrawal as my setting.
Meg went on to share her account of the lack of collegial support at her setting and
how that negatively impacted on the status of her project. This prompted a
discussion in which all participants agreed on the importance of shared responsibility
and ownership with inbuilt opportunities for feedback and communication when
implementing and sustaining their individual projects. During the focus group
session practical information on how to promote shared ownership and collaboration
was identified. All participants linked the accessibility of project information and
opportunities for feedback with increased knowledge of the project details to the
successful status of their projects. The skilling up of staff and informing them of all
project details was presented as being essential to making them feel valued,
empowered and responsible for the success of the project. There was a consensus in
the input of focus group members that project ownership was enhanced by the
project’s usability, appeal and feedback on student gains. All participants agreed that
projects that were easy, realistic, quick to administer, trustworthy and implemented
within manageable time expectations were more likely to elicit positive feedback and
be sustained.
The participants indicated a need for collaboration, including the requirement of
consistency in feedback and opportunities for feedback from multiple perspectives.
These factors were viewed as a way of ensuring that projects remained responsive to
319
student needs. The group agreed that as the projects unfolded it became evident that
feedback was more effective when it was woven into the design of the project rather
than given at the end. Sue confirmed the sentiment of all participants when she stated
that “feedback opportunities must be flexible so that the projects can continue to be
effective in addressing the changing needs of staff and students” (Sue as cited in
Focus group, 2009, p.4).
All participants agreed that collaboration, which included communication and
feedback from many stakeholders (from all levels) needed to be ongoing and
substantive so that it can be practical, relevant and timely. The relationship between
the RTP factors was further described as being more successful when feedback was
consistent and addressed teacher enthusiasm, personal qualities and the changing
needs of individual stakeholder’s and their setting.
The discussion then progressed to participants sharing their interpretation of the
critical links between factors required to promote collaborative cultures within and
across their settings. All participants described the need for united efforts based on
cooperation, respect and engagement in pursuit of genuine questions. The group
viewed these qualities as essential to the success of research-based projects. Mary
and Diane indicated that shared responsibility; ownership and enthusiasm grew as
the project addressed genuine concerns across their schools. Sam explained that
collaborative cultures may not always be harmonious but a shared language and
common goals are essential to achieving successful outcomes. Mary explained that
with opportunities to promote substantive and frequent interactions her project was
able to address a genuine need and it became part of the school policy. Participants
reported that this shared responsibility and ownership led to the increased status of
320
the project, which led to increased stability and comfort amongst stakeholders. Both
Meg and I identified the need for alignment of the project and school’s goals with
shared ownership and unity. It became clear that the status of our projects
significantly reduced as the unity in support and allocation of time for our projects
reduced.
5.37. Leadership
5.37.1. Focus group questions
In all 6 cases, school based leadership by principals and deputy principals have been
attributed with the ability to make or break RBP in schools. The previous phases it
was indicated that effective leaders should be flexible, approachable, be able to
provide consistency in support, be a good communicator, see things from multiple
view points, be a team player and be trusting. How can these attributes be fostered,
enhanced or mandated in current or future leaders?
An interesting comment was made in one case study about how effective leadership
is vital in driving the project without playing a main role. What could this look like?
How can effective leadership drive a project without playing a main role?
5.37.2. Responses
All participants elaborated on the importance of leadership through previous phases.
There was a strong consensus that leadership was a key contributor to the
sustainment of projects as it is directly linked to multiple factors that could enhance
support or conversely increase competing demands. The only time that the leadership
factor was referred to independently of other RTP factors was when participants
commented on the movement of their principals to or from another setting. All
participants described that they had experienced a change in leadership personnel.
321
Five out of six participants described that the principals who were newly appointed
to their schools throughout the sustainment or scaling stages of the projects all
supported the research-based projects.
As the discussion evolved around comments about leadership, it increasingly
identified connections to other RTP factors. Wilma described the increased traction
gained when her personal determination was combined with the support of her
principal, whilst I described the impact of the removal of leadership support on the
trajectory of my project. Differences in leadership style had a positive and negative
impact at individual settings. At five out of six settings, new principals sought to
gain a deeper understanding of the project. Those principals supported the projects
once they identified the gains resulting from their implementation and this had a
positive impact on the status of four out of the six cases. I shared an account of what
occurred at my setting when the new leadership regime did not have an interest in
learning about the project. I described that they did not share the same common
understandings of educational terms as existing staff members. They also placed
additional responsibilities on staff without the allocation of additional time and
support. The combination of these factors had a negative impact on the status of my
project; whilst the change in leadership did not have an adverse impact most of the
other settings. Wilma, Mary, Sam and Diane indicated that the support of their new
leaders had the opposite impact on the status of their projects. They described that in
each of their settings, their new leaders sought to comprehend the details of the
projects. Once the new leaders identified that the strengths of the projects
outweighed the challenges, they maintained or increased the allocation of time and
resources to the projects. Wilma, Mary, Sam and Diane were united in their claims
that the strengthening of the relationship between key factors including leadership
322
support, time, resources and project status significantly assisted in the scaling of
their projects.
Meg reported that her project had the strong support of her school leaders yet their
decision to promote the project and scale it without consulting with all stakeholders
contributed to its extinction. Meg’s experience highlighted the importance of the
relationship between key factors rather than single factors as she had the strong
support of her principal, yet her project still became extinct because of the lack of
collaboration, shared ownership and responsibility for project goals and resources by
other stakeholders.
Wilma, Mary, Sam, Diane who implemented projects that were successfully scaled
beyond their school, stated that their projects had a strong focus within their schools
because they were given status by the leadership team. They all expressed that
leadership support significantly increased the status of their projects and the
likelihood that those projects scaled as they were afforded greater traction in the
school. I explained that at the outset there was support for my project, which was
subsequently reversed with a change of leadership. As the new leadership reduced its
commitment to and focus on my project, the project’s status reduced and it
eventually became extinct.
Mary reported that principal support also improved the status of the learning support
teacher, which had a positive impact her projects sustainment and scalability. She
continued by describing the changes within the school system. Mary explained that
with the change in Directors of the education system, the commitment to special
education from the systems leaders had significantly reduced. All the other five
participants supported her comments and shared their concerns about the distinctive
323
difference between the directions of the previous and current leaders of the system
on the continuing successful sustainment of their RTP projects:
“In our system the status of a special education teacher has been reducing with the
changing leadership model within head office over the past 5 years (Focus group,
2009, p.4).”
Sue and Wilma agreed with Mary’s comments about the status of educators having
an impact on the success of the project. I added that the principal as well as the
system leaders interpretation of the status of the Special Education Teacher can also
have a positive or negative impact as their attitudes can have an impact on the whole
staff. Consensus was again reached when participants connected the knowledge
gained from the Master’s course with their status within the school and the system.
They explained that the course empowered them and gave them increased status
within the system. All participants then expressed that with a change of model and a
different vision of the new system’s leadership, their increased status significantly
reduced. It remained undisputed that the support for research based projects needs to
be provided at a systems level to ensure collaboration opportunities that guide and
support school principals and staff are prioritised.
All six participants described the importance of a distributive leadership style and
linked it to trustworthiness and collaboration. Sue suggested that to be able to
dispersed control requires a lot of faith and trust on the part of the principal. She
added that it is essential as they can’t run everything on their own and they can’t be
expected to know everything. Meg added, “they (principals) are accountable for so
much that they need the assistance of others to reach goals and benefit students,
teachers and parents” (Meg as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.3). Sam reverted to
324
clarifying her thought on distributive leadership. She stated, “they don’t really need a
depth of knowledge of the change process, it is a skill base that is just in them, and it
is just their effective style (Sam as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.3).
5.38. Project scalability with a complete approach and time
5.38.1. Focus group question
Familiarity, confidence and comfort in the project were also stated as important
factors. Many of the interview responses indicate that along with project familiarity
and confidence the program must address a real need. The key is accurately
determining needs and finding where stakeholders are at and moving forward. How
is this done with efficiency and accuracy? How is real need established?
5.38.2. Responses
There was a consensus in the group about the need for scalability if the projects were
to exert whole school influence. Mary and I explained that the scalability of our
projects was enhanced through the use and accessibility of technology. Mary went
further and related the importance of scaling projects within reasonable time frames.
She described that is was easier to scale her project when she was able to use the
student scores generated from the project to inform her instruction and respond to
their identified needs within a reasonable time frame.
Wilma specified that in her setting her RTP project was implemented as a complete
project, rather than just implementing parts of the project. Wilma reported that the
implementation of all the parts of her project increased its scalability and success.
Sam supported this and added that as her project was easily accessible, feasible and
practical, it had a reinforcing effect, which enhanced its scalability. Diane and
325
Wilma went on to link systemic support and parental support to the successful
scaling of their projects:
Additional support needs to come from above as often principals are told to
do it. It has to come from a higher purpose (Diane as cited in Focus group,
2009, p.4).
Yes and the increasing of parent awareness can also have an impact. As if
parents know what is better for their children, they will encourage principals
to go that way and continue with the projects because they are helping their
children. Getting the parents on board is the secret of success, give parents
the information they need to prove it works and why (Wilma as cited in
Focus group, 2009, p.4).
These reports about scalability sparked a discussion where all participants
acknowledged that people who really believe in or are passionate about something
have the capacity to drive and strengthen it. All participants concurred that it is hard
to disseminate passion to the whole school unless a project or initiative is perceived
to be valuable, trustworthy, well planned and accessible. The discussion then led to
claims about the importance of agreed practice. Mary expressed that if a project
became part of the school policy, staff should be expected to support and facilitate its
implementation and sustainment: “if a project is part of the school policy there is an
expectation that all staff would support and adopt school policy” (Mary as cited in
Focus group, 2009, p.3).
Throughout the conversation, comments about the sharing of passion were
consistently linked to collaboration and agreed practice. As the discussion deepened
these areas were linked to the project’s potential for scalability and successful
326
student outcomes. Wendy shared her experience about a year 6 colleague and other
staff members who became involved enabling the experience of success to be shared.
Wendy stated that as more stakeholders experienced success they became
increasingly passionate about supporting the school’s project. She described that this
in-turn encouraged them to become proactive in the dissemination of this new
passion to others. Mary went further and linked passion to leadership; “People in
high places that are passionate seem to have a strong positive impact and it is easier
for the passion to be infectious if the right people are on board (Mary as cited in
Focus group, 2009, p.3).”
During an extended discussion on the successful scalability of Wilma’s, Mary’s,
Sam’s and Diane’s projects and the extinction of mine and Meg’s project, leadership
was once again identified by all participants as having a direct impact on other
factors which ultimately led to the overall status of the projects. The group
confirmed that if people in leadership positions supported their projects, they would
be viewed in an influential way making them easier to scale. The discussion then
progressed to highlight the importance of parental support. All participants agreed
that having the parents on board could contribute to the project success and
scalability. Parental support was also connected to collaboration, support, scalability
and leadership factors. It was briefly introduced during the explanation phase but
additional clarity and specific examples of the positive impact of parental support
were provided during this expansion phase. Wendy described that in her case parents
were informed of the project goals and this encouraged the staff to provide feedback
to parents. As the parents became aware of the project’s benefits, they shared this
knowledge with other parents, who in-turn wanted their children to benefit also.
Wendy’s comment synthesised the sentiment of the group as she stated that “the
327
positive feedback from parents about the success of the projects positively
encouraged the school leaders to continue to support efforts to sustain our project
and time and resources continued” (Wendy as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.3).
As the conversation continued the group acknowledged that group members
represented a strong impetus for change through their implementation and scaling
experiences. All participants were unanimous that credit should be allocated to the
students, as their support for the project also contributed to its increased status.
Participants agreed that when the students identified gains they were making, they
also supported the project and became drivers for this positive change. During the
discussion it became evident that all members agreed with Diane when she asserted
“if our students know things are working or want things to work, they keep us
motivated” (Diane as cited in the Focus group, 2009, p.5). These comments were
linked to the project’s potential to be scaled through statements including; “If we
forget they (our students) are soon there to remind us, as they hold us accountable to
providing them with the service they expect or require” (Wendy as cited in Focus
group, 2009, p.4). The group also shared comments about the benefits of students’
self-monitoring and its positive impact on their progress. “When we work
collaboratively with students they are able to be strong drivers in looking for what
works so our projects must be able to be used so that they all benefit” (Mary as cited
in Focus group, 2009, p.4).
Sue went on to share an interesting insight about agreed practice and how it was
critical to the scaling of her project. She commented on new staff and how teaching
is the only profession, which claims autonomy. During the exchange participants
328
responded to Sue with interest in the relationship she described and nodded
throughout her explanation:
It is about agreed practice, if it is part of the school policy there is an
expectation that when you joined the staff you comply and adopt school
policy and do what you can to sustain and promote the school initiatives. You
really have to do it that way. The voluntary bit is in the discussion.... that way
you voice your opinion, share your thoughts but essentially agreed practice
encourages participation in school based decisions. Interestingly teaching is
the only profession who claim autonomy (Sue as cited in Focus group, 2009,
p.5).
There was a consensus amongst participants irrespective of whether projects were
scaled or extinct, that including ways to address scalability resulted in whole school
influence. It was also identified that projects are more likely to be scaled if systems
and schools have clear goals promoting the use of research-based projects. It was
confirmed by the participants whose projects were scaled that when these goals are
shared and research projects respond to genuine questions, problems and solutions
the RTP gap was reduced. All six participants noted that the success of their projects
was influenced by the extent to which educators could be involved with the research
projects. It was described that by involving multiple stakeholders, strong
partnerships that share responsibility and ownership can be developed. It was further
explained that these relationships could build a sense of credibility among
stakeholders, ultimately supporting the RTP process.
The group reported that time is also a critical factor required for strong and the
practical application and sustainment of research based projects in school settings.
329
Time factors were described as having a significant impact on the scaled or extinct
cases in different ways. Examples of the importance of time ranged from Wilma’s
description of the modification of her timetable to allow her time to work with
others, to Meg’s description that she did not have the time required to make
resources or provide instruction as her project was expanded. Mary reinforced her
description that when the status of her project increased to a whole school priority,
an increase in time allocated to her project. This assisted in the increased status of
her project, as she was better able to address competing demands. All participants
whose projects became scaled supported Mary’s comments as they established that
the status of their projects increased with the allocation of additional time. Meg and I
supported these claims, yet this relationship between time, support and competing
demands was not identified in our projects as they reduced their status within our
schools and became extinct.
Diane, Meg and Mary commented on the importance of timely evaluation and
feedback on reinforcing key project features and eliciting changes as required.
Diane’s report synthesizes the sentiment of all participants when she identified the
relationship between multiple factors as they occurred at her setting:
It has to fit with the plans and needs of the school. It must fit into the whole
school reform and PD agenda at exactly the right time and you must show
how it fits in. This is where the whole lit review and depth of knowledge
comes in, you need that background knowledge and understanding to show
and share how it fits in. It must cater for an established need and be timely so
that it is actually relevant and not too early or too late (Diane as cited in
Focus group, 2009, p.4).
330
Meg responded by stating that “time was key in the implementation stages” of her
project. She explained how time for making resources, the sharing of knowledge,
feedback and recording was vital. Other participants interjected with multiple
comments expressing that time was a priority and was linked to many RTP factors
throughout the implementation, sustainment and scaling phases of their projects.
They explained that time was required to learn skills and rehearse them. It was
essential to cater for the changing needs of stakeholders and it was required to
continue as the projects evolved. Participants whose projects were both scaled and
extinct identified the importance of time on the successful interrelationships between
the RTP factors.
5.39. Masters Course/Teacher Education
5.39.1. Focus group question
A number of you suggested that the university course framework was very effective
in providing a structure or scaffold to promote a depth of knowledge. Specifically
how did the university course framework make a difference to your project? How
can we develop this depth of knowledge learned as a result of our coursework in
other practitioners within schools?
Each participant identified the depth of knowledge gained through the Masters
course as an essential support to the implementation and scaling of research-based
projects. It was referred to in the data collected across each of the areas identified.
The group conversation acknowledged that the teacher education experience was a
key element that underpinned the relationships across multiple factors in the six
direct RTP cases. It was identified as being crucial to the understanding of skills;
knowledge and attitudes essential for collaboration and to ensure research is
331
comprehended and used effectively. There was consistency in comments confirming
the effectiveness of the course structure. This structure was described as being so
effective as it presented essential theoretical knowledge through a series of regular
practical components. All six participants agreed that their teacher education
experience delivered a depth of content knowledge along with an awareness of how
to share that knowledge with staff as required. The following dialogue presents a
series of quotes that reflected the sentiment of the group about the knowledge gained
through the course:
Gave us confidence and increased depth of knowledge (Meg as cited in Focus
group, 2009, p.5).
We could share that depth of knowledge we gained by providing them (staff)
with the key information about the practical efforts required (Wilma as cited
in Focus group, 2009, p.5).
Not everyone wants the depth (of knowledge) we got. It needs to be …...this
is what it looks like in our classrooms; here is the scaffold so this is how you
do it. They are so busy with the day-to-day things so they only want the
practical elements and an explanation of why we should use them (projects)
for our kids. We need to be able to say this is what it looks like for you. We
have the depth to spell it out for them. All they want to know is what it looks
like, they don’t need to know everything but a resource person does as they
can guide them in their practical knowledge as needs and questions arise
(Mary as cited in Focus group, 2009d, p.5).
Participants continued to describe practical components, which contributed to
making the course effective in the delivery of the “lived experience, which increased
332
our knowledge and skills and ultimately our status within our schools” (Diane as
cited in Focus group, 2009, p.5). These components included the consistency in
delivery and structure across subjects including advanced organisers, which
presented expectations graphically at the start of every unit. All participants agreed
that assessment tasks were effective in building the students’ capacity, as they were
relevant to school settings. All participants eagerly supported Sue’s report that the
course was very demanding yet it was equally beneficial in increasing the depth of
research-based knowledge and the ability to be instrumental in implementing it. The
merging of theoretical and practical components was again unanimously agreed upon
as being critical to the imparting of new knowledge and preparing students in their
ability to transfer the newly gained skills and knowledge with other school based
educators.
Teacher education was linked to collaboration, support, accessibility, usability,
trustworthiness and the responsiveness of research throughout the discussion.
Reports that the Master’s course experience increased our depth of knowledge and
capacity by giving us the confidence to share theoretical understandings through
practical experiences to support our students continued to resonate. The following
comments echoed the sentiment shared by all participants about how increased
stakeholder knowledge assisted in the increased status of project. Mary, whose
project was scaled within and beyond her setting, reinforced earlier comments made
about the changing status of the special needs teacher within the school system. All
participants again supported her comments and then shared their concerns about the
distinctive difference between the directions of the previous and current leaders of
the system. Mary’s account expressed the sentiment of the group discussion:
333
“Because we were responsible for implementing the research based projects
our increased status seemed to also have an impact on the success of the
project. It is not only the systems notion of Spec Ed Teacher status which can
have a positive or negative impact it is also that of the principal themselves,
as their attitudes can have an impact on the whole staff. The knowledge
gained from the Master’s course empowered us and gave us some status
within the system, but now with a change of model at a systems level and the
different vision, that status has significantly reduced. I don’t know where we
stand, it has been changing so much over the last 5 years, it even changes
within schools. There is confusion now sometimes I even feel we are an aid.
The confusion is also reflected in how other staff members also looked at us”
(Mary as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.5).
The focus group conversation about the change in the school systems elicited a range
of mixed emotions from participants. They unanimously expressed the benefits that
their teacher education experience had on their capacity to promote the use their
selected research based project, yet were disappointed that “the new leaders did not
have the same commitment to inclusive education as the previous leaders” (Wilma as
cited in Focus group, 2009, p.4). They all agreed that the intentional linking of their
subjects within the course assisted in reinforcing key ideas and this assisted in
aligning their theoretical and practical knowledge, however felt that their “wealth of
knowledge could be shared with other school staff to help the kids as had been
planned under the old model” (Diane as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.4). Another
key feature identified by all six participants was that courses are more beneficial
when they directly respond to teacher needs through a clear and consistent approach.
Mary expressed that the course was very beneficial and gave us the confidence to
334
share our new knowledge but the dismantling of the Special Education arm of the
system made us powerless.
Differences in comments about the type of support gained from the teacher education
experience were identified. These differences built on factors introduced in the
explanation stage and included Meg’s identification of the benefits of practical tools
such as the Gannt chart (a bar graph illustration of the schedule of the project which
identifies a breakdown in structure) to Sam’s explanation of the advantages in
ensuring consistency in comprehension of a common educational language and the
way that language was used to communicate knowledge across all stakeholders. Sam
also identified the benefits of having a colleague whom she completed the course
with at her setting.
Comments on the Masters emerged in other areas discussed during the focus group.
The preparation experienced by the participants was reported as being highly
effective in building their capacity to deliver and implement new content within their
school settings and beyond. The experiences gained through the course were
reported to have changed the educational expectations of each participant. This was
reflected in their individual settings as all six participants expressed that they
successfully implemented a research-based project in their settings. Four of which
continued to be scaled and two became extinct, yet there were no differences
identified during the discussion about the benefits, structure or challenges of the
course.
5.40. Summary of the consistencies identified through the focus group
The focus group format and questions made it possible for participants to identify
connections between the RTP factors and present practical examples of these
335
relationships as a result of the implementation, sustainment or extinction of their
specific RTP cases. Initial factors identified in the exploration phase were
categorised in the sub themes of support, collaboration and responsiveness of
research. These reports were organized using the 16 succinct RTP factors through
the explanation phase. During this expansion phase participants built on these
individual reports and went further to collectively present the relationships between
identified factors. The focus group discussion gave participants an opportunity to
elaborate on their experiences and compare them across cases. Through this cross
case comparison additional details emerged and participants discussed the
interrelationships of factors as they developed through the different stages of their
projects. An overview of the RTP factors and their connections that have exerted an
influence on the status of each case have been presented within the four key areas
consistently referred to during the group discussion. The themes that emerged
represented the interrelationships between the RTP factors that were extrapolated
from the analysis of the reports generated through this final expansion phase. These
areas are not mutually exclusive but are representative of the links that were
presented by participants as key contributors to the status of their projects. Through
these specific accounts, the interrelationships among multiple RTP factors that
influenced the status of the six unique cases were described repeatedly.
Participants had difficulty separating or isolating factors and all participants
described factors according to their connections. Reports of these connections
became stronger as the discussion unfolded. Participants presented more detailed
accounts of their experiences as they progressed through the three phases of this
study.
336
5.41. Inconsistencies identified by participants
All participants agreed on all RTP factors and their connections except for the
comments made about a National Assessment Program - Literacy and Numeracy
(NAPLAN) assessments. These assessments commenced in Australian schools in
2008. Every year, all students in Years 3, 5, 7 and 9 are assessed on the same days
using national tests in Reading, Writing, Language Conventions (Spelling, Grammar
and Punctuation) and Numeracy. Diane’s comments during the discussion identified
a relationship between support, leadership, collaboration and the NAPLAN results of
students at her school. She stated:
That in today’s society established need can also be displayed through
NAPLAN results. These results display an expectation of where our students
need to be. They are another measure of accountability. There is a clear
mandate in schools stating that we must improve the blue line (average
results for the school) (Diane as cited in Focus group, 2009, p.5).
Diane reported that at her school staff spent many meetings in collaborative
discussion about the blue line and ways to support students in improving their
results. She identified that her school leaders wanted to show points of growth to
address the declining numbers in many schools across the system. Diane went on to
state that her leadership team wanted to show that they are a good school and the
NAPLAN statistics are very clear and were used to increase accountability and
status.
These comments promoted a debate about teaching to the test and the usability and
trustworthiness of NAPLAN data. All participants indicated that data generated from
research based projects were more effective than NAPLAN results and could be used
337
to show they were doing something to improve results and that they also offered
solutions to address the identified needs. Diane concluded by stating that principals
and leaders want NAPLAN results. She went further to state that our projects have
identified ways to improve the results of students but Diane explained that she
believed the NAPLAN results are still beneficial to compare student data across
schools. The discussion about the NAPLAN assessment was the only time that
inconsistency across participants was identified.
5.42. Summary of the results collected during the expansion phase
During focus group all participants provided a more detailed account of the
previously identified RTP factors and their relationships. Reports by participants of
the interrelationships among the RTP factors became more descriptive as the focus
group discussion evolved. A summary of those key areas that exerted an influence on
the status of each case was presented within four areas, along with an account of the
ways in which they were connected.
Participants reported the connections between themes and how they had a positive or
negative impact on the status of the projects. All participants agreed on the
importance of the identified themes and their connections. A discussion on
NAPLAN testing was the only area identified that generated division in the
responses of participants. Diane was the only participant from a high school setting
and the only participant who advocated for the use of the NAPLAN assessment
within schools. The results derived from focus group discussion identified
differences in the interrelationships, which contributed to the status of each case
within their unique setting. The responses from the two cases that became extinct
described many positive factors, yet the break down in the connections between RTP
338
factors contributed to different negative experiences, leading to gradual extinction in
both cases. In both cases that became extinct, the participants explained that the
decisions of the school leaders contributed to a breakdown in the positive
relationship between RTP factors. Meg described that the decision by the executive
team to scale the project was not made collaboratively with the staff. This
contributed to lack of ownership and support from the stakeholders who were to
implement it. I described my new principal and deputy did not order the extension of
the project yet their lack of verbal support, interest and resources contributed to a
reduced status, lack of time and the increase of competing demands on stakeholders.
5.43. Overview of the results collected through the three phases of this study
This study collected data through three distinct phases. To summarize the first phase,
the exploration phase, explored prior literature based RTP assertions and presented
initial RTP factors identified by each of the participants as a result of their
experience. The second phase, the explanation phase, further explained the influence
of those factors and others in direct RTP cases. Participants found it difficult to
respond to isolated factors in the explanation phase and connections between them
were identified. Participant responses became more detailed when they compared
experiences across their cases in the final phase. During the third and final phase, the
expansion phase, participants expanded on the complexity of the critical connections
between RTP factors and themes that both enabled and interfered with the successful
translation of the selected research projects in their settings.
The relationships between the projects, the people involved and their preparation
continued to resonate as being vital when participants reported on the key RTP
factors that built their capacity within their school-based contexts. Participants all
339
reported that for their projects to maintain strength and effectiveness their project
content needed to address the changing needs of the staff and students.
Table 6.1 presents an overview of the RTP factors and their relationships that were
prioritized by participants through their individual responses during the exploration
and explanation phases. The responses from participants are not reiterated across
phases. During the explanation phase, participants found it increasingly difficult to
isolate RTP factors and additional information identifying relationships between
RTP factors became increasingly evident. Participants responses collected through
the discussion during the expansion phase went further to confirm the complexity of
the relationships between the RTP factors identified by the participants within and
across cases as they provided a more detailed account of their experience. All
participants, including those of extinct and scaled cases, supported the importance of
these relationships. The significance of the interrelationships between the RTP
factors identified through the extinct cases became more evident as they were
withdrawn. The key resounding interrelationships presented within the expansion
phase were strongly supported by all participants. There was consensus in the
sentiment of the group that the sustainability and scaling of research-based projects
was intuitively enhanced when relationships promoting student gains, teacher
capacity, whole school ownership, complete and comprehensive project designs
were promoted. Participants found it difficult to accurately describe their unique
RTP accounts when RTP factors were presented in lists. Table 6.1 identifies the
increasing detail presented by participants about the importance of the
interrelationships between the RTP factors as they progressed through the three
phases of this study.
340
Table 6.1
Key emphatic themes presented in each case during the three phases of the study
Case Exploration Phase Explanation Phase Expansion Phase
Chris
(extinct)
United decision making
Student gains
Consistent and
standardised project
Relevant and consistent
feedback
New leadership failure
Effective TE course
structure
Stakeholders appreciation and enthusiasm
Useful standardised data that elicited positive
responses
Flexibility in design
Withdrawal of leadership support
Reduced communication
United efforts understood by all
Importance of RTP relationships became more
important as they were withdrawn
Scalability potential
Continuing not isolated event
TE is critical to promoting skills, knowledge and attitudes and
should be clear and consistent to be readily transferred. Essential
theoretical knowledge transferred through practical components.
Increased knowledge leads to increased confidence contributing
to the transfer of relevant information to others
Very demanding, equally beneficial
Reduced leadership support has a negative impact on many RTP
factors and contributes to a cycle of extinction
New leaders require common understanding and commitment to
projects for them to be sustained
Collegial support, awareness of project goals and
communication are essential to projects scalability
Mary
(Scaled
Website support
Resource preparations
Time frames that are responsive to changing
needs
Status of the special needs teacher is impacted by the status and
support of school and education system leaders.
341
beyond
setting)
Responsive to student
needs
School ownership
User friendly, easy to up
skill staff
Practicality and depth of
TE course
Project status within the school
Embedded in school culture through whole
school policy
Comprehensive approach to address genuine
concerns
Technology support
Clear consistent PD
Timely detailed feedback
Substantive and frequent interactions to
promote positive partnerships
Shared involvement and ownership increases
project status
Lived TE experience
Effective adoption of features
Continuing
Knowledge gained from the TE experience empowered our
capacity
Adjustments need to be made with students as the pivotal point
To be appealing projects need to be complete, easy, doable and
quick to administer
Status or personnel impact the status of the projects
Less enthusiastic staff can be encouraged through shared
accountability and responsibility
Projects that address scalability are more likely to succeed
342
Diane Leadership support
Personal motivation
Practicality of TE
experience
Scalability potential of project
Validated
United efforts incorporating feedback and
collegiality
Part of school culture and calendar
Replication of TE structures to share new
knowledge
Intentional linking of subjects and clear and consistent
frameworks reinforced key ideas
TE was highly effective in building capacity of participants and
their staff
Feedback is most effective when it is flexible and is woven into
the design of the project
Students self monitoring can contribute to the promotion of
projects
Wilma
(Scaled
beyond
setting)
Staff and leadership
support and involvement
Responded to identified
school need
Practicality and depth of
TE course
Parent support
Easily comprehended
project materials
Part of whole school assessment plan
Leadership by example
Simplicity of implementation and monitoring
Valued, useful and standardised data
Importance of the little things
Graphic organisers
Complete approach
School system leaders can significantly impact inclusive
education initiatives.
When projects are complete and comprehensive with practical
experiences they have the capacity to reinforce essential learning
Collaboration is essential for teachers to implement projects as a
whole rather than in parts
Well designed TE creates an avenue to promote RBP in
classrooms
Increased traction is possible when personal and leadership
343
Retraining for new staff Resilience and commitment
Time for ongoing PD
Depth of theoretical and practical knowledge
determination are combined
Parental support can encourage accountability and scalability of
the projects
Sam
(Scaled
beyond
setting)
Catered for staff and
student needs
Staff enthusiasm and
support
Strong TE course structure
built our capacity
Model school PD on
course
Flexibility in design
Realistic demands
Part of school policy
Student monitoring
Project growth links to student gains and staff
commitment
Building capacity and rapport through shared
comprehension of educational terms
Being part of a cohort
TE course built practical knowledge and
experience into a theoretical framework
All embodied course structure with
reinforcing effect
Complete and comprehensive
Readiness levels
Sharing of new knowledge improved project and participants
status.
Consistency in common educational language enhance
communication and was transferred to explicit language being
used at schools
Collaboration is not always harmonious. Improving student
outcomes needs to remain the central goal
Cooperation, respect and engagement in pursuit of genuine
questions and solutions led to project scalability and increased
comfort and stability
Principals should be trusting to share decision making and
responsibility
Projects that are realistic and accessible can have a reinforcing
effect if theoretical and practical elements are merged
344
Meg
(Extinct)
Time for monitoring
and feedback
Whole team approach
Depth of TE
experience
Collegial support
Sufficient preparation and input into decisions
Align project and school goals with shared
ownership and unity
Project expansion requires increased supports
Changing setting and stakeholder needs
Flexibility
Complexity in scaling
Collaboration enhances the strength and scalability of projects
Rapid scaling of a project without shared ownership has a
negative impact on other RTP factors which led to gradual
extinction
Unity and time are critical to enhance decision made by leaders
Allocation of time to prepare resources and for PD is critical and
must be ongoing
345
These results were further examined and the key relationships that contributed most
significantly to the scaling or extinction of individual RTP cases were summarised
and represented visually in the following figures. The two cases that became extinct
exhibited many positive factors, yet the break down in the connection of these RTP
factors yielded negative results. In the two cases that became extinct the factors
worked against each other progressively over a one-year period prior to the projects
becoming extinct. The four cases that were scaled within and beyond school settings
provided examples of how the cyclic interconnection between RTP factors
contributed to enhancing the use of research-based projects to address identified
student needs.
5.44. Relationship of factors that contributed to the extinction of two
individual RTP cases
Figure 6.1
Meg’s factors working against each other
reapid expansion decision by
executitive increases Meg's workload and
reduced shared ownership and responsibility
heavy workload on
Meg
lack of shared ownership
and responsibility
Meg
346
Figure 6.2
Chris’ factors working against each other
5.45. Relationship of factors that contributed to the expansion of four
individual RTP cases
Figure 6.3
Mary’s positive relationship between factors
Increased competing demands contributed to the
lack of unity and shared ownership
Reduction in time and resources
with the introduction of
competing demands
Lack of leadership support
Lived teacher education
experience
Status of projects and
teachers/whole school culture
Comprehensive, not isolated approach to addressing
genuine staff needs
Timely detailed feedback/ web
support
Mary
Chris
347
Figure 6.4
Wilma’s positive relationship between factors
Figure 6.5
Diane’s positive relationship between factors
Figure 6.6
Evalutaion and feedback
opportunities that are
consistent and emerging
Well developed student
resources and teacher
materials
Responsive to growth in
stakeholder knowledge and
ability
Support that is consistent,
feasible and accessable
Consistency in leadership and
technology support
Status of projects and part of the
whole school plan
Catering for varying staff abilities and knowledge
Regular meetings with
feedback opportunities
woven into the project design
Wilma
Diane
348
Sam’s positive relationship between factors
These figures assisted in identifying the importance of maintaining the integrity of
the connections between the RTP factors presented through the exploration,
explanation and expansion phases in sustaining research based projects in schools.
Each figure was created from the prioritised relationships between the key RTP
factor identified by each of the participants as a result of their experience. The next
section expands on the importance of the critical connection between RTP factors
that both enabled and interfered with the successful translation of research into
practice in inclusive education settings. It presents an overview of the knowledge
that was confirmed through the progression of this study. As a result of this research
it became increasingly evident that the same factors can be both enablers and
inhibitors in research to practice initiatives depending on the type of relationships
that are formed. The interrelationship between these RTP factors was identified by
all participants being much more significant to reducing the RTP gap than the
strength or number of individual factors identified within each case.
Positive peer responses with
feedback opportunities
woven into the design of the
project
Ongoing leadership
support and frequent
communication
Responds to genuine
classroom contexts, teacher
needs and concerns
Strong united partnerships with a common explicit
language
Sam
349
5.46. Connections between RTP factors that were consistently identified by
participants
This knowledge was derived from the analysis and comparison of the cases that
provided specific details of how the connections between the RTP factors
strengthened and destabilized the status of individual research-based projects in
primary and secondary schools. Practical accounts that were reported by participants
were cited within each phase of the study. The explanation and expansion phases
further described the connections between RTP factors. The following descriptions
portray how the figures and knowledge derived from each of the examined cases
could guide and enhance practical applications of research-based projects and reduce
the RTP gap.
A number of applications or recommendations to promote the use of research-based
projects in school and classroom applications were strongly supported by all
participants. They capture the connections that emerged from three areas including;
people and their capacity, the context that unites schools and universities in
preparing teachers and the projects and their content. The six participants
continuously identified links across all areas as being essential if the research to
practice gap is to be reduced. These applications are based on the recognition that
change (being the reduction in the RTP gap) is about the interaction between and
among the many individual factors that are required to create reinforcing and
responsive RTP cycles. These 13 recommended applications are presented in,
however are not strictly bound by three essential areas being; people and their
capacity, preparation and the research-based projects.
350
5.46.1. Ways that were consistently described to engage people and
enable them to work to their capacity to create effective inclusive
environments
As identified in the literature review, the transference of knowledge and skills
essential to the effective sustainment of research-based programs, has been, and
continues to be a significant challenge. Through the progression of this study and the
analysis of responses from participants, it became increasingly evident that the
binary, which separates researchers and educators, is not productive. The data
gathered suggested that if the efforts of researchers and educators were joined
through a collaborative partnership, they are more likely to have an impact on
reducing the well-documented RTP gap. In the present study that partnership
assumed the form of a graduate teacher preparation program which served as a
vehicle for enhancing a collaborative approach between teachers and researchers in
the promotion of research based project skills and knowledge. The analyses of these
results expanded on previous recommendations from commentary and intervention
research studies to highlight the importance of the relationships between RTP
factors. Five recommended applications have been generated to enhance the capacity
of stakeholders to enable them to foster educational environments that are effective
in implementing and sustaining the use of research based projects to promote student
gains:
1. Addressing students’ needs must be a central and mutual goal of a cooperative
team of researchers and educators. The characteristics, skills and experiences of
individuals implementing and sustaining projects can have an effect on the status of
evidence- based projects within school environments. Personal agendas and biases
are less likely to have a negative impact on the status of projects if stakeholders
351
ensure students remain the central focus. If stakeholders unite through effective
collaboration and communication, their strengths and expertise can more effectively
merge to promote student gains. Sam (2009) highlighted this requirement when
described the sentiment of all participants being that collaboration was not always
harmonious when boundaries were being stretched. All participants concurred with
Sam and Wendy when they added if students were at the centre of the project, unity
amongst stakeholders in achieving common goals was easier to achieve.
2. The interrelated nature of the dissemination of passion for projects between
stakeholders is easier when projects have been promoted and proven to be valuable,
accessible and useable. As described by Meg, Mary, Wilma, Diane, Sam and I
passionate people can drive evidence-based projects and the dissemination of that
passion is enhanced when people in leadership positions support them. The
complexity of the interrelationship of factors relating to the support from school
leaders was evident in both scaled and extinct cases. As identified in the results
chapters, the four, scaled cases presented the positive cyclic sequence of events that
resulted from the relationship of enabling factors that flowed from the support of
their principal. These enabling factors included time, resources and increased status
(see Figure 6.2), yet were not proven to be effective in isolation as stakeholders
continued to link multiple factors in the survey, interview and focus group responses.
The two extinct cases also confirmed the importance of the cyclic sequence of
factors that flowed from decisions made at a school leadership level. For example,
Meg’s executive decided to rapidly expand the project due to its success without
collaboratively consulting with other staff members. My new principal did not
request the completion of my project, but did introduce other demands without
increasing time or resources (See Figure 6.3). Figures 6.2 and 6.3 present the
352
increasing negative impact of the destructive cycle that resulted from the breakdown
in the relationships between RTP factors in both extinct cases. When comparing
scaled and extinct cases, the importance of leadership decisions on the relationship
of RTP factors was highlighted. Similar RTP factors were connected and became
either enablers or inhibitors depending on the sequence of events that resulted from
leadership decisions.
3. Research based projects were more effective when they directly responded to the
unique contextual realities that teachers and students with, or without, disabilities
function. The settings in which participants implemented and tracked the status of
their projects varied greatly. Meg’s use of the Gannt charts, Diane’s students
monitoring and recording their own results and the use of technology were all
examples of ways that stakeholders employed strategies that best served the needs of
their unique settings. Given the highly complex, unique and unpredictable responses
of stakeholders, projects were more successfully sustained and scaled when
researchers and educators worked as a collaborative team with students in school
settings. Increased stakeholder support and involvement in project decisions and
inclusion of the projects in whole school policies and programs also contributed to
the increased status and the likelihood of project sustainment and scaling. Mary
(2009) and Sam (2009) shared the examples of ways they increased involvement in
their projects. Sam (2009) described her scaffolded presentation of the project
features to her. This stated that it replicated the approach used to share new
knowledge by the university-based educators throughout the Master’s Course. Sam
(2009) further described that with constant modelling and feedback, increased
confidence led to increased involvement. Mary (2009) along with all other
353
participants supported this relationship and increased ownership seemed a natural
progression as projects progressed.
4. Educators in schools and universities were described by participants as significant
change agents and were referred to by all participants as being critical in transferring
and matching research-based projects to the characteristics and uniqueness of
students and their settings. The dissemination of research is strengthened when
researchers work collaboratively with educators to empower them with the skills and
knowledge to further disseminate and demonstrate research projects to colleagues,
students and parents in school and community settings. Diane (2009) added that the
students themselves were also advocates for effective research and has proven to be
able to self-monitor and motivate other students, teachers and school leaders. All
participants agreed that the increased number of stakeholders with research based
knowledge, skills and capacity contributed to a stronger intellectual based
knowledge. This was combined with the relevant practical skills in four of the scaled
cases to demonstrate how this relationship enhanced the scalability potential and
sustainment of evidence-based projects within schools.
5. Increasing stakeholder knowledge and their willingness and ability to share this
new knowledge across schools and systems was presented as a way of earning
respect from their peers and increasing status by all participants. This increased
respect and status amongst peers was described by Sam as a way of positively
impacting the sustainment and scaling of research-based projects in school
applications. Meg (2009) added that her principal was key to the relationships that
increased the project status when he knew it was going to help the students.
354
5.46.2. Ways to engaging schools and universities in effectively preparing
teachers
Teacher education was presented as a critical link in the implementation and
sustainment of research-based projects in school applications across all scaled and
extinct case studies. It represented an avenue that combined researcher and educator
knowledge and experience to enhance the use of research-based projects to promote
inclusive environments that cater for the needs of a diverse spectrum of students.
Positive partnerships between people at universities and schools contributed to
shared goals and directions. Each of the six school based educators worked with
university staff with the shared goal of implementing a research-based project in
their individual schools to address student needs. The analyses of the results of all
six cases identified four recommended applications generated within the non-
exclusive area of teacher preparation:
1. The teacher education opportunity was presented by all participants as an avenue,
which provided multiple levels of engagement, ongoing communication and shared
goals between the researchers and educators. As a result of the shared teacher
education experience, the benefits of explicit links between theory and practice were
identified by all participants and were attributed to the successful implementation of
all research-based projects. Participants all reported that the teacher education
experience successfully assisted in aligning previously regarded differing norms,
expectations and roles of researchers and practitioners. Sam, Wilma and I reflected
the sentiment of the others as we explained that this was accomplished effectively by
merging the course content into a theoretical framework where university staff
worked with school based staff to collaboratively decide on which project would best
address the needs of their diverse settings. Sam (2009) expressed the sentiment of
355
others when she stated that she did not realize the positive impact of the teacher
education experience on her knowledge and skill base until after she had completed
it.
2. The structure of the teacher education course not only instilled new knowledge
and skills into course participants but also gave us confidence and ability to replicate
this merger of relevant content and process at our settings. Mary (2009) described
that the projects themselves were a support as the consistency across the design of all
subjects within the course, reduced confusion and provided educators with visible
structures and resources that could be utilized to transfer theoretical understandings
to enhance practice. Wilma (2009) explained that the theoretical understandings
were most effectively shared through practical experiences that catered and were
responsive to the variance in interest and abilities of stakeholders at our settings.
3. Teacher education efforts that responded to participant readiness levels and school
and personal based contextual boundaries encouraged teacher enthusiasm and effort.
The relevance and popularity of teacher education efforts increased when they were
perceived as having the potential to address the needs of school-based staff and their
students. Mutual respect between researchers and educators was established as
teachers’ demonstrated increased determination to use research based projects that
were responsive to their needs and promoted student gains. All participants
explained that this mutual respect has the capacity to promote the use and
sustainment of research projects in schools as the diverse skills and knowledge from
both research (university) and practical (schools) agendas are essential to
relationships united in catering for the needs of a diverse range of students.
356
4. Teacher education initiatives that ensured consistent comprehension of terms
(pattern language as described by Sam, 2009) and provided scaffolds with clear
expectations promoted the use of research in classrooms. A one-size fit all approach
to teacher education has not been as effective. Providing teachers with a clear and
consistent framework and encouraging them to use this as a scaffold to implement a
research-based project in their own setting was referred to by all participants as
being highly beneficial in enhancing their use of such projects. This personalized
approach provided an experience with linked practice and research to create an
avenue for ongoing, open communication within relevant and responsive timeframes
that encouraged its replication in school settings.
5.46.3. Ways that effective projects and content can enable the
engagement of multiple interrelationships to be enacted in ways to
meet the diverse needs of multiple stakeholders
This study identified the relationship between the RTP factors that impacted upon on
the status of projects within a range of schools under differing conditions. Research
based projects that presented an increase in student results were sought after. The
analyses of the results identified four recommended applications that have been
generated within the non-exclusive projects theme to enhance the positive
sustainment of research in practice:
1. All participants explained that projects must be conceptualized with an accurate
awareness of contextual realities. It was acknowledged that classrooms and school
staff members experience different competing demands to university-based staff.
Projects that are developed in light of school-based realities and contextual demands
are more likely to be responsive to the needs of stakeholders and valued by
357
educational practitioners. Participants were unable to comment on the demands of
the school-based settings independent of comments about leadership support. This
strengthened the awareness of the significance of the relationship between support
from the school leaders and the limiting of competing demands in attempts to reduce
the RTP gap.
2. Projects must have the potential to be scaled within educational settings. The
sustainment and scaling of evidence-based projects was a natural progression in all
case studies once the project became part of the school policy. For projects to
become sustained in practice they should be able to be address the needs of the
schools by being scaled successfully so that they can be included in whole school
plans (Wilma, 2009). This potential to be scaled can be enhanced when projects
address the outcomes related to school system, state and national accountability
requirements (Diane, 2009). The inclusive education administration leaders of a
large private school system worked with the university to create a teacher education
program that deliberately linked their investment to the state and federal visions for
inclusive education. These connections were reported as having the capacity to
enhance the status of research-based projects and the status of their implementers
(Mary, 2009). This increased status and scalability of research-based projects could
be further enhanced through recognition and reward at multiple levels (school,
system, state or national) thus, enhancing the potential for research to be used in
practical applications.
3. Projects with clearly worded directions and details of background research and
contact details to address concerns or questions as they arose were more appealing
and accessible to educators. All participants agreed that responsive and inexpensive
358
web downloads and communication opportunities enhanced the accessibility and
usability of research based projects (Chris, 2009). An increased opportunity to
engage with researchers about projects allowed educators to become more confident
users, tutors and advocators for research. All participants agreed with Mary (2009) as
she described that when she felt supported by the university and school staff the
development of responsive and explicit connections between research and practice
continued to evolve. Projects that have access to practical and timely resources,
support and assistance were more likely to be implemented, sustained and scaled
(Sam, 2009).
4. Research based projects that recognised short-term student gains were most
successfully implemented and sustained in practice (Diane, 2009). Accessible
literature that supported the practical use of individual projects increased their
demand at the school level. Most participants indicated that when the time, resources
and effort invested in the project produced strong dividends in terms of student
growth, the projects were scaled at a faster rate than expected. All participants
described that they sought projects that demonstrated identifiable student gains in
comparison to the investment required in terms of their implementation and
sustainment. Participants further explained that projects that met this criterion
assisted them in evidence based reporting to other teachers and parents, which also
contributed to the project’s increased popularity and demand.
359
Chapter 6. Discussion and Conclusion
This study aims to contribute to increase the extant knowledge of the ways research
can be effectively translated to practice to address diverse student needs. It
commenced with the investigation of the research to practice literature, which led to
the investigation of four additional bodies of literature. The five bodies of literature
that were investigated were used as an organisational framework for the study. The
areas of literature investigated included; research to practice, professional
development, teacher education, comprehensive school reform and concerns based
adoption model. RTP factors that were identified through the investigation of these
areas were extrapolated and used to guide the direction of the study and construct the
data collection tools including the survey and interview questions. These data
collection tools continued to evolve as the reports from one phase were used to
inform the next; in order to elicit detail and accurate practice based accounts.
This chapter is presented in four sections and is organized around the research
questions within the three phases of this study. It first presents a brief overview of
the phases. Second, a summary of the key findings in relation to the phased research
questions is provided. Third, a RTP Model, which identifies the connections between
the RTP factors and its recommended application, is presented. This is followed by
the fourth and final section, which presents the limitations of this study, future
research recommendations and concluding remarks.
6.1. Overview of the three phases of this study
The first, exploration phase, sought reports of participant’s direct experiences of the
factors that contributed to the status of their cases. This data was collected from
participants prior to their introduction to the information derived from the literature
360
through Part 1 of the survey and the first round of interviews. These details were
later compared to the RTP literature. During the second explanation phase,
participants were introduced to 75 individual RTP factors (collected through five
bodies of literature) through part 2 of a survey. Participants responded to whether
these factors were identified in their cases using a numerical (1-5) Likert scale. They
also presented written responses to open-ended questions in spaces provided within
the survey about other RTP factors that significantly contributed to the status of their
projects at various stages of implementation.
The final data collection stage, the expansion phase, consisted of an opportunity for
all participants to contribute to a focus group discussion. The results collected during
this phase confirmed and expanded upon the complexities, consistencies and
differences in the interrelations between the factors that enabled and enhanced the
scaling of four cases and contributed to the extinction of two cases. Through this
group discussion participants expanded on previous results as they described and
compared ways in which similar RTP factors worked together to strengthen the
status of four projects whilst that same RTP factors worked against each other to
reduce the status of two cases. These interrelationships were presented through four
themes including: collaboration and feedback, leadership, scalability of projects and
teacher education. These themes were derived from the consistencies identified
across the participant responses and the RTP literature. In brief, the importance of
the interrelationships between the RTP factors presented through the exploration,
explanation and expansion phases of this study influenced the status of the cases in
their school settings and resulted in both scaled and extinct outcomes.
361
The following section provides a summary of the key findings identified through
each of the three phases of this study. The research questions within each phase are
presented firstly and they are followed by overview of the data generated in response
to the phased questions with a discussion of how these results reflect gained through
the RTP literature.
6.1.1. Exploration Phase
Research question: What factors have been identified by research participants that
contribute to sustaining research-based projects in inclusive educational settings?
What factors have been identified in previous literatures that contribute to sustaining
research-based projects in inclusive educational settings? How have these factors
been identified? What RTP factors were identified through initial teacher interviews?
The discussion of RTP was extensive in the five areas of literature investigated;
RTP, professional development, teacher education, comprehensive school reform
and the concerns based adoption models (see literature review). There were few
empirical studies specifically focused on the translation of RTP in inclusive
education settings. Overall, the research articles that were found supported the major
themes identified in opinion papers and reflective essays. These major themes
included ways to assist researchers and practitioners in reducing the RTP gap
including: the responsiveness of research, collaboration and support. The factors
identified through these areas became more detailed as the literature investigation
proceeded.
Although participants were working in settings that ranged from primary to
secondary schools, they all expressed that their projects were stronger if they
responded to organisational demands, displayed tolerance for initial implementation
362
difficulties, recognised accomplishments and encouraged feedback on multiple
levels. These explanations provided practical examples of the claims of made in the
literature (Hargreaves, 2007; Hasbrouck, Woldbeck, Ihnot, & Parker, 1999; Miller et
al., 2005).
There were high levels of consistency in the participant responses describing the
positive impact of the Master’s teaching team on their depth of knowledge and their
ability to implement selected projects in their schools. All participants who
completed the same Masters degree shared the sentiment that the merger of
theoretical knowledge with the practical requirements of the course promoted deeper
involvement as all students had to justify; implement and monitor selected research-
based projects and their decisions. These individual accounts provided examples of
how researchers and teachers worked together in an education system sponsored
initiative. All stakeholders felt positive about establishing long-term collaborative
partnerships between schools and universities to facilitate change and enhance
sustainability (Abbott et al., 1999; El-Dinary, Pressley, Coy-Ogan, & Schuder, 1994;
Klingner et al., 1998; Schumm & Vaughn, 1995).
Although initially participants had not been issued with the TE literature during the
exploration phase, their accounts of their experiences were consistent with the TE
literature. All participants explained that attention should be paid to organisational
issues that worked, such as the practicality of their projects in terms of time and
resourcing if they were to be sustained over time (Miller et al., 2005). They also
expressed the need to incorporate empirically derived educational practices into the
instructional repertoire of educators in order to reduce the RTP gap (Foegen et al.,
2001). The responses of the six participants supported the work of Malouf & Schiller
363
(1995) in their beliefs that increased teacher knowledge is important when
conceptualising the relationship between research and practice so that classrooms
became more responsive to all students.
Participants’ views were also consistent with those of Grimes & Tilly (1996) in that
they all expressed that reducing the RTP gap is only possible when educators are
well informed and actively involved in the research process. Although challenges
such as time management concerns and fatigue in addressing competing demands
did exist in each of the six cases, the four cases that were scaled successfully
reflected the factors highlighted in the RTP literature. This included the importance
of well-designed teacher education programs, which were collaborative, coherent,
responsive to stakeholder needs, provided support and feedback to positively support
research efforts in practical applications (Darling-Hammond, 2006b; Francis, 2002;
Gunstone & Northfield, 1993).
In brief the participants confirmed the RTP factors identified in existing research and
went beyond this data to identify the benefits of parental support and self-
determination. These included the benefits of maintaining projects to respond to
parent’s questions and expectations once they were aware of the projects
implementation and strengths. The self-determination of individuals to continue to
strive to achieve desire project outcomes was described as having an infectious
impact on encouraging other stakeholders to participate. In addition the importance
of the interaction between the RTP factors on the sustainment of projects rather than
the need for a list of isolated RTP factors began to emerge during this introductory
phase.
364
In summary, the purpose of the exploration phase was to examine the existing RTP
literature and question individual participants to identify the factors that contributed
to sustaining research-based projects in inclusive education settings. The results
derived from this phase identified that knowledge gained from the RTP literature
was predominantly generated from commentary reports or intervention research that
aligned closely with this initial preliminary round of data collection. The reports
from participants about their cases had high levels of consistency and face validity
when compared with the extant literature.
Findings from the surveys and interviews also identified that when participants were
asked about their projects (without having prior knowledge of the literature); they
confirmed the importance of all the RTP factors except for the need for reward or
acknowledgement. All participants were more concerned about the projects and the
gains of their students rather than their own potential for financial reward or the
acknowledgement of their efforts. In addition to these findings all of the participants
reported links between RTP factors when describing their individual experiences.
Interestingly the same factors were described in sustained, scaled and extinct cases
yet the critical difference was the way in which the participants defined the
alignment or relationship between the factors. These descriptions were derived from
the rich case examples that identified the way the factors worked well together or
against each other to strengthen, scale or contribute to the extinction of cases. Those
cases that became extinct were characterized by marked change in the
interrelationships between the identified RTP factors over the course of the
implementation. This highlighted the significance of the relationship between
identified factors in projects upon the trajectories of RTP efforts. Broadly, the
participants identified a relationship between many elements required for successful
365
implementation, the way those factors interacted with their schools and respective
capacities to move forward and the practicalities of that movement.
The following section provides a summary of the additional results collected through
the second phase of this study that further explain how the RTP factors worked
together to positively or negatively influence the individual research to practice
cases.
6.1.2. Explanation phase
Research question: How did factors identified in the literature contribute to the status
of research-based projects in inclusive education settings? Describe any additional
RTP factors identified by participants as a result of their direct experiences? In what
ways did those factors exert an influence?
The tool development for the second phase of this research used the data collected
through the first phase to develop the questions for the second round of individual
interviews and Part 2 of the survey. This sequence in the development of data
collection tools assisted in generating deeper explanations from the participants and
allowed an opportunity for the researcher to clarify, confirm and expand upon
previously collected details. Part 2 of the survey was a comprehensive introduction
to the literature-based factors and participants were required to rate the presence of
those factors within their cases over the first three years of their project
implementation. In all six cases the responses made during the semi-structured
interviews were consistent with and expanded on the written survey responses and
comments made during open-ended interviews. Factors derived from the literature
that were not identified by participants during the exploration phase were generally
reported to be present during this explanation phase (see results chapter for specific
366
rating of factors). The more specific responses that were presented by the
participants originated from the more specific questions developed as part of the
methodology whereby the information gleaned from the exploration phase was used
to create more explicit questions.
A major finding of this study was that participants were not able to isolate RTP
factors in their explanations of the experiences at their settings. It was at this point
that the findings of this study departed from the RTP literature, which tended to
identify factors not relationships. Generally, participants identified that RTP factors
were unable to address the contextual demands of their setting if they were isolated
from other RTP factors. For example when participants were asked about the impact
of a RTP factor on their project, all responses made reference to the strong or
weakening relationships between multiple RTP factors. The depths of responses
gained through this phase went beyond the previous phase to provide explicit
examples of the multiple and complex connections between the identified RTP
factors that developed and changed over a three-year period. An example of this
includes the way all participants made reference to collaboration when responding to
questions Each participant alluded to the way in which their shared TE experience
modelled effective collaboration and demonstrated the need and impact of a
complete framework that weaved practical experiences into a theoretical framework
so that they understood and experienced the theoretical and practical requirements of
collaborative cultures. Many participants also made reference to the need for
ongoing feedback and communication in their explanations of ways in which
collaboration was enhanced or deteriorated at their settings.
367
Leadership support was another example of a factor that was not able to be isolated
from other sources of influence. It was raised by participants in conjunction with
other factors including the allocation of the required time, resources and increased
project status within schools. The removal of leadership support was linked to the
gradual breakdown in the allocation of as time, shared responsibility and
communication opportunities. This lack of support and connection between factors
was further linked to a reduction in project status as demands placed on staff
members increased.
These results indicate that implementing a research-based project is a process and
not a single event as successful implementation is dependent on the interconnection
of a combination of RTP factors. This interaction of factors was identified as being
more critical than a list of isolated factors to enhancing the sustainment of research-
based projects in practical applications. There was consensus amongst participants
that without these interconnections between factors, the success of research based
project sustainment would be compromised and the RTP gap became extended rather
than narrowed.
The importance of RTP factors working together to reduce the RTP gap was
evident in the cases that became scaled and those that became extinct. The
importance of the connection or relationship between RTP factors on the sustainment
of research-based projects in practice was further reinforced as participant responses
became more detailed. The practical application of the projects became less effective
as the connection between RTP factors became less apparent. During this phase the
impact of the changing relationship among the RTP factors and the status of the
projects became increasingly evident. The two cases that became extinct
368
demonstrated the impact of these weakening relationships between factors on the
reduction in strength and status of two different RTP examples. When reporting on
the implementation and first year of the sustainment of the projects, all participants
described the positive impact that resulted from RTP factors working together in a
reinforcing way to enhance the status of their projects. All participants still found it
difficult to isolate RTP factors when describing the practical application of their
projects. For example Sam’s comments about the support of the leadership at her
setting were linked with opportunities for timely feedback, with a common language,
which was woven into the design of the project. The importance of the connections
between RTP factors became more pronounced as participant responses became
more specific. Diane added to these links by stating that these features need to be
enhanced by regular meetings and the projects inclusion in the whole school plan by
being incorporated into the school timetable.
As the status of the two projects that became extinct began to diminish, Meg and I
described a definite change in direction from a positive cycle to a negative cycle.
Instead of factors working together to create a harmonious and reinforcing
progression, their connections became fractured and disconnected and they worked
against each other to create a negative cycle that reduced the strength and gains
originally identified within these cases. For example the change in leadership
brought a different agenda in my case, which diminished the focus on the project at
meetings and in school life. This led to a reduction in time allocation, resources,
emphasis or priority for project requirements due to the introduction of competing
agendas. In Meg’s case the leadership dynamic was still evident in a very different
relationship. For example the strong support of her leadership led to the decision to
scale the project across her setting, this decision was made at the executive level
369
without consultation with other stakeholders. This lack of communication
contributed to a lack of shared ownership and accountability, which increased the
workload of individual stakeholders.
Overall the purpose of the explanation phase was to provide a deeper explanation of
the way in which RTP factors contributed to the status of the individual cases. The
results derived from this phase identified that the depths of the descriptions were
strengthened through the use of previous responses to inform the subsequent data
collection tools. Responses collected through this explanation phase expanded on
those responses collected during the previous exploration phase to describe the
necessity of a broad cycle of connections between the RTP factors that are
responsive to the needs of each case.
Positive cycles were described in the four scaled cases where the connections
between the RTP factors became reinforcing. The opposite occurred in the remaining
cases that became extinct. These two previously strong cases began to deteriorate
when factors became misaligned and disconnected. Prior to these cases becoming
extinct, the projects were implemented and maintained successfully and the
connections between the RTP factors were moving in a reinforcing manner. When
the connections between the RTP factors began to break down, the positive impact of
multiple RTP factors working together began to deteriorate. The previously
reinforcing connections or relationship between identified RTP factors had
contributed to a smooth flowing cycle. As the connections between the factors
reduced so did the reinforcing cycle. Generally these factors fell from the broad yet
key areas being the people within their settings, the content of the projects and their
capacity to address the needs of the stakeholders. When these factors did not
370
maintain links between the key areas, the supportive cycle deteriorated. The
previously identified gains of the projects began to diminish and the project
gradually lost traction and sustainment in the real classroom applications and
eventually became extinct.
Wilma, Sue, Mary and Diane's cases demonstrated how the connections between and
across factors continued to positively impact the status of their projects. A significant
connection that resonated across all cases was the importance of well-aligned and
maintained relationships between school leaders and staff that worked toward
mutually aligned goals. In each of these four cases all stakeholders worked
collaboratively to address student needs, which remained central to their project
decisions. All four projects became part of their individual whole school plans and
were successfully scaled within and beyond their settings. The participants who
coordinated the two cases that became extinct confirmed the importance of these
factors working together through their accounts of the difficulties experienced in
maintaining their projects when connections between these RTP factors began to
deteriorate.
All cases continued to echo the findings of the previous phase and emphasized the
requirement and type of RTP factors essential to ensure research projects are
successfully implemented in classroom applications. During this phase participants
went further to describe three common core areas and the connections essential to
research projects becoming routine practice in school settings. These included the
people involved, their preparation and the reliability, scalability and accessibility of
the research-based projects being implemented. There were differences however
between the literature and the data collected as a result of the practical application of
371
the six cases. These differences stemmed from the importance of the connection
between RTP factors and the core areas. No participant was able to isolate the three
core areas in their descriptions of the practical experiences at their schools. This
phase of the study identified that for research-based projects to be successfully
implemented, sustained and scaled in school applications RTP factors cannot exist
independently of each other. They must work together in a reinforcing way. There
was a strong consistency in reports from participants that when the three basic core
areas were successfully united in real contexts, the capacity of stakeholders to
deliver and access usable and relevant content was strengthened.
The analysis of the data from participants through the explanation phase established
that when RTP factors work together rather than individually there is a greater
likelihood that the well articulated RTP gap would be reduced. Conversely, those
factors can also work together to increase that gap. In addition the significant finding
of this explanation phase was that the participants’ reports of the actual RTP factors
remained constant, it was the relationship that varied according to the needs of the
individual settings and the status of the projects. No participant was able to report on
individual factors in isolation and it was the way that the factors worked together that
had a direct impact on the impact and outcome of the research based projects within
case. This raised awareness and concerns about the density and complexity of
information required if educators and researchers are going to be successful in
reducing the RTP gap to address the needs of all students.
The following section provides a discussion that identifies key themes, links them to
the literature and draws conclusions of the results collected through the third and
372
final phase of this study in which all participants joined in a focus group discussion
to elaborate and compare the RTP factors that contributed to the status of their cases.
6.1.3. Expansion phase
Research question: What factors and relationships, between them contributed to the
status of research-based projects in inclusive education settings?
During this final phase of the project, all six participants shared in a joint discussion
about their individual projects and research to practice experiences. Participants were
able to share details about their project implementation and compare various aspects
across cases. Initial comments through this focus group echoed the importance of the
factors identified by participants in the exploration phase and the need for strong
relationship between these factors and how they were established as identified in
explanation phase. During the expansion phase discussions ranged from the shared
teacher education course being a lived experience to the need for flexible feedback
that addressed the changing needs of the staff and students within a complete school
wide approach. The collective dialogue made it possible to hold deeper discussions
across the total sample of participants to confirm and expand upon themes and the
responsive relationship between them. Consistencies and the single area where
opinions were divided were presented.
The voluntary comparing and contrasting of many project details elicited the deepest
knowledge of the projects strengths and the way their projects were implemented,
sustained, scaled or became extinct. During the extensive discussion participants
described the impact of the connection and interrelationship between and amongst
consistent RTP factors as being fundamentally important. They shared and compared
details about how the same RTP factors worked harmoniously or against each other
373
to impact the status of their projects within their unique school settings. The
importance of the relationship between RTP factors in linking key components of
RTP efforts continued to be illuminated in multiple examples as participants could
not provide accurate accounts of their practical experiences if factors were presented
mutually exclusively of one another.
The following examples provide specific demonstrations of the importance of the
way that the RTP factors work together to create a harmonious balance in which the
demands of research being applied in practice are distributed amongst all parts of the
whole school structure. Insights into the way the RTP factors worked together to
share the load to not overburden or weight any area within a whole school system
demonstrated complex connections between factors. These examples reveal how the
same RTP factors (that were identified in both the RTP literature and six practical
case examples) are referred to in interconnecting ways to create reinforcing cycles
that utilised research-based projects to address student needs in individual settings.
Knowledge of these complex connections became authenticated as case example
comparisons demonstrated how the same RTP factors materialised and functioned
differently across settings
The first two examples identify how factors were positively united in a reinforcing
cycle to address the needs of the students at different settings. The second two
examples identify how the connections between the same factors became
compromised and the success of the practical implementation of the projects
deteriorated.
Sam, Diane, Meg and I added to the description of the practical impact of the
connections between the support of the leadership, shared accountability and
374
communication on the sustainment of our projects. Sam reinforced that the ongoing
support from her school leaders led to assigned staff meeting time and other frequent
communication opportunities which enabled her staff to effectively respond to
teacher concerns soon after they arose. She extended her description to specify she
was given release time to work with staff in their classrooms and this encouraged
often informal discussions. With opportunities for increased communication the need
for explicit language that was understood by all became increasingly evident. The
need for communication in which all parties had a shared understanding of
terminology was expanded to ensure consistency in the use of explicit language with
parents and outside agencies. Sam described how these factors collectively worked
together to add support and interest in her project as other stakeholders wanted to
become involved.
Diane elaborated on the way consistent leadership support, encouraged the
timetabling of regular meetings with support staff and across the whole school. She
continued to reinforce that the project was prioritised by the school leaders and staff
as it was published in the school calendar. During the focus group Diane explained
that the inclusion of her project at this level prioritised it in the secondary setting and
this encouraged communication with staff across different faculties. Staff not
directly involved in the project began asking for feedback about project content and
student gains, which led to shared interest and increased potential for collaboration.
As consistent feedback was sought increased opportunities for communication were
also woven into grade meetings. These examples expanded on the data collected in
the first two phases to extend the comparison of how the same RTP factors were
united in different ways to create reinforcing cycles that made them responsive to
their unique settings.
375
Both cases that became extinct also added clarity to the insights gained through the
previous phases through their confirmation of the importance of the reinforcing
relationship between RTP factors by highlighting the result of the deterioration of
such connections. The following examples demonstrate the importance of this cycle
of reinforcing relationships through a diverse perspective being the results the
gradual breakdown in the balanced connections between RTP factors that link the
key areas. The extended discussion in the focus group encouraged the sharing of
specific details about the deteriorating connections between the same RTP factors
that were described by Sam and Diane. Meg and I attributed the lack of connection
between the same factors as having an adverse impact on the scaling of our cases in
previous phases. During the expansion phase it became increasingly evident how the
same factors being leadership support, shared ownership and communication worked
together or against each other in diverse RTP cases. The previously strong
relationships that were evident in my case began to deteriorate with the reduction in
leadership support. The reduction in leadership support diminished meeting time
allocation and funds for PD efforts were reduced. Informal staff room
communication about the project became compromised and scarce given the new
division of interest and ownership of the project. As the status and priority of the
project aims fell on the agenda of the new leadership team a gradual break down in
the connection between the previously mentioned factors slowly contributed to the
extinction of my project, as key elements were no longer aligned and working
together harmoniously. The same factors were also identified in Meg’s case yet the
relationship between them was once again unique in order to respond to the needs of
her setting. In Meg’s case the support of her leadership team was strong and active
yet the decisions to expand the project without consulting other staff members led to
376
feelings over being overwhelmed. Stakeholder became concerned that they were not
consulted prior to the decision to scaling the project and as a result their ownership,
support and interest in the project reduced. Although project meetings were still held,
the contributions of some stakeholders reduced and a subtle divide in staff resulted
as communication between interested and non interested stakeholders diminished.
Again the breakdown in the connection between the identified factors led to the
winding down and gradual extinction of Meg’s project. Through the two cases that
became extinct it became evident that as the way leadership exerts an influence on
time allocation, funding and decisions to scale can have a significant impact on the
capacity of RTP projects in practical contexts.
The data collected through the expansion phase, such as the description of accounts
related to leadership support and related factors, went beyond that of previous phases
to present specific cross case comparisons of RTP cycles. As well as the specific
examples of positive reinforcing cycles, negative cycles between the same factors,
which led to the extinction of two cases further, highlighted the importance of the
RTP connections.
All participants agreed that combinations of factors that work well to reinforce each
other are required for the effective use of research to address divers student needs.
The examples described referred to the relationship between the same factors being
leadership support, shared accountability and communication. These examples of
cases that were reinforced and scaled and those that wound down and became extinct
demonstrated how the connection and relationship between the same RTP factors
were prioritised over isolated RTP factors in all cases. Key considerations that have
been presented include the complex and reinforcing interaction amongst the 16
377
factors and the way they support the core elements within a school setting to engage
the ongoing and beneficial use of research-based projects in practical applications.
Participants consistently supported reports and descriptions linking the people
involved in the projects, their capacity, the contexts that united schools and
universities in preparing teachers and the projects and their content. Throughout the
discussion in this phase participants shared and compared the way in which RTP
factors united in reinforcing or damaging ways to create cycles, which positively or
negatively impacted on the sustainment, scaling or extinction of their cases. As these
descriptions and comparisons continued to evolve, a pattern emerged in which
participants consistently acknowledged the need for common elements. These
included the research-based projects, effective practice, leadership support, teacher
education and a complete and comprehensive approach. This expansion phase built
on the knowledge generated from previous phases and RTP literature as it identified
that factors within each of these common elements must be united if research based
projects are to be sustained in practical applications.
The examples of both extinct and scaled cases compared by participants confirmed
the need for strong relationships between the RTP factors that address contextual
realities. Participants continually identified that reinforcing relationships were a key
requirement to reducing the research to practice gap through cases that were wound
down and scaled up. The focus group discussion highlighted that all six participants
consistently identified reinforcing connections between RTP factors are critical if the
RTP gap is to be reduced. It also went beyond this to identify that the way they
connected was also of importance to ensure that they best fit the contextual realities
of their implementation settings.
378
Another major finding echoed in this phase was the importance of engaging teacher
education experiences. All participants confirmed the need for the people who are
able to promote productive relationships that encourage the use of effective research-
based projects to address a wide range of student needs. All participants consistently
repeated the connections between three vital areas being people, projects and their
preparation. Preparation referred to the teacher education program that was seen as
the key driver, which influenced many of the other RTP factors. These areas
represented the elements that when connected and supported through responsive
relationships between RTP factors may assist in giving traction to the sustained use
of research based projects in schools.
The only discontinuity or difference expressed amongst participants during this
phase was the need for state-wide assessments within schools. During this only
opportunity for group discussion Diane was the only participant who was in favour
of the NAPLAN assessment whilst all other primary school participants were against
them.
In summary, the final phase of the study provided an opportunity for all participants
to describe, compare and respond to questions seeking additional clarity and
justification from other participants about their cases. Over the three phases of the
study the six cases were described with increasing depth. Through the open
discussion of this phase participants revisited, paralleled and confirmed the
relationships they identified between RTP factors. This phase echoed previous
findings of both the RTP literature and direct experiences and went further to
identified how unique connections between the same RTP factors developed or
deteriorated across multiple settings to scale up or wind down RTP initiatives. The
379
interwoven connections between the stakeholders involved in research to practice
initiatives, their preparation and the project’s reliability, accessibility and scalability
were described as critical to reducing the RTP gap. The consistent reports from
participants describing cases across a range of settings provided additional
knowledge to extend our capacity to successfully implement and sustain research-
based programs in varying classroom applications to address a range of student
needs. Knowledge of how the connections between similar RTP factors became
reinforcing or destructive went beyond the current literature to provide direct
examples of ways in which the well articulated RTP gap might be addressed. The
importance of the reinforcing relationships between RTP factors was confirmed, as
projects were not able to remain sustained when the connections between them were
isolated or independent of one another as supportive and strengthening relationships
did not continue to develop.
6.1.4. Summative overview of the data collected through the three
phases of this study
In review this research explored the RTP literature to gain information about ways to
bridge the research to practice gap. These results were compared to participants’
accounts of what factors impacted on the sustainment of their projects, prior to the
RTP literature being introduced to them. The results of this exploration phase were
particularly compelling as there were strong similarities between the participants’
accounts of their direct practical experiences and the RTP literature, given the
literature bases RTP factors had not yet been introduced to participants. Although
this data was very beneficial in that it confirmed many RTP assertions through direct
experiences, one of the major findings was the inability of the participants to
separate RTP factors. The RTP literature tended to produce lists of factors as was
380
identified in the work of Carnine (1997a) and Sydoriak & Fields (1997) who
summarized these factors in their six principles (See literature review). Whilst in this
study participants built on this previous knowledge to validate these claims and
envisioned a milieu in real contexts where many factors interacted. Additional to this
finding, this phase also elicited the question “If the RTP literature and direct
experiences are identifying the same factors, why is the RTP gap still a concern?”
In striving to answer the overarching research question about the factors that
contribute to the RTP gap, the answer to the additional question continued to emerge
through the explanation phase of this research. It was expanded upon and confirmed
in the comparison of multiple cases in the expansion phase. Initially the results of
this research validated the literature based RTP factors through the identification,
explanation and confirmation of their existence in six diverse case studies. However
on further analysis of the results the additional significant finding was the way in
which the same RTP factors worked together or against each other to impact the
status of research-based projects in practical applications.
As the methodology elicited more detailed accounts and richer descriptions the RTP
factors continued to remain constant. They were the same factors identified through
a range of settings and project trajectories yet the way they were linked varied
significantly according to the needs of the unique school settings. One factor
influenced another factor to create interactive relationships between them. This
interactive relationship between RTP factors was reported to be cyclic in both extinct
and scaled cases. During the explanation phase, participants were unable to report on
RTP factors in isolation to explain the events or details they experienced and
witnessed through the implementation and sustainment of their projects. These
381
accounts were compared across cases during the expansion phase to confirm the
complex cyclic links between the same RTP factors that contributed to the
sustainment or extinct of research-based projects. The six well-defined relationships
between RTP factors consistently linked the projects, stakeholders and their teacher
education preparation. The form and specific descriptions of the relationships did
vary from case to case yet there was consistency in the RTP factors and the need for
a balanced alignment within a cyclic connection that supported the same core
elements. Essentially the key elements and the RTP factors remained consistent yet
the cyclic and multi-levelled interaction between the elements and the factors that
gave them capacity in their practical application did vary according to the needs of
the setting. It became increasingly evident that stronger or more reinforcing the
relationships between RTP factors the more likely the projects were to scale up
within and across settings. Conversely the reduction in strength or links between
RTP factors gradually contributed to the scaling down and eventual extinction of
research to practice cases as the previously identified RTP factors became
disconnected. Given the need to provide a usable, accessible and practical form to
the complexity and interactive nature of the relationship data collected through this
research, a RTP Model has been conceptualised as the most efficient way of
communicating my findings.
The following section builds on the existing literature and data collected from the
three phases of this study to respond to the overarching research question; what are
the factors and the relationships between them that contribute to research becoming
routine practice in classroom applications? Given the diversity of the response to
this question a RTP Model was developed to visually articulate the complexity
involved in raising an awareness of the ways that RTP factors align to build capacity
382
in the use of research based project content to respond to the contextual needs of
school settings. A RTP model was selected as the simplest form to build a deeper
understanding and extend the literature to provide future users with a scaffold of
validated variables and their alignment for the purpose of implementing and
sustaining research based projects to enhance students learning. The RTP model was
built from the range of accounts, knowledge and experiences gained from previous
researchers and research participants collected through the three phases of this study.
It visually presents the fundamental requirements and the cyclic relationship between
them that was identified as valuable to sustaining evidence-based projects in multiple
school-based applications.
6.2. Introduction of the RTP Model
The following RTP Model represents the findings of the extant literature and results
of the study. It expresses the importance of the connections that drive RTP so that it
can be beneficial to the development of the relationships that assist in the application
and sustainment of research-based project in school settings. This RTP Model is
presented in a hub and spoke configuration bound by the elements presented in the
outer circle, which, like a tyre represents the interface between a wheel and the
ground, constituting the practical application of research based projects in school
settings. The hub and spoke metaphor has been selected as the RTP Model is like a
wheel in which the whole can function in a manner that is greater than the sum of the
parts. The spokes (like RTP factors) can be configured in different ways, but if one
spoke fails and collapses additional pressure will be added to the other spokes. If
additional spokes fail, additional pressure falls on those that remain and the wheel or
cycle is no longer able to travel smoothly. In brief the hub and spoke model is
383
reflective of a wheel, which is a closed system that it is constantly interacting with
the environment to move forward in addressing the closed system context.
Hi Chris: Re the model- label the influences outside the model and have the arrows direct towards it so that they
do not seem to simply orbit it. Consider making the interior circles porous-broken lines or another strategy to
show that the input from the spokes can get to the hub.
384
Figure 7.1
RTP model
Context
ContentCapacityComplete,prac cal+accessible
Substa
n ve&o
ngoing
feedba
ck
ScalabilityG
enuinequesons
Withcleargoals
Sharedownership
&responsibility
Ongoingn
otasin
gle
even
t
Flexibility&abilityto
Respondtochange
Collaboraon
Reward&acknowledgement
Resour
ces&t
raining
thatad
dresss
takeho
lder
readin
ess
Technology
Projectsviewedas
credibleby
stakeholders
Leadershipschool
&system
Limingco
mpe
ng
demands
Sufficientongoing
Instruconal
me,
Preparaon&
resources
Consistentlongterm
supportthatconsidersthe
personalquali esofall
stakeholders
Preparaon Pe
ople
Projects
RTP
385
6.2.1. Description of the RTP model and the complex and cyclic
interconnection between the identified components
This hub and spoke metaphor was conceptualised to illustrate not only the essential
components of RTP endeavours but also the most significant finding being the way
they interact and align to make RTP efforts responsive to the needs of the
stakeholders at individual settings. The model is comprised of three main sections.
These include the outer circle that is comprised of the four verbs representing the
actions required to give practical application to the model. The four verbs were
selected as they characterise the key features of implementation efforts. For example
RTP approaches need to be engaging through the enactment of harmonious and
balanced relationships between RTP factors so that they are able to move through an
effective cycle, which addresses the practical requirements of varied implementation
settings. For RTP efforts to gain this effective traction in a school, they need to
engage multiple stakeholders to increase their capacity, skills and knowledge in
enabling students to benefit from research based knowledge by enacting with
integrity in areas including long term support, well aligned system and policy goals
and shared ownership and responsibility.
The inner circle includes a Venn diagram at the centre, which represents the dynamic
interaction and intersection of the broader yet vital components being the content of
the project, the capacity of stakeholders and the unique contextual variables of
school setting. These elements were originally derived from the theoretical base that
was retrieved from the RTP literature and then analysed to identify consistencies.
The paramount need for their reactive interaction was confirmed through the
trajectories of six direct RTP cases. The analysis of the results collected through this
study validated the components within the inner and outer circle as areas that should
386
be considered when designing realistic and effective RTP projects. However the
spokes that connect the inner and outer circles represent the key areas or factors that
constitute the scope and diversity of things to be considered in RTP efforts.
The spokes which symbolise the more specific 16 RTP factors were consistent
within both scaled and extinct cases and existed in differing alignments, not as
isolated factors.
The hub and spokes gave structure to the model in the cases that were examined yet
it was the well maintained connections or interrelationships between the RTP factors
that had the capacity to work together to enhance ongoing, effective and engaging
environments. This was evident in the four cases that were successfully implemented
then became scaled within and beyond their school settings. The break down in
alignment and engagement of parts had a negative impact on the sustainment of
research-based projects within two schools. This was evident in gradual break down
in Meg’s case as her project became scaled without shared ownership. This
contributed to additional pressure placed on the other spokes/factors including shared
ownership and responsibility, which gradually resulted in the extinction of her
project. It was also identified throughout my case as the withdrawal of leadership
support led to additional strain within and across other identified RTP factors
including limiting competing demands and projects being viewed as credible and
valued. As the spokes or RTP factors, relationships and alignment reduced in
strength, they increasingly became disengaged and the smooth flow of the cycle
experienced resistance and connections became strained prior to becoming extinct.
387
The following section provides examples of how the RTP Model applied to the six
cases and could serve to provide a guiding framework to enhance the future use of
research-based projects to address student needs across diverse educational settings.
6.3. Examples of the application of the RTP Model
Examples of the positive application of this RTP Model were exhibited through
Mary, Wilma, Sam and Diane’s cases. Each participant identified strong connections
between multiple RTP factors in the ways that they worked together to respond to
their contextual realities. They explained that their projects had the capacity to be
scaled to address their whole school contexts as elements of the Model worked
together to reduce the impact on individual factors. This complete cyclic approach
resulted in the implementation, sustainment and scaling of six direct RTP cases as it
proved to be practical, realistic and accessible when core elements including the
people involved and their capacity, the context and content of the projects
themselves were effectively enabling the engagement of RBP to enact and respond to
student needs.
An example of the application of the RTP Model in Mary’s case can be identified
through the way the spoke strength which included her account of the “lived teacher
education experience”, web support and timely detailed feedback supported the hub
elements being the context demands, her capacity and that of other stakeholders and
the sharing of meaningful and useful project content. As the strength in the
relationship between these spokes increased, the elements of the hub gained strength
as did the status of the project. As the cycle gained momentum teacher involvement
also increased. This positive cycle enabled the practical engagement of research-
388
based projects to effectively address the needs of the student and contribute to a
positive school culture.
Wilma’s case also demonstrated a positive and reinforcing connection between the
RTP factors that gave capacity to the central aim of her project, which was to
effectively use validated research to address student needs. This aim was given
traction through the strength of the relationship between the consistent evaluation
and feedback opportunities, well-developed student and teacher materials and
support spokes. These connections between the spokes gave strength to the
supporting structure, which assisted in ensuring that the project content was
responsive to the growth in stakeholder capacity, knowledge and ability in her school
context. Wilma’s case displayed that the interrelationships between the spokes
contributed to the maintenance of effective and engaging environments, which
enabled the practical use of research-based projects to address the diverse needs of
the students at her setting.
The structure identified in the previous examples yielded a complete research to
practice strategy. The effectiveness of this complete cyclic strategy was further
highlighted through the accounts of the deterioration between the elements that were
exhibited in the cases that became extinct.
These cases demonstrated that a reduction in the interaction between the support
factors or spokes reflected reduced harmonious links between the context, capacity
and content required for research to practice efforts to be sustained. This slow and
gradual break down between the connections between the spokes in Meg’s case
began with the lack of shared ownership and responsibility, which created a heavy
workload for Meg. The decision to rapidly expand the project by the executive
389
further contributed to a lack of alignment as it increased her workload and further
contributed to the reduction in shared ownership and responsibility. Gradually the
lack of connection between and amongst the RTP factors or spokes contributed to
the disengagement of stakeholders and their support for the project. This lead to
additional strain across other spokes reducing support structures for the harmonious
connection of the elements within the hub of the model. In turn the capacity of
stakeholders to use the research-based project content to address the needs of the
students in the school context was not maximised. With the lack of supportive
connections between the RTP factors spoke structure and the lack of balance in
elements identified in the hub of the RTP Model, the effective engagement of
research-based projects did not remain sustained and eventuated in the extinction of
the project.
As a result of completing this study it was apparent that the strong connections
between components of the model became reinforcing. The strong reinforcing
relationships between the RTP factors assisted stakeholders in their sustained use of
research-based projects to address student needs. The RTP factors or spokes
remained consistent, and each of them aligned differently to support the hub by
giving structure, strength and coherence to RTP efforts. When all the spokes were
aligned and well balanced, strong relationships between project content, stakeholder
capacity and educational contexts was supported which enabled the effective
practical use of research based practice. The uniqueness and practicality of this
model is its capacity to be adapted in ways that are responsive to individual
educational settings if implemented. It is not prescriptive in the type of relationships
between the factors that are required across all applications, yet the RTP Model
purports that differing alignments between the consistent factors will need to exist so
390
that the relationships and interactions in the hub of the model can ensure it remains
responsive to the needs of individual settings.
To summarize, the development of the RTP model emerged from the data collected
in response to the research questions as expressed across the three phases of this
study. It is presented around a hub and spoke metaphor, as all components are
required to exist in a cyclic relationship for a smooth ongoing progression to exist.
The model constitutes a visual example to demonstrate that a wheel can still turn
when its spokes become weak, however additional pressure is placed upon the other
spokes and the forward motion may encounter some resistance. This metaphor was
created to succinctly summarize and define the themes in the relationships described
through the three phases of this research. The volume and complexity of the data
collected to assist readers in comprehending the importance of the themes and their
connections when addressing the differing variables within individual school settings
is at the core of the hub and spoke metaphor. It is vital to note that the Hub and
spoke model is not a closed system, as just like wheels connect to the road, RTP
projects must interact with the students and stakeholders within school systems in
order to remain responsive and continue to move in a forward motion. This model
encourages feedback that informs the dynamic interaction between content, context
and capacity as represented by the hub. For this continued dynamic interaction to
exist, opportunities for feedback are encouraged so that any changes can be made to
ensure continued successful and responsive applications.
6.4. Future utility of the RTP Model
This RTP model could be used as a planning heuristic for an RTP effort by
designers, educators, researchers and policies writers and implementation
391
organisations that aim to promote the use of research-based projects to address
student needs. It is a metaphor that can provide a cognitive map for the features that
need to be addressed in RTP efforts. The RTP Model may be used as a guide that can
be implemented to develop an operational strategic and tactical approach that can be
employed to design future RTP initiates on a small or large scale within schools or
education systems. Its application is not restrictive and can be varied as it has the
scope to be responsive to the needs of students from diverse educational settings.
This can be achieved through the sensitive alignment of the spokes or RTP factor
content, which links the interaction between the core elements (hub) and the
practical application (outer circle) of the model.
At an obvious and distal level the Model does the following: It highlights in advance
of the application of an innovation, the need for a complete inclusive approach to
narrowing the RTP gap. If research is to become routine practice in our classrooms
and schools, a complete and comprehensive approach that considers all the different
parts of the Model should be beneficial. It recognises and addresses that different
educational environments are comprised of a wide range of contextual variables and
as a result will require different alignments and relationships to best address the
changing features of individual settings. The model also proposes that teacher
education is essential to adding clarity and uniting the RTP factors.
The model can be applied at different levels of an education system as it can be used
to map the territory for an RTP effort as it creates a schema for the scope of the work
required and the interactions from multiple perspectives. A school leadership team
interested in research-based innovations could use this RTP Model to raise awareness of the
extent of the effort that is required to build interconnections to address diverse fundamentals
if research-based projects are to be successfully sustained. School principals and system
392
leaders can build capacity by using the RTP Model to frame an assessment of needs and
an audit of the current circumstances, variables and dimensions of the school or
system. It can be used to frame the process and inclusions in that process (the
spokes) and to initiate the planning at the interface of the entities involve. It can also
be used to frame the design of an evaluation of an RTP effort at school or system
level.
Researchers designing research that sought to scale up the use of applied
interventions could use the RTP Model to guide the scope of their data collection
tools to ensure that their research addressed the diverse features and relationships
within the model. This could encourage increased mutual respect between
researchers and school based teachers through opportunities for ongoing and
substantive feedback enabling collaborative efforts to address educational
frameworks encouraging the use of research based projects to respond to the needs
of all children.
Education systems and policy designers seeking to build policy for the use,
development and enhancement of RTP could also use the RTP Model to comprehend
the scope of work to assist with budgets, professional development and sponsored
teacher education initiatives. Increased knowledge of the complete schema should
guide realistic expectations at all levels. This may assist in guiding awareness of the
attributes requiring long-term support within the complete RTP framework.
These are examples that demonstrate how the RTP model can be used as a metaphor
that firstly identifies all components essential to giving RTP efforts traction, and
more importantly recognises the significance of the relationships that makes the
whole model greater than the sum of the parts. If applied it may be employed as a
393
framework, which unites efforts of both educators and researchers as it has been
informed by knowledge gained from both perspectives as they strive to achieve the
same outcome of sustaining the implementation of research, based projects in
classroom applications.
In summary, this continued propensity for all participants to see and make the
connections across RTP factors was the major finding that amplified the need for a
RTP model if the RTP gap is to be reduced. The RTP Model was developed to
provide a metaphor that can be employed, with flexibility in the relationships
between the spokes, to ensure that all key RTP requirements are acknowledged and
adopted. With increased knowledge of the importance of the interconnections
required for the successful implementation and sustainment of research-based
projects, stakeholders may better align and attend to the contextual elements of their
unique school settings. If students and staff are to benefit from validated and
effective research-based projects, a strong association between the people involved
and their preparation is required. These elements presented in the hub of the RTP
Model are given capacity through the varying relationships between the spokes or
RTP factors (as presented in the previous examples) which link the inner and outer
circles of the model so that the application of research projects is effective and
engaging enabling all students to reach their potential.
The knowledge and application of the RTP Model may provide a tangible way to
address the gap between research and desired practice. The complexity of the model
reflects the complexity of the interrelationships required to enhance the sustainment
of research-based projects in classrooms. The gap between research and practice can
only be reduced through the development of cyclic and reinforcing relationships
394
which give capacity to the broader RTP factors, (identified in the outer circle of the
model) so that the inner specifics (core of the model), being the sustainment of
research based projects in our classrooms, can become a reality.
6.4.1. Summary
All settings were unique and presented varied contextual circumstances. As a result
RTP endeavours cannot have a “one approach fits all” philosophy. This study built
on and validated the work of previous researchers and raised awareness of the
complexities of the relationships involved in bringing research based projects to
scale in educational settings. The importance of the connections between RTP
factors rather than the factors themselves or the number of factors was prioritised
throughout this study. Factors will operate differently in varied educational settings.
A priority of this research is to use the model to express the scope and dynamic
interaction required if the RTP gap is to be reduced.
The development of the RTP Model was reflective of theoretical and practical
agendas as it stemmed from the knowledge gained from position papers and
intervention research that presented the individual factors that were asserted as being
critical to reducing the RTP gap. Many of these factors (see Table 2.1) were
identified in complex relationships and were verified as having an enabling or
inhibiting impact on the status of the six direct RTP cases examined. The
interrelationships within and across the RTP factors that unfolded through the phases
of the projects were identified as more significant than individual RTP factors.
Additional to the importance of the connection between the RTP factors, knowledge
of way these connections contributed to establishing reinforcing or destructive cycles
became apparent. Strong and reinforcing cycles enabling and enhancing the use of
395
research-based projects became a natural progression when student gains and
increased project status were evident. Conversely, strong embedded projects fell into
a destructive cycle when the spokes and their status and support for the projects
reduced. When the strength between the connections of RTP factors continued to
gain momentum and a natural reinforcing cyclic progression resulted. Alternately a
downward or negative cycle was identified as the reduction in the strength between
the connection of the factors contributed to their destruction and eventual extinction.
In brief, the components presented in the RTP Model can be configured in different
ways yet are all-important to the smooth forward cyclic motion that is required to
addresses the unique contextual realities of education systems, classrooms and
schools. The hub and spoke model represents a RTP strategy that considers the
essential RTP elements and they way in which they unite to work together to provide
designers, educators and researchers with a Segway or roadmap to promote inclusion
through the use of research-based projects to address the educational needs of all
students.
In conclusion the hub and spoke RTP Model builds on the RTP knowledge
previously generated by researchers as it provides a complete framework which can
assist educators and leaders in their efforts to address current endeavours to promote
inclusion through the use of research based projects. This RTP Model promotes the
connections between the spokes or RTP factors to drive the effective engagement of
sustained research based projects, which require the united approach of validated
projects, people and their preparation to build capacity in practical contexts. The
Model can be applied across a range of diverse settings as the relationship between
the RTP factors can vary according to the needs of each setting.
396
If employed the RTP model may have the capacity to contribute to educational
research becoming a reality in schools and classrooms if articulated in the design
stages of RTP efforts. This knowledge base can be employed to underpin efforts to
make classrooms more inclusive through its complete and comprehensive approach
and pre-articulation of the scope of work required. It could promote the alignment of
all levels of stakeholders within a school system through the need to echo and
support whole school RTP endeavours. If strong connections between the RTP
factors which link the inner and outer circles of the Model are not maintained, a
smooth journey may be less likely. Ideally the application of this RTP model could
potentially have the capacity to positively impact the translation of RTP and reduce
the RTP gap.
6.5. Limitations of the study and recommendations for future research
The use of a theoretical framework of knowledge that was informed by five bodies
of literature combined with the introduction of a method that employed various types
of case studies to guide this design was ambitious given the time and energy
required. The risk of implementing a new and unused framework was reduced
through the lessons learnt from previous researchers that contributed to providing a
scaffold to increase focus to add essential rigor of the design, which sought to benefit
from multiple perspectives given the intended diversity and scope of RTP initiatives.
Additional research which examined the direct implementation of the RTP Model in
both primary and secondary settings as well as its application in RTP efforts at
system and policy making divisions would be recommended.
Although a 1-5 rating scale was presented with clear definitions of the numerical
criteria for the completion of the surveys data, participants may attribute scores
397
differently. Data was also collected in retrospect participants had to reflect on their
early project details so it was possible that errors could be made given the time that
had lapsed. The use of the final Master’s projects (permanent product records, which
were completed as the projects were being planned and implemented), were used to
confirm data collected through the surveys and interviews. This limitation was
considered, yet causal comparative case study was selected as it allowed for factors
to be retrospectively traced over time (Stoecker, 1991, as cited in Yin, 1994) and this
assisted in resource assisted in validating the accuracy of details collected after the
implementation of the projects.
Although multiple case study may be considered a strength, the fact that all six
participants were from the same education system may be considered a limitation as
it limits generalizability. Future recommendations would be to conduct additional
research in this area employing participants from diverse educational sectors.
Location threat as defined by Freankel and Wallen (2006) in experimental studies,
refers to the concerns of data collection location and details differing in each case.
These concerns were reduced as data was collected under the same conditions by the
same data collector (see Methods chapter).
Projects were predominantly focused on reading instruction and assessment as this
was an initiative of the school system. This may be considered a limitation as RTP
may manifest differently with different foci. Additional research across school
systems with a wider range of projects would be beneficial. Yet reading is a common
source of RTP intervention making it representative of efforts in the area. Additional
research with other research based interventions other than literacy would be
beneficial.
398
A further limitation of the study may be differences in readiness levels of each
school setting as some schools may have had a more collaborative and inclusive
culture than others making and this was not formally measured. Participants did
report that their settings were ready for the implementation of their projects and they
each described the collaborative cultures, yet this was not determined using a
consistent approach. Future research, which collected insights and experiences from
the university staff that designed the Masters Course and the school system office,
based staff that control systemic budgets and staffing decisions would also have be
beneficial. This could have increased the strength of this study as it would have
investigated a broader range of case applications. Additional research using the same
methodological approach to gain insights from the experiences of systems and
course coordinator perspectives would be beneficial.
6.6. Conclusion
The purpose of this study was to contribute to narrowing the well documented RTP
gap by promoting the use of research to address the needs of a diverse range of
students within school settings (Abbott, Walton, Tapia, & Greenwood, 1999;
Carnine, 1997a; Gersten & Vaughn, 1997; Malouf & Schiller, 1995; Richardson,
1996; Stanovich & Stanovich, 1997). Through developing a deeper understanding of
the way in which research-based projects could be implemented and sustained to
enhance student gain could support a multilayered rather than linear approach to
RTP (DETYA, 2000).
It was hoped that the knowledge gained through this study could be applied to assist
teachers, principals, system leaders and policy makers in successfully responding to
diverse needs of students through the sustained implementation of research-based
399
projects. As a reults of this investigation seven major findings can be drawn. These
findings include;
1. The validation of RTP factors that were identified through five bodies of
literature
2. The importance of teacher education on raising awareness and skill in
relation to all components of the RTP Model and conversely raising the
awareness of these significant considerations required when planning and
designing future teacher education programs
3. The raised comprehension of the complex and diverse interconnections and
interactions essential to bridging the RTP gap through the merger of content
and process through a theoretical framework that was developed from both
researcher and school based practitioner knowledge and experience
4. The importance of giving capacity to stakeholders to address the demands of
unique contexts through the use research based content driven by the
complete schema identified in the RTP Model which was developed through
reoccurring themes across multiple cases in which the practice based
accounts and processes where more significant than the outcomes of
individual projects
5. To disseminate and promote the use of the work of educational researchers
through the sustained use of their efforts to address diverse student needs
across multiple applications.
6. Raise awareness of the complete schema that needs to be considered and
addressed for the implementation of research based projects as outlined in
400
national policies and frameworks that promote inclusive education. It may
also assist in budget decisions and the allocation of educational funds
efficiently through the guidance of future RTP initiatives
7. Provides an example of ways in which researchers and educators can build on
the strengths of their experiences to develop meaningful and long term
connections to design complete framework that benefit from the range of
standpoints to assist the education of students
The knowledge and validation of individual RTP factors is beneficial, yet
comprehending and enhancing the complex interrelationships between these factors
is key to enhancing and sustaining the use of research-based projects in school
settings. The importance of the integration between the content and the structure of
education efforts was validated as an avenue that is foundational to bridging the RTP
gap. This research confirmed that teacher educators share a responsibility for
providing educators with a lens through which to view every learner as valued and
essential. One way to cater for and value every learner is by employing the best
researched practices when working with them. Similarly encouraging TE program
designers to work collaboratively with educators by ensuring TE is “a lived
experience” through the merger of course structure was unanimously described as an
effective way to promote new knowledge and skill to enhance the success of
individual learners. A joint approach between researchers and educators, with
addressing student needs at the core of decisions, can provide coherent,
collaborative, and relevant opportunities for practitioners to develop skills that are
supportive and foster achievement for all learners. The ability to transfer knowledge
and skills gained through the TE experience to school-based colleagues can also
contribute to fostering strong relationships that promote may RTP endeavours.
401
With increased knowledge, shared ownership and capacity in effective use of
research-based project, stakeholders can better address the contextual elements of
their unique school settings. For all students to benefit from validated and effective
research-based projects, the preparation of stakeholders must consider the ongoing,
evolving and cyclic relationships which give capacity to ways that the gap between
the broader elements of RTP and the desired practice can be reduced. The analysis of
the six diverse extinct, sustained and scaled cases investigated confirmed that the
same RTP factors may be viewed as inhibitors or enablers, depending of the
sequence of events and the strength of the connections that are developed and
valued. The strength of these interrelationships was also shown to contribute to the
longevity of the RTP cases. Conversely, cases began to wound down when
relationships between RTP factors were weak or missing.
The importance of the connections within and between the people, their preparation
and the projects to create effective and engaging environments in which stakeholders
are able to use research-based projects to address student needs is presented in the
RTP Model. This model has emerged from the work of both researchers and school-
based educators to assist future RTP initiatives.
It is intended that the data and model can advance the progress of inclusion in
schools and the ability of teachers to respond to the needs of all students through
enhancing the sustainment of research based projects at their schools. This study has
contributed to addressing these concerns and has generated objective evidence about
varying alignments and reoccurring and intersecting interactions across all elements
within the RTP Model.
402
The use of the RTP model and its recommended application aims to promote the
sustainment of the extensive knowledge base on inclusive practice to make policy,
curriculum, materials, schools and classroom environments more responsive to
students from different backgrounds and with different learning needs. Through the
potential increased use of projects that enhance inclusion, it is hoped that segregation
will be reduced based on performance levels or perceived abilities (Cunningham &
Cunningham, 1992; Mastropieri & Scruggs, 1998; Mathes & Fuchs, 1994; Vaughn,
Hughes, Klingner, & Schumm, 1998; Vaughn & Klingner, 2000).
403
Chapter 7. References
Abbott, M., Walton, C., Tapia, Y., & Greenwood, C. R. (1999). Research to practice:
A "blueprint" for closing the gap in local schools. Exceptional Children, 65(3),
339-352.
Ahwee, (2003)
Aladjem, D. K., LeFloch, K. C., Zhang, Y., Kurki, A., Boyle, A., Taylor, J. E., et al.
(2006). Models matter - The final report of the national longitudinal
evaluation of comprehensive school reform. Washington: American Institutes
for Research.
Allen, E., & Cowdery, G. E. (2011). The exceptional child inclusion in early
childhood education. Belmont CA: Wadsworth Publishing
Allen & Johnson, (2012)
Allinder, R. M., & Beckbest, M. A. (1995). Differential effects of two approaches to
supporting teachers' use. School Psychology Review, 24(2), 287.
Allinder, R.M., Fuchs, L.S., & Fuchs, D. (2004). Issues in assessment. In A.M.
Sorrells, H.J. Rieth, & P.T. Sindelar (Eds.), Critical issues in special education
(pp. 106-124). Boston: Pearson.
Allinder, R. M., & Swain, K. D. (1997). An exploration of the use of curriculum-
based measurement by elementary special educators. Diagnostique, 23(2), 87-
104.
Allor, Fuchs, & Mathes. (2001)
Al Otaiba, S., Kosanovich-Grek, M. L., Torgesen, J. K., Hassler, L., & Wahl, M.
(2005). Reviewing core kindergarten and first-grade reading programs in light
of No Child Left Behind: An exploratory study. Reading & Writing Quarterly,
21, 377–400
Appelbaum, D., & Schwartzbeck, T. D. (2002). Defining, measuring and supporting
success: Meeting the challenges of comprehensive school reform research.
Washington D.C.: The National Clearinghouse for Comprehensive School
Reform.
Armstrong, D., Galloway, D., & Tomlinson, S. (1993). Assessment of special
education needs and the proletarianisation of the professionals. British Journal
of Sociology, 14(4), 399-408
Asselin, (2004???2003) Journal of Nurses in Staff Development, 19(2), 99-103.
404
Ax, J., Ponte, P., & Brouwer, N. (2008). Action research in initial teacher education:
An explorative study. Educational Action Research, 16(1), 55-72.
doi:10.1080/09650790701833105
Backtracking practices & policies to research DEYTYA?
Bain, A. (2004?)
Bain, A. (2007). The self-organizing school: Next generation comprehensive school
reforms. Lanham, MD: Rowman & Littlefield Education.
Bain, A., & Hess, P. T. (2001). School reform and faculty culture: A longitudinal
case study. New Hampshire: Brewster Academy.
Bain, A., McDonagh, S., & Lancastert, J. (2005)
Barnes, M. K. (1999). Strategies for collaboration: A collaborative teaching
partnership for an inclusion classroom. Reading and Writing Quarterly:
Overcoming Learning Difficulties, 15(3), 233-238.
Bates, R. (2002). Australian teacher education: Some background observations.
Journal of Education for Teaching, 28(3), 217-220.
Berends, M., Bodilly, S. J., Nataraj Kirby, S., & McKelvey, C. (2001).
Implementation and performance in New American Schools: Three years into
scale-up. Santa Monica, CA: Rand.
Bereiter, (2002)
Berniger, Abbott, Vermeulen, & Fulton, (2006)
Billups, L. H. (1997). Response to bridging the research-to-practice gap. Exceptional
Children, 63(4), 525-527.
Billups, L. H., Kornblet, A., Morrissey, P. A., Mitchell, S. M., Sydoriak, D., &
Fields, M. (1997). Response to bridging the research-to-practice gap.
Exceptional Children, 63(4), 533-534.
Blanton, L. P., Griffin, C. C., Winn, J. A. & Pugach, M. C. (Eds.). (1997). Teacher
education in transition: Collaborative programs to prepare general and
special educators. Denver, CO: Love.
Bogdan, R. C., & Biklen, S. K. (2007). Qualitative Research for Education. An
Introduction to Theories and Methods. Boston, Mass: Pearson international
Bogdan, R. C., & Biklen, S. K. (1982). Qualitative research for education: An
introduction to theory and methods. Boston: Allyn and Bacon.
Borman, (2009)
405
Borman, G. D., Hewes, G. M., Overman, L. T., & Brown, S. (2002).
Comprehensive school reform and student achievement: A meta-analysis.
Baltimore M. D.: Center for Research on the Education of Students Placed At
Risk.
Breen, L. (2007). Silenced voices: Experiences of grief following road traffic crashes
in Western Australia., (Unpublished doctoral thesis, Edith Cowan University,
Perth, Western Australia).
Breslin, M., & Buchanan, R. (2008). On the case study method of research and
teaching in design. Design Issues, 24(1), 36-40. doi:10.1162/desi.2008.24.1.36
Brouwer, N., & Korthagen, F. (2005). Can teacher education make a difference?
American Educational Research Journal, 42(1), 153-224.
doi:10.3102/00028312042001153
Bybee, (2005)
Calhoon, (2005)
Campbell, D.T. (1975). Degrees of freedom and the case study. Comparative
Political Studies, 8(1), 178-191
Capizzi, A. M., & Fuchs, L. S. (2005). Effects of curriculum-based measurement
with and without diagnostic feedback on teacher planning. Remedial & Special
Education, 26(3), 159-174. doi:10.1177/ 07419325050260030401
Carnine, D. (1997). Bridging the research-to-practice gap. Exceptional Children,
63(4), 513.
Carnine, Silbert, & Kame’enui, (1990)
Casale-Giannola, D. (2005). AID: An inclusion resource for student teachers,
cooperating teachers, and supervisors. Teaching & Learning, 19(2), 77-99.
Chris, (2009a)
Chris, (2009b)
Cochran-Smith, (2001). Constructing outcomes in teacher education: Policy, practice
and pitfalls. Education Policy Analysis Archives, 9(11), 1–40.
Cohen, L., Manion, L., & Morrison, K. (2000). Research methods in education (5th
ed.). New York: Routledge
Cohen & Spenciner, (2005). Teaching students with mild and moderate disabilities:
Research-based practices. Upper Saddle NJ: Pearson/Prentice Hall.
Coleman, P. (1979). Teaching, a profession for amateurs? Building
research/practice linkages via informal field-based training activities for
406
teachers. Paper presented at the Canadian Education Association/Canadian
Educational Research Association Conference. Retrieved 22 May, 2009, from
http://search.ebscohost.com/login.aspx?direct=true&db=eric&AN=ED180956
&site=ehost-live
COMPREHENSIVE SCHOOL REFORM QUALITY, (CSRQ). (2005). CSRQ
Center Report on Elementary School Comprehensive School Reform Models.
Washington DC: American Institute for Research.
Corcoran, P. B., Walker, K. E., & Wals, A. E. J. (2004). Case studies, make-your-
case studies, and case stories: A critique of case-study methodology in
sustainability in higher education. Environmental Education Research, 10(1),
7-21.
Creswell, J. W. (2003). Research design: Qualitative, quantitative, and mixed
methods approaches (2nd ed.). Thousand Oaks, Calif.: Sage Publications.
Creswell, J. W. (1998). Qualitative inquiry and research design: choosing among
five traditions. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publications
Crocket, J., & Kauffman, J. (1998). Taking inclusion back to its roots. Educational
Leadership, 56(2), 74-77
Cunningham, P. M., & Cunningham, J. W. (1992). Making Words: Enhancing the
Invented Spelling-Decoding Connection. Reading Teacher, 46(2), 106-115.
Cunningham, P. M., & Hall, D. P. (1994). Making Big Words: Multilevel, hands-on
spelling and phonics activities. Torrance, CA: Good Apple
Daniels, V. I., & Vaughn, S. (1999). A tool to encourage `best practice' in full
inclusion. Teaching Exceptional Children, 31(5), 48.
Darling-Hammond, L. (Ed.). (1994). Professional development schools: Schools for
developing a profession. New York, NY: Teachers College Press.
Darling-Hammond, L. (2000). Teacher quality and student achievement: A review of
state policy evidence. Education Policy Analysis Archives, 8(1). Retrieved
from http://epaa.asu.edu/ojs/article/view/392/515
Darling-Hammond, L. (2005). Prepping our teachers for teaching as a profession.
Education Digest, 71(4), 22–27
Darling-Hammond, L. (2006a). Assessing teacher education the usefullness of
multiple measures for assessing program outcomes. Journal of Teacher Education,
57(2), 120-138. doi:10.1177/0022487105283796
Darling-Hammond, L. (2006b). Securing the right to learn: Policy and practice for
powerful teaching and learning. Educational Researcher, 35(7), 13-24.
doi:10.3102/0013189X035007013
407
Darling-Hammond, L. (2010). The flat world and education: How america’s
commitment to equity will determine our future. Teachers College Press,
Columbia University
Darling-Hammond, L. (2000). Teacher quality and student achievement: A review of
state policy evidence. Education Policy Analysis Archives, 8(1).
Darling-Hammond, L., & Baratz-Snowden, J. (2007). A good teacher in every
classroom: Preparing the highly qualified teachers our children deserve.
Educational Horizons, 85(2), 111-132.
Darling-Hammond, L., & Berry, B. (2006). Highly qualified teachers for all.
Educational Leadership, 64(3), 14-20.
Darling-Hammond, L., Dozer, C., Johnston, P., & Rogers, R. (2006). Teacher
education. Teachers College Record, 108(8), 1688-1694.
Darling-Hammond, L., & McLaughlin, M. W. (1995). Policies that support
professional development in an era of reform. Phi Delta Kappan, 76(8), 597-
604.
Datta, L. (1990). Case study evaluations. Washington DC: US Government.
Davey, L. (1991). The application of case study evaluations. Practical Assessment,
Research & Evaluation, 2(9), 1.
Davidson, (2010)
Davidson, B. J., & McAllister, L. (2002). An introduction to qualitative research
approaches. Acquiring Knowledge in Speech, Language and Hearing, 4(1), 28-
31
Davis, B., & Sumara, D. (2006). Complexity and education: Inquiries into learning,
teaching and research. Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates.
De Landsheere, G., Masoner, P., Masoner, D., Dickson, G., & Kida, H. (1981).
Relating theory to practice through innovation: International Council of
Education.
Delquadri, J., Greenwood, C. R., Whorton, D., Carta, J. J., & Hall, R. V. (1986).
Classwide peer tutoring. Exceptional Children, 52(6), 535-542.
Deno, S. L. (2003). Developments in curriculum-based measurement. Journal of
Special Education, 37(3), 184-192.
Denzin, N. K., & Lincoln, Y. S. (2008). Strategies of qualitative inquiry (3rd ed.).
Los Angeles CA: Sage Publications
Department of Education & Employment (UK), (1998)
408
Department of Education Training and Youth Affairs. (DETYA) (2000). The impact
of educational research. Canberra: Department of Education Training and
Youth Affairs.
Devine, M. A., & King, B. (2006). Research update: The inclusion landscape. Parks
& Recreation, 41(5), 22.
Diane, (2007)
Disability Standards, (2005)
Duhaney, L. M. G. (1999). A content analysis of state education agencies'
policies/position statements on inclusion. Remedial and Special Education, 20,
367-378.
Dwyer, S. C., & Buckle, J. L. (2009). The space between: On being an insider-
outsider in qualitative research. International Journal of Qualitative Methods,
8(1), 54-63
Eash, M. J. (1968). Bringing research findings into classroom practice. Elementary
School Journal, 68(8), 410-418. doi:10.1086/460467
Eckert, T. L., & Shapiro, E. S. (1995). Teachers’ ratings of the acceptability of
curriculum-based assessment methods. School Psychology Review, 24(3), 497-
508.
Edelman, & Cloninger, (1994)
Education Research in Australia
Edwards et al, (2002)
El-Dinary, P. B., Pressley, M., Coy-Ogan, L., & Schuder, T. (1994). The teaching
practices of transactional-strategies-instruction teachers as revealed through
collaborative interviewing. Reading Research Report No. 23: National
Reading Research Center, Athens G. A., College Park M.D.
Ellis, (2005)
Englert, & Tarrant, (1995)
Epstein, J. L. (1996). New connections for sociology and education: Contributing to
school reform. Sociology of Education, 6-23.
Erwin, (1993)
Everington, C., & Hamill, L. B. (1996). Restructuring teacher preparation programs
for inclusion: The change process in one university. Contemporary Education,
68(1), 52-56.
409
Ezzy, D. (2002). Qualitative analysis: practice and innovation. Crows Nest, NSW:
Allen & Unwin
Faykus, S. P., & McCurdy, B. L. (1998). Evaluating the sensitivity of the maze as an
index of reading proficiency for students who are severely deficient in reading,
Education and Treatment of Children, 21(1), 1-21.
Fitzpatrick, J. L., Sanders, J. R., & Worthen, B. R. (2004). Program evaluation:
alternative approaches and practical guidelines, (3rd ed.). Boston, MA:
Pearson
Focus Group, (2009)
Foegen, A., Espin, C. A., Allinder, R. M., & Markell, M. A. (2001). Translating
research into practice: Preservice teachers' beliefs about curriculum-based
measurement. Journal of Special Education, 34(4), 226-236.
doi:10.1177/002246690103400405
Foorman, B. R., & Moats, L. C. (2004). Conditions for sustaining research-based
practices in early reading instruction. Remedial & Special Education, 25(1),
51-60. doi:10.1177/07419325040250 010601
Foreman, P. (2005). Inclusion in action. South Melbourne, Vic: Thomson.
Forlin, C. (2007). A collaborative, collegial and more cohesive approach to
supporting educational reform for inclusion in Hong Kong. Asia Pacific
Education Review, 8(2), 276-287.
Forlin, C., & Lian, M. J. (2008). Contemporary trends and issues in education for
special and inclusive education in the Asia-Pacific region. In C. Frolin & M.J.
Lian (Eds.), Reform, inclusion and education: Towards an era of special
education in the Asia-Pacific region (pp.3-12) Abingdon: Routledge.
Forness, S. R. (2001). Special education and related services: What have we learned
from meta-analysis? Exceptionality, 9, 185–197.
doi:10.1207/S15327035EX0904_3
Forness, S. R., Kavale, K. A., Blum, I. M., & Lloyd, J. W. (1997). Mega-analysis of
meta-analyses: What works in special education and related services. Teaching
Exceptional Children, 29(6), 4-9.
Fraenkel, J. R., & Wallen, N. E. (2006). How to design and evaluate research in
education. (6th ed.). Boston: McGraw-Hill.
Francis, N. J. B. (2002). Transforming for educational reform: A case study of a
teacher preparation center at a research university. New Orleans, MI:
American Educational Research Association
410
Fraser, B. J., Docker, J. G., & Fisher, D. L. (1987). A comparison of psychosocial
climate of different types of schools. Paper presented at the Annual Meting of
the American Educational Research Association. Washington DC
Fuchs, D., Fernstrom, P., Reeder, P., Bowers, J., & Gilman, S. (1992). Vaulting
barriers to mainstreaming with curriculum-based measurement and
transenvironmental programming. Preventing School Failure, 36(2), 34-38.
Fuchs, (1993)
Fuchs, D., & Fuchs, L. S. (1998). Researchers and teachers working together to
adapt instruction for diverse learners. Learning Disabilities Research and
Practice, 13(3), 126-137.
Fuchs, D., & Fuchs, L. S. (2001). One blueprint for bridging the gap: Project
PROMISE: (Practitioners and researchers orchestrating model innovations to
strengthen education). Teacher Education and Special Education, 24(4), 304-
314. doi:10.1177/088840640102400405
Fuchs, Fuchs, & Hamlet, (1989)
Fuchs, Fuchs, & Kazdan, (1999)
Fuchs, D., Fuchs, L. S., Thompson, A., Svenson, E., Yen, L., Al Otalba, S. & Saenz,
L. (2001). Peer-assisted learning strategies in reading: Extensions for
kindergarten, first grade, high school. Remedial and Special education, 22(1),
15-21.
Fuchs, L. S., & Fuchs, D. (1998). Building a bridge across the canyon. Learning
Disability Quarterly, 21(1), 99-101. doi:10.2307/1511375
Fullan, M. (2000). Three stories of educational reform. Phi Delta Kappa, 81, 581–
584.
Fullan, M. (1999). On effecting change in arts education. Arts Education Policy
Review, 100(3), 17-18.
Fullan, M. (1993). Change Forces: Probing the depths of educational reform.
London: Falmer Press.
Fullan, M., Galluzzo, G., Morris, P., & Watson, N. (1998). The rise & fall of teacher
education reform. Washington, DC: American Association of Colleges for
Teacher Education.
Fullan, M., & Hargreaves, A. (1992). Understanding teacher development. New
York: Teachers College Press.
Fullen, et al, (1998)
411
Gartner, A., & Lipsky, D. K. (1987). Beyond special education: Toward a quality
system for all students. Harvard Education Review, 57(4), 367-395.
Gersten, R., Baker, S. K., Shanahan, T., Linan-Thompson, S., Collins, P., Scarcella,
R., (2007). Effective literacy and English language instruction for English
learners in the elementary grades. (NCEE 2007-4011),Washington, DC:
National Center for Education Evaluation and Regional Assistance, Institute of
Education Sciences, U.S. Department of Education.
Gersten, R., Chard, D., & Baker, S. (2000). Factors enhancing sustained use of
research-based instructional practices. Journal of Learning Disabilities, 33(5),
445-457. doi:10.1177/002221940003300505
Gertsen, R., Morvant, M., & Brengelman, S. (1995). Close to the classroom is close
to the bone: Coaching as a means to translate research into classroom practice.
Exceptional Children, 62(1), 52-67.
Gersten, R., & Vaughn, S. (1997). What we know about using research findings:
Implications for improving special education practice. Journal of Learning
Disabilities, 30(5), 466-476.
Gersten, R., Vaughn, S., Deshler, D., & Schiller, E. (1997). What we know about
using research findings: Implications for improving special education practice.
Journal of Learning Disabilities, 30, 466–476.
doi:10.1177/002221949703000501
Gersten, R., Vaughn, S., Jenkins, J. R., & Downing, J. (1997). Responses to Hunt
and Goetz. Journal of Special Education, 31, 30–35.
doi:10.1177/002246699703100103
Gilbert, J. (1998). Through language the child moves from looking to seeing: Action
research into language as a tool to teach drawing. International Journal of
Early Years education, 6(3), 277-290.
Glesne, C., & Peshkin, A. (1992). Becoming qualitative researchers: An
introduction. White Plains, NY: Longman.
Golder, G., Norwich, B., & Bayliss, P. (2005). Preparing teachers to teach pupils
with special educational needs in more inclusive schools: Evaluating a PGCE
development. British Journal of Special Education, 32(2), 92-99.
doi:10.1111/j.0952-3383.2005.00377.x
Golafshani, N. (2003). Understanding reliability and validity in qualitative research.
The Qualitative Report, 8(4), 597-607.
Good, Guba, & Kaminski, (2002)
412
Good, R. H., & Kaminski, R. A. (2002). Dynamic indicators of basic early literacy
skills, (6th ed.). Eugene OR: Institute for the Development of Education
Achievement.
Good, R. H., Kaminski, R. A., Simmons, D., Kame'enui, E. J., & Oregon School
Study Council, E. (2001). Using dynamic indicators of basic early literacy
skills (DIBELS) in an outcomes-driven model: Steps to reading outcomes.
OSSC Bulletin, 44(1), 2-26.
Good, R. H., Simmons, D. C., & Kame'enui, E. J. (2001). The importance and
decision-making utility of a continuum of fluency-based indicators of
foundational reading skills for third-grade high-stakes outcomes. Scientific
Studies of Reading, 5(3), 257-288.
Goodlad, (1990). Goodlad, J. I. (1990). The occupation of teaching in schools. In
J. I. Goodlad, R. Soder, & K. A. Sirotnik (Eds.), The moral
dimensions of teaching (pp. 3Y34). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
Goodlad, J. I. (1993). School-university partnerships and partner schools.
Educational Policy, 7, 24–39. doi:10.1177/0895904893007001003
Gore, J. M., Griffiths, T., & Ladwig, G. (2004). Towards better teaching: Productive
pedagogy as a framework for teacher education. Teaching & Teacher
Education, 20(4), 375-387.
Gottlieb, J. (1981). Mainstreaming: Fulfilling the promise? American Journal of
Mental Deficiency, 86(2), 115-126.
Gravani, M. N. (2008). Academics and practitioners: Partners in generating
knowledge or citizens of two different worlds? Teaching and Teacher
Education, 24(3), 649-659. doi:10.1016/j.tate.2007.09.008
Griffin, M. L., & Warden, M. R. (2006). The effects of a university. International
Journal of Learning, 13(5), 187-194.
Grima-Farrell, C. (2007)
Grimes, J., & Tilly, W. D. (1996). Policy and process: Means to lasting educational
change. School Psychology Review, 25(4), 465-476.
Guba, E. G. (1967). The role of educational research in educational change.
Bloomington IN.: National Institute for the Study of Educational Change.
Gunstone, R. F., & Northfield, J. R. (1986). Learners - teachers - researchers:
Consistency in implementing conceptual change. San Francisco, CA:
American Educational Research Association.
413
Gunstone, R. F., & Northfield, J. R. (1993). Interplay between research and
practice: A case study of a preservice teacher education course. Atlanta, GA:
National Association for Research on Science Teaching.
Hall, G. E. (1978). Concerns-based inservice teacher training: An overview of
concepts, research and practice. Austin, TX: Research Development Center
for Teacher Education, University of Texas at Austin. (ERIC Document
Reproduction Service No. ED186375)
Hall, G. E. (1980). Evaluation of the delivery of services: A concern-based
perspective for the design of evaluations. Paper presented at the National
Conference on Longitudinal Evaluation of Bilingual Programs Austin, Texas.
(ERIC Document Reproduction Service No. ED186375)
Hall, G. E. (1982). Teacher education research commentaries. Journal of Teacher
Education, 33(2), 53-53 doi:10.1177/002248718203300211
Hall, G.E. (2009)
Hall, G. E., & Hord, S. M. (1987). Change in schools: Facilitating the process.
Albany, NY: State University of New York Press.
Hall, G. E., & Pratt, H. (1984). There really can be a symbiotic relationship between
researchers and practitioners: The marriage of a national R&D center and a
large school district. Austin, TX: Research Development Center for Teacher
Education. (ERIC Document Reproduction Service No. ED250816)
Hamel, J., Dufour, S. P., & Fortin, D. (1993). Case study methods. Newbury Park:
Sage Publications.
Hargreaves, A. (2007). Sustainable leadership and development in education:
Creating the future, conserving the past. European Journal of Education,
42(2), 223-233. doi:10.1111/j.1465-3435. 2007.00294.x
Hargreaves, A., & Fullan, M. G. (1992). Understanding teacher development. New
York: Teachers College Press.
Harry, B., Allen, N. A., & McLauglin, M. (1995). Communications verses
compliance: African-American parents’ involvement in special education.
Exceptional Children, 61(4), 364-377.
Hasbrouck, J. E., Woldbeck, T., Ihnot, C., & Parker, R. I. (1999). One teacher's use
of curriculum-based measurement: A changed opinion. Learning Disabilities
Research and Practice, 14(2), 118-126. doi:10.1207/sldrp1402_5
Hattie, (2003)
Hattie, J. A. C. (2009). Visible learning: A synthesis of over 800 meta-analyses
relating to achievement. Abigdon, Oxon: Routledge
414
Herriott, & Firestone, (1983)
Heyward, & Lloyd-Smith, (1990)
Hipp, K. K., Huffman, J. B., Pankake, A. M., & Olivier, D. F. (2008). Sustaining
professional learning communities: Case studies. Journal of Educational
Change, 9(2), 173-195. doi:10.1007/s10833-007- 9060-8
Hitchcock, G., & Hughes, D. (1995). Research and the teacher: A qualitative
introduction to school-based research. (2nd ed.). London. NY; Routledge.
Hord, S. M. (1981). Understanding the change process: A primer for teacher
educators. Austin, TX: Research Development Center for Teacher Education.
Hord,S. M., Rutherford, W. L., Huling-Austin, L. L., & Hall, G. E. (1987). Taking
charge of change. Austin TX: Southwest Educational Development
Laboratory.
Horsley, D. L., & Loucks-Horsley, S. (1998). CBAM brings order to the tornado of
change. Journal of Staff Development, 19(4), 17-20.
Houck, C. K., & Rogers, C. J. (1994). The special/general education initative for
students with specific learning. Journal of Learning Disabilities, 27(7), 435-
453.
Huberman, & Miles, (1987)
Huberman & Miles, (2002)
Hurley, E. A., Chamberlain, A., Slavin, R. E., & Madden, N. A. (2001). Effects of
success for all on TAAS reading scores. Phi Delta Kappan, 82(10), 750-756.
Innes, R. B. (2007). Dialogic communication in collaborative problem solving
groups. International Journal for the Scholarship of Teaching and Learnind,
1(1), 1-19.
Janney, & Snell, (1997)
Jenkins, J. R. & Jewell, M. (1993). Examining the validity of two measures for
formative teaching: Reading aloud and maze. Exceptional Children, 59(5),
421-432.
Jenkins, & Leicester, (1992)
Johnson, G. M. (1997). Teachers in the inner city: Experienced-based ratings of
factors that place students at risk. Preventing School Failure, 42(1), 19-26.
Kaufman, J. (1993). How we might achieve radical reform of special education.
Exceptional Children, 60(1), 6-16.
415
Keller, (2002)
Killen, (2003)
Klingner, J., Ahwee, S., Pilonieta, P., & Menendez, R. (2003). Barriers and
facilitators in scaling up research-based practices. Exceptional Children, 69(4),
411-419.
Klingner, J., Arguelles, M. E., Hughes, M. T., & Vaughn, S. (2001). Examining the
schoolwide "spread" of research-based practices. Learning Disability
Quarterly, 24(4), 221-234. doi:10.2307/1511112
Klingner, J., Vaughn, S., Arguelles, M. E., Hughes, M. T., & Leftwich, S. A. (2004).
Collaborative strategic reading: "Real-world" lessons from classroom teachers.
Remedial and Special Education, 25(5), 291-302.
doi:10.1177/07419325040250050301
Klingner, J., Vaughn, S., Hughes, M. T., & Arguelles, M. E. (1999). Sustaining
research-based practices in reading a 3-year follow-up. Remedial & Special
Education, 20(5), 263-274. doi:10.1177/07419325 9902000502
Klingner, J., Vaughn, S., Schumm, J. S., Cohen, P., & Forgan, J. W. (1998).
Inclusion or pull-out: Which do students prefer? Journal of Learning
Disabilities, 31(2), 148-158. doi:10.1177/002221949803100205
Kochanek, J. R. (2005). Building trust for better schools: Research-based practices.
Thousand Oaks, CA: Corwin Press.
Kornblet, A. (1997). Response to bridging the research-to-practice gap. Exceptional
Children, 63(4), 523-524.
Korthagen, (2001)
Korthagen, F. A. J. (2004). In search of the essence of a good teacher: Towards a
more holistic approach in teacher education. Teaching and Teacher Education,
20(1), 77-97. doi:10.1016/j.tate.2003.10.002
Korthagen, F. A. J. (2007). The gap between theory and practice revisited.
Educational Research & Evaluation, 13(3), 303-310.
Korthagen, F. A. J. (2010). How teacher education can make a difference. Journal of
Education for Teaching, 36(4), 407-423.
Kratochwill, T. R., Hitchcock, J., Horner, R. H., Levin, J. R., Odom, S. L.,
Rindskopf, D. M., & Shadish, W. R. (2010). Single-case designs technical
documentation. Retrieved from What Works Clearinghouse website:
http://ies.ed.gov/ncee/wwc/pdf/wwc_scd.pdf .
416
Kratochwill, T. R., & Shernoff, E. S. (2003). Evidence-based practice: Promoting
evidence-based interventions in school psychology. School Psychology
Quarterly, 18, 389–408. doi:10.1521/scpq.18.4. 389.27000
Kuhn, & Stahl, (2003)
Kurki, A., Boyle, A., & Aladjem, D. K. (2006). Implementation: Measuring and
explaining the fidelity of CSR implementation. Journal of Education for
Students Placed at Risk (JESPAR), 11(1), 255-277.
Lembke, E. S., & Espin, C. A. (2005). Curriculum-based measurement: Using
progress monitoring to influence instruction. In G. Sideridis & T. Citro (Eds.),
Research to Practice: Effective Interventions in Learning Disabilities (pp.
144-167). United States: Learning Disabilities Worldwide.
Lincoln, Y. S., & Guba, E. G. (1985). Naturalistic Inquiry. Beverly Hills. CA: Sage
Lincoln, & Guba, (2000)
Lipsky, D. K., & Gartner, A. (1996). Inclusion, school restructuring, and the
remaking of American society. Harvard Educational Review, 66(4), 762-796.
Lipsky, D. K., & Gartner, A. (1997). Inclusion and school reform: Transforming
America’s classrooms. Baltimore, MD: Brookes.
Lipsky, D. K., & Gartner, A. (1998). International perspectives on special education
reform. European Journal of Special Needs education, 13(1), 128-137.
Little, M. E., & Houston, D. (2003). Research into practice through professional
development. Remedial and Special Education, 24(2), 75-87.
doi:10.1177/07419325030240020301
Lloyd, J. W., Weintraub, F. J., & Safer, N. D. (1997). A bridge between research and
practice: Building consensus. Exceptional Children, 63(4), 535-538.
Loreman, T., Deppeler, J., & Harvey, D. (2011). Inclusive Education: Supporting
diversity in the classroom. Crows Nest, NSW: Allen & Unwin.
Loucks-Horsley, & Stiegelbauer, (1991)
Louis, K. S., & Jones, L. M. (2001). Dissemination with impact: What research
suggests for practice in career and technical education. Columbus, OH:
National Dissemination Center for Career and Technical Education, Ohio State
University. (ERIC Document Reproduction Service No. ED461768)
MacArthur, Schwartz, Graham, Molloy, & Harris, (1996)
417
MacIver, M. A., Kemper, E., & Springfield, S. (2003). The Baltimore Curriculum
Study: Final Report of the Four-Year Evaluation Study. Baltimore, MD:
Center for Research on the Education of Students Placed at Risk.
Madden, N. A., Slavin, R. E., Karweit, N. L., Dolan, L. J., & Wasik, B. A. (1993).
Success for all: Longitudinal effects of a restructuring program for inner-city
elementary schools. American Educational Research journal, 30(1), 123-148.
Madelaine, A., & Wheldall, K. (2004). Curriculum-based measurement of reading:
Recent advances. International Journal of Disability Development and
Education, 51(1), 57.
Malone, M. R. (1984). Concerns based adoption model (CBAM): Basis for an
elementary science methods course. Journal of Research in Science Teaching,
21(7), 755-768. doi:10.1002/tea.3660210709
Malouf, D. B., & Schiller, E. P. (1995). Practice and research in special education.
Exceptional Children, 61(5), 414-424.
Marriam, (1998)
Martens, B., Eckert, T., Begeny, J., Lewandowski, L., DiGennaro, F., Montarello, S.,
et al. (2007). Effects of a fluency-building program on the reading
performance of low-achieving second and third grade students. Journal of
Behavioral Education, 16(1), 38-53.
Mary, (2007)
Mary, (2009)
Marzano, R. J. (1998). A theory-based meta-analysis of research on instruction.
Office of Educational research and Improvement (ED), Washington DC.
Marchand-Martella, Martella, Bettis, & Blakey, (2004)
Mastropieri, M. A., & Scruggs, T. E. (1998). Constructing more meaningful
relationships in the classroom: Mnemonic research into practice. Learning
Disabilities Research and Practice, 13(3), 138-145. (ERIC Document
Reproduction Service No. ED571938)
Mathes, P. G., & Fuchs, L. S. (1993). Peer-mediated reading instruction in special
education resource rooms. Learning Disabilities Research and Practice, 8(4),
233-243.
Mathes, P. G., & Fuchs, L. S. (1994). The efficacy of peer tutoring in reading for
students with mild disabilities: A best-evidence. School Psychology Review,
23(1), 59-81.
418
Maxwell, J. A. (2004). Causal explanation, qualitative research, and scientific
inquiry in education. Educational Researcher, 33(2), 3-11.
McGlinchey, M. T., & Hixson, M. D. (2004). Using curriculum-based measurement
to predict performance on state assessments in reading. School Psychology
Review, 33(2), 193-203.
McLauglin, M. J., & Warren, S. H. (1992). Issues & options in restructuring schools
and special education programs. Office of Special Education and
Rehabilitative Services (ED), Washington, DC.
McLeskey, J., & Billingsley, B. S. (2008). How does the quality and stability of the
teaching force influence the research-to-practice gap? A perspective on the
teacher shortage in special education. Remedial & Special Education, 29(5),
293-305. doi:10.1177/0741932507312010
McLeskey, J., & Waldron, N. L. (2006). Comprehensive school reform and inclusive
schools. Theory Into Practice, 45(3), 269-278.
Meg, (2006)
Meg, (2007)
Meg, (2009)
Miles, M. B., & Huberman, A. M. (1994). Qualitative data analysis: An expanded
sourcebook (2nd ed.). Thousand Oaks: Sage Publications.
Miller, D. N., George, M. P., & Fogt, J. B. (2005). Establishing and sustaining
research-based practices at centennial school: A descriptive case study of
systemic change. Psychology in the Schools, 42(5), 553-567.
doi:10.1002/pits.20091
Miretzky, D. (2007). A view of research from practice: Voices of teachers. Theory
Into Practice, 46(4), 272-280. doi:10.1080/00405840701593857
Mishler, (1996)
Mishler, (2000)
Mitchell, S. M. (1997). Response to bridging the research-to-practice gap.
Exceptional Children, 63, 533– 534.
Mitchell, (2008)
Morrison, (2002)
Morrissey, (1997)
What Matters Most:Teaching for America’s Future
419
The National Commission on Teaching & America’s Future
National Inquiry into the Teaching of Literacy, (2005)
National Joint Committee on Learning Disabilities, (1999)
National Reading Panel. (2000, April). Report of the National Reading Panel:
Teaching children to read (NIH Publication No. 00-4654). Bethesda, MD:
National Institute of Child Health and Human Development, National
Institutes of Health.
National Research Council (1998)
Neilson, (2003)
No Child Left Behind Act of 2001, 20 U.S.C. 70 § 6301 et seq. (2002)
Noble, (2010)
Nuthall, G. (2004). Relating classroom teaching to student learning: A critical
analysis of why research has failed to bridge the theory-practice gap. Harvard
Educational Review, 74(3), 273-306.
O’Leary, (1996)
O'Neil, J. (1994). Aiming for new outcomes: The promise and the reality.
Educational Leadership, 51(6), 6-10.
Orland, Connolly, Fong,Sosenko, Tushnet, Yin, Burt, & Warners, (2008)
Pascale et al, (2002)
Patton, M.Q. (1990). Qualitative evaluation and research methods (2nd ed.).
Newbury Park, CA: Sage Publications.
Patton, (2001)
Patton, M.Q. (2002). Qualitative evaluation and research methods (3rd ed.).
Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publications.
Patton, M.Q. (2003). Qualitative evaluation checklist. Michigan, IL: Western
Michigan University.
Pratt, H. (1982). Case studies of school improvement: A concerns based approach.
Washington, DC: National Institute of Education.
Pratt, H., Thurber, J.C., Hall, G.E., & Hord, S.M. (1982, November). Case studies of
school improvement: A concerns based approach. Paper presented at the
meeting of the International School Improvement Project, Palm Beach, FL.
Randell, Giles, Nelley, & Smith, (2002)
420
Research and its impact on Australian Schools DETYA?
Richardson, V. (1996). From behaviorism to constructivism in teacher education.
Teacher Education and Special Education, 19(3), 263-271.
doi:10.1177/088840649601900324
Richardson, Anders, Tidwell, & Lloyd, (1991)
Rogers, (1993)
Rohrbeck, C. A., Ginsburg-Block, M. D., Fantuzzo, J. W., & Miller, T. R. (2003).
Peer-assisted learning interventions with elementary school students: A meta-
analytic review. Journal of Educational Psychology, 95, 240-257
Roland, W. S., Daniel, J. L., Arnim, W., Alexander, I. W., & Michael, S. (2006).
Transdisciplinary case studies as a means of sustainability learning: Historical
framework and theory. International Journal of Sustainability in Higher
Education, 7(3), 226-251.
Ross, S. M., Smith, L. J., Madden, N. A., & Slavin, R. E. (1997). Improving the
academic success of disadvantaged children: An examination of success for all.
Psychology in the Schools, 34(2), 171-180.
Ross et al, (1995)
Russell, T., McPherson, S., & Martin, A. K. (2001). Coherance and collaboration in
teacher education reform. Canadian Journal of Education, 26(1), 37-55.
Rutherford, W. L. (1982). Describing the concerns principals have about facilitating
change. Austin, TX: Austin Research Development Center for Teacher
Education.
Rutherford, W. L. (1986, April). Teachers' contributions to school improvement:
Reflections on fifteen years of research. Paper presented at the Annual
Meeting of the American Educational Research Association, San Francisco,
CA. (ERIC Document Reproduction Service No. ED 271462)
Sailor, W. (1991). Special education in the restructured school. Remedial and
Special Education, 12, 8– 22. doi:10.1177/074193259101200604
Sailor, W., Gee, K., & Karasoff, P. (1993). Full inclusion and school restructuring.
In M.E. Snell (Ed.), Instruction of students with severe disabilities (4th ed., pp.
1-30). New York: Charles Merrill.
Sam (2007)
Sam, (2009)
Salend, S. J., & Duhaney, L. M. G. (1999). The impact of inclusion on students with
and without disabilities and their educators. Remedial and Special Education,
421
20, 114-126. doi:10.1177/07419325 9902000209
Scanlon, Deshler, & Schumaker, (1996)
Schmidt, R. J., Rozendal, M. S., & Greenman, G. G. (2002). Reading instruction in
the inclusion classroom: Research-based practices. Remedial and Special
Education, 23(3), 130-140. doi:10.1177/07419325020230030101
Schneider, B., & McDonald, S. K. (2006). Scale up in education: Volume 2: Issues
in practice. Blue Ridge Summit, PA: Rowman & Littlefield Publishers Inc.
Schulz, R. (2010). Inquiry-orientated teacher education. Baker, E., McGaw, B.,
Peterson, P. (eds.) International Encyclopaedia of Education (3rd ed.). Oxford:
Elsevier.
Schumm, J. S., & Vaughn, S. (1995). Meaningful professional development in
accommodating students with disabilities: Lessons learned. Remedial &
Special Education, 16(6), 344-353. doi:10.1177/074193259501600604
Seale, C. (1999). The quality of qualitative research. London: Sage Publications.
Seashore, K., & Jones, L. M. (2001). Dissemination with Impact: What research
suggests for practice in career and technical education Ohio: National
Dissemination Center for Career and Technical Education, Ohio State
University.
Shallcross, T., Loubser, C., Le Roux, C., O'Donoghue, R., & Lupele, J. (2006).
Promoting sustainable development through whole school approaches: An
international, intercultural teacher education research and development project.
Journal of Education for Teaching, 32(3), 383-401. doi:10.1080/
02607470600782427
Shanker, (1995)
Sharma et al, (2006)
Sherwood, T. (1999). A practical look at comprehensive school reform for rural
schools. Charleston WV: Eric Clearinghouse on Rural Education.
Shinn, (2002)
Shinn, & Good, (1992)
Shinn, Knutson, Good, Tilly, & Collins, (1992)
Simmons, D. C., Kame'enui, E. J., Good, R. H., Harn, B. A., Cole, C., & Braun, D.
(2000). Building, implementing, & sustaining a beginning reading model:
School by school and lessons learned (No. 43). Oregon: OSSC Bulletin.
422
Singal, N. (2008). Working towards inclusion: Reflections from the classroom.
Teacher & Teacher education, 24(6), 1516-1529.
Skin et al, (2000)
Slavin, R. E. (2004). Translating research into widespread practice: The case of
success for all. Baltimore MD: Success for All Foundation.
Slavin, R. E., & Madden, N. A. (2001). Success for all and comprehensive school
reform evidence-based policies for urban education. Washington, DC: U.S.
Dept. of Education, Office of Educational Research and Improvement,
Educational Resources Information Center.
Slavin, R. E., Madden, N. A., & Educational Resources Information Center (U.S.).
(2001). Success for all and comprehensive school reform evidence-based
policies for urban education [microform :]. Washington, DC: U.S. Dept. of
Education, Office of Educational Research and Improvement, Educational
Resources Information Center.
Slavin et al, (2006)
Slee, (2005)
Smith, G. J., Schmidt, M., Edelen-Smith, P. J. & Cook, B. G. (in press). Merging
Evidence- based Practices with Practice-based Evidence in Pasteur’s Quadrant.
Exceptional Children.
Smith, T. E., Polloway, E. A., Patton, J. R., & Dowdy, C. A. (1998). Teaching
students with special needs in inclusive settings. Needham Heights, MA: Allyn
and Bacon.
Sparks, D., & Richardson, J. (1997). A Primer on professional development. Journal
of staff development, 18(4), 1-8.
Stainback, & Stainback, (1991)
Stake, R.E. (1995). The art of case study research. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage
Publications.
Stanovich, (1986)
Stanovich, P. J., & Stanovich, K. E. (1997). Research into practice in special
education. Journal of Learning Disabilities, 30(5), 477-481.
doi:10.1177/002221949703000502
423
Stecker, P. M., Fuchs, L. S., & Fuchs, D. (2005). Using curriculum-based
measurement to improve student achievement: Review of research. Psychology
in the Schools, 42(8), 795.
Stecker, P. M., & Skinner, M. E. (2006). Using curriculum-based measurement to
monitor reading progress in inclusive elementary settings. Reading & Writing
Quarterly, 22(1), 91-97.
Stenbacka, C. (2001). Qualitative Research requires quality concepts of its own.
Management Decision, 39(7), 551-555.
Sullivan, (2002)
Swain, K. D., & Allinder, R. M. (1996). The effects of repeated reading on two types
of CBM: Computer maze and oral reading with second-grade students with
learning disabilities. Diagnostique, 21(2), 51-66.
Sweeny, A. E. (2003). Theory and practice in science teaching. Teachers and
Teaching: Theory and Practice, 9(2), 107-132.
Sydoriak, D., & Fields, M. (1997). Response to bridging the research-to-practice
gap. Exceptional Children, 63(4), 529-530.
Teacher Knowledge in Action
The ERIC clearinghouse on disabilities and gifted education. (2003). Using data:
Innovative ways to improve results for students with disabilities. Research
Connections in Special Education, 13(1), 3-10.
The National Commission on Teaching & America’s Future, (1996). What matters
most: Teaching for America’s future. Woodbridge, VA:
The Selby Smith Report, (1999)
Titone, C. (2005). The philosophy of inclusion: Roadblocks and remedies for the
teacher and the teacher educator. Journal of Educational Thought, 39(1), 7-32.
Toch, T. (1982). Teacher centres may collapse when they are needed most.
Education Week, 1(22), 5-14.
Tomlinson, C. A. (2001). How to differentiate instruction in mixed-ability
classrooms (2nd ed.). Alexandria VA: Association for Supervision and
Curriculum Development
Tomlinson, C. A. (2004). How to differentiate instruction in mixed ability
classrooms. Association of Supervision and Curriculum Development.
424
Topping, K., & Ehly, S. (1998). Introduction to peer-assisted learning. In K. Topping
& S. Ehly (Eds.), Peer-assisted learning (pp1-23). Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence
Erlbaum.
Tyack, D., & Cuban, L. (1995). Tinkering toward utopia: A century of public school
reform. USA: Harvard College.
UNESCO, (1994). The Salamanca statement and framework for action on special
needs education. Paris
US Department of Education (2004)
Vaughn, (2000)
Vaughn, S., Hughes, M. T., Schumm, J. S., & Klingner, J. (1998). A collaborative
effort to enhance reading and writing instruction in inclusion classrooms.
Learning Disability Quarterly, 21(1), 57-74. doi:10.2307/1511372
Vaughn, S., & Klingner, J. (2000). Sustainability of research-based practices.
Exceptional Children, 66(2), 163.
Vaughn, S., Klingner, J. K. & Bryant, D.P. (2001). Collaborative strategic reading as
a means to enhance peer-mediated instruction for reading comprehension and
content-area learning. Remedial & Special Education, 22(2), 66-74.
doi:10.1177/074193250102200201
Vaughn, S., Klingner, J., & Hughes, M. (2000). Sustainability of research-based
practices. Exceptional Children, 66(2), 163-171.
Vavrus, M., (2002) Transforming the multicultural education of teachers: theory,
research and practice. New York, NY: Teachers College Press.
Villa, R. A., & Thousand, J. (2000). Inclusion: Welcoming, valuing, and supporting
the diverse learning needs of all students in shared general education
environments. Special Services in the Schools, 15(1), 73-108.
Villa, R. A., & Thousand, J. S. (1996). Preparing teachers to support inclusion:
Preservice and inservice programs. Theory Into Practice, 35(1), 42-51.
Villa, R. A., Thousand, J. S., & Chapple, J. W. (1996). Preparing teachers to support
inclusion: Preservice and inservice programs. Theory Into Practice, 35, 42–50.
doi:10.1080/00405849609543700
Volonino, V., & Zigmond, N. (2007). Promoting research-based practices through
inclusion? Theory Into Practice, 46(4), 291-300.
doi:10.1080/00405840701593873
Waldron, & McLeskey, (2010)
425
Wanat, C. L. (1999). Parental involvement in the implementation of school reform:
The basic school. Journal for a Just and Caring Education, 5(3), 318.
Warner, & Braun, (1998)
Westling, & Hobbs, (1998) Hobbs, T., & Westling, D. L. (1998). Promoting
successful inclusion through collaborative problem solving. Teaching
Exceptional Children, 31(1), 12-19.
Wilezenski, F. L. (1992). Measuring attitudes toward inclusive education.
Psychology in the Schools, 29(4), 306-312.
Wilma, (2009)
Winn, S., & Zundans, L. (2004). University and school connections: Enhancing
literacy development of primary aged children with challenging needs and the
skills of special education teachers in training. Special Education Perspectives,
13(1), 75-88.
Witt, J. C., Elliot, S. N., Daly, E. J., III, Gresham, F. M., & Kramer, J. J. (1998).
Assessment of special needs and at-risk students (2nd ed.). Madison, WI:
Brown and Benchmark Publishers.
Yin, R. K. (1989). Interorganizational partnerships in local job creation and job
training efforts: Six case studies, Final report. Washington DC: Cosmos Corp.
Yin, R. K. (1994). Case study research: Design and methods (2nd ed.). Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage.
Yin, R. K. (2003). Case study research: Design and methods (3rd ed.). Thousand
Oaks, CA: Sage Publications.
Yin, R. K., Bateman, P., & Moore, G. (1983). Case studies and organizational
innovation: Strengthening the connection. Washington DC: Cosmos Corp.
Yin, R. K., & Davies, D. (2007). Adding new dimensions to case study evaluations:
The case of evaluating comprehensive reforms. New Directions for Evaluation,
113(), 75-93.
Yin, R. K., & Moore, G. B. (1997). The use of advanced technologies in special
education: Prospects from robotics, artificial intelligence and computer
simulation. Journal of Learning Disabilities, 20(1), 60-63.
Ysseldyke, J. E. (1989). The future of research in special education. In J. B. Jordan
(Ed.), Special education yearbook (pp. 30-39). Reston, VA: The Council for
Exceptional Children.
Zahorik, J. A. (1984). Can teachers adopt research findings? Journal of Teacher
Education, 35(1), 34-36. doi:10.1177/002248718403500110
426
Zigmond, N., & Baker, J. M. (1996). Full inclusion for students with learning
disabilities. Theory Into Practice, 35(1), 26-34.
Zundans, L. (2007). Incorporating theory and practice: what works for university
students. ATEA, Wollongong.
427
Appendix one
Research to Practice Survey (part 1)
Personal Details Name: Age Range: 35-39, 40-44, 45-49, 50-54, 55-59,
60-65
Educational qualifications
(Please complete the fields in the table below)
Qualification Year attained University Duration
Employment Experience -Please begin with current school
(Please complete the fields in the table below)
Name of
employer/school
Years Grades
taught/
special needs
Responsibilities Executive
Position/Title
Are you currently at the school where your project was implemented? Y / N
Please provide a brief statement on the socio economic status of the community and
demographic details of the setting where your project was implemented.
Implementation Setting Details
428
School Name
Suburb
Primary / Secondary /
Other
Please list any other relevant implementation settings details
Please complete the table below
Year Number of
students at
the school
Number of
students
involved in
the project
Number of
staff at the
school
Number of
staff
involved in
the project
Number of
funded
students at
the school
Number of
funded
students
involved in
the project
2006
2007
2008
2009
429
Project Details Masters research based project title
Briefly describe why you selected this type of project for your setting
Please complete the project details by responding to all the fields in the table below
Year Number of
students involved
Year level Number of staff
involved
Was the project
generally
perceived to be
beneficial? Y/N
2006
Implementation
2007
2008
Beyond
(prediction)
If your project was viewed as beneficial please indicate who supported it or you and
how?
Did this support change over time? Y/N How did the support change?
430
Was there a body of research that was used to build this project (for example CBA,
CBM, Peer Tutoring)? Y/N Please give brief details
Was any training available for teachers, administrators or community members
involved in implementing the project? If so please provide details
Did the project include any materials or resources such as student materials,
checklists, teacher guidelines or manuals? Y/N If so please list them
Please describe any factors that assisted in your projects initial implementation
431
Project Details continued Clarification of operational conditions
Project extinct – Project terminated at the conclusion of the year
Partially sustained – Operational beyond year of implementation (course
requirement) however, project form was not fully consistent with project guidelines.
Sustained- Project continues to be utilized in the same capacity as it was in the
implementation year
Scaled within setting- project has been utilized with staff/ students beyond those that
were planned at the initial implementation year (within the same setting)
Scaled beyond setting- project has been utilized in settings beyond the original
implementation setting
Note implementation year refers to year the project was undertaken as a part of the
CSU course requirement.
Using the operational conditions defined above, please tick the box that best
describes your project status at the end of each year in the table below
Year Project
extinct
Partially
sustained
Sustained Scaled
within
setting
Scaled
beyond
setting
2006
2007
2008
2009
What evidence could be given to confirm project status each year? For example
participant surveys, standardized results etc.
Do you expect the outcomes/features of your project to continue in and beyond
2009? Y / N
Do you expect that your project outcomes/features would continue if you were no
longer at your project implementation setting? Y / N
432
Has the Principal or deputy principal changed since the project started? Y / N
Has this influenced the projects status? Y/N If so how?
Please describe any factors that positively or negatively impacted upon the status of your
project during the last three years (please include additional pages if required)
433
Research to Practice Survey (part 2)
Implementation Integrity Checklist (IIC)
Checklist Yes No N/A
1a. Did your project use a pre existing program with
guidelines or instructions (for example, CBM, CBA,
DIBELS)?
b. If so were they utilized?
c. Was there consistency in the implementation of those
features?
d. Were suggested project materials, such as workbooks or
manuals used throughout your project?
e. Were results collected and calculated in accordance with
guidelines or instructions provided?
f. Was the project evaluated using the guidelines or
instructions provided?
2a. Briefly describe how you maintained project implementation integrity during the
required CSU implementation?
b. and after the required CSU implementation period?
How was the project evaluated?
434
Investigation Categories Please respond with a 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 in each box of the following four tables
1- Always
2- Mostly
3- Sometimes
4- Rarely
5- Never
NA-Project is extinct
Please include additional pages if extended responses can be offered
Collaboration
2006
2007
2008
1.1 Were there opportunities for substantive and
frequent communication and interaction with other
stakeholders (e.g. project coordinators, staff
members, administrators, parents)?
1.2a Was responsibility of the project shared by all
stakeholders?
1.2b Was ownership of the project shared by all
stakeholders?
1.3 Was there a sense of mutual respect for the
project amongst stakeholders?
1.4 Were there mutually identified
a. boundaries,
b. structures and
c. purposes for the implementation and sustainment
of the project?
1.5 Was there engagement in pursuit of genuine
a. questions,
b. problems and
c. solutions amongst stakeholders?
1.6 Were stakeholder’s co operative?
1.7 Were system policy goals of your
implementation setting well aligned with the goals of
the project?
1.8 Were
a. norms,
b. expectations and
c. roles of the Masters students and CSU academic
staff mutually aligned in relation to the
implementation of the project?
1.9 Was there an awareness of individual strengths of
the stakeholders for the purpose of the project?
1.10 Was there an awareness of the changing needs
of the stakeholders throughout the project?
1.11 Was there a sense of partnership amongst the
various levels of stakeholders?
435
1.12 Were there opportunities for feedback across
multiple levels? Eg. Teachers, executive etc.
1.13 Were teachers provided with an opportunity to
contribute to the research project? Eg through
identification of need, design or implementation
1.14 Did the project create links between theory and
practice in your setting?
1.15a Were stakeholders united?
b. Were the intentions of the project understood by
all?
Key collaboration components
1.16 Please describe the level of stakeholder “buy in” (interest, involvement)
throughout the project?
1.17 Please describe the level of shared ownership of the changing elements or
features throughout the project?
1.18 Overall how would you describe collaborative efforts (working jointly towards
a common goal) throughout your project? Please include any features that you
believed supported or inhibited your project?
436
Please respond with a 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 in each box of the following four tables
1- Always
2- Mostly
3- Sometimes
4- Rarely
5- Never
NA-Project is extinct
Please include additional pages if extended responses can be offered
Support
2006
2007
2008
2.1 Were
a. instructional,
b. monitoring or materials available to stakeholders?
2.2 Was adequate time available to implement and
support the project?
2.3 Was leadership support ongoing?
2.4 Were well developed student materials available
to teachers?
2.5 Did support structures change as the needs of
individuals changed?
2.6 Was technology used as a support?
2.7 Were teachers sufficiently prepared to participate
in your project?
2.8 Were stakeholders able to seek assistance when
required?
2.9 Was there continuity in support?
2.10a Were opportunities for feedback from
participants woven into the project design?
b.Was feedback emergent (helped with what to do
next)?
2.11 Did the project leaders have an awareness of the
demands placed on practitioners?
2.12 Was there a team or a network that was
responsible for the projects implementation?
2.13 Were regular meetings held where stakeholders
could share experiences?
2.14 Did students or project participants whom the
project was designed to benefit, respond positively to
the project?
2.15 Did your peer cohort respond positively to the
project?
2.16 Did communication throughout the project
include staff from multiple levels?
2.17a Was the effort involved in bringing the project
to the school recognized in feedback on performance
437
from other stakeholders?
2.18 Was there clear evidence of school based
support for the project?
2.19 Was additional time allocated to stakeholders to
maintain the project?
2.20 Was student learning central to the project?
2.21 Was evaluation an emergent function (evolved
from actions) rather than an add on?
2.22 Was sufficient instructional time provided by
project leaders to ensure stakeholders were familiar
with project details?
2.23 Were stakeholders actively involved in the
project?
2.24 Was the project supported by research?
2.25 Were instructional leaders supportive of the
project?
Key support components
2.26 How were time and resources allocated throughout the project?
2.27 How was consistency in support maintained?
2.28 How were competing demands limited to achieve a balance of multiple
agendas?
438
2.29 Was there initial teacher enthusiasm? Y/N How was this supported, encouraged
or enhanced?
2.30 Please describe any other factors/features that supported or inhibited your
project (These may include ongoing feedback, shared responsibility, mutual
respect/positive student and per responses, pride in achievement or effective
communication).
439
Please respond with a 1, 2, 3, 4 or 5 in each box of the following four tables
1- Always
2- Mostly
3- Sometimes
4- Rarely
5- Never
NA-Project is extinct
Please include additional pages if extended responses can be offered
Responsiveness of Research
2006
2007
2008
3.1 Did the project provide
a. specific directions or
b. materials?
3.2 Was the project manageable for stakeholders to
implement?
3.3 Was the project supported by research based
evidence?
3.4 Was the project effective in the contexts of your
setting/application?
3.5 Was the project flexible enough to respond to the
changing needs of your setting?
3.6 Was the project consistently relevant to the needs
of the students and staff?
3.7 Was the project
a. practical,
b. feasible and
c. accessible to participants?
3.8 Was project data useful in addressing the needs
of your setting?
3.9 Were opportunities available for the development
of participants’
a. practical skills and
b. knowledge to support the project?
3.10 Did the project cater for the variance in staff
a. abilities and
b. needs?
3.11 Did the project respond to genuine teacher
concerns?
3.12 Was the project responsive to the needs of
classroom contexts?
3.13 Did the project have the potential to be scaled
beyond its initial planned implementation?
3.14 Was the project a good contextual fit (with your
implementation setting)?
3.15 Was the project valued by students?
3.16 Were the project features adopted effectively?
440
3.17 Did the project respond to the personal growth
in skills of stakeholders?
3.18 Would you describe your project as a process
rather than an event?
3.19 Would you describe your project as having the
potential for a school level design for a school level
influence?
3.20 Would you describe your project as self
reinforcing?
Key Responsiveness of Research components
3.21 How was the research responsive to perceived practitioner need?
3.22 How did the research make a practical difference to the needs of your students,
stakeholders and setting?
3.23 How was the research responsive to organisational demands of your setting?
3.24 Are the any other factors or features that contributed or inhibited your projects
responsiveness to the needs of your setting?
441
Please include additional pages if extended responses can be offered
Teacher Education (CSU Masters Course)
Always
Mostly
Sometimes
Rarely
Never
4.1 Was the teacher education project based on
a complete theoretical framework?
4.2 Was there consistency in
a. design and
b. implementation within and across all course
subjects?
4.3 Was the course design
a. adequate and
b. complete?
4.4 Did the course provide a useful
intersection of process and content?
4.5 Did CSU staff and CEO staff members
share
a. mutually aligned norms,
b. expectations
c. and roles?
4.6 Was the course structure
a. responsive and
b. cohesive?
4.7a Was there consistency in the marking of
all subjects?
4.7b Did the course provide effective delivery
of intended key components?
4.8 Did the teacher preparation experience
maintain flexibility to ensure project designs
could be responsive to unique educational
environments?
442
Key Teacher Education components
4.9 Were there any features of a theoretical framework /schema around which the
course was designed that assisted in the design and implementation of the project? If so
please outline them.
4.10 How was the course design responsive to practitioner needs and the needs of the
unique project settings?
4.11 How did the consistency in the design of subjects and their implementation influence
your project?
4.12 Did your project replicate or modify any feature of the course design? How?
(For example, the embedding of key ideas within and across subjects)
4.13 Please include any other comments about the ways in which the course design
and implementation positively or negatively impacted the status research project?
443
Appendix 2
Fisrt Interview Schedule
Open ended interview questions
1. Could you please briefly describe your project?
2. How was your project designed to meet the specific
needs of your setting?
3. What were the project’s objectives?
4. Did it meet these objectives? How? Or why not?
5. What is the current status? How did it change over time?
6. What factors influenced that status of your project over
the period of its implementation?
7. How did the master’s course influence the project? Were
there specific features that exerted an influence on your
project?
8. Did you replicate any aspect of the CSU course in your
setting?
9. Was there a sense that your efforts were making a
difference?
10. Were there any other factors that you feel may have
contributed to the status of your project?
11. Is there anything else you would like to add that
influenced the implementation or extinction of your
project?
12. To conclude, from your experience what would you say
are the main that factors influence the translation of
research into practice in inclusive education settings?
444
Appendix 3
Semi Structured Interview
Now that you have looked at the survey which identifies the literature based RTP
assertions, my aim is to try to get a deeper understanding of what processes and
structures unfolded at your school that contributed to the factors you identified in the
first interview and survey.
Collaboration Collaboration is a general and widely interpreted term. 1. How is collaboration structured at your school? 2. Can you describe any specific features/ examples of collaboration that promoted the project’s implementation? Was there anything that inhibited it? 3. How did examples of collaboration impact the sustainment or extinction of your project? Ask if the answer to your priority follow-ups do not emerge from the answers to the above questions What do you mean when you refer to collaboration in relation to this project? How did collaboration change throughout the project? What practical actions/features promoted collaboration with your settings? Was there anything that hampered collaborative efforts in your school?
Chapter 1. Support
The need for different types of support (including time, resources, peer, executive support) rated highly in interviews and survey. 4. How would you describe the supports at your setting? 5. How did your educational system support the project?
6. How could the education department support the use of research based projects in
our schools?
7. How did stakeholder “buy in” increase as the project success increased? Why?
8. Are there any specific types or levels of support that stand out in terms of the way the project was influenced? Ask if the answer to your priority follow-ups do not emerge from the answers to the above questions What school structures were in place to support the project and staff?
Leadership
Leadership has been presented as being a strong contributor to the projects status.
9. Please describe the leadership style of your principal?
10. How did this leadership style impact your project? Please give examples
445
11. In what ways did you provide a unique contribution to the implementation and
sustainment of the project? What characteristics, skills or strengths did you require to
do this?
Ask if the answer to your priority follow-ups do not emerge from the answers to the above questions What effect did leadership have in your setting?
How did it manifest in the organization in practical ways and how did it affect the
project?
Teacher Education
Increasing teacher knowledge of research has been suggested as being important to the practical applications of projects. 12. How did features of the CSU course have an impact on your knowledge and skill level in promoting the use of research based projects? 13. What aspects of the degree helped with the design and implementation of the project? 14. How was research based knowledge delivered to staff at your school? Was it then used by them? Ask if the answer to your priority follow-ups do not emerge from the answers to the above questions Is there any aspect of the course that you would change or modify?
Practical Implementation and Responsiveness of Research
15. How is technology used in your project?
16. How could technology be used to gather feedback about the project? How could
this happen formally? Informally?
17. What structures were in place to maximize the use of standardised results or research based knowledge? Did this change over time? 18. How did your setting address competing demands placed on teachers? How were workloads structured? Shared? 19. How would you describe the standing of this project in terms of the school's priorities? Has that changed over time? 20. How was the project given status and why? 21. How was the implementation of this project different from other projects you have experienced? Use? 22. How did “ buy in” increase as the project success increased? How did that impact upon the role of the project itself? 23. Feedback was also identified as a key factor. How was feedback incorporated into the design of your project? Ask if the answer to your priority follow-ups do not emerge from the answers to the above questions
446
How could the use of technological support further enhance your project? How
would you organise this differently for future projects? Why?
Can technology be used in a reinforcing way?
How was/is the projects implementation monitored to ensure integrity? What processes were/are in place if concerns re implementation arise/arose? A number of the factors associated with successful implementation were not so influential at the beginning so what catalyzed the project in the early stages of implementation? What features of your project elicited positive or negative staff attitudes? How did consistency in elements, processes or features of your project contribute to its status?
Other
How were you received as you introduced the project? Implemented the project?
Could you have enhanced this in any way?
What skills and knowledge would you suggest are critical for project co coordinators
to poses to ensure research projects are successfully implemented in schools?
447
Appendix 4
Focus Group Questions
Black are the main questions and blue are the prompting and deepening questions to use as required.
1. All 6 case studies identified the importance of shared responsibility and ownership
in implementing and sustaining RBP in schools. How can this be gained or scaled
up? Is there a process? Should there be?
2. Collaboration has also been cited as a critical factor in implementing and
sustaining RBP in schools. A comment was made about collaboration not always
being harmonious and the need to push boundaries in some communities of practice
to get things done. What can be done in schools to foster respectful disagreeing
without animosity? (transparent participatory process)
Intensity of focus and status have also been presented as a key priorities as they give
the project more traction....How do you maintain a collaborative culture with a
shared language, goals when the audience increases quickly?
Time is a key in the implementation phase...How can we expect administrators to
allocate time and resources at early stages when projects have not yet demonstrated
their value?
3. Voluntary teacher or stakeholder participation and student gain have been
suggested as key RTP components through literature based assertions as well as data
collected from this research. How do you ensure maximum student opportunity if
teacher participation is voluntary?
Often people really believe in or are passionate about something, they drive it but it
is hard to disseminate that passion to the whole school unless it is valuable...How
can you disseminate that passion amongst a team?
4. Familiarity, confidence and comfort in the program are also essential so that it is
not threatening. The program must address a real need. The key is determining
accurate needs and finding where stakeholders are at and moving forward....How is
this done with efficiency and accuracy?...How is real need established?
5. In all 6 cases leadership has been attributed with the ability to make or break RBP
in schools. Some comments about effective leaders indicate that they should be
flexible, approachable, be able to provide consistency in support, be a good
communicator, see things from multiple view points, be a team player and be
trusting. How can these attributes be fostered, enhanced or mandated in current or
future leaders?
6. An interesting comment was made in one case study about how effective
leadership is vital in driving the project without playing a main role. What could this
look like? How can effective leadership drive a project without playing a main role?
Attempting to have a discussion about dispersed control.
7. A number of you suggested the CSU course framework as being very effective in
providing a structure or scaffold to promote a depth of knowledge and success.
448
Specifically how did it make a difference to your project and how can this depth of
knowledge be transferred to other practitioners within schools?
How can you link university structures knowledge to schools to gain such a depth of
solid knowledge? What can you do to promote this type of practice knowledge at
school level?
Knowing why every element is included in a program is said to be important. It adds
to the depth and strength of programs. How many people do you think really
understand WHY they really implement specific programs or type of instruction?
Does this make a difference to a programs status?
8. Increasing parent knowledge has also been said to increase schools
accountability...How can school and system based accountability to implement and
maintain RBP be promoted?
9. What are the factors that influence the translation of research into practice in
inclusive education settings?